Operating Guidelines
Operating Guidelines
SULFUR BLOCK
NO. 2 AROMATICS COMPLEX
DAESAN, KOREA
OPERATING GUIDELINES
Prepared by
Ortloff Engineers, Ltd.
Midland, Texas USA
Project 507000
Fall 2011
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page i
1. INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................... 1-1
2. GENERAL SAFETY ..................................................................................................... 2-1
2.1 DEFINITION OF TERMS ....................................................................................... 2-1
2.2 HYDROGEN SULFIDE (H
2
S) ................................................................................ 2-3
2.2.1 Description and Properties ............................................................................. 2-3
2.2.2 First Aid .......................................................................................................... 2-7
2.2.3 Precautions (remember these facts) .............................................................. 2-8
2.2.4 Good Work Practices ...................................................................................... 2-9
2.3 SULFUR DIOXIDE (SO
2
) ..................................................................................... 2-10
2.3.1 Description and Properties ........................................................................... 2-10
2.3.2 First Aid ........................................................................................................ 2-13
2.3.3 Precautions ................................................................................................... 2-14
2.4 SULFUR .............................................................................................................. 2-15
2.4.1 Description and Properties ........................................................................... 2-15
2.4.2 Precautions ................................................................................................... 2-20
2.4.3 Fire Fighting .................................................................................................. 2-21
2.5 AMMONIA (NH
3
) .................................................................................................. 2-22
2.5.1 Description and Properties ........................................................................... 2-22
2.5.2 First Aid ........................................................................................................ 2-26
2.5.3 Precautions ................................................................................................... 2-26
2.6 METHYLDIETHANOLAMINE (MDEA, CH
3
-N-(CH
2
-CH
2
-OH)
2
) ........................... 2-28
2.6.1 Description and Properties ........................................................................... 2-28
2.6.2 First Aid ........................................................................................................ 2-29
2.6.3 Precautions ................................................................................................... 2-30
2.7 SODIUM HYDROXIDE (CAUSTIC SODA, NAOH) ............................................. 2-31
2.7.1 Description and Properties ........................................................................... 2-31
2.7.2 First Aid ........................................................................................................ 2-35
2.7.3 Precautions ................................................................................................... 2-36
2.8 SULFUR PLANT SAFETY ................................................................................... 2-37
2.8.1 Hydrogen Sulfide .......................................................................................... 2-37
2.8.2 Sulfur Dioxide ............................................................................................... 2-37
2.8.3 Sulfur Storage Tank ...................................................................................... 2-38
2.9 HOT WORK ......................................................................................................... 2-39
2.10 VESSEL ENTRY .................................................................................................. 2-39
2.11 PIPES AND LINES .............................................................................................. 2-41
2.11.1 General ......................................................................................................... 2-41
2.11.2 Before Breaking Lines .................................................................................. 2-42
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page ii
2.11.3 When Breaking Lines ................................................................................... 2-42
2.12 ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT ................................................................................ 2-42
2.12.1 Electrical Repairs .......................................................................................... 2-43
2.12.2 Grounding ..................................................................................................... 2-43
2.12.3 Conduit, Cables, and Wires .......................................................................... 2-43
2.12.4 Fuses ............................................................................................................ 2-43
2.12.5 Switching ...................................................................................................... 2-43
2.12.6 Hand Tools and Portable Equipment ............................................................ 2-44
2.12.7 Miscellaneous ............................................................................................... 2-44
2.13 BOILERS AND OTHER DIRECT-FIRED EQUIPMENT ...................................... 2-45
2.13.1 General ......................................................................................................... 2-45
2.13.2 Boilers ........................................................................................................... 2-45
2.13.3 Direct-Fired Equipment ................................................................................. 2-46
2.14 LABORATORY SAFETY ..................................................................................... 2-47
2.14.1 Good Housekeeping ..................................................................................... 2-47
2.14.2 Equipment .................................................................................................... 2-47
2.14.3 Chemical Sorting and Identification .............................................................. 2-47
2.14.4 Chemical Handling ....................................................................................... 2-48
2.15 MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEETS (MSDS) .................................................... 2-49
3. GENERAL .................................................................................................................... 3-1
3.1 ORGANIZATION ................................................................................................... 3-1
3.2 GENERAL PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................. 3-2
3.2.1 Mechanical ..................................................................................................... 3-2
3.2.2 Electrical ......................................................................................................... 3-3
3.2.3 Instrumentation ............................................................................................... 3-5
3.3 DESIGN BASIS ..................................................................................................... 3-7
3.3.1 Plant Capacity ................................................................................................ 3-7
3.3.2 Sulfur Block Feed Streams ............................................................................. 3-7
3.3.3 Effluent Stream Conditions ........................................................................... 3-12
3.3.4 Other Design Requirements ......................................................................... 3-13
3.3.5 Utility Information .......................................................................................... 3-14
3.3.6 Plant Site Conditions .................................................................................... 3-16
4. POWER DISTRIBUTION .............................................................................................. 4-1
4.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 4-1
4.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 4-1
4.2.1 General ........................................................................................................... 4-1
4.2.2 Hazardous (Classified) Areas ......................................................................... 4-1
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page iii
4.3 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION ................................................................................ 4-2
4.3.1 Motors and Motor Controls ............................................................................. 4-2
5. PLANT CONTROL SYSTEMS ..................................................................................... 5-1
5.1 DISTRIBUTED CONTROL SYSTEM .................................................................... 5-1
5.2 PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROL SYSTEM ................................................. 5-2
5.3 EMERGENCY SHUTDOWN SYSTEMS ............................................................... 5-3
5.4 LOCAL CONTROL PANELS ................................................................................. 5-3
6. UTILITY SYSTEMS ...................................................................................................... 6-1
6.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 6-1
6.2 SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................... 6-1
6.2.1 Nitrogen Supply .............................................................................................. 6-1
6.2.2 C4 LPG and Treated Fuel Gas Supply .......................................................... 6-2
6.2.3 Hydrogen Supply ............................................................................................ 6-2
6.2.4 Plant Air .......................................................................................................... 6-3
6.2.5 Instrument Air ................................................................................................. 6-3
6.2.6 Sour Water Disposal ....................................................................................... 6-3
6.2.7 Steam, Condensate, Boiler Feed Water, and Blowdown ............................... 6-4
6.3 PRECOMMISSIONING, STARTUP, AND SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES............. 6-8
7. AMINE TREATING & AMINE REGENERATION ......................................................... 7-1
7.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 7-1
7.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 7-1
7.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 7-2
7.3.1 General ........................................................................................................... 7-2
7.3.2 Water Washing ............................................................................................... 7-2
7.3.3 Sour Gas Contacting ...................................................................................... 7-3
7.3.4 Solvent Regeneration ..................................................................................... 7-3
7.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION ................................................................................ 7-6
7.4.1 Wash Water Column, A2-DA1510 .................................................................. 7-6
7.4.2 Amine Absorber, A2-DA1511 ......................................................................... 7-6
7.4.3 Flash Gas Contactor, A2-DA1512 .................................................................. 7-6
7.4.4 Stripper, A2-DA1513 ...................................................................................... 7-6
7.4.5 Wash Water Column Packing, A2-DB1510 .................................................... 7-7
7.4.6 Amine Absorber Trays, A2-DB1511 ............................................................... 7-7
7.4.7 Stripper Trays, A2-DB1513 ............................................................................ 7-7
7.4.8 Amine Absorber Overhead Cooler, A2-EA1510 ............................................. 7-8
7.4.9 Lean/Rich Exchanger, A2-EA1511A/B ........................................................... 7-8
7.4.10 Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1512A/B .................................................................. 7-8
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page iv
7.4.11 Stripper Reflux Condenser, A2-EC1511 ......................................................... 7-8
7.4.12 Lean Amine Cooler, A2-EC1510 .................................................................... 7-8
7.4.13 Wash Water Feed Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1510 ........................................... 7-8
7.4.14 Amine Absorber Feed Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1511 ..................................... 7-9
7.4.15 Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1512 ............................. 7-9
7.4.16 Rich Amine Flash Drum, A2-FA1513 ............................................................. 7-9
7.4.17 Stripper Reflux Accumulator, A2-FA1514 ..................................................... 7-10
7.4.18 Stripper Reboiler Condensate Pot, A2-FA1515A/B ...................................... 7-10
7.4.19 ATU Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1516 ................................................................. 7-10
7.4.20 ATU Skim Oil Pump Sump, A2-FA1517A/B ................................................. 7-10
7.4.21 ATU Amine Drips Tank, A2-FA1580 ............................................................. 7-11
7.4.22 MDEA Storage Tank, A2-FB1580 ................................................................ 7-11
7.4.23 Wash Water Filter, A2-FD1510A/B ............................................................... 7-11
7.4.24 Rich Amine Filter, A2-FD1511A/B ................................................................ 7-11
7.4.25 Lean Amine Filter, A2-FD1512 ..................................................................... 7-11
7.4.26 Lean Amine Carbon Filter, A2-FD1513 ........................................................ 7-12
7.4.27 Lean Amine After-Filter, A2-FD1514 ............................................................ 7-12
7.4.28 ATU Amine Drips Filter, A2-FD1580 ............................................................ 7-12
7.4.29 Wash Water Pump, A2-GA1510A/B ............................................................. 7-13
7.4.30 Lean Amine Pump, A2-GA1511A/B ............................................................. 7-13
7.4.31 ATU Skim Oil Pump, A2-GA1512A/B ........................................................... 7-13
7.4.32 Rich Amine Pump, A2-GA1513A/B .............................................................. 7-13
7.4.33 Lean Amine Booster Pump, A2-GA1514A/B ................................................ 7-13
7.4.34 Stripper Reflux Pump, A2-GA1515A/B ......................................................... 7-13
7.4.35 MDEA Transfer Pump, A2-GA1580 .............................................................. 7-14
7.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................. 7-15
7.5.1 Treated Fuel Gas H
2
S Analyzer ................................................................... 7-15
7.5.2 ATU Emergency Shutdown Systems ........................................................... 7-15
7.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ............................. 7-19
7.6.1 Amine Absorber Operation ........................................................................... 7-19
7.6.2 Stripper Operation ........................................................................................ 7-22
7.6.3 Amine Water Balance ................................................................................... 7-24
7.6.4 Amine Loss ................................................................................................... 7-27
7.6.5 Operation at Low Flow Rates ....................................................................... 7-29
7.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................................. 7-30
7.7.1 Preliminary Check-out .................................................................................. 7-30
7.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out ....................................................................... 7-31
7.7.3 Leak Testing the Process Piping and Equipment ......................................... 7-31
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page v
7.7.4 Washing the Wash Water System ................................................................ 7-33
7.7.5 Washing the Amine System ......................................................................... 7-38
7.7.6 Purging the Low Pressure Columns ............................................................. 7-50
7.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES .................................................................................. 7-52
7.8.1 Wash Water and Amine Systems ................................................................. 7-52
7.8.2 Sour Fuel Gas Flow to the Columns ............................................................. 7-53
7.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ............................................................................. 7-56
7.9.1 Planned Shutdown - ATU ............................................................................ 7-57
7.9.2 Planned Shutdown - ATU and ARU ............................................................. 7-60
7.9.3 Emergency Shutdown .................................................................................. 7-62
7.9.4 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems .................................. 7-63
7.10 ANALYTICAL PROCEDURES ............................................................................ 7-64
7.10.1 General Procedures for Analyzing ATU/ARU Solvent
,
................................. 7-64
7.10.2 Determination of Amine Concentration in ATU/ARU Solvent ....................... 7-68
7.10.3 Determination of Total Acid Gas Loading in ATU/ARU Solvent ................... 7-70
7.10.4 Determination of H
2
S and CO
2
Loading in ATU/ARU Solvent ...................... 7-72
7.10.5 Determination of Foaming Tendency of ATU/ARU Solvent .......................... 7-76
7.10.6 H
2
S Conc. in Amine Absorber Ovhd by the Tutweiler Method ..................... 7-78
7.10.7 H
2
S Conc. in Amine Absorber Ovhd Using Gas Detector Tubes ................. 7-79
8. SOUR WATER STRIPPING ......................................................................................... 8-1
8.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 8-1
8.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 8-1
8.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 8-2
8.3.1 General ........................................................................................................... 8-2
8.3.2 Sour Water Collection ..................................................................................... 8-2
8.3.3 Sour Water Stripping ...................................................................................... 8-3
8.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION ................................................................................ 8-5
8.4.1 Sour Water Stripper, A2-DA1520 ................................................................... 8-5
8.4.2 Sour Water Stripper Packing and Internals, A2-DB1520 ................................ 8-5
8.4.3 Stripper Trays, A2-DB1521 ............................................................................ 8-5
8.4.4 SWS Cross Exchanger, A2-EA1520 .............................................................. 8-5
8.4.5 Sour Water Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1521 ..................................................... 8-6
8.4.6 SWS Quench Water Cooler, A2-EC1520 ....................................................... 8-6
8.4.7 SWS Bottoms Cooler, A2-EC1521 ................................................................. 8-6
8.4.8 Sour Water Flash Drum, A2-FA1520 .............................................................. 8-6
8.4.9 SWS Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1522 .................................................................. 8-7
8.4.10 SWS Skim Oil Pump Sump, A2-FA1523A/B .................................................. 8-7
8.4.11 Sour Water Tank, A2-FB1520 ........................................................................ 8-7
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page vi
8.4.12 Sour Water Filter, A2-FD1520A/B .................................................................. 8-7
8.4.13 Sour Water Transfer Pump, A2-GA1520A/B .................................................. 8-7
8.4.14 SWS Feed Pump, A2-GA1521A/B ................................................................. 8-8
8.4.15 SWS Quench Water Pump, A2-GA1522A/B .................................................. 8-8
8.4.16 SWS Bottoms Pump, A2-GA1523A/B ............................................................ 8-8
8.4.17 SWS Skim Oil Pump, A2-GA1524A/B ............................................................ 8-8
8.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................... 8-9
8.5.1 SWS Shutdowns and Alarms ......................................................................... 8-9
8.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ............................. 8-11
8.6.1 SWS Stripper Operation ............................................................................... 8-11
8.6.2 Quench Water Circulation ............................................................................ 8-12
8.6.3 pH Control .................................................................................................... 8-13
8.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................................. 8-14
8.7.1 Preliminary Check-out .................................................................................. 8-14
8.7.2 Washing the Sour Water System ................................................................. 8-15
8.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES .................................................................................. 8-19
8.8.1 Initial Startup of the SWS ............................................................................. 8-19
8.8.2 Normal Startup of the SWS .......................................................................... 8-23
8.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ............................................................................. 8-29
8.9.1 Planned Shutdown ....................................................................................... 8-29
8.9.2 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems .................................. 8-31
9. SULFUR RECOVERY .................................................................................................. 9-4
9.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 9-4
9.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 9-4
9.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 9-5
9.3.1 Overview ......................................................................................................... 9-5
9.3.2 General ........................................................................................................... 9-6
9.3.3 Feed Gas Processing ..................................................................................... 9-6
9.3.4 Thermal Processing ........................................................................................ 9-7
9.3.5 Catalytic Processing ....................................................................................... 9-8
9.3.6 Air Control System .......................................................................................... 9-9
9.3.7 Molten Sulfur Handling ................................................................................. 9-10
9.3.8 Steam Production ......................................................................................... 9-10
9.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION .............................................................................. 9-11
9.4.1 Reactor Furnace, A2-BA1530 (A2-BA1540) ................................................. 9-11
9.4.2 Acid Gas Burner Assembly, A2-BA1531 (A2-BA1541) ................................ 9-12
9.4.3 Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1530 (A2-FA1540) ................................. 9-12
9.4.4 SWS Gas Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1531 (A2-FA1541) ................................ 9-12
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page vii
9.4.5 Reactor, A2-DC1530 (A2-DC1540) .............................................................. 9-13
9.4.6 Catalyst for Sulfur Plant Reactors, A2-MC1530 (A2-MC1540) ..................... 9-13
9.4.7 Acid Gas Preheater, A2-EA1530 (A2-EA1540) ............................................ 9-13
9.4.8 Sulfur Condenser, A2-EA1531 (A2-EA1541) ............................................... 9-13
9.4.9 Reactor No. 1 Feed Heater, A2-EA1532 (A2-EA1542) ................................ 9-14
9.4.10 Reactor No. 2 Feed Heater, A2-EA1533 (A2-EA1543) ................................ 9-14
9.4.11 Reactor No. 3 Feed Heater, A2-EA1534 (A2-EA1544) ................................ 9-15
9.4.12 Sulfur Surge Tank, A2-FB1530 (A2-FB1540) ............................................... 9-15
9.4.13 Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum Pump, A2-GA1530A/B (A2-GA1540A/B) .......... 9-16
9.4.14 SWS Gas Knock-Out Drum Pump, A2-GA1531A/B (A2-GA1541A/B) ......... 9-17
9.4.15 Sulfur Storage Tank Vent Ejector, A2-EE1530 (A2-EE1540) ....................... 9-17
9.4.16 Process Air Blower, A2-GB1530A/B (A2-GB1540A/B) ................................. 9-18
9.4.17 Air Blower Suction Screen/Silencer, A2-FD1530A/B (A2-FD1540A/B) ........ 9-19
9.4.18 Process Air Vent Silencer, A2-FG1530A/B (A2-FG1540A/B) ....................... 9-19
9.4.19 Sulfur Drain Seal Assembly, A2-ME1530A-D (A2-ME1540A-D) .................. 9-19
9.4.20 Refractory for Reactor Furnace and Waste Heat Boiler, A2-MR1530
(A2-MR1540) .............................................................................................................. 9-20
9.4.21 Ceramic Ferrules for Waste Heat Boiler, A2-MR1532 (A2-MR1542) ........... 9-20
9.4.22 Refractory for Waste Heat Boiler, A2-MR1533 (A2-MR1543) ...................... 9-20
9.4.23 Refractory for Sulfur Condenser, A2-MR1534 (A2-MR1544) ....................... 9-20
9.4.24 Refractory for Reactor, A2-MR1535 (A2-MR1545) ...................................... 9-21
9.4.25 Rainshield for Reactor Furnace, A2-ME1531 (A2-ME1541) ........................ 9-21
9.4.26 Ceramic Ferrule for Reactor Furnace, A2-MR1531 (A2-MR1541) ............... 9-21
9.4.27 Waste Heat Boiler, A2-BF1530 (A2-BF1540) ............................................... 9-22
9.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................. 9-24
9.5.1 SRU Air:Acid Gas Ratio Control Loop .......................................................... 9-24
9.5.2 Acid Gas Burner Management System ........................................................ 9-30
9.5.3 Process Air Blower Controls ......................................................................... 9-34
9.5.4 Reactor Furnace Temperature Control ......................................................... 9-39
9.5.5 Knock-Out Drum Pump Control .................................................................... 9-41
9.5.6 "Ride-Through" System Considerations ....................................................... 9-41
9.5.7 Boiler Low-Low Level S/D Transmitter Testing ............................................ 9-44
9.5.8 SRU Emergency Shutdown Systems ........................................................... 9-46
9.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ............................. 9-56
9.6.1 Equipment Damage ...................................................................................... 9-56
9.6.2 Cold Catalyst Bed Startup ............................................................................ 9-58
9.6.3 Sulfur Solidification ....................................................................................... 9-60
9.6.4 Ammonia Salt Formation .............................................................................. 9-61
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page viii
9.6.5 Catalyst Fouling ............................................................................................ 9-62
9.6.6 Operation of SRUs in Parallel ....................................................................... 9-62
9.6.7 Process air Blower Operation ....................................................................... 9-65
9.6.8 Reactor Furnace Temperature ..................................................................... 9-70
9.6.9 Ammonia Destruction Considerations .......................................................... 9-73
9.6.10 Sulfur Recovery Efficiency ............................................................................ 9-76
9.6.11 Operation at Low Flow Rates ....................................................................... 9-78
9.6.12 Pressure Drop Surveys ................................................................................ 9-82
9.6.13 Boiler Water Treatment ................................................................................ 9-84
9.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................................. 9-86
9.7.1 Preliminary Check-out .................................................................................. 9-86
9.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out ....................................................................... 9-87
9.7.3 Leak Testing the Process Piping and Equipment ......................................... 9-88
9.7.4 Purging the Inlet Knock-Out Drums .............................................................. 9-93
9.7.5 Commissioning Fuel Gas and Instrument Air to the Process ....................... 9-95
9.7.6 Commissioning Nitrogen to the Process ...................................................... 9-99
9.7.7 Commissioning the Sulfur Surge Tank Heating and Ventilation ................. 9-102
9.7.8 Pre-filling the Sulfur Drain Seal Assemblies ............................................... 9-104
9.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES ................................................................................ 9-105
9.8.1 Initial Firing / Refractory Cure-out ............................................................... 9-105
9.8.2 Amine Acid Gas Flow ................................................................................. 9-117
9.8.3 SWS Gas Flow ........................................................................................... 9-124
9.8.4 Routing SRU Tailgas to the TGCU ............................................................. 9-127
9.8.5 Normal Startup - Cold System .................................................................... 9-129
9.8.6 Normal Startup - Hot System ...................................................................... 9-146
9.8.7 Firing Supplemental Fuel Gas .................................................................... 9-158
9.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ........................................................................... 9-164
9.9.1 Planned Shutdown - No Reactor Entry ....................................................... 9-165
9.9.2 Planned Shutdown for Reactor Entry ......................................................... 9-170
9.9.3 Shutting Down When Boiler Tubes Are Leaking ........................................ 9-180
9.9.4 Emergency Shutdown ................................................................................ 9-181
9.9.5 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems ................................ 9-183
9.10 ANALYTICAL PROCEDURES .......................................................................... 9-187
9.10.1 Procedure for Sampling and Titrating with a Tutweiler Apparatus ............. 9-187
9.10.2 H
2
S Concentration in Acid Gas by the Tutweiler Method ........................... 9-189
9.10.3 H
2
S and SO
2
Concentration in Tailgas by the Tutweiler Method ................ 9-192
9.10.4 Tailgas Analysis Table ................................................................................ 9-196
9.10.5 Tailgas Analysis Operating Chart ............................................................... 9-197
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Table of Contents
Issued 30Aug11 Table of Contents Page ix
9.10.6 Essential Apparatus for Tutweiler Analysis ................................................ 9-199
9.10.7 Materials for Tutweiler Analysis .................................................................. 9-200
9.10.8 H
2
S and SO
2
Conc. in Tailgas Using Gas Detector Tubes ......................... 9-200
9.11 ADJUSTING STACKMATCH
.
2.2.1.8 Water Solubility
Hydrogen sulfide is soluble in water. At 60F (15C), approximately
3 parts (by volume) H
2
S will dissolve in one part water.
2.2.1.9 Other Characteristics
Hydrogen sulfide is soluble in liquid sulfur and many hydrocarbons.
Many porous materials, such as muds and residues, tend to absorb
hydrogen sulfide. Increased temperature or mechanical disturbance
tends to release the absorbed gas.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-6
2.2.1.10 Fire and Explosion Hazard
H
2
S is a dangerous fire hazard when exposed to an ignition source.
2.2.1.11 Life Hazard
Hydrogen sulfide is extremely toxic even in very low concentrations.
The maximum allowable concentration for continuous exposure
during an eight hour working day (per current OSHA regulations) is
10 parts per million by volume, or 0.001%.
Hydrogen sulfide poisoning is not cumulative like mercury, lead, and
some other materials. Repeated exposure to small doses will not
have the same effect as exposure to one long dose.
Hydrogen sulfide is highly irritating to the eyes and mucous
membranes. When inhaled, hydrogen sulfide is both an irritant and
an asphyxiant. Low concentrations of 20-150 PPM cause irritation of
the eyes; slightly higher concentrations may cause irritation of the
upper respiratory tract, and, if exposure is prolonged, pulmonary
edema may result. (Edema is a condition in which irritated tissues
swell, collect fluid, and slowly excrete a watery fluid, in this case into
the lungs or voice box.) The irritation action has been explained on
the basis that H
2
S combines with the alkali present in moist surface
tissues to form sodium sulfide, a caustic compound. (This compound
is used by the leather industry to help remove hair from animal
hides.)
With higher concentrations, the action of H
2
S on the nervous system
becomes more prominent. A 30 minute exposure to 500 PPM results
in headache, dizziness, excitement, staggering gait, diarrhea, and
dysuria, followed sometimes by bronchitis or bronchopneumonia.
The action on the nervous system is, with small amounts, one of
depression; in larger amounts, it stimulates; and, with very high
amounts, the respiratory center is paralyzed. Exposure to
800-1000 PPM may be fatal in 30 minutes, and higher
concentrations are instantly fatal. Fatal hydrogen sulfide poisoning
may occur even more rapidly than that following exposure to a
similar concentration of hydrogen cyanide. H
2
S does not combine
with the hemoglobin of the blood; its asphyxiant action is due to
paralysis of the respiratory center (which is usually the cause of
death).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-7
With repeated exposures to low concentrations, conjunctivitis,
photophobia, corneal bullae, tearing, pain, and blurred vision are the
most common findings. Higher concentrations may cause rhinitis,
bronchitis, and occasionally pulmonary edema. Exposure to very
high concentrations results in immediate death. Chronic poisoning
results in headache, inflammation of the conjunctivae and eyelids,
digestive disturbances, loss of weight, and general debility. H
2
S is a
common air contaminant. It is an insidious poison since sense of
smell may be fatigued and fail to give warning of high concentrations.
The following table from the U.S. Bureau of Mines represents the
degree of inhalation hazard with varying concentrations of hydrogen
sulfide:
HYDROGEN SULFIDE INHALATION HAZARDS
PERIOD OF EXPOSURE EXPOSURE
PPM PERCENT
Maximum allowable concentration for
prolonged exposure
10 0.001
Slight symptoms after exposure of several
hours
70-150 0.007-0.015
Maximum concentration that can be inhaled
for one hour without serious consequences
170-300 0.017-0.03
Dangerous after exposure of thirty minutes
to one hour
400-500 0.04-0.05
Fatal in exposures of thirty minutes or less 600 & above 0.06 & above
Concentrations exceeding 0.1% are considered rapidly fatal.
2.2.2 First Aid
Anyone overcome by H
2
S should be removed immediately to fresh air,
preferably a warm, well ventilated room. If breathing has stopped, begin
artificial respiration immediately. The arm lift-back pressure method of
artificial respiration is recommended. Since H
2
S paralyzes the respiratory
system, time is very important. Administer oxygen (or carbogen,
97% oxygen and 3% carbon dioxide) if available and if someone trained
with oxygen inhalation apparatus is present. Attempts to give oxygen by
someone unfamiliar with the use of the apparatus may result in the loss of
valuable time or may be harmful to the patient.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-8
For severe irritation of the eyes, hold the lids open and pour clean water
over the eyeball and lids (or use an eye irrigation fountain). Wash
thoroughly in this fashion for 15 minutes. A physician, preferably an eye
specialist, should be summoned immediately.
2.2.3 Precautions (remember these facts)
1. Odor is not a reliable test for the presence of hydrogen sulfide.
2. Since hydrogen sulfide is heavier than air, it settles when released
into the atmosphere and becomes more concentrated near the
ground and in low places.
3. Water at room temperature will dissolve approximately three times its
volume of hydrogen sulfide. Heating or agitation of the water will
cause the hydrogen sulfide to be released.
4. Hydrogen sulfide dissolves in liquid sulfur and is a hazard in storage
tanks and pits.
5. H
2
S is a serious fire and explosion hazard.
6. Low concentrations of hydrogen sulfide hinder the ability of an
individual to think clearly and function properly.
7. H
2
S concentrations higher than 0.06% can be fatal within 30 minutes
and concentrations higher than 0.1% are rapidly fatal.
8. In the Sulfur Block, H
2
S will always be present in the following
locations:
a. In most of the process gas streams.
b. In the rich and lean amine streams in the Amine Treating Unit.
c. In the rich and lean amine streams in the Amine Regeneration
Unit.
d. In the Sour Water Stripper liquid streams.
e. In the Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum and the SWS Knock-Out
Drum liquids, TGCU quench water, TGCU solvent, and the
TGCU Stripper reflux.
f. In the amine acid gas, the TGCU recycle gas, and the SWS gas
(the feed gases for the Sulfur Recovery Unit).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-9
g. In all of the Sulfur Recovery, Tailgas Cleanup, Tailgas Thermal
Oxidation, and Sulfur Degassing system process gases, with
the exception of the incinerated vent gas.
h. In the vapors from the molten sulfur storage tank.
2.2.4 Good Work Practices
Know the above facts and use caution when working around any
equipment that may contain H
2
S. If H
2
S will be a hazard in any operation:
1. Make adequate plans to cope with any situation that may develop.
2. Adequate respiratory protective equipment is essential; have it
available and use it. Persons who must work in an atmosphere
contaminated with H
2
S should use either a self-contained breathing
unit or a hose mask with a hand-operated blower.
3. Observe the wind direction. Stay upwind if possible and warn others
who may be downwind.
4. Keep ignition sources away from the area.
5. Two men should always be present when opening a flange or
performing any other work where the release of H
2
S is possible.
6. When one man is working in an area of potential H
2
S exposure, the
other man should concentrate on the wind direction and on the action
of the man performing the work. At the first sign of loss of
coordination or illogical action, the worker should be removed
immediately to fresh air. If a man is being overcome by H
2
S, he will
be outwardly sluggish and poorly coordinated (although inwardly he
will be peacefully unconcerned) and he will then begin illogical
actions as his mind begins to imagine things. Any sign of actions
that are out of the ordinary is a last minute warning.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-10
2.3 Sulfur Dioxide (SO
2
)
2.3.1 Description and Properties
2.3.1.1 General
Sulfur dioxide is a colorless, nonflammable, highly toxic gas.
2.3.1.2 Toxicity Information
LCLo: 400 PPM / 1 minute (death of humans after
inhalation)
LCLo (Lethal Concentration Low) is the lowest concentration of a
substance in air which has been reported to have caused death in
humans or animals. In other words, exposure to 400 PPM of SO
2
for
1 minute can cause death.
TCLo: 3 PPM / 5 days (pulmonary system effects on
humans after inhalation)
TCLo: 4 PPM / 1 minute (pulmonary system effects on
man after inhalation)
TCLo (Toxic Concentration Low) is the lowest concentration of a
substance in air to which humans or animals have been exposed for
any given period of time that has produced any toxic effect in
humans or produced a carcinogenic, neoplastigenic, or teratogenic
effect in animals or humans. In other words, exposure to 3 PPM SO
2
for 5 days or to 4 PPM SO
2
for 1 minute have both been reported to
have toxic effects on the human pulmonary system.
2.3.1.3 Permissible Exposure Limits
TLV: 2 PPM in air
TLV (Threshold Limit Value) is the highest level of exposure to a
toxic chemical at which no deleterious effect is noted. The American
Conference of Government Industrial Hygienists (ACGIH) has set
such levels for human exposure in industry. OSHA regulations set a
limit of 5 PPM TWA (Time Weighted Average) concentration for
continuous exposure during an eight hour working day.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-11
2.3.1.4 Odor
Sulfur dioxide has a pungent, suffocating odor that can be detected
at very low concentrations, 0.3 to 1.0 PPM, possibly by taste rather
than odor.
2.3.1.5 Physical Data
a. Melting Point: -104F (-76C)
b. Boiling Point: 14F (-10C)
c. Lower Explosive Limit: N/A (SO
2
will not burn)
d. Upper Explosive Limit: N/A
e. Auto-Ignition Temperature: N/A
f. Vapor Specific Gravity: 2.2 (heavier than air)
2.3.1.6 Reactivity Data
Sulfur dioxide is dangerously reactive with the following substances:
Formula Name
C
3
H
4
O acrolein
Al aluminum
CsHC
2
cesium hydrogencarbide
Cs
2
O cesium oxide
x-ClO
3
chlorates
ClF
3
chlorine trifluoride
Cr chromium
FeO ferrous oxide
F
2
fluorine
lithium acetylene carbide diammino
Mn manganese
KHC
2
potassium carbide
KClO
3
potassium chlorate
Rb
2
C
2
rubidium carbide
Na sodium
Na
2
C
2
sodium carbide
SnO tin monoxide
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-12
Sulfur dioxide is incompatible with the following substances:
Formula Name
halogens or interhalogens
LiNO
3
lithium nitrate
x-C
2
H metal acetylides
metal oxides
metals
polymeric tubing
NaH sodium hydride
2.3.1.7 Corrosivity Data
a. Dry SO
2
causes only mild corrosion of carbon steel and
stainless steel.
b. Wet SO
2
(sulfurous acid) is very corrosive to carbon steel and
most stainless steels. Certain alloy materials (Carpenter
20Cb-3
.
2.3.1.8 Water Solubility
Sulfur dioxide will dissolve readily in water to form a weak solution of
sulfurous acid (H
2
SO
3
). At 60F (15C), about 50 parts (by volume)
SO
2
will dissolve in one part water.
2.3.1.9 Fire and Explosion Hazard
None
2.3.1.10 Life Hazard
Like hydrogen sulfide, sulfur dioxide is extremely toxic in very low
concentrations. The serious life threat is through paralysis of the
respiratory system. The maximum allowable concentration for
continuous exposure during an eight hour working day (per current
OSHA regulations) is 5 parts per million by volume, or 0.0005%.
Sulfur dioxide is highly irritating to skin, eyes, and mucous
membranes. When inhaled, sulfur dioxide is very irritating and can
cause pulmonary distress. This gas is dangerous to the eyes, as it
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-13
causes irritation at 20 PPM and inflammation of the conjunctiva. It
has a suffocating odor and is a corrosive and poisonous material. In
moist air or fogs, it combines with water to form sulfurous acid, but is
only slowly oxidized to sulfuric acid. Concentrations of 6-12 PPM
cause immediate irritation of the nose and throat, while 0.3-1 PPM
can be detected by the average individual, possibly by taste rather
than by sense of smell. 3 PPM has an easily noticeable odor and
20 PPM is the least amount which is irritating to the eyes.
10,000 PPM is an irritant to moist areas of the skin within a few
minutes of exposure.
SO
2
chiefly affects the upper respiratory tract and the bronchi. It may
cause edema of the lungs or glottis, and can produce respiratory
paralysis. (Edema is a condition in which irritated tissues swell,
collect fluid, and slowly excrete a watery fluid, in this case into the
lungs or voice box.)
This material is so irritating that it provides its own warning of toxic
concentrations. 400-500 PPM is immediately dangerous to life, and
50-100 PPM is considered to be the maximum permissible
concentration for exposures of 30-60 minutes. Excessive exposures
to high enough concentrations of this material can be fatal. Its
toxicity is comparable to that of hydrogen chloride. However, less
than fatal concentrations can be borne for fair periods of time with no
apparent permanent damage. It is used as a fumigant, insecticide
and fungicide, and a chemical preservative food additive. It is a
common air contaminant.
2.3.2 First Aid
In cases of inhalation, remove the victim to fresh air and begin artificial
respiration immediately if breathing has ceased. The arm lift-back
pressure method of artificial respiration is recommended. If an oxygen
apparatus is available, oxygen (100%) should be administered only by
someone trained in the use of the apparatus. Preferably, oxygen should
be administered against a positive exhalation pressure of 1.25 inches of
water.
Oxygen inhalation must be continued as long as necessary to maintain
the normal color of the skin and mucous membranes. In cases of severe
exposure, the patient should breathe 100% oxygen under positive
exhalation pressure for 30 minute periods every hour for at least 3 hours.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-14
If there are no signs of lung congestion at the end of this period, and if the
breathing is easy and the color is good, oxygen inhalation may be
discontinued. Throughout this time, the patient should be kept
comfortably warm, but not hot.
For irritation of the eyes, flush them with large amounts of warm water for
at least 15 minutes. It is advisable to irrigate the eyes gently with water at
room temperature in order to minimize additional pain and discomfort.
Take the patient to a physician, preferably an eye specialist, at once.
2.3.3 Precautions
Special precautions should be observed when fighting sulfur fires. Sulfur
fires should be approached from an upwind direction if possible, and
respiratory equipment should be used in the case of larger fires or when
fires are in enclosed areas. SO
2
is always present in the following
locations:
1. In all of the Sulfur Recovery Unit process gases downstream of the
Reactor Furnace, up through and including the TGCU Reactor in the
TGCU Unit.
2. In the stack or flare gases in any process where sulfur or hydrogen
sulfide is being burned, including the Thermal Oxidizer.
3. In the vapors from the molten sulfur storage tank.
4. In the fumes from sulfur fires.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-15
2.4 Sulfur
2.4.1 Description and Properties
2.4.1.1 General
Sulfur is a yellow solid at normal ambient temperatures. However, it
is normally handled in bulk quantities in plant operations as a liquid.
2.4.1.2 Toxicity Information
Sulfur is nontoxic. Sulfur dust in air can produce irritation of the
human eye at concentrations of 6 PPM or above, resulting in its
classification as a nuisance dust. Repeated inhalation can cause
irritation to the mucous membranes.
2.4.1.3 Permissible Exposure Limits
There are no standards or regulations concerning sulfur.
2.4.1.4 Odor
Pure sulfur is odorless.
2.4.1.5 Physical Data
a. Melting Point: 246F (119C)
b. Boiling Point: 832F (444C)
c. Auto-Ignition Temperature: 450F (232C) for liquid sulfur
374F (190C) for sulfur dust
suspended in air
d. Flash Point: 405F (207C)
e. Liquid Specific Gravity: 1.8 (almost twice as heavy as
water)
f. Color Pure sulfur is bright yellow when
solid. Sulfur produced by Claus
sulfur plants may be contaminated
with hydrocarbons, causing the
color to be orange, green, tan,
brown, gray, or black. The color of
liquid sulfur ranges from bright
yellow to dark orange (almost red),
depending on its temperature.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-16
2.4.1.6 Reactivity Data
Sulfur can react violently with the following substances:
Formula Name
alkali metal nitrides
Al aluminum
Al + Cu aluminum + copper
Al + Nb
2
O
5
aluminum + niobium pentoxide
NH
3
ammonia
NH
4
NO
3
ammonium nitrate
NH
4
ClO
4
ammonium perchlorate
Ba(BrO
3
)
2
H
2
O barium bromate
BaC
2
barium carbide
Ba(ClO
3
)
2
H
2
O barium chlorate
Ba(IO
3
)
2
barium iodate
B boron
BrF
5
bromine pentafluoride
BrF
3
bromine trifluoride
Cd cadmium
Ca calcium
Ca(BrO
3
)
2
H
2
O calcium bromate
CaC
2
calcium carbide
Ca(ClO
3
)
2
calcium chlorate
Ca(ClO)
2
calcium hypochlorite
Ca(IO
3
)
2
calcium iodate
Ca
3
P
2
calcium phosphide
Ca + VO + H
2
O calcium + vanadium oxide + water carbides
Cs
3
N cesium nitride
C + impurities charcoal
ClO
2
chlorine dioxide
ClO chlorine monoxide
ClF
3
chlorine trifluoride
ClO
3
chlorine trioxide
Cr(ClO)
2
chromium oxychloride (chromyl chloride)
CrO
3
chromium trioxide (chromic acid) anhydride,
chromic
Cu + x-ClO
3
copper + chlorates
As
2
S
3
diarsenic trisulfide
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-17
Formula Name
Cl
2
O dichlorine monoxide
(C
2
H
5
)
2
O diethyl ether
fiberglass + iron filings
F
2
fluorine
halogenates
halogenites
halogens
Ag
7
NO
11
heptasilver nitrate octaoxide
C
x
H
y
hydrocarbons
In indium
interhalogens
IF
5
iodine pentafluoride
IO
5
iodine pentoxide
C lampblack (carbon black)
Pb(ClO
3
)
2
lead chlorate
PbCl
2
lead chloride
Pb(ClO
2
)
2
lead chlorite
PbCrO
4
lead chromate
PbO
2
lead dioxide (lead peroxide)
Li lithium
Li + NH
3
lithium dissolved in ammonia
Li
2
C
2
lithium carbide
Mg magnesium
Mg(BrO
3
)
2
6H
2
O magnesium bromate
Mg(ClO
3
)
2
magnesium chlorate
Mg(IO
3
)
2
4H
2
O magnesium iodate
Hg(NO
3
)
2
H
2
O mercuric nitrate
HgO mercury(II) oxide (mercuric oxide)
Hg
2
O mercury(I) oxide (mercurous oxide)
x-C
2
H metal acetylides of carbides
x-(ClO
3
)
n
metal chlorates
x-(zO
3
)
n
metal halogenates
x-O
n
metal oxides
metals
RbC
2
H monorubidium acetylide (rubidium acetylene
carbide)
Ni nickel
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-18
Formula Name
NO
2
nitrogen dioxide
Os osmium
oxidants
Pd palladium
x-(ClO
4
)
n
inorganic perchlorates
x-(MnO
4
)
n
permanganates
P phosphorus (phosphorus, red)
P
4
phosphorus, white (phosphorus, yellow)
P
2
O
3
phosphorus trioxide
K potassium
KBrO
3
potassium bromate (bromic acid)
KClO
3
potassium chlorate
KClO potassium chlorite (potassium hypochlorite)
KIO
3
potassium iodate
KNO
3
+ As
2
S
3
potassium nitrate (saltpeter) + arsenic sulfide
K
3
N potassium nitride
KClO
4
potassium perchlorate
KMnO
4
potassium permanganate
K + SnI
4
potassium + tin(IV) iodide (stannic iodide)
Rh rhodium
Rb rubidium
Se selenium
SeC
2
selenium carbide
AgBrO
3
silver bromate
AgClO
3
silver chlorate
AgClO
2
silver chlorite
AgNO
3
silver nitrate
Ag
2
O silver oxide
Na sodium
NaBrO
3
sodium bromate
NaClO
3
sodium chlorate
NaClO
2
sodium chlorite
NaH sodium hydride
NaIO
3
sodium iodate
NaNO
3
+ charcoal sodium nitrate + charcoal
Na
2
O
2
sodium peroxide
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-19
Formula Name
Na + SnI
4
sodium + tin(IV) iodide (stannic iodide)
SrC
2
strontium carbide
SrC
2
+ Se strontium carbide + selenium
SCl
2
sulfur dichloride
(C
6
H
5
)
4
Pb tetraphenyl lead
Tl
2
O
3
thallic oxide (thallium peroxide)
Th thorium
ThC
2
thorium carbide
Sn tin
U uranium
UC
2
uranium carbide (uranium dicarbide)
Zn zinc
Zn(BrO
3
)
2
6H
2
O zinc bromate
Zn(ClO
3
)
2
zinc chlorate
Zn(IO
3
)
2
zinc iodate
2.4.1.7 Corrosivity Data
Dry sulfur is not corrosive but in the presence of moisture it will
attack steel rapidly.
2.4.1.8 Other Characteristics
a. Both hydrogen sulfide and sulfur dioxide will dissolve in liquid
sulfur.
b. At temperatures up to about 317F (158C), the viscosity of
pure liquid sulfur decreases as the temperature increases. As
the temperature increases from 317F to 370F (158C to
188C), the viscosity of pure liquid sulfur rises rapidly to a
tremendously high maximum, causing the liquid to become a
dark, sticky, plastic material impossible to pump. However,
sulfur produced by Claus sulfur plants contains dissolved H
2
S
that lowers the viscosity of the molten sulfur so that fluidity is
not normally a concern, regardless of the temperature.
2.4.1.9 Fire and Explosion Hazard
a. Solid Sulfur
The primary hazard in handling solid sulfur results from the fact
that sulfur dust suspended in the air ignites easily. Even though
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-20
the explosion hazard is considered moderate, an explosion
occurring in a confined area could cause considerable damage.
Sulfur, being a very poor conductor of electricity, tends to
develop static electric charges when it is in motion. Ignition of
sulfur dust by static-caused sparks is not uncommon. Frictional
heat in equipment has also been responsible for starting sulfur
fires.
b. Liquid Sulfur
The fire hazards of liquid sulfur result primarily from the low
ignition point of sulfur and from the presence of hydrogen
sulfide.
2.4.1.10 Life Hazard
a. Solid Sulfur
Solid elemental sulfur is considered to be more of a nuisance
dust with a very low toxicity. Occasionally, sulfur dust will
irritate the inner surfaces of the eyelids.
b. Molten Sulfur
Molten sulfur is capable of inflicting severe burns.
2.4.2 Precautions
1. Employees operating equipment containing molten sulfur should
wear clothing capable of protecting the chest and arms, trousers
without cuffs, high top shoes, safety glasses with side shields, and
heat resistant gloves. When making connections or other changes in
molten sulfur piping, full-face shields (in addition to safety glasses)
and leather protective clothing may be needed.
2. Every reasonable step should be taken to minimize formation of dust
during the handling of solid sulfur.
3. Eliminate ignition sources where sulfur dust may be produced.
Enclosed areas are considered Class II hazardous locations
according to the United States National Electrical Code. Where
static electricity is a hazard, equipment should be grounded.
4. Eliminate ignition sources near liquid sulfur where H
2
S may be
liberated.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-21
5. Sulfur spills and drips should be cleaned up to avoid accumulations
of sulfur. Sulfur dust should never be allowed to accumulate in
buildings.
2.4.3 Fire Fighting
1. Small sulfur fires may be extinguished by smothering them with dirt
or sand or by using a fire extinguisher. Water is the most satisfactory
extinguishing agent but should be used as a fine spray or fog.
Steam smothering can be used in storage pits and in other relatively
small enclosures. Carbon dioxide is also a satisfactory fire
extinguishing agent.
2. Sulfur fires should be approached very carefully, from the upwind
side if possible, because burning sulfur emits highly toxic fumes of
sulfur dioxide.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-22
2.5 Ammonia (NH
3
)
2.5.1 Description and Properties
2.5.1.1 General
Ammonia is a colorless, flammable, toxic gas.
2.5.1.2 Toxicity Information
LCLo: 5,000 PPM / 1 minute (death of mammals after
inhalation)
LCLo (Lethal Concentration Low) is the lowest concentration of a
substance in air which has been reported to have caused death in
humans or animals. In other words, exposure to 5,000 PPM of NH
3
for 1 minute can cause death.
TCLo: 20 PPM (toxic and irritant effects on
humans after inhalation)
TCLo (Toxic Concentration Low) is the lowest concentration of a
substance in air to which humans or animals have been exposed for
any given period of time that has produced any toxic effect in
humans or produced a carcinogenic, neoplastigenic, or teratogenic
effect in animals or humans. In other words, exposure to 20 PPM
NH
3
has been reported to have toxic and irritant effects on humans.
2.5.1.3 Permissible Exposure Limits
TLV: 25 PPM in air
TLV (Threshold Limit Value) is the highest level of exposure to a
toxic chemical at which no deleterious effect is noted. The American
Conference of Government Industrial Hygienists (ACGIH) has set
such levels for human exposure in industry. OSHA regulations set a
limit of 50 PPM TWA (Time Weighted Average) concentration for
continuous exposure during an eight hour working day.
2.5.1.4 Odor
Ammonia has a pungent odor that can be detected at low
concentrations, 20 to 50 PPM.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-23
2.5.1.5 Physical Data
a. Melting Point: -108F (-78C)
b. Boiling Point: -28F (-33C)
c. Lower Explosive Limit: 15% NH
3
(by volume) in air
d. Upper Explosive Limit: 28% NH
3
(by volume) in air
e. Auto-Ignition Temperature: 1204F (651C)
f. Vapor Specific Gravity: 0.6 (lighter than air)
2.5.1.6 Reactivity Data
Ammonia is incompatible with the following substances:
Formula Name
C
2
H
4
O acetaldehyde
C
3
H
4
O acrolein
H
8
N
2
O
8
S
2
ammonium peroxo disulfate
Sb antimony
SbH
3
antimony hydride
B boron
boron halides
BI
3
boron triiodide
BrF
5
bromine pentafluoride
HClO
3
chloric acid
ClN
3
chlorine azide
ClO chlorine monoxide
ClF
3
chlorine trifluoride
x-ClO
2
chlorites
SiH
x
Cl
4-x
chlorosilane
CrO
3
chromium trioxide (chromic anhydride, chromic
acid)
CrCl
2
chromyl chloride
Cl
2
O dichlorine oxide
C
2
H
4
Cl
2
+ NH
3
(liq) ethylene dichloride + liquid ammonia
C
2
H
4
O ethylene oxide
Au gold
AuCl
3
gold (III) chloride
halogens
C
3
N
6
Cl
6
hexachloromelamine
H
4
N
2
+ Li, Na, etc. hydrazine + alkali metals
HBr hydrogen bromide (hydrobromic acid)
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-24
Formula Name
HOCl hypochlorous acid
H
2
O
2
hydrogen peroxide
Mg(ClO
4
)
2
magnesium perchlorate
Hg mercury
HNO
3
nitric acid
NO
2
nitrogen dioxide (nitrogen peroxide)
N
2
O
4
nitrogen tetraoxide
NCl
3
nitrogen trichloride
NF
3
nitrogen trifluoride
NO
2
Cl nitryl chloride
OF
2
oxygen difluoride
O
2
+ Pt oxygen + platinum
P
2
O
5
phosphorus pentoxide
P
2
O
3
phosphorus trioxide
C
6
H
3
N
3
O
7
picric acid
K + AsH
3
potassium + arsine
KClO
3
potassium chlorate
K
3
Fe(CN)
6
potassium ferricyanide
K
2
Hg(CN)
4
potassium mercuric cyanide
K + PH
3
potassium + phosphine
K + NaNO
2
potassium + sodium nitrite
Ag silver
AgCl silver chloride
AgNO
3
silver nitrate
Ag
2
O silver oxide
Na + CO sodium + carbon monoxide
S sulfur
SCl
2
sulfur dichloride
TeCl
4
tellurium chloride
tellurium hydropentachloride
(CH
3
)
4
N
2
COH
2
tetramethyl ammonium amide
SOCl
2
thionyl chloride
N
3
S
4
Cl thiotrithiazyl chloride
C
3
H
3
N
6
Cl
3
trichloromelamine
O
3
F
2
trioxygen difluoride
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-25
2.5.1.7 Corrosivity Data
a. Iron and carbon steel are recommended for ammonia service.
b. Moist ammonia will rapidly attack copper, tin, zinc, and their
alloys.
c. Mixtures of ammonia and hydrogen sulfide are often very
corrosive to carbon and stainless steels when wet. The
corrosivity appears to increase when hydrogen cyanide (HCN)
is present. (Hydrogen cyanide is a common contaminant in the
sour water processed in many refineries.)
d. Ammonia is considered to be non-corrosive to glass and
Teflon
.
2.5.1.8 Water Solubility
Ammonia will dissolve very readily in water. At 60F (15C), about
800 parts (by volume) NH
3
will dissolve in one part water.
2.5.1.9 Fire and Explosion Hazard
Ammonia is a low fire hazard when exposed to heat or flame
because it is difficult to ignite. It is a moderate explosion hazard
when exposed to flame or fire. Air-ammonia mixtures can detonate
in a fire.
2.5.1.10 Life Hazard
Ammonia is toxic in moderate concentrations. However, its pungent
odor will provide ample warning of its presence, so it is unlikely that
an individual would unknowingly become overexposed. The
maximum allowable concentration for continuous exposure during an
eight hour working day (per current OSHA regulations) is 50 parts
per million by volume, or 0.005%.
Ammonia is highly irritating to the eyes and mucous membranes.
When inhaled, ammonia is both an irritant and an asphyxiant, and
can cause respiratory distress. This gas is dangerous to the eyes,
as it causes irritation at 40-100 PPM. Prolonged exposure to
700 PPM or more can cause extensive injuries to the eyes - irritation,
hemorrhages, swollen lids, corneal ulcers, even partial or total loss of
sight. Ammonia will also irritate the skin, particularly if the skin is
moist, to the point of causing chemical burns from prolonged
exposure.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-26
The life hazard from ammonia is due to its damage to the lungs when
inhaled. This material is so irritating that it provides its own warning
well below toxic concentrations. Ammonia can usually be detected
at levels of 20-50 PPM. There will be noticeable irritation of the eyes
and nasal passages when exposed to 100 PPM, severe irritation of
the throat, nasal passages, and upper respiratory tract at 400 PPM,
and severe eye irritation at 700 PPM. At 1700 PPM, there will be
severe coughing and bronchial spasms, and an exposure of
30 minutes or less may be fatal. Concentrations of 5000 PPM and
above are fatal almost immediately, causing serious edema of the
lungs, strangulation, and asphyxiation. (Edema is a condition in
which irritated tissues swell, collect fluid, and slowly excrete a watery
fluid, in this case into the lungs.)
2.5.2 First Aid
Anyone overcome by ammonia should be removed immediately to fresh
air, preferably a warm, well-ventilated room. If breathing has stopped,
begin artificial respiration immediately (by trained personnel only). The
arm lift-back pressure method of artificial respiration is recommended. Be
aware that excessive force during artificial respiration will further injure the
lungs. Administer oxygen if available and if someone trained with oxygen
inhalation apparatus is present.
For severe irritation of the eyes, hold the lids open and pour clean water
over the eyeball and lids (or use an eye irrigation fountain). Wash
thoroughly in this fashion for 15 minutes. A physician, preferably an eye
specialist, should be summoned immediately.
2.5.3 Precautions
In this part of the complex, ammonia will usually be found mixed with
hydrogen sulfide. Ammonia will always be present in the following
locations:
1. In the process gas and liquid streams in the Sour Water Stripping
Unit.
2. In the Sour Water Stripper off-gas feeding the sulfur plant.
3. In the SWS Gas Knock-Out Drum liquids, the TGCU quench water,
and the TGCU Stripper reflux.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-27
4. In the overhead gas from the TGCU Stripper, and possibly in the
TGCU recycle gas.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-28
2.6 Methyldiethanolamine (MDEA, CH
3
-N-(CH
2
-CH
2
-OH)
2
)
2.6.1 Description and Properties
2.6.1.1 General
MDEA is a colorless, viscous liquid.
2.6.1.2 Toxicity Information
Ingestion of MDEA is moderately toxic, and may cause nausea,
vomiting, and abdominal discomfort. Single dose oral toxicity is low.
MDEA can cause moderate irritation of the eyes, with possible
corneal damage. Prolonged or repeated exposure can cause skin
irritation or burns. Inhalation of vapors is unlikely at room
temperature due to its low vapor pressure. MDEA at elevated
temperature may produce sufficient vapor to cause moderately
severe eye and upper respiratory irritation.
2.6.1.3 Permissible Exposure Limits
There are no standards or regulations concerning MDEA.
2.6.1.4 Odor
MDEA has a slight odor of amine.
2.6.1.5 Physical Data
a. Melting Point: -6F (-21C)
b. Boiling Point: 477F (247C)
c. Vapor Pressure: <0.01 mm Hg @ 68F (20C)
d. Flash Point: 260F (127C)
e. Lower Explosive Limit: not determined
f. Upper Explosive Limit: not determined
g. Specific Gravity: 1.042 (about the same as water)
h. Color: Clear to light straw color
2.6.1.6 Reactivity Data
MDEA is incompatible with strong oxidizers and strong acids. MDEA
should not be allowed to contact sodium nitrite (NaNO
2
) or other
nitrosating agents, as nitrosamines (suspected cancer-causing
agents) could be formed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-29
2.6.1.7 Corrosivity Data
a. MDEA and MDEA-water solutions are generally non-corrosive
to carbon and stainless steels.
b. Acid gas (H
2
S and/or CO
2
) dissolved in MDEA-water solutions
can cause appreciable corrosion of carbon steel, particularly in
areas subjected to erosion.
c. Copper, copper alloys, and galvanized steel should not be
exposed to MDEA. Aluminum should not be exposed to MDEA
at elevated temperatures.
d. Oxygen will degrade MDEA by forming corrosive organic acids.
e. MDEA is considered to be non-corrosive to glass, asbestos,
Teflon
, and EPDM.
2.6.1.8 Water Solubility
MDEA is completely soluble in water.
2.6.1.9 Fire and Explosion Hazard
MDEA is considered a slight fire hazard when exposed to heat or
flame.
2.6.1.10 Life Hazard
The toxicity of MDEA is low. Ingestion of MDEA can cause nausea
and vomiting. MDEA will irritate the skin and eyes, and can cause
damage to the eyes. If heated, sufficient MDEA vapor may be
evolved to irritate the nose and/or eyes.
2.6.2 First Aid
If large amounts of MDEA are ingested, induce vomiting, then take the
patient to a physician.
If MDEA vapors are inhaled, remove the patient to fresh air. A physician
should be consulted.
In case of eye contact, flush the eyes with large amounts of water for at
least 15 minutes. Take the patient to a physician, preferably an eye
specialist, at once.
In case of skin contact, flush the affected area with plenty of water. If
exposure has produced a burn, it should be treated like a thermal burn,
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-30
with treatment based on the physician's judgment. Contaminated clothing
should be removed and washed before reuse.
2.6.3 Precautions
1. When handling MDEA, employees should wear protective clothing
resistant to MDEA. The choice of gloves, boots, apron, or full-body
suit will depend on the tasks to be performed. Chemical-resistant
goggles should always be worn.
2. Good general ventilation should be sufficient for most operations. If
vapor concentrations are high, use local exhaust ventilators.
3. If irritation of the nose and/or respiratory system is experienced, use
an approved air-purifying respirator.
4. Minimize the exposure of MDEA to oxygen to avoid forming organic
acids.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-31
2.7 Sodium Hydroxide (Caustic Soda, NaOH)
2.7.1 Description and Properties
2.7.1.1 General
Pure sodium hydroxide is a white solid. When dissolved in water,
NaOH forms a clear, colorless or water-white, strongly alkaline liquid.
2.7.1.2 Toxicity Information
Sodium hydroxide has acute oral toxicity if ingested. It will cause
severe burns, including perforation and scarring, on the mouth,
throat, esophagus, and stomach, and death may result. Cases of
squamous cell carcinoma of the esophagus have occurred years
after ingestion.
Sodium hydroxide, both solid and in solution, has a markedly
corrosive action on all body tissues. Inhalation of dust or mist can
cause injury to the entire respiratory tract. The effects of inhalation
depend on the severity of the exposure, ranging from mild irritation of
the mucous membranes to severe pneumonitis. Contact with the
eyes may cause irritation and, with greater exposure, severe burns
and possible blindness. Skin contact may cause burns, frequently
with deep ulceration and scarring. Prolonged contact, even with
dilute solutions, can cause tissue damage.
2.7.1.3 Permissible Exposure Limits
TLV: 2 mg/m
3
in air (approximately 2 PPM by weight)
TLV (Threshold Limit Value) is the highest level of exposure to a
toxic chemical at which no deleterious effect is noted. The American
Conference of Government Industrial Hygienists (ACGIH) has set
such levels for human exposure in industry. OSHA regulations set a
limit of 2 mg/m
3
TWA (Time Weighted Average) concentration for
continuous exposure during an eight hour working day.
2.7.1.4 Odor
Sodium hydroxide has no odor, in pure form or when dissolved in
water.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-32
2.7.1.5 Physical Data
Solid Form
a. Melting Point: 608F (320C)
b. Boiling Point: 2534F (1390C)
c. Auto-Ignition Temperature: Not combustible
d. Flash Point: N/A
e. Specific Gravity: 2.1 (more than twice as heavy as
water)
f. Color: White
Water Solutions
25 wt% 50 wt%
a. Melting Point: -2F (-19C) 50F (10C)
b. Boiling Point: 232F (111C) 288F (142C)
c. Auto-Ignition Temp.: Not combustible Not combustible
d. Flash Point: N/A N/A
e. Specific Gravity: 1.27 1.53
f. Color: Colorless or
water-white
Colorless or
water-white
2.7.1.6 Reactivity Data
Adding water to sodium hydroxide or sodium hydroxide solutions
may cause localized overheating and spattering.
Under the proper conditions, sodium hydroxide can react violently
with the following substances:
Formula Name
C
2
H
2
O acetaldehyde
C
2
H
2
O
2
acetic acid
C
2
H
6
O
3
acetic anhydride
C
3
H
4
O acrolein
C
3
H
3
N acrylonitrile
C
3
H
6
O allyl alcohol
C
3
H
5
Cl allyl chloride
Al aluminum
ClF
3
chlorine trifluoride
CHCl
3
+ CH
3
OH chloroform + methanol
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-33
Formula Name
C
3
H
7
ClO
2
chlorohydrin (chlorhydrin)
C
7
H
7
ClO 4-chloro-2-methylphenol
C
7
H
6
ClNO
2
chloronitrotoluene
ClHSO
3
chlorosulfonic acid (chlorosulfuric acid)
C
9
H
8
O cinnamaldehyde
Cu copper
CN
4
cyanogen azide
B
2
H
6
diborane (boron hydride)
C
2
H
2
Cl
2
1,2-dichloroethylene
C
2
H
4
F
2
difluoroethane
C
3
H
5
NO ethylene cyanohydrin (hydracrylonitrile)
C
2
H
2
O
2
glyoxal
HCl hydrochloric acid (hydrogen chloride)
HF hydrofluoric acid (hydrogen fluoride)
C
6
H
6
O
2
hydroquinone
Mg magnesium
C
4
H
2
O
3
maleic anhydride
CH
3
OH + C
6
H
2
Cl
4
methanol + tetrachlorobenzene
C
7
H
7
NO
3
4-methyl-2-nitrophenol
3-methyl-2-penten-4-yn-1-ol
HNO
3
nitric acid
C
2
H
5
NO
2
nitroethane (forms shock-sensitive salts)
CH
3
NO
2
nitromethane (forms shock-sensitive salts)
CxH
2x+1
NO
2
nitroparaffins (forms shock-sensitive salts)
C
3
H
7
NO
2
nitropropane (forms shock-sensitive salts)
H
2
SO
4
SO
3
oleum (fuming sulfuric acid)
C
5
H
12
O pentol
P phosphorus
P
2
O
5
phosphorus pentoxide
C
3
H
4
O
2
-propiolactone (2-oxetanone)
strong mineral or organic acids
H
2
SO
4
sulfuric acid
C
6
H
2
Cl
4
1,2,4,5-tetrachlorobenzene
C
4
H
8
O tetrahydrofuran
Sn tin
C
2
H
3
Cl
3
O 1,1,1-trichloroethanol
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-34
Formula Name
C
2
HCl
3
trichloroethylene
CCl
3
NO
2
trichloronitromethane
H
2
O water
Zn zinc
Zr zirconium
2.7.1.7 Corrosivity Data
a. At ambient temperature, sodium hydroxide solutions will cause
only slight corrosion of carbon steel.
b. Carbon steel can experience caustic embrittlement and
intergranular corrosion when exposed to sodium hydroxide
solutions at elevated temperature. Stress relieving the carbon
steel after fabrication may reduce the susceptibility to this.
c. If sodium hydroxide solutions must be handled at elevated
temperatures, special resistant alloys should be used. Nickel
and copper are common components in such alloys.
d. Aluminum, tin, zinc, and their alloys are rapidly attacked by
sodium hydroxide solutions, and should not be allowed to come
in contact with NaOH.
e. Sodium hydroxide is considered to be non-corrosive to glass,
natural rubber, EPDM, and Teflon
.
2.7.1.8 Water Solubility
Sodium hydroxide will dissolve readily in water, with the amount
depending on the solution temperature. If a solution of sodium
hydroxide is cooled below its saturation temperature, it will
precipitate solid hydrates. At 60F (15C), sodium hydroxide will
dissolve in water to produce solutions exceeding 50 wt% NaOH.
2.7.1.9 Fire and Explosion Hazard
Sodium hydroxide and its water solutions are not flammable.
However, adding water to NaOH or solutions of NaOH can cause
localized overheating due to its heat of dilution.
Sodium hydroxide will generate gaseous hydrogen (which is
flammable and/or explosive) when in contact with aluminum, copper,
tin, zinc, and their alloys.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-35
2.7.1.10 Life Hazard
Sodium hydroxide will cause damage to any tissue it contacts. It is
acutely toxic if swallowed, causing severe burns and scarring to the
mouth, throat, esophagus, and stomach, and may lead to death.
Squamous cell carcinoma of the esophagus can occur years after
the exposure.
Contact with the skin, eyes, nose, or respiratory passages can result
in severe burns and scarring. In the case of eye contact, blindness
can occur rapidly.
2.7.2 First Aid
If swallowed, do not induce vomiting - this will cause further damage to the
throat and esophagus. Dilute by giving water to the patient immediately.
Vinegar, 1% acetic acid solution, citrus fruit juices, or 5% citric acid
solution may also be administered to help neutralize the alkaline solution.
Follow this with milk, egg white in water, or milk of magnesia. Keep the
patient warm and still, and summon a physician immediately.
If dust or mist is inhaled, remove the patient to fresh air at once. If
breathing has stopped, begin artificial respiration immediately. The air
lift-back pressure method of artificial respiration is recommended. Keep
the patient warm and still, and summon a physician immediately.
In case of eye contact, immediately begin flushing the eyes with large
amounts of water, preferably with an eye wash fountain. Continue
flushing for at least 15 minutes, forcibly holding the eyelids apart and
rotating the eyeball, to ensure complete irrigation of all eye and lid tissue.
A physician, preferably an eye specialist, should be summoned
immediately.
In case of skin contact, immediately flush the affected areas with large
amounts of water. If large areas of the body are contaminated, or if
clothing has been penetrated to the skin, immediately use a safety
shower, preferably removing clothing while under the shower. Continue
flushing the areas for at least 15 minutes. If available, follow the water
flush with a generous application of vinegar or 1% acetic acid solution to
neutralize the residual NaOH. After the acid treatment, apply a good
protective dressing as with any other burn and take the patient to a
physician. Contaminated clothing should be washed before reuse.
Contaminated leather articles (shoes, belts, etc.) should be discarded.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-36
2.7.3 Precautions
1. Employees should wear impervious rubber, neoprene, or vinyl
gloves, boots, and overalls or full-body suits, plus tightly fitting
goggles and face shields.
2. If dust or mist is present, use an appropriate respirator.
3. When diluting sodium hydroxide, use agitation (mixing) and add the
concentrated sodium hydroxide to water at a controlled rate to
control the heat of dilution and avoid spattering. Never add water to
sodium hydroxide.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-37
2.8 Sulfur Plant Safety
2.8.1 Hydrogen Sulfide
Hydrogen sulfide will be present in all of the process gas streams flowing
in the ATU, the SWS, the SRU, the SDU, the TGCU, and the Thermal
Oxidizer. The hydrogen sulfide content will decrease as the sulfur is
extracted from the gas stream and will reach its lowest concentration in
the incinerated vent gas. Some hydrogen sulfide will be dissolved in the
liquid sulfur produced. Review the characteristics of this poisonous gas
often, and be fully familiar with them.
Avoid all possibility of exposure to hydrogen sulfide. Plan and think
ahead, so that when there is a possibility of hydrogen sulfide release, you
will know what to do. Plant safety procedures should be established that
require the presence of at least two men before a flange is loosened, or
any other opening is created, to allow a possible H
2
S release. The man
doing the work should either wear a gas mask with canister, manufactured
specifically for hydrogen sulfide protection, or a fresh air pack. The
second man should stand on the side a few yards away, upwind, with the
oxygen supply in his hands.
If the job requires entering a vessel or enclosure which might contain
some hydrogen sulfide, a safety harness with lifeline shall be attached to
the man entering the vessel. Two men should remain outside the vessel
to pull the man who entered the vessel to safety if he should be overcome.
If a man who is working in a hydrogen sulfide exposure should begin
moving sluggishly or lose coordination, the man who is standing by should
remove him immediately to fresh air. Any sign of actions that are out of
the ordinary is a last minute warning. After an extended exposure, a man
will be unusually sensitive to even small concentrations of H
2
S gas.
2.8.2 Sulfur Dioxide
Sulfur dioxide will not be present within the SRU, the SDU, the TGCU unit,
and the Thermal Oxidizer as a pure gas but will be present in the
following:
1. Most process gas streams (reactor gases, tailgas, and stack gas).
2. Sulfur tank gases.
3. Smoke from any sulfur fire.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-38
The maximum allowable concentration in which it is safe to work is
5 PPM. Reactor gases, tailgas, and stack gas may have concentrations
up to 10,000 PPM and vapors from sulfur fires may have concentrations
up to 100,000 PPM.
The most likely source of sulfur dioxide in sufficient concentration to cause
problems is a fire in the sulfur storage tank. The simplest way to stop
such a fire is to smother it by covering all openings to the air, then putting
water into the storage tank. This water will vaporize to steam and help
smother the fire. Smothering a sulfur fire with plant steam is also
effective.
2.8.3 Sulfur Storage Tank
Molten sulfur produced in each SRU flows through the drain seals and is
stored in the sulfur surge tanks. These drain seals and tanks present a
combination of principle hazards.
2.8.3.1 Poisonous Gases
Hydrogen sulfide and sulfur dioxide are present in the vapor space
above the molten sulfur. They should not be inhaled as they are
extremely toxic.
2.8.3.2 Explosion and Fire
The surge tanks are equipped with steam-powered eductors to
provide ventilation of the vapor space. Each tank also has a
steam-jacketed stack that can provide natural-draft ventilation if its
eductor system is not functioning. These ventilation systems are
designed to sweep sufficient fresh air through the vapor space to
prevent hydrogen sulfide liberated from the sulfur from reaching
explosive concentrations. However, common sense dictates that no
ignition sources should be allowed near the tanks in case some
obstruction of the ventilation system should occur and allow an
explosive concentration of H
2
S to build up. Therefore, tools which
might cause a spark or open flame, should not be brought into the
area around the sulfur surge tanks without special review and
precautions, and smoking must be prohibited in the area.
Operators should be aware of the possible existence of an explosive
mixture in the sulfur surge tanks, as there is some history of
explosions in European sulfur pits and at least one U.S. pit. The
breather vents, where the air is sucked into the tanks, should be
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-39
checked regularly for adequate air flow. The motive steam supply to
the eductors, as well as the steam supply to and condensate from
the ventilation system jacketing, should also be monitored.
Sulfur fires may occur in the tanks. Molten sulfur has an auto-ignition
temperature of approximately 450F (232C). This is a spontaneous
reaction; no spark or flame is required. Steam system temperatures
are normally well below the auto-ignition point of sulfur. However,
some iron-sulfur corrosion compounds are unstable and can ignite,
or decompose, at lower temperatures to create localized hot spots
and sulfur burning.
SECTIONS 2.9 THROUGH 2.14 LIST SOME IMPORTANT SAFETY
CONSIDERATIONS THAT PERSONNEL SHOULD KEEP IN MIND WHEN
WORKING IN THE PLANT. THESE SECTIONS ARE NOT A COMPLETE LIST OF
SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS AND DO NOT OUTLINE COMPLETE OPERATING
OR MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES. ALL PERSONNEL SHOULD FOLLOW
THEIR EMPLOYER'S DETAILED SAFETY PROCEDURES FOR ANY WORK
DONE IN THE PLANT.
2.9 Hot Work
Any work which requires the use of equipment that is capable of being an
ignition source in an area where flammable vapors or materials may be present
is defined as "Hot Work". Examples of equipment considered as ignition
sources are: welding equipment, open lights, gasoline engines, grinders, etc.
"Hot Work" normally requires specific approval by plant management and
should be implemented by following detailed instructions for obtaining "Hot
Work" permits.
2.10 Vessel Entry
The procedures used for vessel entry shall be in conformance with ANSI Z117.1
(latest edition), the "American National Standard Safety Requirements for
Confined Spaces". The discussion in this section is a general information
supplement to ANSI Z117.1. In all cases, consult ANSI Z117.1 and any
applicable Samsung Total Petrochemicals policies for specific precautions and
procedures regarding each instance of vessel entry.
Vessel entry refers to any tank, vessel, equipment, or other enclosed place
where there is a hazard of: 1) a toxic, corrosive, or flammable substance;
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-40
2) insufficient oxygen; or 3) severe restrictions that would hinder escape or
rescue. Vessel entry normally requires specific approval by plant management.
Almost all of the vessels in this facility fit at least one of the three categories
mentioned above, due to the potential presence of hydrocarbon gas, caustic or
corrosive chemicals, or toxic H
2
S and SO
2
. All vessels should be assumed
unsafe for normal entry until prescribed vessel entry procedures have been
followed.
Consider the precautions advised for vessel entry when gauging tanks,
sampling, and blowing down lines or instruments.
Some or all of the following items should be considered for most vessel entry
jobs:
A. Disconnect and blank off all lines to the vessel.
B. Remove all sources of ignition before removing manway covers.
C. Check all internal lines and liquid traps to verify they are free of hazardous
liquid.
D. Clean the vessel as thoroughly as possible by draining, purging with inert
gas, steaming, ventilating, or other suitable means.
If steam is used, guard against static electricity by grounding the steam
nozzle. After steaming, allow the vessel to cool slowly. Sudden cooling
with water spray may cause a static electric charge. Also, it is not good
practice to allow the inside surfaces of the sulfur plant process piping and
vessels to become water wetted. Excessive corrosion occurs when
oxygen and water are present.
E. Test the Atmosphere for:
(1) Oxygen - The atmosphere must contain 19.5-23.5% oxygen and the
vessel should have adequate ventilation, either forced or natural.
(2) Explosive mixture - A vessel may not be entered if the testing
instrument indicates an air-vapor mixture that exceeds 10% of the
lower explosive limit, or the value specified in your organization's
safety procedures.
(3) Toxic fumes - The presence of any toxic fumes requires the use of
respiratory protective equipment, normally an air supplied mask with
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-41
hand blower, or a self-contained breathing unit; otherwise, additional
cleaning or purging of the vessel is indicated.
F. A safety harness and a lifeline shall be worn by the person entering the
vessel if respiratory equipment is required.
G. Personal protective clothing suitable for the job inside the vessel should
be worn.
H. An observer should be stationed outside the vessel. His duty should be to
watch the person inside the vessel. When respiratory equipment is
required for the person entering the vessel, the observer should also have
the suitable respiratory equipment available.
I. Fire extinguisher and other emergency equipment should be available as
required.
2.11 Pipes and Lines
In the discussion that follows, line breaking is defined as the opening of any line,
the contents of which are flammable, corrosive, toxic, or under high pressure.
All other line opening jobs or work are excluded from this definition. Line
breaking usually requires specific approval by plant management.
The following items should be considered in all work involving lines and valves:
2.11.1 General
1. Know the contents of each line being worked on.
2. Know the pressure ratings of the pipes and fittings. Never install low
pressure connections on high pressure lines.
3. Never hammer on high-pressure lines.
4. Use extreme caution when thawing frozen lines.
5. Never use fire to locate leaks of flammable materials.
6. Be very cautious when attempting to tighten steam pipe fittings while
pressure is on a line.
7. When opening valves, do so slowly to allow pressure to equalize
before opening the valve fully.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-42
8. When removing blinds, loosen bolts and allow any pressure to bleed
down. Gas sometimes leaks into the space between the blind and
the valve.
2.11.2 Before Breaking Lines
1. Drain the contents into a tank or to the lowest point.
2. Lock out, tag out, and try the pump. All gauges and sight glasses
should be checked for zero readings.
3. Close and tag the nearest upstream and downstream valves.
2.11.3 When Breaking Lines
1. Wear suitable personal protective equipment, such as full clothing.
At times, rubber suits should be worn to guard against chemical
splash. Goggles should be worn to protect eyes against chemical
splash and flying particles.
2. Always assume a line is full and under maximum possible pressure.
3. The placement of a deflector over the flange joint is usually desirable
for the initial "cracking" of flanges in lines containing corrosive or
toxic material.
4. The worker should slowly open the bolts on the far side, so that if
there is a spray it will be away from him.
5. Sections that have been removed should be handled carefully until
they are inspected for trapped material or residues and flushed if
required.
2.12 Electrical Equipment
Everyone recognizes that high voltages can be very dangerous. However,
some people fail to realize that so-called "low-voltage" can be hazardous and
under certain conditions can produce fatal injuries. Deaths have occurred
because of contact with circuits of less than 50 volts. It is not voltage but
amperage that kills. Under certain conditions, as little as 1/10 ampere is
sufficient to cause death. The following may be used as a guide when working
with electrical equipment.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-43
2.12.1 Electrical Repairs
When electrical equipment is to be repaired, switches must be locked
open, tagged, and the circuit "tried" to confirm the power is off. Working
on "hot circuits" normally requires the permission of plant management.
Refer to detailed plant tag-out procedures before proceeding.
2.12.2 Grounding
1. All electrical equipment is to be grounded.
2. If it is necessary to move any equipment, the ground should be
replaced before the equipment is used.
2.12.3 Conduit, Cables, and Wires
1. Electrical conduits should not be used to support other equipment.
2. Exposed ends of electrical wires must be taped.
3. Unused and abandoned electric wires must be removed or
disconnected at each end.
2.12.4 Fuses
1. Fuses should be replaced only by authorized personnel.
2. Fuse tongs and/or rubber electrical gloves should be used and the
disconnect should be opened. Rubber gloves must always be used
for voltages in excess of 150 volts.
3. Never use coins or tin foil in lieu of fuses.
4. Never use fuses of greater capacity than is specified by the
equipment manufacturer.
2.12.5 Switching
1. When starting electric motors, handle all switches according to
instructions. Make contact so as to prevent arcs. Stand in a safe
position.
2. Never pull a disconnect switch under load except in an emergency.
3. Always be certain that hands are dry and that the footing is dry when
operating switches or plugging in electrical appliances.
4. Keep rubber mats in front of switchboards where possible.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-44
5. Switch-panel fronts should be kept closed.
6. Maintain clear access to disconnects/switches.
2.12.6 Hand Tools and Portable Equipment
1. Extension lights without bulb protectors must not be used. Use only
low voltage lights with isolating transformers in boilers and similar
places.
2. All extension cords should be the grounded type. Before each period
of use, examine extension cords carefully for any failure of the outer
insulation, particularly at terminal points where the cord enters a plug
or a fixture.
3. Lights and tools should not be disconnected from an extension cord
while the other end of the cord is in a socket or receptacle.
4. The ground cable with which each tool is equipped should be
secured to a suitable ground before the tool is plugged into a source
of electricity.
2.12.7 Miscellaneous
1. Contact with electrical conductors should be avoided whether they
are energized or not.
2. Fenced sub-station areas should be entered only by authorized
personnel.
3. Faulty electrical equipment must not be used. Report it immediately.
4. Before changing broken light bulbs, be certain the current is turned
off.
5. No employee may work within 15 feet of a high voltage power line
except by special authorization of plant management.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-45
2.13 Boilers and Other Direct-Fired Equipment
2.13.1 General
1. In this facility, the Waste Heat Boiler, Sulfur Condenser, TGCU
Waste Heat Reclaimer, and Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler are
classified as boilers, but they are not direct-fired. The Reactor
Furnace and Thermal Oxidizer are the direct-fired pieces of
equipment.
2. Work on the Waste Heat Boiler, Sulfur Condenser, TGCU Waste
Heat Reclaimer, Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler, Reactor
Furnace, and Thermal Oxidizer should be approved as required by
local procedures.
3. Control valves should be operated only when necessary by the
operator in charge.
4. Refer to detailed vendor instructions for specific descriptions of
actual safety procedures and equipment on the direct-fired
equipment in this plant.
2.13.2 Boilers
2.13.2.1 Repair and Maintenance
a. Only boiler inspectors or the State boiler agency should
determine a new setting for safety relief valves. Seals on safety
relief valves should never be removed. If a valve leaks, remove
it to a Code-authorized shop for repairs.
b. Before entering a boiler fire box:
(1) Ventilate the fire box.
(2) Lock, tag, and try the blower valve.
(3) Blank or disconnect fuel gas lines.
c. Before entering the drum or shell:
(1) Feed water lines and blow-off lines should be blinded or
suitably locked.
(2) Blank the steam line between the stop valve and the
boiler.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-46
(3) If blinding is prevented by piping connections, non-return
and main stop valves should be locked and vents between
valves should be opened.
d. If valves are to be locked, the man entering the boiler shall
supervise the operations and retain the keys to the locks.
e. After repairs, examine the boiler carefully for tools and other
matter before replacing the manhole cover.
f. Before filling begins, all locks should be removed by the man, or
men, who have retained keys to the locks.
2.13.2.2 Operations
a. Open steam valves very slowly to allow cold lines to heat up
and water to drain out before pressure builds.
b. Open blow-off valves or cocks slowly. Before a boiler is blown
out, it is advisable to attain a high water level so that scale and
sediment can be blown out without lowering the water to a
dangerous level.
2.13.3 Direct-Fired Equipment
1. Before attempting to light burners, be certain that combustible gases
are purged from the system.
2. Stand to one side of openings when lighting burners.
3. Ignite each burner or pilot as described in operating instructions.
4. Observation ports should be used with care when lighting burners
because of the chance of high positive pressures and explosion.
5. Before entering a fire box:
a. Ventilate the fire box.
b. Lock, tag, and try the blower valve.
c. Blank or disconnect fuel gas and tailgas lines.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-47
2.14 Laboratory Safety
2.14.1 Good Housekeeping
1. Cleanliness and orderliness are essential to the operations of
laboratories.
2. A continuous program should be in effect to prevent the
accumulation of rubbish, rags, partly used samples, dismantled
equipment, etc.
2.14.2 Equipment
1. Inspect all gas hoses for leaks each day that they are used.
2. Extinguish all gas burners when they are not in use.
3. Glassware
a. Discard all cracked, broken, or scrap glassware.
b. Fire-polish all chipped edges on burettes, beakers, graduates,
etc.
c. Avoid thermal shock with all glassware.
d. Use only glass tubing with fire-polished ends.
e. Before attempting to insert glass tubing into stopper holes, be
certain that the holes are the proper size. Always moisten the
stopper hole and the glass tubing with water, and rotate the
glass tube as it is inserted, pushing it away from the body.
When rubber tubing or stoppers stick on glassware, cut them
away.
f. Do not drink or eat out of laboratory glassware.
2.14.3 Chemical Sorting and Identification
1. Adequately label or mark bottles and containers to identify the
chemical within.
2. Keep chemicals stored in their proper place. Solvents should not be
brought into laboratory in quantities greater than five gallons.
3. Keep volatile combustible liquids in safety containers and away from
direct flames or sources of heat.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-48
2.14.4 Chemical Handling
1. When handling acids or caustics in quantities, always wear protective
clothing and eye protection.
2. Always pour acids and caustics into water, never the reverse.
3. If acids or caustics enter the eye, flush with plenty of water and
report for first aid treatment.
4. Wash hands immediately after handling chemicals bearing poison
labels. Wash hands after handling mercury and clean up mercury
spills at once.
5. Use large quantities of water when disposing of acids or caustic
materials through the drains.
6. Refer to vendor information for specifics on the safe handling of
individual types of chemicals and first aid steps for accidents
involving them.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Safety Page 2-49
2.15 Material Safety Data Sheets (MSDS)
This section contains Material Safety Data Sheets (MSDS) for the hazardous
chemicals listed below that operating personnel in this part of the complex may
encounter while operating the unit and systems described in this manual. Of
necessity, these MSDS are generic in nature. As they become available,
Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co. should replace and/or supplement the
MSDS provided in this manual with those prepared by the manufacturers and/or
suppliers of the specific chemicals used in the complex.
A. Hydrogen Sulfide
B. Sulfur Dioxide
C. Sulfur
D. Ammonia
E. Methyldiethanolamine
F. Sodium Hydroxide
G. UOP/ESM S-2001 Sulfur Conversion Catalyst
H. Criterion 234 Tailgas Treating Catalyst
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
HYDROGEN SULFIDE
SECTION I - PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION
Substance: HYDROGEN SULFIDE CAS Number: 7783-06-4
Trade Names / Synonyms: Hepatic Gas; Hydrosulfuric Acid; Stink Damp; Sulfureted Hydrogen; Sulfur
Hydride
Molecular Formula: H
2
S Molecular Weight: 34.08
General or Generic ID: Inorganic Gas
SECTION II - COMPONENTS
Component: Hydrogen Sulfide Percent: > 99.0
Other Contaminants: Methyl Mercaptan; Carbon Disulfide; Oxides of Carbon and Sulfur
Exposure Limits: Hydrogen Sulfide
20 PPM OSHA acceptable ceiling concentration
50 PPM / 10 minutes OSHA peak
10 PPM ACGIH TWA
10 PPM ACGIH STEL
15 mg/m
3
(10 PPM) NIOSH recommended 10 minute ceiling
SECTION III - PHYSICAL DATA
Description: Colorless gas at atmospheric temperature and pressure, with the odor of
rotten eggs.
Melting Point: -122F (-86C) Boiling Point: -77F (-60C)
Liquid Specific Gravity: 1.54 Vapor Specific Gravity: 1.18
(water = 1.0) (air = 1.0)
Vapor Pressure: 294 PSI (20 atm) @ 78F (25C)
Odor Threshold: 0.05 PPM
Solubility in Water: 4.2 g/l @ 60F (15C), 3.2 g/l @ 78F (25C)
Other Solvents Carbon Disulfide, Weak Acids, Ethanol, Gasoline, Kerosene, Crude Oil, Liquid
Sulfur
Other Physical Data: Solubility decreases with increasing temperature or with mechanical
disturbance (agitation), causing evolution of dissolved gas.
ISSUE DATE: 06/12/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 1 OF 6
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
HYDROGEN SULFIDE
SECTION IV- FIRE AND EXPLOSION INFORMATION
Fire and Explosion Hazard: Highly flammable gas when exposed to heat, flame, or oxidizers.
Moderate explosion hazard. Gas-air mixtures are explosive. Vapors
are heavier than air, and may travel a considerable distance to a
source of ignition and flash back.
Auto-Ignition Temperature: 500F (260C) Flash Point Temperature: N/A
Explosive Limits in Air: Lower: 4.3% Upper: 46%
Extinguishing Media: Let burn unless leak can be stopped immediately.
(1984 Emergency Response Guidebook, DOT P 5800.3).
For larger fires, use water spray, fog, or foam.
(1984 Emergency Response Guidebook, DOT P 5800.3).
Fire-Fighting Procedures: Extinguish only if flow can be stopped; use water in flooding amounts
as fog. Apply from as far a distance as possible. Avoid breathing
poisonous vapors, keep upwind. Evacuate to a radius of 2500 feet for
uncontrollable fires. Evacuate downwind areas as required for leaks.
Fire-Fighting Phases: Stop flow of gas. Use water to keep fire-exposed containers cool and
to protect personnel effecting the shut off. (NFPA 49, Hazardous
Chemicals Data, 1975).
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA
Permissible Exposure Level: 10 PPM
Threshold Limit Value: 10 PPM
Health Effects from Exposure
Swallowing: Ingestion of a gas is unlikely.
Inhalation: Corrosive/Neurotoxin/Toxic. 300 PPM immediately dangerous to life or health.
Acute Exposure - Low concentrations may produce nasal and respiratory tract irritation.
At 50 PPM, anosmia, anoxia, headache, nausea, dizziness, vomiting, confusion,
weakness, ataxia, irritability, and insomnia may occur. Rhinitis, pharyngitis, coughing,
bronchitis, and pneumonitis are also possible. At 500-1000 PPM, coma, convulsions,
and death may occur within 30 minutes. At extremely high concentrations, respiratory
paralysis and death from asphyxia may be immediate. Non-fatal exposures may result
in sequelae including residual cough, cardiac dilation, slow pulse, peripheral neuritis,
albuminuria, amnesia, psychic disturbances, and permanent brain damage.
ISSUE DATE: 06/12/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 2 OF 6
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
HYDROGEN SULFIDE
SECTION V- HEALTH HAZARD DATA (continued)
Inhalation:
(continued)
Chronic Exposure - Prolonged or repeated exposure to low concentrations may cause
hypotension, nausea, anorexia, weight loss, incoordination, and chronic cough.
Prolonged exposure to 250 PPM has led to pulmonary edema.
Eye Contact: Corrosive.
Acute exposure - 50 PPM for one hour has caused conjunctivitis, pain, lacrimation,
photophobia, and appearance of haloes around lights. Within a few hours or days,
symptoms may progress to keratoconjunctivitis and vesiculation of the corneal
epithelium. Higher concentrations may cause severe irritation, lacrimation, and intense
pain.
Chronic Exposure - Prolonged or repeated exposure may cause conjunctivitis.
Skin Contact: Corrosive.
Acute Exposure - High vapor concentrations may cause severe irritation of the skin.
Chronic Exposure - A high incidence of furunculosis has been reported in industrial
hydrogen sulfide workers.
First Aid Measures
Swallowing: Treat symptomatically and supportively. Get medical attention immediately. If vomiting
occurs, keep head lower than hips to prevent aspiration.
Inhalation: Remove from exposure area to fresh air immediately. If breathing has stopped, give
artificial respiration. Maintain airway and blood pressure and administer oxygen if
available. Keep affected person warm and at rest. Administration of oxygen should be
performed by qualified personnel. Get medical attention immediately.
Eye Contact: Wash eyes immediately with large amounts of water, occasionally lifting upper and
lower lids, until no evidence of chemical remains (at least 15-20 minutes). In case of
burns, apply sterile bandages loosely without medication. Get medical attention
immediately.
Skin Contact: Flush affected areas with large amounts of water. Consult a physician for further
treatment.
Antidote: Amyl nitrite or sodium nitrite can be used to aid in the formation of sulfmethemoglobin,
thus removing sulfide from combination in tissues. Pyridoxine 25 mg/kg intravenously,
or 10% urea, 1 g/kg intravenously, has been suggested as a sulfide acceptor.
Administration of antidotes should be performed by qualified medical personnel. The
nitrite antidote is toxic; therapy is dangerous. (Dreisbach, Handbook of Poisoning, 11th
ed.)
ISSUE DATE: 06/12/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 3 OF 6
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
HYDROGEN SULFIDE
SECTION VI- REACTIVITY DATA
Reactivity: Stable under normal temperatures and pressures.
Incompatibilities: Acetaldehyde: Violent reaction.
Barium Oxide, Mercurous Oxide, and Air: Incandescent reaction or explosion.
Barium Oxide, Nickel Oxide, and Air: Incandescent reaction or explosion.
Barium Peroxide: Ignition reaction.
Bromine Pentafluoride: Fire and explosion hazard.
Chlorine Monoxide: Ignition reaction on contact.
Chlorine Trifluoride: Explosive reaction.
Chromic Anhydride: Incandescent reaction on heating.
Copper: Intense exothermic reaction.
Copper Powder: Intense reaction.
Diiron Trioxide Hydrate: Formation of combustible substance.
Fluorine: Ignition reaction.
Metals: Attacks most metals, especially in the
presence of water.
Metal oxides: Combustion, incandescent reaction, or
explosion.
Lead Dioxide: Combustion reaction.
Nitric Acid: Incandescent reaction.
Nitric Acid (Fuming or Concentrated): Violent reaction.
Nitrogen Trichloride: Explosive reaction.
Nitrogen Trifluoride: Formation of explosive mixture.
Nitrogen Triiodide and Ammonia: Explosive reaction.
Oxidants: Violent reaction.
Oxygen Difluoride: Explosive reaction on mixing.
Perchloryl Fluoride: Ignition or explosion at 100-300C.
Phenyl Diazonium Chloride: Formation of explosive substance.
Rust: Hydrogen sulfide may ignite if passed
through rusty iron pipes.
Silver Fulminate: Violent reaction at ambient
temperatures.
Soda Lime and Air: Incandescent reaction.
Sodium: Rapid reaction on contact with moist gas.
Sodium Peroxide: Violent reaction or ignition, even in the
absence of air.
Decomposition: Thermal decomposition products may include toxic and hazardous hydrogen, sulfur,
and oxides of sulfur.
Polymerization: Hazardous polymerization has not been reported to occur under normal temperatures
and pressures.
ISSUE DATE: 06/12/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 4 OF 6
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
HYDROGEN SULFIDE
SECTION VII- SPILL OR LEAK PROCEDURES
Steps to Be Taken in Case Material is Released or Spilled
Shut off ignition sources. Stop leak if you can do it without risk. Use water spray to reduce vapors.
Isolate area until gas has dispersed. No smoking, flames, or flares in hazard area! Keep unnecessary
people away; isolate hazard area and deny entry. Ventilate closed spaces before entering. Evacuate
area endangered by gas.
Waste Disposal Method
Water used to knock-down vapors is corrosive and toxic, and should be diked for containment. Add
suitable agent to neutralize to 7 pH prior to disposal.
SECTION VIII - PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Ventilation: Provide local exhaust or process enclosure ventilation to meet the published exposure
limits. Ventilation equipment must be explosion-proof.
Respirator: The following respirators and maximum use concentrations are recommendations by the
U.S. Department of Health and Human Services; NIOSH Pocket Guide to Chemical
Hazards or NIOSH Criteria Documents; or, Department of Labor, 29CFR1910,
Subpart Z.
The specific respirator selected must be based on contamination levels found in the work
place and be jointly approved by the National Institute of Occupational Safety and Health
and the Mine Safety and Health Administration.
Hydrogen Sulfide:
100 PPM - Supplied-air respirator.
Self contained breathing apparatus.
250 PPM - Supplied-air respirator operated in continuous flow mode.
Self-contained breathing apparatus.
300 PPM - Self-contained breathing apparatus.
Supplied-air respirator with full facepiece.
Escape - Air-purifying full facepiece respirator (gas mask) with chin-style or front-
or back-mounted canister.
Escape-type self-contained breathing apparatus.
ISSUE DATE: 06/12/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 5 OF 6
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
HYDROGEN SULFIDE
SECTION VIII - PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED (continued)
Respirator For firefighting and other immediately dangerous to life or health conditions:
(continued):
Self-contained breathing apparatus with full facepiece operated in pressure-demand
or other positive pressure mode.
Supplied-air respirator with full facepiece and operated in pressure-demand or other
positive pressure mode in combination with an auxiliary self-contained breathing
apparatus operated in pressure-demand or other positive pressure mode.
Clothing: Wear protective clothing. Prevent any possibility of repeated or prolonged vapor contact
with skin.
Gloves: Wear full protective gloves.
Eye Protection: Employee must wear splash-proof or dust-resistant safety goggles and a faceshield to
prevent contact with this substance.
Where there is any possibility that an employee's eyes may be exposed to this substance,
the employer shall provide an eye-wash fountain within the immediate work area for
emergency use.
SECTION IX - SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS OR OTHER COMMENTS
1. Odor is not a reliable test for the presence of hydrogen sulfide.
2. Since hydrogen sulfide is heavier than air, it settles when released into the atmosphere and becomes
more concentrated near the ground and in low places.
3. Hydrogen sulfide dissolves in liquid sulfur and is a hazard in storage tanks and pits.
Disclaimer
The information contained herein is believed to be accurate, but is not warranted to be, whether originating within the company or not. Health and safety precautions in this data sheet
may not be adequate for all individuals and/or situations. Recipients are advised to confirm in advance of need that the information is current, applicable, and suitable to their
circumstances. It is the end users responsibility to evaluate and use this product safely, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations. No statement made in this data sheet
shall be construed as a permission or recommendation for use of any product in a manner that might infringe existing patents. No warranty is made, either expressed or implied.
ISSUE DATE: 06/12/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 6 OF 6
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR DIOXIDE
SECTION I - PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION
Substance SULFUR DIOXIDE CAS Number: 7446-09-5
Trade Names / Synonyms: Sulfurous Acid Anhydride; Sulfurous Anhydride; Sulfurous Oxide;
Sulfur Oxide
Molecular Formula: SO
2
Molecular Weight: 64.06
General or Generic ID: Inorganic Gas
SECTION II - COMPONENTS
Component: Sulfur Dioxide Percent: > 99.0
Other Contaminants: Hydrogen Sulfide
Exposure Limits: Sulfur Dioxide
5 PPM OSHA TWA per 8-hour working day
2 PPM ACGIH TWA
0.5 PPM NIOSH recommended TWA
SECTION III - PHYSICAL DATA
Description: Colorless gas at atmospheric temperature and pressure, with an irritating,
suffocating odor.
Melting Point: -104F (-76C) Boiling Point: 14F (-10C)
Liquid Specific Gravity: 1.43 Vapor Specific Gravity: 2.21
(water = 1.0) (air = 1.0)
Vapor Pressure: 49 PSIA (3.3 atm) @ 70F (21C)
Odor Threshold: 0.47 PPM
Solubility in Water: 129 g/l @ 60F (15C), 102 g/l @ 68F (20C)
Other Solvents: Sulfur
Other Physical Data:
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 1 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR DIOXIDE
SECTION IV- FIRE AND EXPLOSION INFORMATION
Fire and Explosion Hazard: None
Auto-Ignition Temperature: N/A Flash Point Temperature: N/A
Explosive Limits in Air: Lower: N/A Upper: N/A
Extinguishing Media: Material is nonflammable. Use what is appropriate to the surrounding fire.
SO
2
will form a corrosive acidic mist with water fog or steam.
Fire-Fighting Procedures: Fire fighters must use full protective clothing, eye protection, and self-
contained breathing equipment when this material is involved in a fire
situation.
Fire-Fighting Phases: N/A
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA
Permissible Exposure Level: 5 PPM
Threshold Limit Value: 2 PPM
Health Effects from Exposure
Swallowing: Ingestion of a gas is unlikely.
Inhalation: Chiefly affects the upper respiratory tract and the bronchi, causing irritation, difficulty
with breathing, pulmonary edema, and, at high levels, respiratory paralysis. Short
exposures above 50-100 PPM can be dangerous, and, above 400-500 PPM,
immediately life threatening.
Systemic effects of acute or chronic exposure are not fully known. Statistical evidence
has been reported to show increased pulmonary function impairment at chronic SO
2
levels of 1-4 PPM. Mixture with smoke particulate or aerosols may increase the
hazards of SO
2
inhalation.
Eye Contact: At 20 PPM and above, irritation and inflammation of the conjunctiva.
Skin Contact: At 10,000 PPM, irritating to moist areas within a few minutes.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 2 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR DIOXIDE
SECTION V- HEALTH HAZARD DATA (continued)
First Aid Measures
Swallowing: Treat symptomatically and supportively. Get medical attention immediately. If vomiting
occurs, keep head lower than hips to prevent aspiration.
Inhalation: The victim must be carried at once to an uncontaminated atmosphere and effective
artificial respiration started immediately if breathing has ceased. Oxygen (100%)
should be administered (by trained personnel only) as soon as possible after a severe
exposure, preferably against a positive exhalation pressure of 1.25 inches of water.
Oxygen inhalation must be continued as long as necessary to maintain the normal
color of the skin and mucous membranes. In cases of severe exposure, the patient
should breathe 100% oxygen under positive exhalation pressures for 30 minute
periods every hour for at least 3 hours. If there are no signs of lung congestion at the
end of this period, and if the breathing is easy and the color is good, oxygen inhalation
may be discontinued. Throughout this time, the patient should be kept comfortably
warm, but not hot.
Eye Contact: If sulfur dioxide has contacted the eyes, they should be washed promptly with large
quantities of water for at least 15 minutes. Chemical neutralizers are not advisable. It
is advisable to irrigate the eyes gently with water at room temperature in order to
minimize additional pain and discomfort. Refer the victim at once to a physician,
preferably an eye specialist.
Skin Contact: On skin contact with sulfur dioxide, use an emergency safety shower at once. Clothing
and shoes contaminated with sulfur dioxide should be removed under the shower.
Sulfur dioxide should be washed off with very large quantities of water. Wash skin
areas with large quantities of soap and water. Do not apply salves or ointments to
chemical burns for 24 hours.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 3 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR DIOXIDE
SECTION VI- REACTIVITY DATA
Reactivity: Stable under normal temperatures and pressures.
Incompatibilities: Acrolein Manganese
Aluminum Metal Acetylides
Cesium Hydrogencarbide Metal Oxides
Cesium Oxide Metals
Chlorates Polymeric Tubing
Chlorine Trifluoride Potassium Carbide
Chromium Potassium Chlorate
Ferrous Oxide Rubidium Carbide
Fluorine Sodium
Halogens or Interhalogens Sodium Carbide
Lithium Acetylene Carbide Diammino Sodium Hydride
Lithium Nitrate Tin Monoxide
Polymerization: Hazardous polymerization has not been reported to occur under normal temperatures
and pressures.
SECTION VII- SPILL OR LEAK PROCEDURES
Steps to Be Taken in Case Material is Released or Spilled
Notify safety personnel of significant leaks. Exclude all from area except those assigned to leak and
spill control who are using full protective gear (see Section VIII). Provide ventilation. Locate and control
leakage.
Waste Disposal Method
If water is used to knock-down vapors, it will be corrosive and toxic, and should be diked for
containment. Add suitable agent to neutralize to 7 pH prior to disposal.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 4 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR DIOXIDE
SECTION VIII - PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Ventilation: Provide local exhaust or process enclosure ventilation to meet the published exposure
limits. (Treatment of exhausted air to remove SO
2
may be necessary before discharge
to the outside environment.)
Respirator: For fire fighting and other immediately dangerous to life or health conditions:
Self-contained breathing apparatus with full facepiece operated in
pressure-demand or other positive pressure mode.
Supplied-air respirator with full facepiece and operated in pressure-demand or
other positive pressure mode in combination with an auxiliary self-contained
breathing apparatus operated in pressure-demand or other positive pressure
mode.
(An approved cartridge respirator can be used when contamination is known to
be below 20 PPM.)
Clothing: Wear protective clothing. Prevent any possibility of repeated or prolonged vapor
contact with skin.
Gloves: Wear full protective gloves.
Eye Protection: Employee must wear splash-proof or dust-resistant safety goggles and a faceshield to
prevent contact with this substance.
Where there is any possibility that an employee's eyes may be exposed to this
substance, the employer shall provide an eye-wash fountain within the immediate work
area for emergency use.
SECTION IX - SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS OR OTHER COMMENTS
Disclaimer
The information contained herein is believed to be accurate, but is not warranted to be, whether originating within the company or not. Health and safety precautions in this data sheet
may not be adequate for all individuals and/or situations. Recipients are advised to confirm in advance of need that the information is current, applicable, and suitable to their
circumstances. It is the end users responsibility to evaluate and use this product safely, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations. No statement made in this data sheet
shall be construed as a permission or recommendation for use of any product in a manner that might infringe existing patents. No warranty is made, either expressed or implied.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 5 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION I - PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION
Substance: SULFUR CAS Number: 7704-34-9
Trade Names / Synonyms: Asulfa-Supra; Bensulfoid; Brimstone; Colloidal Sulfur; Cosan; Devisulphur;
Flowers of Sulfur; Ground Vocle Sulphur; Hexasul; Kumulus; Microwetsulf;
Precipitated Sulfur; Precipitated Sulphur; S-590; S-594; S-595;
Solid Sulfur; Solid Sulphur; Sublimed Sulfur; Sublimed Sulphur; Sulfex;
Sulfran; Sulphur; Uni350
Molecular Formula: S Molecular Weight: 32.06
General or Generic ID: Non-metallic Element
SECTION II - COMPONENTS
Component: Sulfur Percent: > 99.0
Other Contaminants: Hydrogen Sulfide, Sulfur Dioxide, Hydrocarbons, Carbon
Exposure Limits: The Nuisance Dust TLV should govern exposure to solid sulfur in the absence of
other standards:
10 mg/m
3
(8 PPMW) ACGIH TWA for total dust
5 mg/m
3
(4 PPMW) ACGIH TWA for respirable dust
Liquid sulfur may release hydrogen sulfide and/or sulfur dioxide as gases. Refer
to the specific Material Safety Data Sheets for these substances giving the
applicable exposure limits.
SECTION III - PHYSICAL DATA
Description: Solid sulfur is odorless, tasteless, yellow rhombic or monoclinic crystals, lumps,
granules, or powder. Sulfur contaminated with hydrocarbon or carbon may be
orange, green, tan, brown, or black in color. Liquid sulfur is viscous and odorless,
with a color ranging from bright yellow to dark orange (almost red) depending on
temperature. Contaminants (particularly hydrogen sulfide) sometimes give sulfur
the odor of rotten eggs.
Melting Point: 246F (119C) Boiling Point: 832F (444C)
Liquid Specific Gravity: 1.80 Solid Specific Gravity: 2.07
(water = 1.0) (water = 1.0)
Vapor Pressure: 0.05 PSIA (2.50 mm Hg) @ 400F (204C)
Odor Threshold: N/A
Solubility in Water: Negligible
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 1 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION III- PHYSICAL DATA (continued)
Other Solvents: Other Solvents:
Slightly soluble in Ethyl Alcohol; Ethyl Ether; Benzene; Toluene; Olive Oil.
Other Physical Data: At temperatures up to about 317F (158C), the viscosity of pure liquid sulfur
decreases as the temperature increases. As the temperature increases from
317F to 370F (158C to 188C), the viscosity of pure liquid sulfur rises rapidly to
a tremendously high maximum, causing the liquid to become a dark, sticky,
plastic material impossible to pump.
SECTION IV - FIRE AND EXPLOSION INFORMATION
Fire and Explosion Hazard: Solid - The primary hazard in handling solid sulfur results from the fact that
sulfur dust suspended in the air ignites easily. Even though the explosion
hazard is considered moderate, an explosion occurring in a confined area
could cause considerable damage.
Sulfur, being a very poor conductor of electricity, tends to develop static
electric charges when it is in motion. Ignition of sulfur dust by static-caused
sparks is not uncommon. Frictional heat in equipment has also been
responsible for starting sulfur fires.
Liquid - The fire hazards of liquid sulfur result primarily from the low ignition
point of sulfur and from the presence of hydrogen sulfide.
Auto-Ignition Temperature: 450F (232C) for liquid sulfur
374F (190C) for sulfur dust suspended in air
Flash Point Temperature: 405F (207C)
Explosive Limits in Air: Lower: 35 g/m
3
(2.9% by wt) Upper: 1400 g/m
3
(53% by wt)
Extinguishing Media: Small Fires: Water, dry chemical, soda ash, or sand.
(1987 Emergency Response Guidebook, DOT P 5800.4)
Larger fires: Use water spray, fog, or standard foam.
(1987 Emergency Response Guidebook, DOT P 5800.4)
Steam smothering can be used in storage pits and other relatively small
enclosures. Carbon dioxide is also a satisfactory fire extinguishing agent.
Fire-Fighting Procedures: Straight streams of water from a nozzle can scatter molten sulfur and
disperse sulfur dust into the air. Sulfur dust is a moderate explosion hazard
when dispersed in air. As sulfur burns, it generates sulfur dioxide, a toxic
gas. Wear self-contained breathing apparatus.
Unusual Hazards: Small dust explosions may disperse larger quantities of dust into the air,
resulting in a serious explosion, particularly in confined areas.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 2 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION V- HEALTH HAZARD DATA
Permissible Exposure Level: None indicated.
Threshold Limit Value: None indicated.
Health Effects from Exposure
Swallowing: Acute Exposure - A man has survived ingestion of 60 grams of sulfur over a period of
24 hours. Large doses (15 grams) by mouth may lead to hydrogen sulfide production
in vivo, chiefly due to bacterial action within the colon. Small particles are generally
more toxic than large ones. If high levels of impurities are present, sore throat, nausea,
headache, dullness, and possible unconsciousness may occur.
Chronic Exposure - In medicine, it is used as a laxative. No adverse effects have been
reported.
Inhalation: Irritant.
Acute Exposure - Inhalation of large amounts of dust may cause catarrhal inflammation
of the nasal mucosa which may lead to hyperplasia with abundant nasal secretions.
Tracheobronchitis is a frequent occurrence, with dyspnea, persistent cough, and
expectoration, which may sometimes be streaked with blood.
Chronic Exposure - Prolonged inhalation of dust may cause bronchopulmonary
disease which, after several years, may be complicated by emphysema and
bronchiectasis. Early symptoms in sulfur miners often include upper respiratory tract
catarrh, with cough and expectoration which is mucoid and may even contain granules
of sulfur. Asthma is a frequent complication. The maxillary and frontal sinuses may be
affected; involvement is usually bilateral and pansinusitis may occur. Pulmonary
function may be reduced. Radiological examinations have revealed irregular opacities
in the lungs and occasionally nodulation has been reported.
Eye Contact: Irritant.
Acute Exposure - 8 PPM has caused irritation of human eyes. Dust may cause
irritation, redness and pain with lacrimation, photophobia, conjunctivitis, and
blepharoconjunctivitis; cases of damage to the crystalline lens have been reported
with the formation of opacities and even cataract and focal chorioretinitis.
Chronic Exposure - Low levels may cause conjunctivitis. Higher levels may cause
symptoms similar to acute exposure.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 3 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA (continued)
Skin Contact: Irritant.
Acute Exposure - In highly purified form, the dust is low in irritation effects, but
frequently impurities of hydrogen sulfide are present and may produce irritation or
possibly burns.
Chronic Exposure - Soaps, ointments, gels, and drugs containing sulfur are used as
fungicides and parasiticides in the treatment of cutaneous disorders such as psoriasis,
seborrhea, eczema-dermatitis, and scalp disorders. Sulfur possesses a keratolytic
property which may be the basis of its therapeutic reaction. Prolonged local use of
sulfur may result in characteristic dermatitis venenata, possibly with erythematous and
eczematous lesions and signs of ulceration.
Molten sulfur - Capable of inflicting severe burns.
First Aid Measures
Swallowing: Give water or fluids. Emesis is not necessary. Treat supportively and symptomatically.
If irritation or digestive upset occurs, get medical attention.
Inhalation: Remove from exposure area to fresh air immediately. If breathing has stopped,
perform artificial respiration. Keep person warm and at rest. Get medical attention
immediately.
Eye Contact: Wash eyes immediately with large amounts of water, occasionally lifting upper and
lower lids, until no evidence of chemical remains (approximately 15-20 minutes). Get
medical attention immediately.
Skin Contact: Remove contaminated clothing and shoes immediately. Wash affected area with soap
or mild detergent and large amounts of water until no evidence of chemical remains
(approximately 15-20 minutes). Get medical attention immediately.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 4 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION VI- REACTIVITY DATA
Reactivity: Stable under normal temperatures and pressures.
Incompatibilities: Alkali Metal Nitrides: Highly flammable mixture which evolves
ammonia and hydrogen sulfide in contact with
water.
Aluminum Powder: Possible explosion if ignited with a magnesium
fuse.
Aluminum Powder: Violent reaction.
Aluminum and Copper: Possible explosion when heated in a closed
container.
Aluminum and Niobium Oxide: Ignition.
Ammonia: Possible formation of an explosive product.
Ammonia Nitrate: Possible explosion on impact.
Ammonia Perchlorate: Possible explosion on impact.
Barium Bromate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Barium Carbide: Ignites in sulfur vapor at 150C and incandesces.
Barium Chlorate: Possible spontaneous ignition at 108C. When
both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Barium Iodate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Boron: Incandesces at 600C.
Bromine Pentafluoride: Violent reaction with possible ignition.
Bromine Trifluoride: Incandescence on contact.
Cadmium: Vigorous reaction.
Calcium: Burns in the vapor at 400C. Explodes on
ignition.
Calcium Bromate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Calcium Carbide: Ignites in the vapor at 400C.
Calcium Chlorate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Calcium Hypochlorite Powder: Explosion if heated in closed vessel.
Calcium Hypochlorite: With damp sulfur, produces a crimson flash with
scattering of molten sulfur.
Calcium Iodate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Calcium Phosphide: Incandesces at 300C.
Calcium, Vanadium Oxide, and
Water:
Ignition.
Cesium Nitride: Intense reaction.
Charcoal, Freshly Calcined: Ignites spontaneously.
Chlorate and Copper: Probable explosion.
Chlorine Dioxide: Ignition and possible explosion.
Chlorine Monoxide: Violent explosion.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 5 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION VI - REACTIVITY DATA (continued)
Incompatibilities: Chlorine Trifluoride: Violent reaction with possible ignition.
(continued) Chlorine Trioxide: Possible violent reaction.
Chromic Anhydride: Ignition on heating, possible explosion.
Chromium Trioxide: Ignition on warming.
Chromyl Chloride: Ignition.
Copper: Attacked corrosively.
Copper Alloy: Attacked corrosively.
Diarsenic Trisulfide: Formation of explosion mixture.
Dichlorine Monoxide: Probable explosion.
Diethyl Ether: Possible explosion on evaporation.
Fiberglass and Iron Filings: Exothermic reaction above 125C.
Fluorine: Ignition at ambient temperatures.
Halogen Oxides: Possible explosion.
Heptasilver Nitrate Octaoxide: Explosion on impact.
Hydrocarbons: Explosive products produced on contact with
molten sulfur.
Indium: Ignition and incandescence on heating.
Interhalogens: Possible ignition or incandescent reaction.
Iodine Pentafluoride: Incandescence on contact.
Iodine Pentoxide: Explosive reaction on warming.
Lampblack: Spontaneous ignition.
Lead Chlorate: Possible spontaneous ignition at 63C.
Lead Chloride: Explosion.
Lead Chlorite: Explosion.
Lead Chromate: Pyrophoric mixture.
Lead Dioxide: Explosion.
Lead (IV) Oxide: Ignition on grinding or addition of sulfuric acid.
Lithium: When either is molten, explosively violent
reaction.
Lithium dissolved in Ammonia: Vigorous reaction, even at -33C.
Lithium Carbide: Burns in sulfur vapor.
Magnesium: Vigorous reaction with molten sulfur or its vapor.
Magnesium Bromate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Magnesium Chlorate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Magnesium Iodate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Mercuric Nitrate: Possible explosion.
Mercuric Oxide: Explosion when heated.
Mercurous Oxide: Ignition on light impact.
Mercury (I) Oxide: Ignition on frictional initiation.
Mercury (II) Oxide: Explosion on heating.
Metal Acetylides of Carbides: Possible ignition.
Metal Chlorates: Powerfully explosive, sensitive to friction or
shock.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 6 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION VI - REACTIVITY DATA (continued)
Incompatibilities: Metal Halogenates: Possible violent or explosive reaction.
(continued) Metal Oxides: Possible ignition or explosion on initiation.
Metals: Possible ignition or explosion.
Monorubidium Acetylide: Ignites in molten sulfur.
Nickel Powder: Ignition and incandescence in boiling sulfur or its
vapor at 600C.
Nitrogen Dioxide: Sulfur burns vigorously.
Osmium: Ignition and incandescence in boiling sulfur or its
vapor at 600C.
Oxidants: Possible ignition or explosion.
Palladium: Ignition and incandescence on heating.
Perchlorates (Inorganic): Explosive on impact.
Permanganates: Formation of an explosive mixture.
Phosphorus: Ignition or explosion.
Phosphorus, Red: Violent exothermic reaction or explosion.
Phosphorus, Yellow: Ignition or explosion on heating.
Phosphorus Trioxide: Violent reaction or explosion.
Potassium: Violent reaction on warming.
Potassium: Vapors of both react with chemiluminescence at
300C and low pressure.
Potassium Bromate: Unstable mixture which may ignite after several
hours. When both are finely divided, explosion
may occur with heat, percussion, or friction.
Potassium Chlorate: Ignition at 160-162C. When both are finely
divided, explosion with heat, percussion, or
friction.
Potassium Chlorite: Violent reaction.
Potassium Iodate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Potassium Nitrate and Arsenic
Trisulfide:
Pyrotechnic formulation.
Potassium Nitride: Highly flammable mixture which evolves
ammonia and hydrogen sulfide.
Potassium Perchlorate: Explosion on moderately strong impact.
Potassium Permanganate: Possible explosion on heating.
Rhodium: Ignition and incandescence on heating.
Rubidium (Molten): Ignition in the vapor at 200-300C.
Rubidium Acetylene Carbide: Ignition.
Selenium: Ignition.
Selenium Carbide: When heated, incandesces with the vapor.
Silver Bromate: Ignition at 73-75C. Explosive reaction in
presence of water.
Silver Chlorate: Possible spontaneous ignition. Ignition at 74C.
Silver Chlorite: Explosion on rubbing.
Silver Nitrate: Explosion on percussion.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 7 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION VI - REACTIVITY DATA (continued)
Incompatibilities: Silver Oxide: Ignition on grinding.
(Continued) Sodium: Violent or explosive reaction with heat or friction.
Sodium Bromate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Sodium Chlorate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Sodium Chlorite: Ignition in presence of water.
Sodium Hydride: Vigorous reaction with vapors.
Sodium Iodate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Sodium Nitrate and Charcoal: Explosion.
Sodium Peroxide: Explosive mixture.
Stannic Iodide and Potassium: Explosion on impact.
Stannic Iodide and Sodium: Explosion on impact.
Static Discharges: Easily ignited due to very low minimum ignition
energy.
Steel: Attacked corrosively in presence of moisture.
Strontium Carbide: Incandescence or ignition in vapors about 500C.
Strontium Carbide and Selenium: Incandescence at 500C.
Sulfur Dichloride: Very violent explosion on impact.
Tetraphenyllead: Possible explosion.
Thallic Oxide: Explosion on grinding.
Thorium: Ignition and incandescence with heating.
Thorium Carbide: Incandesces when heated. Ignites in the vapors
about 500C.
Tin: Vigorous reaction with incandescence. Ignition
on heating.
Uranium: Incandescence and ignition with boiling sulfur or
its vapor.
Uranium Carbide: Ignition in the vapors about 500C.
Zinc Bromate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Zinc Chlorate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Zinc Iodate: When both are finely divided, explosion with heat,
percussion, or friction.
Zinc Powder: Explosive reaction on warming.
Decomposition: Combustion may release toxic oxides of sulfur, some of which may react with air and
moisture to produce corrosive sulfurous and sulfuric acids. Toxic and corrosive
hydrogen sulfide may be generated by molten sulfur.
Polymerization: Hazardous polymerization has not been reported to occur under normal temperatures
and pressures.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 8 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION VII- SPILL OR LEAK PROCEDURES
Steps to Be Taken in Case Material is Released or Spilled
Small Spill: Shut off ignition sources. Do not touch spilled material. With clean shovel, place material
into clean, dry container and cover; move containers from spill area.
Large Spill: Shut off ignition sources. Do not touch spilled material. Wet down with water and dike
for later disposal. No smoking, flames, or flares in hazard area! Keep unnecessary
people away. Isolate hazard area and deny entry.
Waste Disposal Method
Waste should be mixed with four times its weight of crushed limestone, marble, or shell, and then buried
at a permitted disposal site.
SECTION VIII- PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Ventilation: Provide local exhaust or process enclosure ventilation to meet the published exposure
limits. Ventilation equipment must be explosion-proof.
Respirator: In routine handling of molten sulfur in adequately ventilated premises, respiratory
protective equipment is not required, but should be available nearby.
For areas containing sulfur dust, the specific respirator selected must be based on the
contamination levels found in the work place, must not exceed the working limits of
the respirator, and be jointly approved by the National Institute for Occupational Safety
and Health and the Mine Safety and Health Administration.
The following respirators are recommended based on the data found in the Physical
Data and Health Hazard Data sections. They are ranked in order from minimum to
maximum respiratory protection:
Chemical cartridge respirator with an organic vapor cartridge(s) with a high-
efficiency particulate filter and full facepiece.
High-efficiency particulate respirator with a full facepiece.
Powered air-purifying respirator with a high-efficiency filter with a full facepiece.
Type "C" supplied-air respirator with a full facepiece operated in
pressure-demand or other positive pressure mode, or with a full facepiece,
helmet, or hood operated in continuous-flow mode.
Self-contained breathing apparatus with a full facepiece operated in
pressure-demand or other positive pressure mode.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 9 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SULFUR
SECTION VIII- PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Respirator: For firefighting and other immediately dangerous to life or health conditions:
(continued)
Self-contained breathing apparatus with a full facepiece operated in
pressure-demand or other positive pressure mode.
Supplied-air respirator with a full facepiece operated in pressure-demand or other
positive pressure mode in combination with an auxiliary self-contained breathing
apparatus operated in pressure-demand or other positive pressure mode.
Clothing: Employees operating equipment containing molten sulfur should wear clothing capable
of protecting the chest and arms, trousers without cuffs, and high-top shoes. When
making connections or other changes in molten sulfur piping, leather protective clothing
may be needed.
Gloves: Employee must wear heat-resistant gloves when working with molten sulfur.
Eye Protection: Employee must wear splash-proof or dust-resistant safety goggles to prevent eye
contact with this substance. When making connections or other changes in molten
sulfur piping, full face shields (in addition to safety glasses or goggles) should be worn.
SECTION IX - SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS OR OTHER COMMENTS
Disclaimer
The information contained herein is believed to be accurate, but is not warranted to be, whether originating within the company or not. Health and safety precautions in this data sheet
may not be adequate for all individuals and/or situations. Recipients are advised to confirm in advance of need that the information is current, applicable, and suitable to their
circumstances. It is the end users responsibility to evaluate and use this product safely, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations. No statement made in this data sheet
shall be construed as a permission or recommendation for use of any product in a manner that might infringe existing patents. No warranty is made, either expressed or implied.
ISSUE DATE: 06/13/95 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 10 OF 10
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
AMMONIA
SECTION I - PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION
Substance: AMMONIA CAS Number: 7664-41-7
Trade Names / Synonyms: Ammonia Anhydrous; Ammonia Gas; Spirit of Hartshorn
Molecular Formula: NH
3
Molecular Weight: 17.03
General or Generic ID: Inorganic Gas
SECTION II - COMPONENTS
Component: Ammonia Percent: > 99.0
Other Contaminants:
Exposure Limits: Ammonia
50 PPM OSHA TWA per 8-hour working day
35 PPM ACGIH STEL
50 PPM NIOSH recommended 5 minute ceiling
SECTION III - PHYSICAL DATA
Description Colorless gas at atmospheric temperature and pressure, with a pungent odor.
Melting Point: -108F (-78C) Boiling Point: -28F (-33C)
Liquid Specific Gravity: 0.77 Vapor Specific Gravity: 0.59
(water = 1.0) (air = 1.0)
Vapor Pressure: 147 PSIA (10 atm) @ 78F (25C)
Odor Threshold: 20 PPM
Solubility in Water: 579 g/l @ 60F (15C), 444 g/l @ 68F (20C)
Other Solvents:
Other Physical Data:
ISSUE DATE: 06/29/06 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 1 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
AMMONIA
SECTION IV - FIRE AND EXPLOSION INFORMATION
Fire and Explosion Hazard: Ammonia is a low fire hazard when exposed to heat or flame
because it is difficult to ignite. It is a moderate explosion hazard
when exposed to flame or fire. Air-ammonia mixtures can detonate
in a fire.
Auto-Ignition Temperature: 1204F (651C) Flash Point Temperature: N/A
Explosive Limits in Air: Lower: 15% Upper: 28%
Extinguishing Media: Water Fog.
Hazardous Decomposition Products: Toxic fumes of NH
3
and NO
X
.
Fire-Fighting Procedures: Stop flow of gas. Wear self-contained breathing apparatus with a
full facepiece operated in pressure-demand mode and full body
protection when fighting fires.
SECTION V- HEALTH HAZARD DATA
Permissible Exposure Level: 50 PPM
Threshold Limit Value: 25 PPM
Health Effects from Exposure
Swallowing: Ingestion of a gas is unlikely.
Inhalation: The life hazard from ammonia is due to its damage to the lungs when inhaled. When
inhaled, ammonia is both an irritant and an asphyxiant, and can cause respiratory
distress. Ammonia can usually be detected at levels of 20-50 PPM. There will be
noticeable irritation of the eyes and nasal passages when exposed to 100 PPM, and
severe irritation of the throat, nasal passages, and upper respiratory tract at 400 PPM.
At 1700 PPM, there will be severe coughing and bronchial spasms, and an exposure of
30 minutes or less may be fatal. Concentrations of 5000 PPM and above are fatal
almost immediately, causing serious edema of the lungs, strangulation, and
asphyxiation.
Eye Contact: This gas is dangerous to the eyes, as it causes irritation at 40-100 PPM. Prolonged
exposure to 700 PPM or more can cause extensive injuries to the eyes - irritation,
hemorrhages, swollen lids, corneal ulcers, even partial or total loss of sight.
Skin Contact: Ammonia will irritate the skin, particularly if the skin is moist, to the point of causing
chemical burns from prolonged exposure.
ISSUE DATE: 06/29/06 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 2 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
AMMONIA
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA (continued)
First Aid Measures
Swallowing: Treat symptomatically and supportively. Get medical attention immediately. If vomiting
occurs, keep head lower than hips to prevent aspiration.
Inhalation: Where breathing is weak, administer oxygen or mixtures of carbon dioxide and oxygen,
containing not more than 5% carbon dioxide. It should be administered intermittently
for periods of two minutes over a total time not to exceed fifteen minutes. If breathing
has ceased, start artificial respiration immediately, by trained personnel only. Artificial
respiration, when administered by an inexperienced person, is definitely hazardous
following exposure to ammonia, and should be avoided where possible. The use of a
pulmotor is definitely not recommended as its more violent action will irritate and may
severely injure the lungs. A resuscitator used with oxygen and operated by a trained
person is recommended. Keep the patient warm and still, and get medical attention
immediately.
Eye Contact: Hold the lids open and pour clean water over the eyeball and lids (or use an eye
irrigation fountain). Wash thoroughly in this way for 15 minutes. A doctor, preferably
an eye specialist, should be summoned immediately
Skin Contact: Speed is essential. Strip the ammonia-saturated clothing from the body immediately.
Flood affected areas continuously with clean water for at least 15 minutes. Do not
cover burns with clothing or dressings. Allow them to remain open to the air.
ISSUE DATE: 06/29/06 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 3 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
AMMONIA
SECTION VI- REACTIVITY DATA
Reactivity: Stable under normal temperatures and pressures.
Incompatibilities: Acetaldehyde Nitrogen Dioxide
Acrolein Nitrogen Tetraoxide
Ammonium Peroxo Disulfate Nitrogen Trichloride
Antimony Nitrogen Trifluoride
Antimony Hydride Nitryl Chloride
Boron Oxygen + Platinum
Boron Halides Oxygen Difluoride
Boron Triiodide Phosphorus Pentoxide
Bromine Pentafluoride Phosphorus Trioxide
Chloric Acid Picric Acid
Chlorine Azide Potassium + Arsine
Chlorine Monoxide Potassium + Phosphine
Chlorine Trifluoride Potassium + Sodium Nitrite
Chlorites Potassium Chlorate
Chlorosilane Potassium Ferricyanide
Chromium Trioxide Potassium Mercuric Cyanide
Chromyl Chloride Silver
Dichlorine Oxide Silver Chloride
Ethylene Dichloride + Liquid Ammonia Silver Nitrate
Ethylene Oxide Silver Oxide
Gold Sodium + Carbon Monoxide
Gold (III) Chloride Sulfur
Halogens Sulfur Dichloride
Hexachloromelamine Tellurium
Hydrazine + Alkali Metals Tellurium Chloride
Hydrogen Bromide Tellurium Hydropentachloride
Hydrogen Peroxide Tetramethyl Ammonium Amide
Hypochlorous Acid Thionyl Chloride
Magnesium Perchlorate Thiotrithiazyl Chloride
Mercury Trichloromelamine
Nitric Acid Trioxygen Difluoride
Polymerization: Cannot occur.
SECTION VII - SPILL OR LEAK PROCEDURES
Steps to Be Taken in Case Material is Released or Spilled
Notify safety personnel of significant leaks. Exclude all from area except those assigned to leak and spill
control who are using full protective gear (see Section VIII). Provide ventilation. Locate and control
leakage.
Waste Disposal Method
If water is used to knock-down vapors, it will be corrosive and toxic, and should be diked for containment.
Add suitable agent to neutralize to 7 pH prior to disposal.
ISSUE DATE: 06/29/06 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 4 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
AMMONIA
SECTION VIII - PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Ventilation: Provide local exhaust or process enclosure ventilation to meet the published exposure
limits. Ventilation equipment must be explosion-proof.
Respirator: If work place exposure limit(s) of product or any component is exceeded (see Section
II), a NIOSH/MSHA approved air supplied respirator is advised in absence of proper
environmental control. OSHA regulations also permit other NIOSH/MSHA respirators
(negative pressure type) under specified conditions (see your safety equipment
supplier). Engineering or administrative controls should be implemented to reduce
exposure.
Clothing: To prevent repeated or prolonged skin contact, wear impervious clothing and boots.
Gloves: Wear resistant gloves such as neoprene, nitrile rubber, butyl rubber.
Eye Protection: Employee must wear splash-proof or dust resistant safety goggles and a faceshield to
prevent contact with this substance.
Where there is any possibility that an employee's eyes may be exposed to this
substance, the employer shall provide an eye-wash fountain within the immediate work
area for emergency use.
SECTION IX - SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS OR OTHER COMMENTS
DISCLAIMER
The information contained herein is believed to be accurate, but is not warranted to be, whether originating within the company or not. Health and safety precautions in this data
sheet may not be adequate for all individuals and/or situations. Recipients are advised to confirm in advance of need that the information is current, applicable, and suitable to their
circumstances. It is the end user's responsibility to evaluate and use this product safely, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations. No statement made in this data
sheet shall be construed as a permission or recommendation for use of any product in a manner that might infringe existing patents. No warranty is made, either expressed or
implied.
ISSUE DATE: 06/29/06 SUPERSEDES: 02/19/93 PAGE 5 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
METHYLDIETHANOLAMINE
SECTION I - PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION
Substance: METHYLDIETHANOLAMINE CAS Number: 105-59-9
Trade Names / Synonyms: MDEA; n-Methyldiethanolamine; n-Methyliminodiethanol;
n-Methyl-2,2'-iminodiethanol; N,N-di(2-hydroxyethyl)-N-methylamine; 2,2'-
(Methylimino) bis-ethanol
Molecular Formula: CH
3
-N-(CH
2
CH
2
OH)
2
Molecular Weight: 119.17
General or Generic ID: Organic Base
SECTION II - COMPONENTS
Component: Methyldiethanolamine Percent: > 99.0
Other Contaminants: Often stored and transported as an aqueous solution containing about 10% water
by weight.
Exposure Limits: Methyldiethanolamine
There are no standards or regulations concerning MDEA.
SECTION III - PHYSICAL DATA
Description: Clear, colorless, viscous liquid.
Melting Point: -6F (-21C) Boiling Point: 477F (247C)
Liquid Specific Gravity: 1.042 Vapor Specific Gravity 4.11
(water = 1.0) (air = 1.0)
Vapor Pressure: < 0.0002 PSIA (0.01 mm Hg) @ 68F (20C)
Odor Threshold: MDEA has a slight ammoniacal odor.
Solubility in Water: MDEA is completely soluble in water.
Other Solvents:
Other Physical Data:
ISSUE DATE: 01/25/95 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 1 OF 3
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
METHYLDIETHANOLAMINE
SECTION IV- FIRE AND EXPLOSION INFORMATION
Fire and Explosion Hazard: MDEA is considered a slight fire hazard when exposed to heat or flame.
Auto-Ignition Temperature: N/A Flash Point Temperature: 260F (127C)
Explosive Limits in Air: not determined
Extinguishing Media: Small Fire - dry chemical or CO
2
.
Large Fire - water fog, alcohol foam, polymer foam, ordinary foam.
Fire-Fighting Procedures: Wear positive pressure, self-contained breathing apparatus.
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA
Permissible Exposure Level: None established.
Threshold Limit Value: None established.
Health Effects from Exposure
Swallowing: Single dose oral toxicity is low. The oral LD50 for rats is 4780 mg/kg for MDEA.
Amounts ingested incidental to industrial handling are not likely to cause injury;
however, ingestion of larger amounts may cause injury. Ingestion of MDEA can
cause nausea, vomiting, and abdominal discomfort.
Inhalation:: At room temperature, exposure to vapors is unlikely due to physical properties.
Higher temperatures may generate vapor levels sufficient to cause irritation.
Eye Contact: May cause moderately severe irritation with corneal injury.
Skin Contact: Prolonged or repeated exposure may cause skin irritation, even a burn. A single
prolonged exposure is not likely to result in the material being absorbed through
skin in harmful amounts. The dermal LD50 has not been determined.
Systemic Effects: Repeated excessive exposures may cause kidney effects.
First Aid Measures
Swallowing: Induce vomiting if large amounts are ingested. Consult medical personnel.
Inhalation: Remove to fresh air if effects occur. Consult a physician.
Eye Contact: Flush eyes with large amounts of water for at least 15 minutes. Take the patient to a
physician, preferably an eye specialist, at once.
Skin Contact: Flush the affected area with plenty of water. If exposure has produced a burn, it
should be treated like a thermal burn, with treatment based on the physician's
judgement. Contaminated clothing should be removed and washed before reuse.
Contaminated leather articles (shoes, belts, etc.) should be removed and destroyed.
ISSUE DATE: 01/25/95 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 2 OF 3
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
METHYLDIETHANOLAMINE
SECTION VI- REACTIVITY DATA
Reactivity: Stable under normal storage conditions.
Incompatibilities: Incompatible with strong oxidizers and strong acids. Do not allow
MDEA to contact sodium nitrite (NaNO
2
) or other nitrosating
agents, as nitrosamines (suspected cancer-causing agents) could
be formed.
Hazardous Decomposition Products: Nitrous oxides, carbon monoxide, and/or carbon dioxide.
Polymerization Hazardous polymerization will not occur.
SECTION VII - SPILL OR LEAK PROCEDURES
Steps to Be Taken in Case Material is Released or Spilled
Wear suitable protective equipment, especially eye protection. Collect for disposal. Toxic to fish; avoid
discharge to natural waters.
Waste Disposal Method
Burn in approved incinerator. Follow all local, state, and federal requirements for disposal.
SECTION VIII - PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Ventilation: General (mechanical) room ventilation is expected to be satisfactory.
Respirator: None required in normal use. If irritation of the nose and/or respiratory system is
experienced, use an approved air-purifying respirator.
Clothing: Use protective clothing impervious to this material. Selection of specific items such as
boots, apron, or full-body suit will depend on operation.
Gloves: Use gloves impervious to this material, such as rubber.
Eye Protection: Use chemical goggles.
SECTION IX - SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS OR OTHER COMMENTS
Avoid contact with eyes, skin, and clothing when handling and storing MDEA. Wash thoroughly after
handling.
Disclaimer
The information contained herein is believed to be accurate, but is not warranted to be, whether originating within the company or not. Health and safety precautions in this data sheet
may not be adequate for all individuals and/or situations. Recipients are advised to confirm in advance of need that the information is current, applicable, and suitable to their
circumstances. It is the end users responsibility to evaluate and use this product safely, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations. No statement made in this data sheet
shall be construed as a permission or recommendation for use of any product in a manner that might infringe existing patents. No warranty is made, either expressed or implied.
ISSUE DATE: 01/25/95 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 3 OF 3
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
SECTION I - PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION
Substance: SODIUM HYDROXIDE CAS Number: 1310-73-2
Trade Names / Synonyms: Caustic; Caustic Soda; Caustic Soda Liquid; Liquid Caustic; Lye;
Lye Solution; Soda Lye; Sodium Hydrate; Quaker Caustic Blend;
White Caustic
Molecular Formula: NaOH Molecular Weight: 40.00
General or Generic ID: Alkali
SECTION II - COMPONENTS
Component: Sodium Hydroxide Percent: > 99.0
Other Contaminants: Often stored and transported as an aqueous solution. Common strengths are
25, 50, and 73 weight percent NaOH.
Exposure Limits: Sodium Hydroxide
2 mg/m
3
(2 PPM) OSHA TWA for an 8-hour working day
2 mg/m
3
(2 PPM) ACGIH ceiling
2 mg/m
3
(2 PPM) NIOSH recommended ceiling
SECTION III - PHYSICAL DATA
Description: Pure sodium hydroxide is a white solid. When dissolved in water, NaOH forms
a clear, colorless or water-white, strongly alkaline liquid. Neither form has an
odor.
Melting Point: Solid: 608F (320C)
25 wt% solution: -2F (-19C)
50 wt% solution: 50F (10C)
Boiling Point: Solid: 2534F (1390C)
25 wt% solution: 232F (111C)
50 wt% solution: 288F (142C)
Specific Gravity: Solid: 2.13
(water = 1.0) 25 wt% solution: 1.27
50 wt% solution: 1.53
Vapor Pressure: Solid: 0.02 PSIA (1 mm Hg) @ 1362F (739C)
Odor Threshold: N/A
Solubility in Water: At 60F (15C), more than 50 wt% will dissolve in water.
Other Solvents:
Other Physical Data:
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 1 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
SECTION IV- FIRE AND EXPLOSION INFORMATION
Fire and Explosion Hazard: Sodium hydroxide and its water solutions are not flammable. However,
adding water to NaOH or solutions of NaOH can cause localized
overheating due to its heat of dilution.
Sodium hydroxide will generate gaseous hydrogen (which is flammable
and/or explosive) when in contact with aluminum, copper, tin, zinc, and
their alloys.
Auto-Ignition Temperature: N/A Flash Point Temperature: N/A
Explosive Limits in Air: Lower: N/A Upper: N/A
Extinguishing Media: Not combustible. Use extinguishing agents as may be suitable for
material in surrounding fire.
Fire-Fighting Procedures: Not combustible. Use clothing and safety equipment as may be suitable
for sodium hydroxide and materials in the surrounding fire.
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA
Permissible Exposure Level: 2 mg/m
3
(approximately 2 PPMW)
Threshold Limit Value: 2 mg/m
3
(approximately 2 PPMW) ceiling
Health Effects from Exposure
Swallowing: Acutely toxic if swallowed, causing severe burns and scarring to the mouth,
throat, esophagus, and stomach, and may lead to death. Squamous cell
carcinoma of the esophagus can occur years after the exposure.
Inhalation: Inhalation of dust or mist can cause injury to the entire respiratory tract. The
effects of inhalation depend on the severity of the exposure, ranging from mild
irritation of the mucous membranes to severe pneumonitis.
Eye Contact: Contact with the eyes may cause irritation and, with greater exposure, severe
burns and possible blindness.
Skin Contact: Skin contact may cause burns, frequently with deep ulceration and scarring.
Prolonged contact, even with dilute solutions, can cause tissue damage.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 2 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
SECTION V - HEALTH HAZARD DATA (continued)
First Aid Measures
Swallowing: Do not induce vomiting - this will cause further damage to the throat and
esophagus. Dilute by giving water to the patient immediately. Vinegar, 1% acetic
acid solution, citrus fruit juices, or 5% citric acid solution may also be administered
to help neutralize the alkaline solution. Follow this with milk, egg white in water, or
milk of magnesia. Keep the patient warm and still, and summon a physician
immediately.
Inhalation: Remove the patient to fresh air at once. If breathing has stopped, begin artificial
respiration immediately. Keep the patient warm and still, and summon a physician
immediately.
Eye Contact: Immediately begin flushing the eyes with large amounts of water, preferably with
an eye wash fountain. Continue flushing for at least 15 minutes, forcibly holding
the eyelids apart and rotating the eyeball, to ensure complete irrigation of all eye
and lid tissue. A physician, preferably an eye specialist, should be summoned
immediately.
Skin Contact: Immediately flush the affected areas with large amounts of water. If large areas of
the body are contaminated, or if clothing has been penetrated to the skin,
immediately use a safety shower, preferably removing clothing while under the
shower. Continue flushing the areas for at least 15 minutes. If available, follow
the water flush with a generous application of vinegar or 1% acetic acid solution to
neutralize the residual NaOH. After the acid treatment, apply a good protective
dressing as with any other burn and take the patient to a physician. Contaminated
clothing should be washed before reuse. Contaminated leather articles (shoes,
belts, etc.) should be discarded.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 3 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
SECTION VI- REACTIVITY DATA
Reactivity: Stable.
Incompatibilities: Acetaldehyde Hydroquinone
Acetic Acid Magnesium
Acetic Anhydride Maleic Anhydride
Acrolein Methanol + Tetrachlorobenzene
Acrylonitrile 4-Methyl-2-nitrophenol
Allyl Alcohol 3-Methyl-2-penten-4-yn-1-ol
Allyl Chloride Nitric Acid
Aluminum Nitroethane (forms shock-sensitive salts)
Chlorine Trifluoride Nitromethane (forms shock-sensitive salts)
Chloroform + Methanol Nitroparaffins (forms shock-sensitive salts)
Chlorohydrin (Chlorhydrin) Nitropropane (forms shock-sensitive salts)
4-Chloro-2-methylphenol Oleum (fuming Sulfuric Acid)
Chloronitrotoluene Pentol
Chlorosulfonic Acid Phosphorus
(Chlorosulfuric Acid) Phosphorus Pentoxide
Cinnamaldehyde -Propiolactone (2-Oxetanone)
Copper Strong Mineral or Organic Acids
Cyanogen Azide Sulfuric Acid
Diborane (Boron Hydride) 1,2,4,5-Tetrachlorobenzene
1,2-Dichloroethylene Tetrahydrofuran
Difluoroethane Tin
Ethylene Cyanohydrin 1,1,1-Trichloroethanol
(Hydracrylonitrile) Trichloroethylene
Glyoxal Trichloronitromethane
Hydrochloric Acid Trifluoride
(Hydrogen Chloride) Water
Hydrofluoric Acid Zinc
(Hydrogen Fluoride) Zirconium
Polymerization: Hazardous polymerization cannot occur.
Other Hazards: Adding water to sodium hydroxide or sodium hydroxide solutions may cause
localized overheating and spattering.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 4 OF 5
MATERIAL SAFETY DATA SHEET
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
SECTION VII - SPILL OR LEAK PROCEDURES
Steps to Be Taken in Case Material is Released or Spilled
Cleanup personnel must wear proper protective equipment (refer to Section VIII). Completely contain
spilled material with dikes, sandbags, etc., and prevent run-off into ground or surface waters or
sewers. Recover as much material as possible into containers for disposal. Remaining material may
be diluted with water and neutralized with dilute hydrochloric acid. Neutralization products, both liquid
and solid, must be recovered for disposal.
Waste Disposal Method
Recovered solids or liquids may be sent to a licensed reclaimer or disposed of in a permitted waste
management facility. Consult federal, state, or local disposal authorities for approved procedures.
SECTION VIII - PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT TO BE USED
Ventilation: Ventilation is not usually required for caustic solutions. Avoid creation of mist or
spray. If present, wear appropriate safety clothing and provide local exhaust
systems.
Respirator: Provide mist protection where applicable. Use NIOSH or MSHA approved
respirators.
Clothing: Employees should wear impervious rubber, neoprene, or vinyl boots, overalls, and/or
full-body suits.
Gloves: Use impervious rubber, neoprene, or vinyl gloves.
Eye Protection: Use chemical goggles and face shield.
SECTION IX - SPECIAL PRECAUTIONS OR OTHER COMMENTS
When diluting sodium hydroxide, use agitation (mixing) and add the concentrated sodium hydroxide to
water at a controlled rate to control the heat of dilution and avoid spattering. Never add water to sodium
hydroxide.
Disclaimer
The information contained herein is believed to be accurate, but is not warranted to be, whether originating within the company or not. Health and safety precautions in this data sheet
may not be adequate for all individuals and/or situations. Recipients are advised to confirm in advance of need that the information is current, applicable, and suitable to their
circumstances. It is the end users responsibility to evaluate and use this product safely, and to comply with all applicable laws and regulations. No statement made in this data sheet
shall be construed as a permission or recommendation for use of any product in a manner that might infringe existing patents. No warranty is made, either expressed or implied.
ISSUE DATE: 02/19/93 SUPERSEDES: PAGE 5 OF 5
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 1 of 9 June 2008
MATERI AL SAFETY DATA SHEET
1. CHEMICAL PRODUCT AND COMPANY INFORMATION
Product Name: Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221
Product Use: Alumina
ASM Catalysts, LLC Euro Support B.V.
8550 United Plaza Blvd., Suite 702 Kortegracht 26
Baton Rouge, LA 70809-0200 3811 KH Amersfoort
USA The Netherlands
Tel.: +1-225-752-4276 Tel: +31-33-4650465
Fax: +1-225-922-4550 Fax: +31-33-4650721
2. HAZARDS IDENTIFICATION
Emergency Overview:
Repeated or prolonged exposure may irritate eyes, skin and respiratory system. The product gets hot as it first adsorbs
water.
Form: Spheres
Color: White
Potential Health Effects:
Primary Routes of Exposure: Contact with skin and eyes. Exposure may also occur via inhalation or
ingestion if product dust is generated.
Eye Contact: Dust and/or product may cause eye discomfort and/or irritation seen as tearing and reddening.
Skin Contact: Repeated or prolonged exposure may cause skin irritation.
Ingestion: The product is considered to have a low order of oral toxicity.
Inhalation: Exposure to dust particles generated from this material may cause irritation of the respiratory tract.
Irritation may be accompanied by coughing and chest discomfort.
Chronic Effects: Prolonged or repeated inhalation of dust generated from this material may cause lung injury.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 2 of 9 June 2008
Carcinogenicity Classification:
International Agency for Research on Cancer (IARC):
Neither the product nor the components are classified.
U.S. National Toxicology Program (NTP):
Neither the product nor the components are classified.
U.S. Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA):
Neither the product nor the components are classified or regulated.
American Conference of Governmental Industrial Hygienists (ACGIH):
Aluminum oxide Not Classifiable as a Human Carcinogen (A4).
3. COMPOSITION/INFORMATION ON INGREDIENTS
INGREDIENT
& CAS NO.
% WEIGHT ACGIH TLV-TWA OSHA PEL-TWA UNITS
Aluminum oxide (non-fibrous)
1344-28-1
<95
1(R)
15 (TD)
5(R)
mg/m
3
Water
7732-18-5
<10
N.E.
N.E. N.A.
Abbreviations:
N.A. - Not Applicable RD - Respirable Dust Fu - Fume IS - Insoluble
N.E. - None Established R - Respirable Fraction I - Inhalable FuD - Fume and Dust
STEL - Short Term Exposure Limit F - Respirable Fibers TD - Total Dust SC - Soluble Compounds
4. FIRST AID MEASURES
Eye contact: Flush immediately with plenty of water for at least 15 minutes. If eye irritation persists, consult a physician.
Skin contact: Wash off with soap and plenty of water. If skin irritation persists, call a physician.
After inhalation: Remove the victim into fresh air. If symptoms persist, call a physician.
After ingestion: Drink at least 2 glasses of water. Obtain medical attention. Never give anything by mouth to an
unconscious person.
Notes to physician: This product is a desiccant and generates heat as it adsorbs water. Symptomatic treatment is
advised. The used product can retain material of a hazardous nature. Identify that material and treat symptomatically.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 3 of 9 June 2008
5. FIRE FIGHTING MEASURES
Suitable extinguishing media: Non-combustible. Use extinguishing media for surrounding fire.
Unsuitable extinguishing media: N.A.
Fire and explosion hazards: The product itself does not burn. The used product can retain material of a hazardous
nature. Identify that material and inform the fire fighters.
Special protective equipment: In the case of respirable dust and/or fumes, use self-contained breathing apparatus and
dust impervious protective suit.
Flash point: N.A.
6. ACCIDENTAL RELEASE MEASURES
Personal protection: See Section 8.
Environmental precautions: No special environmental precautions required.
Clean-up: Sweep, shovel or vacuum spilled product into appropriate containers (do not use a vacuum if material has
contacted a hydrocarbon material). Pick-up and arrange disposal without creating dust. Never use spilled product. Spilled
product should be disposed of in accordance with all applicable government regulations.
7. HANDLING AND STORAGE
Handling: Handle and open container with care. Avoid formation of dust particles. Avoid contact with skin and eyes.
Provide an electrical ground connection during loading and transfer operations to avoid static discharge in an explosive
atmosphere and to prevent persons handling the product from receiving static shocks.
Storage: Store in original container. Keep in a dry place.
8. EXPOSURE CONTROLS/PERSONAL PROTECTION
Engineering measures: Where natural ventilation is inadequate, especially in confined areas, use mechanical
ventilation, other engineering controls or respiratory protection to prevent inhalation of product dust.
Personal protection equipment: Handle in accordance with good industrial hygiene and safety practice.
Eye protection: Safety glasses or goggles.
Hand protection: Protective gloves.
Skin and body protection: Work uniform and gloves to prevent prolonged contact.
Respiratory protection: In case of insufficient ventilation, wear suitable respiratory equipment. Air-purifying
respirator with NIOSH classification N-95 filter or P-95 (or equivalent) if oil/liquid aerosols are present (42 CFR 84).
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 4 of 9 June 2008
9. PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL PROPERTIES
These data do not represent technical or sales specifications.
Form: Spheres Color: White
Odor: None pH: 9 11 (AS)
Boiling point/range: None Melting point/range: N.A.
Flash point: N.A. Autoignition temperature: N.A.
Bulk density: 38-60 lbs/ft
3
Explosion limits: N.A.
Vapor pressure: N.A. Relative density/Specific gravity: 3.0
Vapor density: N.A. Viscosity: N.A.
Water solubility: Insoluble Solubility: N.D.
10. STABILITY
St abil i t y: Stable
Hazardous Decomposi t i on Product s: No decomposition if used as directed. Hydrocarbons and other materials that
contact the product during normal use can be retained on the product. It is reasonable to expect that decomposition
products will come from these retained materials of use. I f the product is subject to extreme temperatures or chemical
conditions, decomposition may occur and he product will include the oxides shown in Section 3.
Condi t i ons/ Mat eri al s t o avoi d: Reacts violently with chlorine trifluoride, producing flames. May cause ethylene oxide
to polymerize violently, releasing heat.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 5 of 9 June 2008
11. TOXICOLOGICAL INFORMATION
Acute toxicity:
LD50/oral/rat: No data available.
LD50/dermal/rabbit: No data available.
LD50/inhalation/rat: No data available.
Chronic toxicity: Classification of Ingredients
EC Carcinogenic: Carcinogenicity (ACGIH):
Not listed. A4 (Aluminum oxide)
EC Mutagenic: IARC classification:
Not listed. Not listed.
EC Toxic for Reproduction:
Not listed.
Routes of exposure: Exposure may occur via inhalation, contact with skin and eyes.
Irritation:
Skin (rabbit): No data available.
Eye (rabbit): No data available.
Additional product information:
Avoid repeated exposure.
Additional component information:
No data available.
12. ECOLOGICAL INFORMATION
Mobility: Biodegradation:
No data available. No data available.
Bioaccumulation: Aquatic toxicity:
No data available. No data available.
Further Information:
No information available.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 6 of 9 June 2008
13. DISPOSAL CONSIDERATIONS
Provisions relating to waste: EPA Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (RCRA) Hazardous and Solid Waste
Management Regulations.
Disposal information: This product (in its fresh unused state) is not listed by generic name or trademark name in the
U.S. EPAs RCRA regulations and does not possess ay of the four identifying characteristics of hazardous waste
(ignitability, corrosivity, reactivity or toxicity). Materials of a hazardous nature that contact the product during normal use
may be retained on this product. The user of the product must identify the hazards associated with the retained material
in order to assess the waste disposal options.
14. TRANSPORT INFORMATION
UN-No.: Proper shipping name: Packing group:
N.A. Not applicable. N.A.
Transport mode Class Additional Information Remarks
U.S. DOT: Not regulated. Reportable N.A. N.A.
Quantity:
Marine Pollutant DOT: No
ADR/RID: Not regulated. Danger Code: N.A. N.A.
IMDG: Not regulated. Marine pollutant: No N.A.
EmS: N.A.
IATA: Not regulated. Instr. Passenger: N.A. N.A.
Instr. Cargo: N.A.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 7 of 9 June 2008
15. REGULATORY INFORMATION
United States
Toxic Substances Control Act (TSCA): All the ingredients of this mixture are registered on the TSCA Chemical
Substance Inventory.
CERCLA (Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act) Reportable Quantity:
The following component(s) of this product is/are subject to release reporting under 40 CFR 302 when release exceeds
the Reportable Quantity (RQ):
--None
SARA Title III (Superfund Amendments and Reauthorization Act of 1986):
Section 302 (Extremely Hazardous Substances):
The following component(s) of this product is/are subject to the emergency planning provisions of 40 CFR 355 when
there are amounts equal to or greater than the Threshold Planning Quantity (TPQ):
--None
Section 313 (toxic Chemicals):
The following component(s) have been specified as Toxic Chemicals under SARA Section 313 and may be subject to the
Toxic Release Inventory (TRI) reporting requirements under 40 CFR 372:
--None
The following components are listed in U.S. State Regulations:
State Reg Reference: State Reg Reference:
California Proposition 65: None.
Massachusetts Right-to-Know: Aluminum oxide
New Jersey Right-To-Know: Aluminum oxide
Pennsylvania Right-to-Know: Aluminum oxide
Note: Other U.S. State Regulations may exist, check your local sources if available.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 8 of 9 June 2008
Canada
Canadian Hazardous Products Act:
This product is not classified as a controlled product under regulations pursuant to the Federal Hazardous Product Act
(e.g. WHMIS).
Canadian Environmental Protection Act: All the ingredients of this mixture are notified to CEPA and on the DSL
(Domestic Substances List).
European Union (EU)
European Inventory of Existing Commercial Chemical Substances: All components of this product are included in
EINECS/ELINCS.
Council of European Communities Directive on Classification, Packaging and Labeling of Dangerous
Substances/Preparation (67/548/EEC & 1999/45/EC, as amended):
No Dangerous Goods Label Required.
Additional Governmental Inventories
Australia Inventory of Chemical Substances (AICS): All the ingredients of this mixture appear on the AICS.
China All the ingredients of this mixture appear on the China Inventory.
Japan Existing and New Chemical Substances (ENCS): All the ingredients of this mixture appear on the
ENCS.
Korea Existing and Evaluated Chemical Substances (ECL): All the ingredients of this mixture appear on the
ECL.
Philippines Inventory of Chemicals and Chemical Substances (PICCS): All the ingredients of this mixture
appear on the PICCS.
Activated Alumina S-2001/ESM-221 Revision Number: 1
Page 9 of 9 June 2008
16. OTHER INFORMATION
HMIS - Hazardous Material Identification System:
HMIS Ratings: 0-minimal hazard, 1-slight hazard, 2-moderate hazard, 3-serious hazard, 4-severe hazard
HEALTH: 1
FLAMMABILITY: 0
REACTIVITY: 1
For additional information concerning this product, contact the following:
ASM Catalysts, LLC Euro Support B.V.
8550 United Plaza Blvd., Suite 702 Kortegracht 26
Baton Rouge, LA 70809-0200 3811 KH Amersfoort
USA The Netherlands
Tel: +1-225-752-4276, Fax: +1-225-922-4550 Tel: +31-33-465-0465, Fax: +31-33-465-0721
The data and recommendations presented in this data sheet concerning the use of our product and the materials contained therein are believed to be
accurate and are based on information which is considered reliable as of the date hereof. However, the customer should determine the suitability of
such materials for his purpose before adopting them on a commercial scale. Since the use of our products by others is beyond our control, no
guarantee, express or implied, is made and no responsibility assumed for the use of this material or the results to be obtained therefrom. Information on
this form is furnished for the purpose of compliance with Government Health and Safety Regulations and shall not be used for any other purposes.
Moreover, the recommendations contained in this data sheet are not to be construed as a license to operate under or a recommendation to infringe, any
existing patents, nor should they be confused with state, municipal or insurance requirements, or with national safety codes.
Page 1 of 8
Material Safety Data Sheet (MSDS)
MSDS Number: 6179-12 01/26/2010
EMERGENCY ASSISTANCE
CANUTEC (Canada): 613-996-6666
CHEMTREC (US): 1-800-424-9300
CHEMTREC (International): +1-703-527-3887
(Call Collect)
SECTION I. MATERIAL IDENTIFICATION
PRODUCT:
CRITERION 234 CATALYST
COMMON NAME: Metal Oxide
PRODUCT USE: Hydrotreating Catalyst
SECTION 2. COMPOSITION/INFORMATION ON INGREDIENTS
COMPONENTS OF THE MATERIAL
Component Chemical
Formula
CAS Concentration
Aluminum oxide
Al2O3
1344-28-1 74 - 98 %
Cobalt oxide
CoO
1307-96-6 1 - 5 %
Molybdenum oxide
MoO3
1313-27-5 10 - 19 %
SECTION 3. HAZARDS IDENTIFICATION
EMERGENCY OVERVIEW
Physical Appearance: Blue Extrudates or Spheres. Odorless
Human Health Hazards:
Irritating to eyes and respiratory system.
May cause allergic reaction (rash) with skin contact and asthma-like allergic reaction by inhalation in
sensitive individuals.
Physical Hazards:
No specific hazards.
Environmental Hazards:
Toxic to aquatic organisms, may cause long-term adverse effects in the aquatic environment.
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 2 of 8
Potential Health Effects
Eye:
Mildly irritating to eyes.
Skin:
Mildly irritating to the skin. May cause contact dermatitis (allergic skin rash) in cobalt sensitive
individuals.
Inhalation:
Dusts may be irritating to the nose, throat and respiratory tract. May cause sensitization by inhalation
due to presence of a cobalt compound. Existing respiratory diseases may be aggravated by exposure to
this material.
Ingestion:
Low-level cobalt ingestion is known to cause effects on the heart after a short-term exposure. The
symptoms of heart damage may be a swelling of the feet (edema) and shortness of breath on exertion
or when lying flat on the back (supine).
Other Health Effects:
Molybdenum compounds have a low order of toxicity, may be irritating and may cause anemia.
SECTION 4. FIRST AID MEASURES
Eye Contact:
Flush eyes with water. If persistent irritation occurs, get medical attention.
Skin Contact:
Wash skin with water and, if available, soap. If persistent irritation occurs, get medical attention.
Inhalation:
Move to fresh air. If rapid recovery does not occur, get medical attention.
Ingestion:
Do not induce vomiting. Give nothing by mouth. Get medical attention immediately.
Note to Physicians:
Treat symptomatically. If skin sensitization has developed and a causal relationship has been
confirmed, further exposure should not be allowed.
SECTION 5. FIRE FIGHTING MEASURES
Extinguishing Media:
Material will not burn; use an extinguishing medium appropriate for the surrounding fire.
SECTION 6. ACCIDENTAL RELEASE MEASURES
Precautionary Measures:
Do not breathe dust. Avoid contact with skin and eyes. Avoid dust generation. Wear suitable
protective clothing and gloves. Wear a NIOSH approved respirator if there is a possibility of exposures
above the established occupational exposure limits. (See Section 8 for exposure limits.)
Spill Management:
Prevent contamination of soil and water. Do not wash spills into sewers or other public water systems.
Prevent further leakage or spillage and prevent from entering drains.
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 3 of 8
Spill Disposal:
Shovel up and place in a labeled, sealable container for subsequent safe disposal.
Environmental Compliance:
Refer to latest state or local regulations to determine if there are disposal or reporting requirements.
SECTION 7. HANDLING AND STORAGE
Handling Recommendations:
Avoid contact with skin and eyes.
Avoid dust generation.
Do not breathe dust.
Do not eat, smoke or drink in areas where catalyst is present.
Use only in well ventilated areas. Use local exhaust extraction.
Take precautionary measures against static discharge.
Ground all equipment.
Storage Recommendations:
Keep container tightly closed and dry.
Reseal plastic liner.
SECTION 8. EXPOSURE CONTROLS/PERSONAL PROTECTION
Engineering Controls:
Use only in well ventilated areas. Use local exhaust extraction.
Hygiene Measures:
Avoid contact with material. Wash hands thoroughly after handling. Do not reuse clothing if
contaminated until thoroughly decontaminated.
Respiratory Protection:
Use either an atmosphere-supplying respirator or an air-purifying respirator for particulates.
Eye Protection:
Wear safety goggles or glasses to prevent eye contact.
Hand Protection:
Wear neoprene, nitrile, PVC or latex gloves to prevent contact.
Body Protection:
When there is a possibility of exposure wear a one piece coated overall with integral hood, safety
boots, chemical-resistant without lace holes.
Chemical Name
Authority
Limits
Special Notations
Aluminum oxide OSHA PEL 15 mg/m total dust
Aluminum oxide OSHA PEL 5 mg/m respirable dust
Aluminum oxide ACGIH TWA 10 mg/m total dust
Cobalt oxide OSHA PEL 0.1 mg/m metal dust & fumes; as Co;
Cancer: 3
Cobalt oxide ACGIH TWA 0.02 mg/m as Co
Cobalt oxide ACGIH BEI 15 g/m as creatinine
Cobalt oxide ACGIH BEI 20 g/m BEI
Molybdenum oxide OSHA PEL 15 mg/m as Mo; total dust
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 4 of 8
Molybdenum oxide OSHA PEL 5 mg/m as Mo; respirable dust
Molybdenum oxide ACGIH TWA 10 mg/m as Mo; total dust
SECTION 9. PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL PROPERTIES
Product
Physical & Chemical Properties Characteristics
Appearance and Odor: Blue Extrudates or Spheres. Odorless
Solubility in water: <5%
Bulk density (solids): 0.48 g/cc
Melting point: ~3700
SECTION 10. STABILITY AND REACTIVITY
Stability:
Stable. Hygroscopic.
Materials To Avoid:
Strong acids, strong bases, strong oxidizing agents.
SECTION 11. TOXICOLOGICAL INFORMATION
The hazard determination and the information presented below is based on available data derived from
testing for the material, hazardous components of this material and/or a testing on a substantially
similar material(s). The material tested is indicated in the data.
Acute Lethality
Route Material Tested LD/LC50 Species
Dermal Molybdenum oxide >2000 mg/kg Rat
Sensitization
Route Material Tested Description Species
Dermal Cobalt oxide Sensitizer Human
Inhalation Cobalt oxide Sensitizer Human
Other Health Effects:
Cobalt was used as a defoaming agent in beer at 1 ppm. After a few weeks of exposure beer drinkers were found
to have myocardial effects. Deaths were reported. Medical evaluations found myocardial infarction.
In a lifetime feeding study with cobalt in hamsters, no statistically significant increases in tumors were seen.
Carcinogenicity:
Cobalt oxide is classified by:
IARC as a possible human carcinogen (Group 2B)
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 5 of 8
SECTION 12. ECOLOGICAL INFORMATION
Ecotoxicological data have not been determined specifically for this material. The information given
below is based on knowledge of the components and the ecotoxicology of similar products.
Toxicity to Aquatic Organisms:
Toxic to aquatic organisms, may cause long-term adverse effects in the aquatic environment.
Persistence & Bioaccumulation:
Not inherently biodegradable.
Mobility:
Sinks in water. If product enters soil, one or more constituents will be mobile and may contaminate
groundwater.
Sewage Treatment:
Not toxic at the limit of water solubility.
SECTION 13. DISPOSAL CONSIDERATIONS
Product disposal:
Recover or recycle, if possible. Otherwise: Send to an approved contractor for regeneration or metal
recovery or dispose with a licensed disposal contractor.
Waste Disposal:
If product is unused, see above. If used, evaluate the toxicity and physical properties of the material
you have generated and dispose of the material in accordance with local, state and federal regulations.
Container Disposal:
Empty containers may contain residues. Ensure container is properly cleaned. Remove all packaging
for recovery or waste disposal. DO NOT USE CONTAINER FOR OTHER PURPOSES.
Regulatory Controls:
Comply with all federal, state and local laws regulating the handling and disposal of wastes.
SECTION 14. TRANSPORTATION INFORMATION
Transport Statement:
Not dangerous for conveyance under USA DOT, Canadian TDG, and IATA/ICAO codes. Consult
local laws to determine transportation regulations.
U. S. A. - DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION (DOT)
Not regulated by DOT (USA).
CANADA - TRANSPORTATION OF DANGEROUS GOODS (TDG)
Not dangerous for conveyance under Canadian TDG.
Maritime transport (IMO)
UN No. UN 3077
Proper Shipping Name ENVIRONMENTALLY HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCE, SOLID,
N.O.S. ( Cobalt compounds )
Class 9
Packing Group III , MARINE POLLUTANT
Hazard symbol MISCELLANEOUS DANGEROUS SUBSTANCES AND ARTICLES
ENVIRONMENT
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 6 of 8
Air transport ICAO/IATA
Not dangerous for conveyance under IATA/ICAO codes.
SECTION 15. REGULATORY INFORMATION
National Inventories
National Authority Country Status
EINECS/ELINCS EC All ingredients listed.
TSCA USA All ingredients listed.
MITI Japan All ingredients listed.
DSL/NDSL Canada All ingredients listed.
TCCL Korea All ingredients listed.
AICS Australia All ingredients listed.
PICCS Philippines All ingredients listed.
IECS China All ingredients listed.
PRODUCT SAFETY CLASSIFICATIONS
Canada WHMIS
Canadian - Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System (WHMIS)
Class D - Toxic and Infectious Materials Division 2 - Materials Causing other Toxic Effects
Subdivision A - Very Toxic Materials
California Proposition 65
Name on List Classification
Cobalt oxide Carcinogen
Massachusetts
Aluminum oxide Right-To-Know Substances List
Pennsylvania
Aluminum oxide Right-To-Know Hazardous Substance
Molybdenum oxide PA Environmental Hazard E (1 % threshold)
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 7 of 8
European Community
Label Name CONTAINS COBALT OXIDE / MOLYBDENUM OXIDE
Hazard Symbols Xn: Harmful
N: Dangerous to the Environment
Classification Harmful Dangerous to the Environment
Risk Phrases R48/20/22: Harmful: danger of serious damage to health by prolonged
exposure through inhalation and if swallowed.
R42/43: May cause sensitization by inhalation and skin contact.
R36/37: Irritating to eyes and respiratory system.
R51/53: Toxic to aquatic organisms, may cause long-term adverse
effects in the aquatic environment.
Safety Phrases S22: Do not breathe dust.
S24: Avoid contact with skin.
S37/39: Wear suitable gloves and eye/face protection.
S61: Avoid release to the environment. Refer to special
instructions/Safety data sheets.
NATIONAL ENVIRONMENTAL AND SAFETY REGULATIONS
Superfund Amendments and Reauthorization Act (SARA)
SARA 311/312 Classification: Immediate (acute) health hazard
Delayed health hazard
SARA 313 Chemicals: Cobalt compounds Molybdenum oxide
SECTION 16. OTHER INFORMATION
COMPANY NAME: Criterion Catalysts & Technologies L.P.
16825 Northchase Drive,
2 Greenspoint Plaza
Houston, Tx. 77060 (USA)
+1 281 874 2600
+1 281 874 2641 (FAX)
MSDS Prepared By: CRI/Criterion, Inc.
16825 Northchase Drive, Suite #1110
Houston, TX 77060 (USA)
+1 281-874-2600 (USA CST)
[email protected]
Uses and restrictions:
Use as a raw material/intermediate for catalyst manufacture, as a catalyst for refinery processing or for
petrochemicals manufacture.
MSDS Distribution:
The information in this document should be made available to all who may handle the product.
CRITERION 234 CATALYST MSDS Number: 6179
Page 8 of 8
Amendment Notation:
Amendments from the previous version of the MSDS are indicated by two vertical bars in the left
margin and the section is highlighted.
Disclaimer:
This information is based on our current knowledge and is intended to describe the product for the
purposes of health, safety and environmental requirements only. It should not, therefore, be construed
as guaranteeing any specific property of the product.
Issue Date:
01/25/2010
US/Canada - (English)
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-i
Table of Contents
3. GENERAL .................................................................................................................... 3-1
3.1 ORGANIZATION ................................................................................................... 3-1
3.2 GENERAL PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................. 3-2
3.2.1 Mechanical ..................................................................................................... 3-2
3.2.2 Electrical ......................................................................................................... 3-3
3.2.3 Instrumentation ............................................................................................... 3-5
3.3 DESIGN BASIS ..................................................................................................... 3-7
3.3.1 Plant Capacity ................................................................................................ 3-7
3.3.2 Sulfur Block Feed Streams ............................................................................. 3-7
3.3.3 Effluent Stream Conditions ........................................................................... 3-12
3.3.4 Other Design Requirements ......................................................................... 3-13
3.3.5 Utility Information .......................................................................................... 3-14
3.3.6 Plant Site Conditions .................................................................................... 3-16
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-1
3. GENERAL
3.1 Organization
This manual discusses the startup and operation of the new Sulfur Block,
consisting of an Amine Treating Unit, an Amine Regeneration Unit, a Sour
Water Stripping Unit, two Sulfur Recovery Units, a common Tailgas Thermal
Oxidation Unit, Tailgas Cleanup Unit, and Sulfur Degassing Unit, on a systems
basis. The systems are discussed individually, but are also grouped together
into two main categories. The categories and systems, in order of presentation,
are:
A. UTILITY SYSTEMS
1. Power Distribution
2. Plant Control Systems
3. Utility Systems
B. PROCESS SYSTEMS
1. Amine Treating / Amine Regeneration
2. Sour Water Stripping
3. Sulfur Recovery
4. Tailgas Thermal Oxidation
5. Tailgas Cleanup
6. Sulfur Degassing and Transfer
7. Solvent Storage and Drain
The systems are presented in the sequence required for a normal startup. That
is, electric power is usually the first system commissioned and the Sulfur
Degassing system is usually the last.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-2
3.2 General Precommissioning Procedures
Prior to placing each of the Amine Treating, Sour Water Stripping, Sulfur
Recovery, Tailgas Thermal Oxidation, Tailgas Cleanup, Sulfur Degassing, and
associated systems in operation, check-out of the various systems should be
made in as much detail as practical. This will help eliminate problems during
startup and familiarize personnel with the plant equipment.
3.2.1 Mechanical
A complete check of all plant construction should be made to assure it is
in accordance with the Piping & Instrument Diagrams and equipment
manufacturer's recommendations. Any discrepancies or defects should
be corrected before attempting to put the plant in operation. Each piece of
equipment should be checked against the vendor's recommendations and
guidelines. Some of the steps that should be taken to ensure the plant is
mechanically ready for startup include:
A. Make an internal check of vessels for correct installation of mist
pads, support grids, trays, vortex breakers, etc.
B. Check to ensure suction strainers are installed in all pump suction
lines before the pumps are operated for any reason.
C. Perform all necessary pressure tests. After tests, remove the test
blinds, giving special attention to those below relief valves.
D. Check the nameplate on each relief valve to ensure it has been
installed in the proper location.
E. Clear the plant area involved in startup of construction equipment
and debris that could cause fire or injuries.
F. Check for proper rotation of all motors.
G. Check all motors and rotating equipment to ensure proper lubrication
and that belts are free and properly aligned.
H. Check pumps for packing where required (follow manufacturer's
instructions).
I. Check filters to ensure they contain properly installed filter elements
or charcoal media and that adequate spare elements are on hand.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-3
J. Prior to commencement of startup, the following items should be on
hand:
(1) Spare parts
(2) Lubricants, greases, etc.
(3) Chemicals, or provisions to provide chemicals
(4) Spare filter elements
(5) Any special tools required
(6) Fire extinguishers
(7) Safety equipment
(8) Oxygen analyzer
(9) Laboratory test equipment
(10) Pertinent test procedures
3.2.2 Electrical
The purpose of commissioning electrical components and control systems
prior to the startup of a plant is to ensure correct performance per
specifications under simulated operating conditions.
POWER SHOULD NOT BE APPLIED TO ANY ELECTRICAL
DEVICE, CONTROL PANEL, CONTROL SYSTEM, OR MOTOR IN
THE FACILITY UNTIL SUCH TIME THAT ALL POWER AND
CONTROL WIRING FOR THE FACILITY HAS BEEN TERMINATED
AND PROPERLY MADE-UP ON EACH CONDUCTOR END.
Electrical power circuits must be energized in order to make an electrical
check-out prior to startup. Some of the following procedures may be
accomplished during construction; however, before the plant is put in
operation the following should be completed:
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-4
A. Test each circuit with a megger, phase-to-phase and
phase-to-ground.
B. Test the motor feeder with the motor out of the circuit. After motors
are connected, make phase-to-ground tests on the motor circuit.
C. Test the control circuit with the push-buttons and over-current
devices connected.
D. Test the feeders to the panel-boards with the branch circuits open.
E. Test the power feeder with switches and circuit breakers in place.
F. Megger the power and control circuits of the switchgear and motor
control centers.
G. Check the control switches, alarm and shutdown devices, indicating
lights, and meters for proper operation.
H. Install thermal overload heaters where required after checking them
against the manufacturer's heat tables and motor nameplate data to
ensure the heaters are of the proper size and rating. Check
operation of time-delay under-voltage devices for proper timing,
proper restart, and dropout action.
I. Megger motor windings and transformer windings for ground.
Examine them for moisture accumulation. If evidence of moisture
accumulation is found, the equipment must be dried before being
placed in operation.
J. Check circuit breakers, motor starters, switches, relays, and other
equipment for loose connections (both mechanical and electrical)
and to see that contacts and working parts are correctly aligned and
free from dust and foreign material.
K. Check motors for proper rotation, lubrication, and alignment.
L. For circuit breakers with adjustable trips, check the thermal rating
against the value shown on the drawings and adjust the magnetic
setting to the "LO" position. On magnetic-only (instantaneous trip)
breakers in combination starters, the instantaneous setting should be
adjusted so that the setting is just above the motor in-rush current.
Lower the setting to the point where the contacts open when the
motor is started, then raise the setting in small increments to the
point where the breaker allows the motor to start.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-5
M. Ensure that all individual motor starter and feeder breakers are in the
"OFF" position.
N. Provide power to the MCC by engaging the main feeder breaker.
O. Turn the MCC feeder breakers to the "ON" positions, applying power
to all individual circuit breakers, contactors, and motor switches.
P. In order to initially energize any motor, pump, or fan, the shutdown
control system should first be energized and the emergency
shutdown system reset.
3.2.3 Instrumentation
The purpose of commissioning instruments prior to the startup of the
facility is to ensure correct performance per specifications under simulated
operating conditions. Handling of instruments after calibration should be
kept to a minimum.
The instruments have been ordered pre-calibrated and set. It should be
necessary only to verify the factory calibration and zero of the instruments.
In the event that an instrument requires re-calibration or major mechanical
adjustments, the manufacturer's recommendations and guidelines should
be adhered to, and will be considered the applicable standard.
All instruments, components, and accessory devices (including charts,
scales, dials, gauges, switches, etc.) should be checked against their
specification sheets for agreement.
Specific steps that should be taken to ensure the plant pneumatic
instrumentation system is ready for startup include:
A. The instrument air system must be put into operation in order to
check-out the instrument loops. The individual block valves for each
air user should be closed as the air system is pressurized. Once
operating pressure is reached, dirt and pipe scale should be blown
from the headers. The individual instrument lines should then be
disconnected at the instruments and any debris blown from the entire
tubing run.
B. All air supply regulators should be adjusted to the recommended
settings.
C. Once the instrument air system is pressurized, the piping and tubing
should be checked for leaks.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-6
D. All instrument loops should be checked to ensure the instruments
and control devices are properly interconnected. The controllers
should be set to the proper control action with the proper control
modes and tuning characteristics.
E. "Stroke" the control valves to ensure the valves move in the proper
direction.
F. Check orifice plates for proper bore and direction of installation.
G. Level switches and transmitters should be put in service and
checked for proper actuation. Calibration of level devices may be
completed after liquid levels are established.
H. Check the tag numbers on the steam traps to confirm that each trap
has been installed in the proper location.
I. In plants controlled by a distributed control system (DCS), confirm
that the range stored in the DCS for each field instrument matches
the actual range of the instrument. This is particularly important for
flow meters used in ratio control loops, as an incorrect range may
prevent the control loop from functioning properly. It is also
important on flow loops to confirm that either the transmitter or the
DCS (and not both) is extracting the square root of the signal.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-7
3.3 Design Basis
The information used to design the Sulfur Block is given in this section.
Unless stated otherwise, the design conditions presented below are assumed to
be available at the battery limits for the new units.
3.3.1 Plant Capacity
The feedstock basis for the Sulfur Block is a nominal sulfur production of
35 MT/D. In order to provide a design margin for the Sulfur Recovery
Units, each unit is designed for 75% of the normal feed rates, which
results in a nominal sulfur production of 52 MT/D.
3.3.2 Sulfur Block Feed Streams
3.3.2.1 Amine Treating Unit Feed Gas (Max Contaminate Case)
Composition, mol fraction
Combined Sour
Offgas
H
2
0.583538
H
2
S 0.133806
NH
3
0.000146
Methane 0.023661
Ethane 0.018913
Propane 0.016896
i-Butane 0.008563
n-Butane 0.115412
i-Pentane 0.057487
n-Pentane 0.030181
nC6 0.00264
H
2
O 0.008757
Naphtha + -
Total, kgmol/hr 463.85
Total, kg/hr 9902
Temp, C 38
Press, kg/cm
2
(g) 6
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-8
3.3.2.2 Rich Amine to Amine Regeneration Unit
Composition,
kmol/hr
Rich MDEA
from DHT RGS
Rich MDEA
from LPG
Absorber
H
2
O 752.79 1027.14
MDEA 61.32 83.56
H
2
S 14.31 11.49
NH
3
0.00088 -
CO
2
- 8.24
H
2
0.51 -
Methane
0.01 -
Ethane
0.004 0.04
Propane
0.002 0.09
i-Butane
0.0004 0.04
n-Butane
0.0004 0.12
Heptane 0.0006
C1/C2 RSH - 0.04
Total 828.95 1130.75
Total, kg/hr 21358 29231
Temp, C 63 41
Press, kg/cm
2
(g) 4.5 4.5
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-9
3.3.2.1 Sour Water to SWS (Max Contaminant Case)
Composition
kgmol/hr
Sour
Water
from
NHT
(1)
Sour
Water
from
KHT
Sour
Water
from
DHT
Sour
Water
from
CFU
Sour
Water
from UOP
Guard
Bed
H
2
--- 0.23 0.16 --- ---
NH
3
0.03 0.06 0.22 0.02 0.0005
H
2
S
0.53 0.58 0.50 0.02 0.0010
H
2
O
834.34 425.94 320.09 447.70 0.7986
Total
834.90 426.81 320.97 447.75 0.8000
Total - kg/hr
15050 7695 5788 8067 14
Temp, C
52 55 54 60 38
Press,
kg/cm
2
(g) 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0 3.0
Note (1) The maximum NHT sour water rate is 19585 kg/h containing 35 wt
ppm H2S and 18 wt ppm NH3 when running 100% NWS Narrow
feed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-10
3.3.2.2 Fuel Gas Streams
Fuel gas for the Sulfur Block is supplied from the treated fuel gas
header. The treated fuel gas is used only for the fuel to the Thermal
Oxidizer Burner. Vaporized C4 LPG is supplied to the Acid Gas
Burner, Acid Gas Burner Pilot, and the Thermal Oxidizer Burner
Pilot.
Composition, mole %
Treated Fuel
Gas
Hydrogen 67.353
H2S 0.010
Water Vapor 1.067
Methane 2.729
Ethane 2.180
Propane 1.948
i-Butane 0.988
n-Butane 13.306
i-Pentane 6.633
n-Pentane 3.481
C
6
+ 0.305
Totals 100.000
Temperature, C
38
Pressure, kg/cm
2
(g) (min)
3.5
LHV, kcal/kg
10,425
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-11
3.3.2.3 Hydrogen Stream (Reducing Gas)
Composition, mole % PSA Hydrogen
Hydrogen 99.9
Nitrogen ---
CO & CO
2
20 ppm
Methane 0.1
Ethane ---
Propane ---
i-Butane ---
n-Butane ---
Totals 100.0
Temperature, C 40
Pressure, kg/cm
2
(g) (min) 25
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-12
3.3.3 Effluent Stream Conditions
3.3.3.1 Treated Fuel Gas from ATU
Stream: Treated Gas
Temperature C normal / max 38 / 40
Pressure kg/cm
2
(g) min / max 3.5 / 4.2
H
2
S ppmv max (dry) 100
3.3.3.1 Treated Water from SWS
Stream: Treated water
Temperature C max 60
Pressure kg/cm
2
(g) min 5.0
H
2
S ppmw max 20
NH
3
ppmw max 20
3.3.3.1 Incinerated Effluent from TTO
Min. Norm. Max.
Temperature
C
232 288 400
Pressure
kg/cm
2
(g)
atm.
SO
2
ppmv (dry, 0% oxygen)
200
H
2
S ppmv
10
CO
(1)
ppmv
50
NO
X
ppmw
65
Note (1) For oxidation of H
2
S to SO
2,
the normal operating
temperature for the Tailgas Thermal Oxidizer (TTO) is
about 650C. If CO emissions must be limited and,
therefore, the CO must be oxidized to CO
2
, then the
normal operating temperature for the TTO is about
816C.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-13
3.3.3.1 Molten Sulfur
Min. Norm. Max.
Temperature C 119 138
Pressure kg/cm
2
(g) atm.
Purity % (dry basis) 99.9
H
2
S ppmw
10
Carbon % 0.2
Color Texas Bright
3.3.4 Other Design Requirements
3.3.4.1
The Lean Amine from the Amine Regeneration Unit is a 35 wt%
MDEA solution with a residual loading of 0.01 mole acid gas / mole
MDEA.
3.3.4.2
The Rich Amine from the DHT, LPG Absorber and Amine Treating
Unit will go to the Amine Regeneration Unit for regeneration. The
maximum Rich Amine loading will be 0.40 mole acid gas / mole
MDEA.
3.3.4.3
Liquid sulfur from the SRU is to be degassed to convert H
2
S
X
species to H
2
S and reduce the concentration of H
2
S to less than
10 PPMW for safe handling.
3.3.4.4
In general, the Sulfur Block is to be designed for a 3-4 year run
length between turnarounds. Mechanical turnaround duration is
usually 3-7 days for each unit.
3.3.4.5
All units are to be designed individually for a 98% or better
on-stream factor.
3.3.4.6
Critical equipment is to be spared, to permit on-line maintenance.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-14
3.3.5 Utility Information
3.3.5.1 Electricity
Service Voltage Phase Cycles
Motors above 132 kW 6,600 V 3 60
Motors 0.2 kW up to and including 132 kW 440 V 3 60
Fractional kW motors up to 0.2 kW 440 V 3 60
3.3.5.2 Steam
Operating Pressure:
kg/cm(g)
Operating Temp.
C
Mechanical
Design
Press: Temp:
Min Norm Max Min Norm Max kg/cm(g) C
HP Steam 44 45 46 380 400 420 50 427
MP Steam 16 17 17.5 275 280 300 20 350
IP Steam 13.7 14.4 15.1 202 204 206 16.7 227
LP Steam 3 3.5 4 190 195 210 5.5 300
3.3.5.3 Condensate
Condensate Destination
or Designation
Grade Level Battery Limit
Pressure: kg/cm(g)
HP Steam HP Condensate 19
MP Steam MP Condensate 6
IP Steam LP Condensate 1.5
LP Steam LP Condensate 1.5
3.3.5.4 Boiler Feed Water
Min.
Normal Max.
Design
BFW Temperature, C 132 132 132 160
BFW Pressure, kg/cm
2
(g) 57 57 58 63
Dissolved Solids, PPMW (avg) < 5
Conductivity, S/cm (avg) <20
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-15
3.3.5.5 Cooling Water
Normal Min. Design
kg/cm
2
(g) C kg/cm
2
(g) C kg/cm
2
(g)
C
Supply 5
(1)
-- -- 32 8 60
Return 2
(1)
-- -- 42 8 60
TSS ppmw 20 max
Chlorides ppmw 1200
Ammonia ppmw nil
Note (1) These conditions are not necessarily the conditions
at the inlet or outlet connections of the equipment.
3.3.5.6 Instrument Air and Plant Air
Min.
Normal Max.
Design
Plant Air, kg/cm
2
(g) 5.5 5.5 6 10
Instrument Air, kg/cm
2
(g) 4 7 8 10
Plant Air Dewpoint C ---
Instrument Air Dewpoint C -40
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 General Page 3-16
3.3.5.7 Gaseous Nitrogen
Min.
Normal Max.
Design
Pressure, kg/cm
2
(g) 4 6 8 10
Composition, mole %
Nitrogen 99.5
Oxygen 20 ppmv (max)
CO 20 ppmv (max)
CO
2
20 ppmv (max)
Other C Compounds 5 ppmv (max)
Chlorine 1 ppmv (max)
H
2
O 5 ppmv (max)
Hydrogen 20 ppmv (max)
Noble Gases Remainder
Total 100.0
3.3.6 Plant Site Conditions
3.3.6.1 Barometric Pressure:
760 mm Hg (average)
3.3.6.2 Air Temperature: 37C (dry bulb) maximum summer design
30C (dry bulb) for air blower design
-10C (dry bulb) minimum winter design
-14.3C (dry bulb) winterizing
3.3.6.3 Site Elevation:
5.6 m above mean sea level
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Power Distribution Page 4-i
Table of Contents
4. POWER DISTRIBUTION .............................................................................................. 4-1
4.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 4-1
4.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 4-1
4.2.1 General ........................................................................................................... 4-1
4.2.2 Hazardous (Classified) Areas ......................................................................... 4-1
4.3 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION ................................................................................ 4-2
4.3.1 Motors and Motor Controls ............................................................................. 4-2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Power Distribution Page 4-1
4. POWER DISTRIBUTION
4.1 Purpose of System
This utility system supplies electrical power to all users in the Amine Treating,
Amine Regeneration, Sour Water Stripping, Sulfur Recovery, Tailgas Cleanup,
Tailgas Thermal Oxidation, and Sulfur Degassing units including motors,
instruments, controls, lights, receptacles, and heat tracing.
4.2 Safety
4.2.1 General
Only authorized and qualified personnel should maintain and repair
electrical equipment. All operator controls and adjustments are accessible
without opening electrical equipment enclosures.
Maintain extreme care when operating electrical equipment and
machinery driven by electrical motors. Equipment may start without
warning.
Observe company safety rules and permit-to-work system.
If you suspect a person has been electrocuted, DO NOT approach the
victim until the source of power has been turned off or it is obvious the
victim is no longer in contact with the source. If possible, drag victim clear
of any metal or potential electrical sources using victim's clothing or by
wearing insulating gloves. If the victim is still in contact with the electrical
source and skin contact is made, you may also be electrocuted.
4.2.2 Hazardous (Classified) Areas
Most of the process areas in the Amine Treating, Amine Regeneration,
Sour Water Stripping, Sulfur Recovery, Tailgas Cleanup, Tailgas Thermal
Oxidation, and Sulfur Degassing units have been classified as Zone 2,
Gas Group IIA/IIB for electrical installation. The only exceptions to this are
any below-grade vaults which have been classified as Zone 1, Gas Group
IIA/IIB.
Locations are classified depending on the properties of the flammable
vapors, liquids, or gases which may be present and the likelihood that a
flammable or combustible concentration or quantity is present. The
electrical equipment and installation in classified areas conforms to the
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Power Distribution Page 4-2
International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) Standards. Special
precautions are required when operating electrical equipment in classified
areas. The equipment should be approved for the area classification or a
"hot-work" permit system should be followed during the period a
non-approved piece of equipment is used in the classified area.
4.3 Equipment Description
4.3.1 Motors and Motor Controls
A. In general, the electric motors are TEFC, 444 VAC, 3 , 60 Hz with
the exception of:
(1) The motors on the Process Air Blower, A2-GB1530A/B, are
TEFC, 6600 VAC, 3 , 60 Hz.
B. The motor control circuits for the Process Air Blower
(A2-GB1530A/B), Thermal Oxidizer Air Blower (A2-GB1570A/B), and
TGCU Start-Up Blower (A2-GB1560) include provisions that allow
the blowers to "ride-through" brief power interruptions.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Plant Control Systems Page 5-i
Table of Contents
5. PLANT CONTROL SYSTEMS ..................................................................................... 5-1
5.1 DISTRIBUTED CONTROL SYSTEM .................................................................... 5-1
5.2 PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROL SYSTEM ................................................. 5-2
5.3 EMERGENCY SHUTDOWN SYSTEMS ............................................................... 5-3
5.4 LOCAL CONTROL PANELS ................................................................................. 5-3
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Plant Control Systems Page 5-1
5. PLANT CONTROL SYSTEMS
This section of the manual describes the various control systems associated with the
new Amine Treating, Amine Regeneration, Sour Water Stripping, Sulfur Recovery,
Tailgas Cleanup, Tailgas Thermal Oxidation, and Sulfur Degassing units. Most of the
process control functions are performed by a Distributed Control System (DCS). The
DCS, with its operator interface screens and keyboards, allows the control room
operator to monitor and control nearly all of the systems within the new units.
The safety system interlocks and sequential control functions are performed by a
programmable logic controller (PLC). A PLC is a solid-state microprocessor that
performs the functions of a traditional relay logic system. The PLC for the new units
will communicate with the DCS to allow the operator to monitor the PLC using the
operator interface screens of the DCS.
5.1 Distributed Control System
The Distributed Control System (DCS) provides control, monitoring, recording,
alarming, and all other functions required for dependable and effective process
control of the facility. It is a microprocessor based, fully engineered system of
hardware and software products integrated into an industrially-proven DCS
design capable of both functional and geographic distribution. A communication
system links these locations to a centralized operating center with video displays
configured as operator workstations.
The system has been designed so that control and monitoring functions are
distributed on a modular basis to minimize control and data information loss in
the event of a failure anywhere within the system. Control functionality does not
depend on a single centrally-based device or communication system to assure
that on a single failure the system will remain operative to allow continued
control and monitoring of the remainder of the process. To achieve this,
redundancy has been included for controllers, power supplies, communication
modules and cables, and operator workstations.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Plant Control Systems Page 5-2
5.2 Programmable Logic Control System
A Programmable Logic Control (PLC) system is used for the new Amine
Treating, Amine Regeneration, Sour Water Stripping, Sulfur Recovery, Tailgas
Cleanup, Tailgas Thermal Oxidation, and Sulfur Degassing units to perform the
functions of traditional relay logic systems. The logic control systems for each
unit are all contained in one or more PLCs. Each logic control system will be
discussed in more detail in later sections of the manual:
a. Amine Treating Unit Emergency Shutdown System (see Section 7.4.2).
b. Sour Water Stripper Unit Interlocks (see Section 8.4).
c. Sulfur Recovery Unit Emergency Shutdown System (SRU ESD) and
Burner Management System (see Sections 9.5.2 and 9.5.8).
d. Sulfur Degassing Unit Startup Interlock and Emergency Shutdown System
(SDU ESD) (see Sections 10.5.3 and 10.5.7).
e. Sulfur Loading Emergency Shutdown System (see Section 10.5.8).
f. Tailgas Cleanup Unit Emergency Shutdown System (TGCU ESD) (see
Section 11.5.5).
g. Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Emergency Shutdown System (TTO ESD) and
Burner Management System (see Sections 12.5.1 and 12.5.5).
The PLC hardware and programs are fail-safe by design. Loss of power to the
PLC will de-energize all its outputs and send devices (control valves, etc.) to
their "fail" position. The restoration of power to the PLC will restart the PLC, but
program interlocks will "lock-out" control actions until the respective ESD
systems are reset. Similarly, the PLC logic has been designed such that open
circuits in field wiring or open field contacts will de-energize their respective
outputs and render equipment and process to a "safe" status.
The PLC system is connected by both "hard-wired" cables and software "links"
that allow it to communicate with the DCS. This enables the DCS operator
interface to be used by the operators to monitor the status of the PLC and its
safety and sequential control systems.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Plant Control Systems Page 5-3
5.3 Emergency Shutdown Systems
The purpose of the Amine Treating Unit Emergency Shutdown (ATU ESD), Sulfur
Recovery Unit Emergency Shutdown (SRU ESD), Tailgas Cleanup Unit
Emergency Shutdown (TGCU ESD), Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Unit Emergency
Shutdown (TTO ESD), and Sulfur Degassing Unit Emergency Shutdown (SDU
ESD) systems is to shut down the appropriate equipment and divert the
appropriate streams to the flare when serious problems occur. Each of these
ESD systems can be initiated either by a system response or by an operator.
Refer to the Instrumentation and Control Systems sections of these guidelines for
complete discussions of these emergency shutdown systems.
These ESD systems are mostly independent of each other, with the exception of
the TGCU ESD system, which is activated when both of the SRU ESD systems
are activated. Except for this situation, activation of the ESD system in a
particular unit will not cause any other ESD systems to be directly activated. Of
course, depending on the particular circumstances, the effects that result when
a particular ESD system is activated may indirectly cause another ESD system
to be activated due to the process upset that occurs.
5.4 Local Control Panels
There are three local control panels that are used for startup of each Sulfur
Recovery Unit and the Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Unit. The functions of these
local panels are described in the Instrumentation and Control Systems sections
of these guidelines for the Sulfur Recovery system and the Tailgas Thermal
Oxidation system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-i
Table of Contents
6. UTILITY SYSTEMS ...................................................................................................... 6-1
6.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 6-1
6.2 SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................... 6-1
6.2.1 Nitrogen Supply .............................................................................................. 6-1
6.2.2 C4 LPG and Treated Fuel Gas Supply .......................................................... 6-2
6.2.3 Hydrogen Supply ............................................................................................ 6-2
6.2.4 Plant Air .......................................................................................................... 6-3
6.2.5 Instrument Air ................................................................................................. 6-3
6.2.6 Sour Water Disposal ....................................................................................... 6-3
6.2.7 Steam, Condensate, Boiler Feed Water, and Blowdown ............................... 6-4
6.2.7.1 Purpose of Systems ................................................................................ 6-4
6.2.7.2 Safety ...................................................................................................... 6-4
6.2.7.3 Process Description ................................................................................ 6-5
6.2.7.4 Boiler Feed Water ................................................................................... 6-5
6.2.7.5 HP Steam ................................................................................................ 6-6
6.2.7.6 LP Steam ................................................................................................. 6-7
6.2.7.7 Condensate Return ................................................................................. 6-7
6.3 PRECOMMISSIONING, STARTUP, AND SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES............. 6-8
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-1
6. UTILITY SYSTEMS
6.1 Purpose of System
The utility headers supply the fluids necessary for plant operation and
maintenance.
6.2 System Description
The Piping and Instrument Diagrams show the utility system tie-ins for this
project. Some of the more important or complex systems are discussed in more
detail in the sections below.
6.2.1 Nitrogen Supply
The SRUs and TGCU have two sections of equipment or piping that are
stagnant during certain modes of operation. One of these, the SRU
warmup bypass line(s), would cause undesirable effects on sulfur
recovery and/or severe corrosion if leakage occurred in the line. The
other one, the TGCU Start-Up Blower, could suffer corrosion if exposed to
wet process gases when it is not running.
The most positive means of preventing these problems is to isolate the
section in question and purge it with inert gas (such as nitrogen). If the
pressure of the purge gas is higher than the process operating pressure,
then any leakage through the isolation valves will be the inert purge gas
leaking out rather than process gas leaking in. Nitrogen is used in this
manner at each of these locations within the new unit.
Nitrogen is also used for several other purposes within the new units: 1) to
purge instruments (flame scanners, pyrometers, flow meters, etc.)
exposed to process gas containing sulfur vapor or ammonia; 2) to empty
out and purge vessels before opening them for maintenance; 3) to prevent
a vacuum from forming in several overhead lines; 4) as the motive fluid for
the aspirator in the air demand analyzer; and 5) as a cool-down medium
for the SRUs and the front-end of the TGCU. A dedicated low pressure
header is used for purges permanently connected to low pressure sulfur
plant equipment; a high pressure header operating at about 7.0 kg/cm
2
(g)
provides nitrogen for the other users.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-2
6.2.2 C4 LPG and Treated Fuel Gas Supply
When the refractory in the Reactor Furnace, A2-BA1530 (A2-BA1540),
must be heated in a controlled fashion according to its cure-out schedule,
fuel is fired in the Acid Gas Burner, A2-BA1531 (A2-BA1541), on manual
control. Variable fuel gas quality could lead to temperature "run-aways" if
there is not close operator attention throughout the heating cycle. For this
reason, vaporized C4 LPG is used as the fuel gas for the Acid Gas
Burner. The heating value of vaporized LPG normally varies much less
than the heating value of a typical treated fuel gas stream, so vaporized
LPG should be much less likely to cause temperature control problems
during this manual operation.
The fuel gas to the Thermal Oxidizer Burner, A2-BA1571, is automatically
adjusted to maintain the desired temperature in the Thermal Oxidizer,
A2-BA1570. In addition, this burner normally operates with considerable
excess air, since the oxygen to oxidize the sulfur compounds entering the
Thermal Oxidizer comes from the burner combustion products. As a
result, the variable nature of treated fuel gas can be tolerated by this
burner much more easily than the Acid Gas Burner, so this burner is
designed to burn treated fuel gas.
The pilot burners for the Acid Gas Burner and the Thermal Oxidizer
Burner are not as reliable if variable quality fuel gas is used. For this
reason, vaporized LPG is used for both pilots to ensure reliable light-off
and good service life.
During normal operation, loss of the treated fuel gas supply will cause the
Thermal Oxidizer to shut down. However, the SRU should continue to
operate. The Thermal Oxidizer shutdown will be due to "flame failure" of
the Thermal Oxidizer Burner. Loss of LPG will normally not affect either
unit, but it will not be possible to restart either unit should a shutdown
occur until the LPG supply is restored.
6.2.3 Hydrogen Supply
The TGCU Unit is designed to use an external supply of reducing gas to
hydrogenate the sulfur compounds in the SRU tailgas back into H
2
S,
rather than generate its own reducing gas. High-purity hydrogen is
imported into the Sulfur Block, let-down to low pressure, and combined
with the SRU tailgas upstream of the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer,
A2-ME1560. If the hydrogen supply is interrupted, it is likely that the
TGCU Unit will have to be bypassed until the hydrogen supply is restored.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-3
6.2.4 Plant Air
The Plant Air system provides compressed air for the utility air stations
throughout the plant. It can be used for operating pneumatic tools and
other pneumatic equipment such as air movers, spray guns, and sand
blasting apparatus. Plant air is also used in the Tailgas Cleanup Unit for
catalyst passivation.
6.2.5 Instrument Air
Dry instrument air is used to provide the motive force to operate the
control valves and shutdown valves in the Sulfur Block. Loss of the air
supply for brief periods will probably not cause any operational problems.
However, if the instrument air pressure falls below about 4.2 kg/cm
2
(g),
some of the large process gas valves may begin to move. If one of the
process gas valves that is in the open flowpath through the SRUs, the
TGCU, and the TTO should begin to close, the ESD system for that SRU
and/or the TGCU will be activated, resulting in an SRU and/or TGCU
shutdown.
6.2.6 Sour Water Disposal
Sour water is produced at several points in the SRU and TGCU, such as
in the Acid Gas Knock-Out Drums, A2-FA1530 (A2-FA1540), the SWS
Gas Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1531 (A2-FA1541), and the excess water
condensed in the TGCU Quench Column, A2-DA1560. Some of this sour
water is intermittent in nature, like the knock-out drum liquids, whereas the
excess quench water will be a continuous flow. The sour water from the
Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum is pumped to the Rich Amine Flash Drum,
A2-FA1513, while the remaining sources are sent to the Sour Water Flash
Drum, A2-FA1520.
Sour water must also be drained from equipment items periodically (pump
cases, level instruments, etc.). The Closed Drain Tank, A2-FA1582, has
an underground header system to collect these liquids and hold them. As
the tank fills, the Closed Drain Pump, A2-GA1581A/B, can be used to
send the collected sour water to Sour Water Stripping Unit.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-4
THE LIQUID DRAINED INTO THE CLOSED DRAIN TANK AND ITS
UNDERGROUND HEADER SYSTEM CONTAINS DISSOLVED H
2
S.
ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS
WHEN DRAINING LIQUID FROM THESE ITEMS OR PERFORMING
MAINTENANCE ON THEM. THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION
OF THIS MANUAL SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF THERE IS ANY
DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK SAFELY WHEN H
2
S MAY BE
PRESENT.
6.2.7 Steam, Condensate, Boiler Feed Water, and Blowdown
6.2.7.1 Purpose of Systems
The Steam system provides heating media for plant systems and
equipment and motive driving power for each vent ejector. The
Condensate system is designed to collect and return the steam
which has been condensed by the users to the Steam system. The
Boiler Feed Water system provides suitably conditioned water to the
steam generators located within the Sulfur Block. The Blowdown
system collects the blowdown water from the boilers in the Sulfur
Block for safe disposal.
6.2.7.2 Safety
Use appropriate safety precautions when handling the boiler feed
water chemicals (sulfite, amine, phosphate, etc.).
The normal operating temperatures in the Steam, Condensate, and
Boiler Feed Water systems are high enough to cause burns:
Steam Pressure Steam Temperature
48.5 kg/cm
2
(g) 262C
45.0 kg/cm
2
(g) 400C superheated
4.2 kg/cm
2
(g) 153C
Personnel should take the appropriate precautions to avoid burns
when working around open vents, open drains, steam traps, or any
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-5
un-insulated piping in the Steam, Condensate, and Boiler Feed
Water systems. It is common for hot water to drip from steam tracing
connections, steam traps, etc. Steam leaks and steam vent streams
can cause severe burns and lacerations. Also, refer to the
discussion concerning boilers in the General Safety section of this
manual, Section 2.13.
6.2.7.3 Process Description
There are three Steam headers (saturated 48.5 kg/cm
2
(g),
superheated 45 kg/cm
2
(g) and saturated 3.5 kg/cm
2
(g)), a low
pressure Condensate Return header, a high pressure Condensate
Return Header, a Cold Condensate Header, a Boiler Feed Water
header, and an atmospheric pressure Blowdown header.
There are six steam generators in the Sulfur Block:
A2-BF1530
Waste Heat Boiler
(sat. 48.5 kg/cm
2
(g) steam)
A2-BF1540
Waste Heat Boiler
(sat. 48.5 kg/cm
2
(g) steam)
A2-EA1531
Sulfur Condenser
(sat. 4.2 kg/cm
2
(g) steam)
A2-EA1541
Sulfur Condenser
(sat. 4.2 kg/cm
2
(g) steam)
A2-EA1561
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer
(sat. 4.2 kg/cm
2
(g) steam)
A2-BF1570 Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler
(superheated 45.0 kg/cm
2
(g) steam)
The different subsystems are described below.
6.2.7.4 Boiler Feed Water
In accordance with the ASME Section I Code for Power Boilers,
boiler feed water must be provided to the Waste Heat Boiler,
A2-BF1530 (A2-BF1540), and the Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat
Boiler, A2-BF1570, at 58.3 kg/cm
2
(g) or higher (i.e., 6% above the
relief valve settings). The BFW supply header must be maintained at
or above this pressure to safely satisfy this requirement.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-6
In accordance with the ASME Section VIII Code for Unfired Steam
Boilers, boiler feed water must be provided to the Sulfur Condenser,
A2-EA1531 (A2-EA1541), and the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer,
A2-EA1561, at 5.8 kg/cm
2
(g)or higher (i.e., 6% above the relief valve
settings).
6.2.7.5 HP Steam
The Waste Heat Boiler, A2-BF1530 (A2-BF1540), generates
HP steam at a normal operating pressure of about 48.5 kg/cm
2
(g). A
small portion of this steam is consumed in the reactor feed heaters to
reheat the feed streams to the catalytic reactors in the SRUs. The
rest of the HP steam is combined with the steam from the Thermal
Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler, A2-BF1570, enters the Steam
Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1570, to remove any entrained water
droplets, and is then routed to the superheat passes in the Thermal
Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler.
The Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler includes a water-tube boiler
that uses part of the waste heat from the Thermal Oxidizer to
generate 48.5 kg/cm
2
(g) saturated steam. The remainder of the
waste heat is used to superheat the steam from this boiler after it
combines with the HP steam produced by the Waste Heat Boiler.
The Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler allows a major portion of
the heat required to incinerate the sulfur compounds to SO
2
to be
recovered as useful steam. The superheated steam is exported to
the refinery HP steam header at about 400C and 45.0 kg/cm
2
(g).
Note that the Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler is the only source
of superheat for the HP steam produced in the Sulfur Block. If the
Thermal Oxidizer shuts down and begins to cool, the steam will no
longer be sufficiently superheated to satisfy the requirements of the
users located outside of battery limits. Under this circumstance, the
steam from the superheat passes of the TTO Waste Heat Boiler will
instead be vented to atmosphere automatically until the Thermal
Oxidizer is restarted and the steam is once again superheated to the
proper temperature.
HP steam is used as motive fluid for the Sulfur Surge Tank Vent
Ejector, A2-EE1530 (A2-EE1540). The steam for this service is
normally supplied from the steam produced within the process train.
When the HP steam is being vented to atmosphere as described
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-7
above, however, steam must be imported into the Sulfur Block for
this equipment item.
6.2.7.6 LP Steam
The Sulfur Condenser, A2-EA1531 (A2-EA1541), in the sulfur plant
and the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, A2-EA1561, in the tailgas
cleanup unit generate LP steam at a normal operating pressure of
about 4.2 kg/cm
2
(g). This LP Steam is used for heating amine acid
gas in the Acid Gas Preheater, A2-EA1530 (A2-EA1540), reboiling
the solvent in the ARU Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1512A/B, the water
in the Sour Water Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1521, and the TGCU
solvent in the TGCU Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1565, miscellaneous
steam tracing and steam jacketing of process gas lines, sulfur
rundown lines, sulfur vapor valves, etc., and for the heating coils in
the Sulfur Surge Tank, A2-EA1531 (A2-EA1531), and Sulfur Storage
Tank, A2-FB1550. The remaining LP Steam is exported to the
refinery.
6.2.7.7 Condensate Return
The HP condensate produced from the HP Steam used in the Sulfur
Block is collected and routed to the HP Condensate return system.
The LP condensate produced from the LP Steam used in the Sulfur
Block is collected and routed to the LP Condensate return system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Utility Systems Page 6-8
6.3 Precommissioning, Startup, and Shutdown Procedures
The utility equipment and piping may be put into service as required by the
process systems they serve. Normal procedures should be followed after
completion of construction to ensure that the lines have been adequately blown
or flushed clean before being commissioned. Other than checking for
cleanliness and possible leaks, and following good practice in venting lines
while they are being filled, no other special procedures should be required to
commission the utility systems.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 7-i
Table of Contents
7. AMINE TREATING & AMINE REGENERATION ......................................................... 7-1
7.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 7-1
7.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 7-1
7.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 7-2
7.3.1 General ........................................................................................................... 7-2
7.3.2 Water Washing ............................................................................................... 7-2
7.3.3 Sour Gas Contacting ...................................................................................... 7-3
7.3.4 Solvent Regeneration ..................................................................................... 7-3
7.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION ................................................................................ 7-6
7.4.1 Wash Water Column, A2-DA1510 .................................................................. 7-6
7.4.2 Amine Absorber, A2-DA1511 ......................................................................... 7-6
7.4.3 Flash Gas Contactor, A2-DA1512 .................................................................. 7-6
7.4.4 Stripper, A2-DA1513 ...................................................................................... 7-6
7.4.5 Wash Water Column Packing, A2-DB1510 .................................................... 7-7
7.4.6 Amine Absorber Trays, A2-DB1511 ............................................................... 7-7
7.4.7 Stripper Trays, A2-DB1513 ............................................................................ 7-7
7.4.8 Amine Absorber Overhead Cooler, A2-EA1510 ............................................. 7-8
7.4.9 Lean/Rich Exchanger, A2-EA1511A/B ........................................................... 7-8
7.4.10 Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1512A/B .................................................................. 7-8
7.4.11 Stripper Reflux Condenser, A2-EC1511 ......................................................... 7-8
7.4.12 Lean Amine Cooler, A2-EC1510 .................................................................... 7-8
7.4.13 Wash Water Feed Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1510 ........................................... 7-8
7.4.14 Amine Absorber Feed Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1511 ..................................... 7-9
7.4.15 Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1512 ............................. 7-9
7.4.16 Rich Amine Flash Drum, A2-FA1513 ............................................................. 7-9
7.4.17 Stripper Reflux Accumulator, A2-FA1514 ..................................................... 7-10
7.4.18 Stripper Reboiler Condensate Pot, A2-FA1515A/B ...................................... 7-10
7.4.19 ATU Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1516 ................................................................. 7-10
7.4.20 ATU Skim Oil Pump Sump, A2-FA1517A/B ................................................. 7-10
7.4.21 ATU Amine Drips Tank, A2-FA1580 ............................................................. 7-11
7.4.22 MDEA Storage Tank, A2-FB1580 ................................................................ 7-11
7.4.23 Wash Water Filter, A2-FD1510A/B ............................................................... 7-11
7.4.24 Rich Amine Filter, A2-FD1511A/B ................................................................ 7-11
7.4.25 Lean Amine Filter, A2-FD1512 ..................................................................... 7-11
7.4.26 Lean Amine Carbon Filter, A2-FD1513 ........................................................ 7-12
7.4.27 Lean Amine After-Filter, A2-FD1514 ............................................................ 7-12
7.4.28 ATU Amine Drips Filter, A2-FD1580 ............................................................ 7-12
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 7-ii
7.4.29 Wash Water Pump, A2-GA1510A/B ............................................................. 7-13
7.4.30 Lean Amine Pump, A2-GA1511A/B ............................................................. 7-13
7.4.31 ATU Skim Oil Pump, A2-GA1512A/B ........................................................... 7-13
7.4.32 Rich Amine Pump, A2-GA1513A/B .............................................................. 7-13
7.4.33 Lean Amine Booster Pump, A2-GA1514A/B ................................................ 7-13
7.4.34 Stripper Reflux Pump, A2-GA1515A/B ......................................................... 7-13
7.4.35 MDEA Transfer Pump, A2-GA1580 .............................................................. 7-14
7.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................. 7-15
7.5.1 Treated Fuel Gas H
2
S Analyzer ................................................................... 7-15
7.5.2 ATU Emergency Shutdown Systems ........................................................... 7-15
7.5.2.1 Causes of ATU ESD .............................................................................. 7-15
7.5.2.2 Effects of ATU ESD ............................................................................... 7-17
7.5.2.3 Non-ESD Shutdowns and Alarms ......................................................... 7-17
7.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ............................. 7-19
7.6.1 Amine Absorber Operation ........................................................................... 7-19
7.6.1.1 Low Temperature .................................................................................. 7-19
7.6.1.2 Acid Gas Loading .................................................................................. 7-20
7.6.1.3 High Amine Concentration .................................................................... 7-20
7.6.2 Stripper Operation ........................................................................................ 7-22
7.6.3 Amine Water Balance ................................................................................... 7-24
7.6.4 Amine Loss ................................................................................................... 7-27
7.6.5 Operation at Low Flow Rates ....................................................................... 7-29
7.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................................. 7-30
7.7.1 Preliminary Check-out .................................................................................. 7-30
7.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out ....................................................................... 7-31
7.7.3 Leak Testing the Process Piping and Equipment ......................................... 7-31
7.7.4 Washing the Wash Water System ................................................................ 7-33
7.7.4.1 Water Flush ........................................................................................... 7-33
7.7.4.2 Acid Wash ............................................................................................. 7-35
7.7.4.3 Alkaline Wash ........................................................................................ 7-36
7.7.4.4 Initial Water Fill ...................................................................................... 7-37
7.7.5 Washing the Amine System ......................................................................... 7-38
7.7.5.1 Water Flush ........................................................................................... 7-38
7.7.5.2 Acid Wash ............................................................................................. 7-43
7.7.5.3 Weak Amine Wash ................................................................................ 7-45
7.7.5.4 Initial Solvent Fill ................................................................................... 7-46
7.7.6 Purging the Low Pressure Columns ............................................................. 7-50
7.7.6.1 Purging the Columns ............................................................................. 7-50
7.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES .................................................................................. 7-52
7.8.1 Wash Water and Amine Systems ................................................................. 7-52
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 7-iii
7.8.2 Sour Fuel Gas Flow to the Columns ............................................................. 7-53
7.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ............................................................................. 7-56
7.9.1 Planned Shutdown - ATU ............................................................................ 7-57
7.9.2 Planned Shutdown - ATU and ARU ............................................................. 7-60
7.9.3 Emergency Shutdown .................................................................................. 7-62
7.9.4 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems .................................. 7-63
7.9.4.1 Steam System Outage .......................................................................... 7-63
7.10 ANALYTICAL PROCEDURES ............................................................................ 7-64
7.10.1 General Procedures for Analyzing ATU/ARU Solvent
,
................................. 7-64
7.10.2 Determination of Amine Concentration in ATU/ARU Solvent ....................... 7-68
7.10.3 Determination of Total Acid Gas Loading in ATU/ARU Solvent ................... 7-70
7.10.4 Determination of H
2
S and CO
2
Loading in ATU/ARU Solvent ...................... 7-72
7.10.5 Determination of Foaming Tendency of ATU/ARU Solvent .......................... 7-76
7.10.6 H
2
S Conc. in Amine Absorber Ovhd by the Tutweiler Method ..................... 7-78
7.10.7 H
2
S Conc. in Amine Absorber Ovhd Using Gas Detector Tubes ................. 7-79
7.10.7.1 Operating Principles .............................................................................. 7-79
7.10.7.2 Sampling the Amine Absorber Overhead Gas ...................................... 7-80
7.10.7.3 Calculations ........................................................................................... 7-81
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-1
7. AMINE TREATING & AMINE REGENERATION
7.1 Purpose of System
The purpose of the Amine Treating system is to remove essentially all the
H
2
S from the sour fuel gas stream using an aqueous amine solvent, MDEA
(methyldiethanolamine). The H
2
S is absorbed in the amine solvent and the
treated fuel gas stream, containing with less than 100 ppmv of H
2
S, is
returned to the complex for consumption as fuel.
The purpose of the Amine Regeneration system is to strip the H
2
S from the
rich amine solvent produced in the Amine Treating, LPG Treating and DHT
units. The H
2
S-laden acid gas is sent to the Sulfur Recovery Unit (SRU) for
disposal and the lean amine is recycled back to the upstream process units.
7.2 Safety
ALL PIPING AND VESSELS INCLUDED IN THIS UNIT EITHER CONTAIN
OR HAVE THE POTENTIAL FOR CONTAINING HAZARDOUS GAS THAT
MAY CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH. THE GAS THAT IS MOST
COMMON AND HAZARDOUS IN A TOXIC WAY IS HYDROGEN SULFIDE.
CLOSE ATTENTION SHOULD BE PAID TO THE "GENERAL SAFETY"
SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES AS TO THE NATURE AND ABILITY
OF THIS GAS TO CONTAMINATE OTHER ELEMENTS IN THIS UNIT.
AN EMPLOYEE'S KNOWLEDGE OF THE HAZARDOUS CHEMICALS AND
COMPOUNDS WITH WHICH HE WILL BE WORKING IS ONE OF THE
MOST BASIC PREREQUISITES FOR HIS OWN SAFETY, THE SAFETY
OF OTHERS, AND THE PROTECTION OF EQUIPMENT. ALL
EMPLOYEES SHOULD REVIEW THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION OF
THESE GUIDELINES OCCASIONALLY TO REFRESH THEIR MEMORIES.
NEW EMPLOYEES SHOULD STUDY IT UNTIL THE INFORMATION IS
THOROUGHLY UNDERSTOOD. PEOPLE WHO HAVE NOT BEEN
PROPERLY TRAINED SHOULD NOT BE ALLOWED TO OPERATE OR
WORK IN AND AROUND THIS PLANT.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-2
7.3 Process Description
7.3.1 General
The Systems Diagram, Material Balance and Process Flow Diagrams,
Dwg. Nos. 507000-7000-01, through -04, are contained in the "Process
Flow Diagrams" Section of the Basic Engineering Package. Please refer
to these drawings to follow this description of the process.
The Amine Treating Unit (ATU) uses an aqueous amine solvent, MDEA
(methyldiethanolamine), to remove essentially all the H
2
S from the sour
fuel gas stream. The normal solvent concentration is 45 wt % MDEA in
water. The ATU is designed to treat 10,397 Nm
3
/hr of sour fuel gas. The
treated gas stream is returned to the refinery for consumption as fuel, and
the acid gas (H
2
S, plus CO
2
) is routed to the Sulfur Recovery Units
(SRUs). Less than 100 PPMV of H
2
S remains in the treated fuel gas.
7.3.2 Water Washing
Sour fuel gas streams in chemical complexes are often contaminated with
various gaseous, liquid, and even solid substances. In order to prevent
these contaminants from causing operating problems (foaming, poor
treating, corrosion, etc.) in the amine solvent system, the sour fuel gas
streams are washed with water to remove the contaminants upstream of
the amine contactors. Some of the more common contaminants are
ammonia (NH
3
), hydrogen cyanide (HCN), and hydrocarbon liquids.
The sour fuel gas enters Wash Water Feed Knock-out Drum, A2-FA1510,
at 38C [100F] and 6.0 kg/cm
2
(g) [85 PSIG]. Any entrained liquids are
removed automatically on level control and routed to the sour liquids
system. The scrubbed gas enters the bottom of the Wash Water Column,
A2-DA1510, and passes upward through a packed bed where it is
countercurrently contacted with a stream of circulating water. The washed
sour gas stream leaves the top of the column and flows to Amine
Absorber Feed Knock-out Drum, A2-FA1511, to remove any wash water
that may be carried over with the gas. The scrubbed gas proceeds to the
Amine Absorber, A2-DA1511, while any wash water carry-over is routed
to the Closed Drain system on level control.
The wash water leaving the bottom of the column is pumped by the Wash
Water Pump, A2-GA1510A/B, to the Wash Water Filter, A2-FD1510A/B,
for removal of any particulates or other solid material removed from the
sour gas feed. Most of the filtered water is returned to the top of Wash
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-3
Water Column on flow control, after being mixed with fresh makeup water.
The remainder of the filtered water is directed to the Sour Water Stripping
Unit (SWS) to purge the gaseous and liquid contaminants removed by the
wash water from the system. The makeup water rate can be adjusted as
necessary to control the contaminants (primarily ammonia in most cases)
at an acceptable concentration, and the level control on the column
bottoms will automatically adjust the purge rate to balance the water
added to the system with the makeup water flow control.
7.3.3 Sour Gas Contacting
The washed sour refinery fuel gas enters the bottom of the Amine
Absorber at 37C [98F] and 5.8 kg/cm
2
(g) [82 PSIG] and passes upward
through 30 trays to be contacted countercurrently with lean MDEA solvent.
As the sour gas is contacted by the amine, the acidic H
2
S (and CO
2
, if
present) in the gas reacts with the basic amine solution:
(1) H
2
S + CH
3
(CH
2
OHCH
2
)
2
N CH
3
(CH
2
OHCH
2
)
2
NH
+
+ HS
(2) CO
2
+ CH
3
(CH
2
OHCH
2
)
2
N + H
2
O CH
3
(CH
2
OHCH
2
)
2
NH
+
+ HCO
3
This is an acid-base reaction, forming an amine "salt" that remains
dissolved in the aqueous solution. The rich amine leaves the bottom of
the column at 58C [136F] on level control and is routed to the Rich
Amine Flash Drum, A2-FA1513. The treated gas leaves the top of the
column and flows to the Amine Absorber Overhead Cooler, A2-EA1510,
where it is cooled to 37C [98F] before flowing to the Amine Absorber
Overhead Knock-out Drum, A2-FA1512, where any solvent carry-over is
recovered and returned to the rich solvent stream on level control. The
scrubbed treated gas at 37C [98F] and 4.5 kg/cm
2
(g) [64 PSIG] is then
routed to the treated fuel gas header for consumption elsewhere in the
complex.
7.3.4 Solvent Regeneration
The combined rich solvent stream from the Amine Treating Unit, the LPG
Treating Unit, and the DHT Unit enters the Rich Amine Flash Drum at
54C [130F]. This vessel is operated at low pressure (0.64 kg/cm
2
(g)
[9 PSIG]) to maximize the vaporization and removal of any light
hydrocarbons that may be entrained or dissolved in the amine solvent. A
small amount of H
2
S will be liberated from the rich amine by the pressure
reduction, so the resulting flash gases enter the bottom of the Flash Gas
Contactor, A2-DA1512, and flow upward through its packed bed to be
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-4
countercurrently contacted with a small stream of lean amine. The amine
will remove most of the H
2
S from the flash gas, so that the treated gas
flowing to the flare will contain 200 PPMV or less of H
2
S. The rich amine
from the bottom of the packed bed falls into the flash drum to join the
other rich solvent.
The flash drum is large enough to provide 30-40 minutes or more of
residence time for the rich solvent. This allows time for any heavy
hydrocarbons entrained in the solvent to separate as a second liquid
phase that spills over the internal weir at the inlet end of the drum,
collecting in the ATU Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1516. The ATU Skim Oil
Pump, A2-GA1512A/B, sends the collected hydrocarbon to the
Condensate Feed Tank on start/stop level control.
After removal of any liquid hydrocarbon, the heavier amine phase passes
under the internal weir at the outlet end of the drum to be pumped through
the Rich Amine Filter, A2-FD1511A/B, by the Rich Amine Pump,
A2-GA1513A/B, on level/flow cascade control. The filter removes
particulates from the solvent before it enters the tube side of the
Lean/Rich Amine Exchanger, A2-EA1511A/B. The Rich Amine is
preheated to 105C [221F] by cooling the lean solvent before flowing to
the Stripper, A2-DA1513, entering between trays #4 and #5.
The Stripper contains 30 valve trays (4 wash water trays, 26 stripping
trays) and one chimney draw tray. As the solvent flows down the column,
the absorbed H
2
S and CO
2
are stripped from the MDEA by countercurrent
contact with stripping steam rising upward. This stripping steam is
generated in the Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1512A/B, using LP
(3.5 kg/cm
2
(g) [50 PSIG]) steam as the heat input. The heat input to the
reboilers is adjusted by flow control of the steam. The steam flow
controllers can be reset by the Stripper overhead temperature, which will
maintain the desired overhead temperature of 114C [238F] by varying
the heat input in proportion to the amount of acid gas contained in the
Rich Amine.
The stripping steam supplies the heat of reaction required to reverse
reactions (1) and (2), and carries the H
2
S and CO
2
stripped from the
solvent overhead to the Stripper Reflux Condenser, A2-EC1511, where
the steam is condensed as the stream is cooled to 49C [120F]. The
condensed water is removed by the Stripper Reflux Accumulator,
A2-FA1514, and returned as reflux to the wash water trays in the tower by
the Stripper Reflux Pump, A2-GA1515A/B. The acid gas (H
2
S and CO
2
,
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-5
along with the uncondensed water) stripped from the solvent exits the
reflux drum at 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) [12 PSIG] and flows to the SRUs.
The Lean Amine Booster Pump, A2-GA1514A/B, pumps the regenerated
lean MDEA solvent from the bottom of the Stripper through the shell side
of the Lean/Rich Amine Exchanger, cooling the lean solvent from 259F to
78C [172F] by countercurrent heat exchange with the cool rich amine. A
slipstream of the lean amine then flows through the Lean Amine Filter,
A2-FD1512, to remove accumulated solids from the solvent and through
the Lean Amine Carbon Filter, A2-FD1513, where the activated carbon
adsorbs contaminants such as hydrocarbons and degradation products
from solvent. The Lean Amine After-Filter, A2-FD1514, catches any
carbon "fines" before the filtered slipstream rejoins the main solvent
stream. A portion of the lean amine flows to the DHT unit on temperature
control while the remainder flows to the Lean Amine Cooler, A2-EC1510,
where it is cooled to 50C [122F].
A small stream of cool lean amine is directed on flow control to the top of
the Flash Gas Contactor as described previously. A portion of the cool
lean amine flows to the LPG Treating Unit and a portion flows to the DHT
unit on temperature control. The remaining lean amine is pumped to
higher pressure by the Lean Amine Pump, A2-GA1511A/B before being
directed on flow control to the top of the Amine Absorber.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-6
7.4 Equipment Description
7.4.1 Wash Water Column, A2-DA1510
The Wash Water Column contains a single bed of random packing to
provide good contact between the sour fuel gas and the circulating wash
water. The tower has a 304 S.S. woven wire mist eliminator above the
packed bed to remove entrained water droplets from the gas before it
leaves the tower.
7.4.2 Amine Absorber, A2-DA1511
The Amine Absorber contains a 30 valve trays to provide good contact
between the sour fuel gas and the amine solvent to remove H
2
S from the
fuel gas. The tower has a 304 S.S. woven wire mist eliminator above the
top bed to remove entrained solvent droplets from the gas before it leaves
the tower.
7.4.3 Flash Gas Contactor, A2-DA1512
As lighter hydrocarbons are allowed to disengage from the amine in the
Rich Amine Flash Tank, a small amine flow scrubs these lighter
hydrocarbons of acid gas as the amine and hydrocarbon flow counter
currently. The Flash Gas Contactor contains a single bed of random
packing which provides good contact between the light hydrocarbon gas
entering below it and the amine fed above it.
7.4.4 Stripper, A2-DA1513
The Stripper contains 28 valve trays to provide good contact between the
rich amine solvent and the reboiler vapors to strip H
2
S and CO
2
from the
solvent. The rich amine enters on the fifth tray from the top; the four trays
above that are "water wash" trays that allow the reflux water (entering on
the top tray) to remove traces of MDEA from the overhead vapor and
minimize solvent losses.
A chimney tray is located below the bottom valve tray to gather all of the
column liquids to feed the Stripper Reboiler. The column section located
below this chimney tray serves to separate the outlet steam and lean
amine from the reboiler and to provide surge for the solvent circulating
system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-7
7.4.5 Wash Water Column Packing, A2-DB1510
This bed of random packing provides good contact between the sour fuel
gas entering below it and the wash water fed above it inside the Wash
Water Column. The packing has a bed limiter above it and rests on a bed
support. The quench water is distributed over the packing by a distributor
tray. The packing is 304 S.S.; the other internals are 304 S.S.
Gaskets are installed where the bed support and distributor tray bolt to the
support ring and clips inside the Wash Water Column to prevent direct
contact between the stainless steel internals and the carbon steel vessel.
This electrically isolates the dissimilar metals from each other to prevent
direct contact that could lead to galvanic corrosion.
7.4.6 Amine Absorber Trays, A2-DB1511
These 1-pass valve trays provide good contact between the fuel gas
entering below it and lean amine fed above it inside the Amine Absorber.
The tray decks and tray downcomers are 304L S.S., and the valves are
fabricated from 304 S.S. to resist corrosion and to prevent "sticking" to the
tray decks.
7.4.7 Stripper Trays, A2-DB1513
These 1-pass valve trays provide good contact between the rich amine
solvent fed above them and the reboiler vapors fed below them inside the
Stripper. The tray decks are 304L S.S., and the valves are fabricated
from 304 S.S. to resist corrosion and to prevent "sticking" to the tray
decks. The chimney tray deck is 304L S.S. The bottom valve tray has a
seal pan for its downcomer to maintain a liquid seal and prevent gas from
blowing up the downcomer.
The chimney tray gathers the tower liquids to feed the reboiler. The outlet
from the reboiler reenters the column below the chimney tray, with the
vapor produced by the reboiler flowing upward through the chimneys in
order to reach the valve trays above.
The top four trays in the column are located above the rich amine feed
point and serve as water-wash trays to minimize the amount of amine
carried-over in the tower overhead. Since these trays have only the reflux
water flowing over them, the liquid rates for these trays are much lower
than for the trays lower in the column. For this reason, these four trays
are designed for minimum leakage (i.e., picket fence weirs, minimum
downcomer clearance, etc.).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-8
7.4.8 Amine Absorber Overhead Cooler, A2-EA1510
This shell and tube exchanger is used to provide the final cooling of the
treated fuel gas, with cooling water from the complex as the cooling
medium.
7.4.9 Lean/Rich Exchanger, A2-EA1511A/B
These shell and tube exchangers conserve energy by providing heat
exchange between the rich amine and the lean amine, so that the hot lean
amine leaving the Stripper can preheat the rich amine before it feeds the
Stripper. This cross exchange saves reboiler duty by preheating the rich
amine, and reduces the load on the Lean Amine Cooler by partially
cooling the hot lean amine.
7.4.10 Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1512A/B
The Stripper Reboilers are a fixed tubesheet shell and tube heat
exchangers. The exchangers are arranged as once-through vertical
thermosiphon reboilers, mounted on the side of the Stripper. The static
head of the solvent above the inlet nozzle on the lower channel provides
the driving force to circulate the solvent through the tubes. LP steam on
the shell of the exchangers heats the solvent inside the tubes, partially
vaporizing it to create stripping steam to remove the H
2
S and the CO
2
from the solvent flowing down the Stripper.
7.4.11 Stripper Reflux Condenser, A2-EC1511
This forced-draft aerial exchanger provides cooling to condense the
majority of the water from the acid gas stream leaving the overhead of the
Stripper. Fans are used to circulate air across the finned tubes to remove
heat from the overhead stream and condense the water to be used as
reflux for the tower.
7.4.12 Lean Amine Cooler, A2-EC1510
This forced-draft aerial exchanger provides the final cooling of the lean
amine stream returning from the regeneration section of the process.
Fans are used to circulate air across the finned tubes to remove heat from
the solvent.
7.4.13 Wash Water Feed Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1510
This vertical vessel is installed in the inlet sour fuel gas line to remove
liquids from the gas stream before it is routed to the Wash Water Column.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-9
The liquid produced in this vessel is routed to the closed drain on
automatic start/stop control. The vessel is equipped with high level alarms
to warn of a rising level in the drum, and a high-high level shutdown to
activate the ATU ESD system before liquids can reach the column. The
shutdown requires that 2 out of 3 transmitters have a high-high level
indicated.
7.4.14 Amine Absorber Feed Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1511
This vertical vessel is installed in the overhead line from the Wash Water
Column to remove liquids from the gas stream before it is routed to the
Amine Absorber. The liquid produced in this vessel is routed to the closed
drain on automatic start/stop control. The vessel is equipped with high
level alarms to warn of a rising level in the drum, and a high-high level
shutdown to activate the ATU ESD system before liquids can reach the
absorber. The shutdown requires that 2 out of 3 transmitters have a
high-high level indicated.
7.4.15 Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1512
This vertical vessel is installed in the overhead line from the Amine
Absorber to remove liquids from the treated fuel gas stream before it is
routed to the complex fuel gas system. The liquid produced in this vessel
is combined with the rich amine stream leaving the Amine Absorber on
automatic start/stop control.
7.4.16 Rich Amine Flash Drum, A2-FA1513
This horizontal vessel allows for the removal of hydrocarbons that may be
carried out of the various upstream processes with the amine. The rich
amine enters the vessel through a slotted, vertical distributor. Any
hydrocarbon that may be carried with the amine from the upstream
processes will accumulate in the center section of this vessel. When a
sufficient amount of hydrocarbon has accumulated, the hydrocarbon will
overflow the partition and flow into the hydrocarbon section. Lighter
hydrocarbons are disengaged from the amine and exit through the Flash
Gas Contactor where they are washed free of any acid gases.
Hydrocarbon-free amine then passes under another partition, at the
opposite end of the vessel, and into the amine outlet section, where the
amine is pumped to the Stripper.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-10
7.4.17 Stripper Reflux Accumulator, A2-FA1514
This vertical pressure vessel removes condensed water from the stream
leaving the Stripper Reflux Condenser so that the water can be used as
reflux for the Stripper. The vessel has a 304 S.S. woven wire mist
eliminator in the top to remove entrained liquid droplets from the gas
before it leaves the vessel.
7.4.18 Stripper Reboiler Condensate Pot, A2-FA1515A/B
These two vertical pressure vessels collect the condensate from the
Stripper Reboiler and return it to the condensate system on level control.
This method of removing condensate from the exchanger provides much
smoother control of the heat input to the reboiler than a conventional
steam trap could.
As stated above, this vessel is simply a very good steam trap. During
normal operation, the steam pressure required to provide the necessary
reboil heat to the Stripper may be much less than the 3.5-4.2 kg/cm
2
(g)
steam pressure available in the LP steam system. The normal steam
pressure in the shell of the reboiler may be such that the water level in the
condensate pot will rise upwards from the pot, perhaps even within the
shell of the reboiler. During these periods, the level valve will remain fully
open and the sight glass will indicate a full water level. This is a normal
operating condition for this vessel. The vessel will usually operate with a
visible level only when the Stripper Reboiler is operating near its
maximum capacity with full steam pressure on the shell of the exchanger.
Under these conditions, the level control and level valve will function
normally and maintain a water level in the vessel.
7.4.19 ATU Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1516
This horizontal vessel is located in a below-ground concrete vault. It
collects the heavy hydrocarbons from the Rich Amine Flash Tank. The
collected hydrocarbon liquid is pumped back to the Condensate Feed
Tank on stop/start level control.
7.4.20 ATU Skim Oil Pump Sump, A2-FA1517A/B
These vertical vessels house the ATU Skim Oil pumps. Hydrocarbon
liquids from the ATU Skim Oil Sump flow into this vessel and are pumped
out by the ATU Skim Oil Pump.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-11
7.4.21 ATU Amine Drips Tank, A2-FA1580
This horizontal pressure vessel is located in a below-ground concrete
vault. It collects solvent from the ATU via headers when equipment is
drained for maintenance, etc. The vessel will normally operate with little
or no pressure so that gravity-flow is sufficient to cause solvent to drain
into the vessel. The collected solvent is pumped back to the solvent
system in the ATU for reuse when the vessel gets full.
7.4.22 MDEA Storage Tank, A2-FB1580
This vertical, cylindrical, cone roof storage tank holds fresh MDEA solvent
unloaded from transport trucks until it is needed for make-up to the ATU
solvent system.
7.4.23 Wash Water Filter, A2-FD1510A/B
These filters are designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and larger
from the circulating wash water.
7.4.24 Rich Amine Filter, A2-FD1511A/B
These full-flow filters are designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and
larger from the circulating rich solvent, which will help prevent fouling of
the downstream heat exchangers.
THESE FILTERS HANDLE LIQUID CONTAINING H
2
S AND OTHER
HARMFUL SUBSTANCES. ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER
PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS WHEN PERFORMING
MAINTENANCE ON THIS FILTER. THE "GENERAL SAFETY"
SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF
THERE IS ANY DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK SAFELY WHEN
H
2
S MAY BE PRESENT.
7.4.25 Lean Amine Filter, A2-FD1512
This full-flow filter is designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and
larger from the circulating lean solvent.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-12
7.4.26 Lean Amine Carbon Filter, A2-FD1513
This full-flow filter is designed to remove organic contaminants (trace
hydrocarbons, degradation products, etc.) from a slipstream of the
circulating lean solvent using a bed of activated carbon.
7.4.27 Lean Amine After-Filter, A2-FD1514
This filter is designed to remove solid particles, particularly carbon fines,
5 microns and larger from the lean solvent leaving the Lean Amine
Carbon Filter.
7.4.28 ATU Amine Drips Filter, A2-FD1580
This filter is designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and larger from
the recovered solvent drained from equipment, etc. in the ATU. The
recovered solvent is filtered as it is routed back to the ATU.
SINCE THE PUMPS DESCRIBED IN THE FOLLOWING SECTIONS ARE
CONSTRUCTED OF STAINLESS STEEL, DO NOT HYDROTEST THE
ASSOCIATED VESSELS OR PIPING WITH WATER CONTAINING HIGH
LEVELS OF CHLORIDES. AVOID ALLOWING WATER CONTAINING MORE
THAN 50 PPM CHLORIDES TO COME IN CONTACT WITH THESE PUMPS TO
PREVENT STRESS CORROSION CRACKING OF THE STAINLESS STEEL.
THE LIQUID IN THESE PUMPS CONTAINS DISSOLVED H
2
S. THIS H
2
S CAN
BE RELEASED TO THE SURROUNDINGS WHEN LIQUID IS DRAINED FROM
THESE PUMPS OR FROM THE PIPING CONNECTED TO THE PUMPS.
ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS WHEN
DRAINING LIQUID FROM THESE PUMPS OR PERFORMING MAINTENANCE
ON THEM. THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES
SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF THERE IS ANY DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK
SAFELY WHEN H
2
S MAY BE PRESENT.
CAUTION
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-13
7.4.29 Wash Water Pump, A2-GA1510A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to circulate wash water to which is
used to remove contaminates from the sour gas feed stream. Each pump
is designed for the total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These
pumps are equipped with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of
releasing H
2
S to the surroundings.
7.4.30 Lean Amine Pump, A2-GA1511A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the lean amine from the Amine
Regeneration Unit to the Amine Absorber. Each pump is designed for the
total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are equipped
with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to the
surroundings.
7.4.31 ATU Skim Oil Pump, A2-GA1512A/B
These vertical sump-type pump is mounted in the ATU Skim Oil Pump
Sump to transfer the recovered hydrocarbons back to the Condensate
Feed Tank.
7.4.32 Rich Amine Pump, A2-GA1513A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the rich amine from the Rich
Amine Flash Drum to the Stripper. Each pump is designed for the total
duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are equipped with
tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to the
surroundings.
7.4.33 Lean Amine Booster Pump, A2-GA1514A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the lean amine from the Amine
Regeneration Unit to the DHT Unit, the LPG Treating Unit, and to the
suction of the Lean Amine Pumps in the Amine Treating Unit. Each pump
is designed for the total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These
pumps are equipped with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of
releasing H
2
S to the surroundings.
7.4.34 Stripper Reflux Pump, A2-GA1515A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the reflux from the Stripper
Reflux Accumulator to the Stripper. Each pump is designed for the total
duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are equipped with
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-14
tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to the
surroundings.
7.4.35 MDEA Transfer Pump, A2-GA1580
This single-stage centrifugal pump is used to transfer amine from the
MDEA Storage Tank to the ATU solvent system. This pump does not run
continuously so no spare is provided.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-15
7.5 Instrumentation and Control Systems
7.5.1 Treated Fuel Gas H
2
S Analyzer
Analyzer A2-AE15057 measures the H
2
S concentration in the treated fuel
gas leaving Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-out Drum, A2-FA1512. If
the H
2
S concentration exceeds the specification for fuel gas (200 PPMV),
DCS relay A2-AY15057 should start ramping down the signal that
pressure controller A2-PC15057 is supplying to control valve
A2-PV15057. As this valve closes, the pressure will start to rise, until it
reaches the setpoint (6.0 kg/cm
2
(g)) of the over-ride pressure controller,
A2-PC15059, which will then open control valve A2-PV15059 to divert the
fuel gas to the flare header. The duration of the ramping should be about
60 seconds or so, so that the pressure in the system does not change too
rapidly.
Once the H
2
S concentration is back on-specification, A2-AY15057 should
start ramping up the signal from A2-PC15057 to A2-PV15057. As this
control valve opens and the pressure starts to drop back to its normal
value (5.0 kg/cm
2
(g)), the over-ride pressure controller will then close
A2-PV15059, so that the fuel gas is flowing to the fuel gas header once
again. The duration of this ramping should again be about 60 seconds or
so, so that the pressure in the system does not change too rapidly.
A2-HS15057 in the DCS is a bypass to disable relay A2-AY15057 and
prevent it from changing the control signal to A2-PV15057. This switch
can be used to prevent upset of process operations when calibrating or
performing maintenance on the analyzer.
7.5.2 ATU Emergency Shutdown Systems
The purpose of the ATU ESD system is to shut off the flow of sour fuel
gas to the treating system when serious problems occur. The Cause and
Effect Diagrams are contained in the Instrumentation and Controls
Drawings section of the Basic Engineering Package. These diagrams
describe the ATU ESD system in block format. For reference, the causes
and effects of the ESD system shown on these diagrams is explained
below.
7.5.2.1 Causes of ATU ESD
Any one of the devices listed below will activate the ATU ESD
system:
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-16
a. Manual Shutdown Switch, A2-HS15022
An operator can activate the ATU ESD system using these
guidelines shutdown switch in the DCS, a "timed pulse" switch.
b. Wash Water Feed Knock-out Drum High-High Liquid Level,
A2-LT15008A/B/C.
This device prevents liquids in this vessel from entering the
wash water system for the sour refinery fuel gas and
contaminating it, since this could then lead to contamination of
the solvent system. It is set to actuate if the liquid level reaches
1,050 mm above the bottom seam of the vessel. Note that
there are three independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic
is used for the ESD (i.e., at least two transmitters must show
high-high level) to avoid spurious "trips" due to the malfunction
of a single transmitter.
c. Amine Absorber Feed Knock-out Drum High-High Liquid Level,
A2-LT15030A/B/C.
This device prevents liquids in this vessel from entering the
Amine Absorber and contaminating the solvent system. It is set
to actuate if the liquid level reaches 1,200 mm above the
bottom seam of the vessel. Note that there are three
independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic is used for the
ESD.
d. Amine Absorber Low-Low Liquid Level, A2-LT15040A/B/C.
If the solvent level drops too low in the Amine Absorber, large
amounts of high pressure gas could blow through control valve
A2-LV15040 into the Rich Solvent Flash Drum, A2-FA1513, and
other equipment and piping in the ATU/ARU with a lower design
pressure than this column. Loss of solvent in this column could
also result in the treated fuel gas going sour.
This device is set to actuate if the liquid level drops to 450 mm
above the bottom seam of the vessel. To reduce the chances
of blow-through, this device will also de-energize solenoid valve
A2-NY15040 to close the control valve. Note that there are
three independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic is used for
the ESD.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-17
7.5.2.2 Effects of ATU ESD
A shutdown of the Amine Absorber, activated either manually or
automatically, has the following effects on the ATU/ARU:
a. Closes A2-NV15002, blocking the flow of high pressure sour
fuel gas into the ATU.
b. If the ESD system is activated by low-low level in the Amine
Absorber, closes A2-LV15040 to prevent possible blow-through
of high pressure gas into the low pressure sections of the
ATU/ARU.
When S/D valve A2-NV15002 closes to stop the gas flow into the
ATU, the pressure of the incoming sour fuel gas will begin to rise.
When it reaches the setpoint (6.3 kg/cm
2
(g)) of over-ride pressure
controller A2-PC15001, the controller will open control valve
A2-PV15001 to divert the sour gas to the flare header.
7.5.2.3 Non-ESD Shutdowns and Alarms
In addition to the devices listed in Section 7.5.2.1 that activate the
ATU ESD system, there are several interlocks of significance that
either generate an alarm or shut down an individual piece of
equipment. These devices/interlocks and their effects are described
in this section.
a. Wash Water Column Low-Low Level, A2-LT15014A/B/C
The Wash Water Pump (A2-GA1510A/B) could be damaged if
the pump loses suction because the level in the Wash Water
Column drops too low. This device will protect the pump by
stopping it before this can occur. The setpoint is 450 mm
above the bottom seam of the column. Note that there are
three independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic is used for
the shutdown.
b. Treated Fuel Gas High-High H
2
S, A2-AE15057
This device closes pressure control valve A2-PV15057 to the
treated fuel gas header and opens pressure control valve
A2-PV15059 to the flare header when the H
2
S concentration for
the treated fuel gas exceeds 200 ppmv.
a. Rich Amine Flash Drum Low-Low Level, A2-LT15068A/B/C
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-18
The Rich Amine Pump (A2-GA1513A/B) could be damaged if
the pump loses suction because the level in the Rich Amine
Flash Drum drops too low. This device will protect the pump by
stopping it and closing the downstream flow control valve
before this can occur. The setpoint is 685 mm above the
bottom of the vessel. Note that there are three independent
transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic is used for the shutdown.
c. Lean Amine Cooler Fan High Vibration, A2-WSH15080
Each fan on the Lean Amine Cooler (A2-EC1510) is provided
with its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed by the
switch exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to stop the
associated fan and activate an alarm in the DCS.
d. Stripper Low-Low Level, A2-LT15108A/B/C
The Lean Amine Booster Pump (A2-GA1514A/B) could be
damaged if the pump loses suction because the level in the
Stripper drops too low. Likewise, the Lean Amine Pump
(A2-GA1511A/B) could be damaged if the pump loses suction
because the Lean Amine Booster Pump has stopped. This
device will protect these pumps by stopping both pumps before
this scenario can occur. The setpoint is 450 mm above the
bottom seam line of the column. Note that there are three
independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic is used for the
shutdown.
e. Stripper Reflux Condenser Fan High Vibration, A2-WSH15118
Each fan on the Stripper Reflux Condenser (A2-EC1511) is
provided with its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed
by the switch exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to
stop the associated fan and activate an alarm in the DCS.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-19
7.6 Process Principles and Operating Techniques
The more important considerations involved in startup, operation, shutdown,
maintenance, and emergency procedures for the ATU and ARU are
discussed in the remaining sections of this portion of the operating guidelines.
The operator should also be thoroughly acquainted with the equipment and
the "Process Description" section of these guidelines before attempting to
operate the plant in accordance with the operating techniques that follow. If
the function of each portion of the plant equipment is understood, the
sequence of steps outlined in the "procedures" sections will be more easily
understood. In addition, the following general discussion of principles and
techniques will clarify the reasons for some of the procedures.
7.6.1 Amine Absorber Operation
The main requirement for the Amine Absorber is to consistently produce
treated fuel gas which contains a low level of residual H
2
S.
The absorption of H2S in the amine solution is favored by:
1. Low temperature
2. Acid gas loading
3. High amine concentration
4. High H2S partial pressure in the feed stream
5. Intimate contacting
In general practice, items 4 and 5 are not operating variables, having been
fixed by the design criteria for the unit and choice of equipment in the
absorber design.
7.6.1.1 Low Temperature
The lower the temperature of the lean amine solution, the better the
H2S removal. When treating a hydrocarbon gas, however, the lean
amine temperature is limited by the temperature of the gas being
treated. The lean amine temperature must be maintained 3-6C
higher than that of the gas feed stream to avoid any possible
condensation of these vapors. The circulating lean amine
temperature before it enters the absorber is commonly between
27C and 49C.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-20
7.6.1.2 Acid Gas Loading
Good acid gas removal efficiency depends on good amine solution
regeneration, as will be discussed in the following sections. However,
it also depends on restricting the H2S loading in the rich amine to
favor the forward direction of reaction (1) given in section 7.3.3. The
loading of the amine solution is controlled by adjustment of the amine
circulation rate. In most cases, unless special design considerations
have been employed, the rich amine acid gas loading (H2S plus
CO2) should not exceed 0.3 to 0.4 mols total acid gas per mol of
amine present.
7.6.1.3 High Amine Concentration
The concentration of uncombined amine ion is favored by high amine
concentration in the amine solution, good regeneration, and freedom
from strong acids. Practical and economic considerations confirmed
by field experience have generally shown that the optimum amine
concentration is between 15 and 50 wt-% amine depending upon the
type of amine used. This is based on the lowest heat requirement for
the desired H2S removal, the lowest chemical losses, and the fewest
operational problems. The free amine ion concentration in the lean
amine is mainly affected by the efficiency and control of amine
regeneration. The fewer the sulfide ions in the lean amine, the
greater the free amine ion concentration available for removal of
H2S. In most cases, lean amine should not contain more than 0.03
mol H2S per mol amine nor more than 0.1 mol CO2 per mol amine.
The amine strength should be monitored and the amine content of
the circulating amine should be maintained close to the 45% (by
weight) design value. Should the amine concentration decrease
(normally due to blowdown and other amine losses), it will be
necessary to add fresh amine to compensate. Laboratory
procedures for analyzing amine are given in a later section of these
guidelines.
The amine should also be checked periodically for heat-stable salt
content. Heat-stable salts form when the amine in the amine solution
(a base) reacts with strong acids to form salts that do not decompose
at the normal amine regeneration temperature. The most common
heat-stable salts encountered in amine systems are SO
2
salts,
although oxygen contamination of the amine is another common
culprit for heat-stable salts in these systems. Heat-stable salts
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-21
increase the corrosivity of the amine (particularly at higher
temperatures, like in the Stripper Reboiler) and increase the foaming
tendencies of the amine. (Interestingly, heat-stable salts sometimes
improve the H
2
S-removal capability of the amine, but the higher
corrosion rate caused by the salt far outweighs this advantage.)
A heat-stable salt content of 2 wt % or lower is desirable. Salt
contents in the 5-20 wt % range can be corrosive and should be
avoided if possible. The only way to reduce the heat-stable salt
content of the amine is by dilution, blowing down some of the
circulating amine and making up with fresh amine. There is no
means for regenerating heat-stable salt from the amine while it is in
the ATU/ARU, as vacuum distillation is required. (In recent years,
however, several companies have successfully reclaimed amine
on-line using ion exchange on a slipstream of the amine.) There are
firms that specialize in reclaiming amine (usually off-site), and it may
be economical to use such a firm if a large amount of amine has
been contaminated with heat-stable salts. The best practice,
however, is to avoid forming heat-stable salt in the first place by
proper operation of the ATU, and gas-blanketing the fresh amine to
avoid oxygen contamination.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-22
7.6.2 Stripper Operation
The lean amine must remain comparatively free of H
2
S and CO
2
to assure
attainment of the fuel gas specification. These acid gases are removed
from the rich amine in the Stripper by stripping them out with steam. The
stripping steam supplies heat to reverse the acid-base reaction between
the H
2
S/CO
2
and the amine, and also reduces the H
2
S/CO
2
partial
pressure in the vapor phase inside the column to promote mass transfer
from the liquid.
The stripping steam is produced by vaporizing some of the water in the
amine in the Stripper Reboiler, using LP (3.5-4.2 kg/cm
2
(g)) steam for the
heat input. The steam rate to the reboiler (and, hence, the amine stripping
rate) is controlled by A2-FC15112A. Adjust this steam rate as needed to
keep the H
2
S and CO
2
loading in the lean amine low. See Section 7.10 in
these guidelines for appropriate laboratory procedures. For a given
column operating pressure, the overhead temperature is a direct
indication of the stripping rate: the higher the temperature, the more
stripping. Column bottoms temperature should not be used as a guideline
for degree of stripping, as it is a function only of amine concentration and
column pressure.
THE DESIGN STRIPPING STEAM RATE SHOWN ON THE
PROCESS FLOW DIAGRAM SHOULD BE CLOSE TO OPTIMUM.
ALTHOUGH IT MAY BE POSSIBLE TO REDUCE THIS SOMEWHAT
WITHOUT GOING OUT OF COMPLIANCE (I.E., WITH LITTLE
CHANGE IN THE H
2
S LOADING OF THE LEAN SOLVENT),
REDUCING THE STRIPPING STEAM RATE SIGNIFICANTLY CAN
CAUSE ACCELERATED CORROSION DUE TO HIGH CO
2
LOADINGS IN THE LEAN SOLVENT. SEVERAL PLANTS HAVE
REPORTED UNEXPECTEDLY HIGH CORROSION RATES IN THE
HOT, HIGH VELOCITY AREAS OF THE LEAN SOLVENT SYSTEM,
SUCH AS THE OUTLET ENDS OF THE REBOILER TUBES AND
THE LEAN SOLVENT PUMPS, AFTER REDUCING THE REBOILER
STEAM.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-23
IF IT IS NECESSARY TO OPTIMIZE THE STEAM TO THE
STRIPPER REBOILER, REDUCE THE STEAM BY SMALL
INCREMENTS AND CHECK THE LEAN SOLVENT LOADINGS
(BOTH H
2
S AND CO
2
) AFTER EACH CHANGE. DO NOT REDUCE
THE STEAM FURTHER IF EITHER LOADING BEGINS TO RISE
SIGNIFICANTLY, AND BE PREPARED TO PERFORM MORE
EXTENSIVE CORROSION MONITORING WHEN OPERATING THE
STRIPPER IN THIS MANNER. REFER TO SECTION 7.10 OF
THESE GUIDELINES FOR THE PROCEDURES TO BE USED TO
DETERMINE THE LEAN SOLVENT LOADINGS.
The withdrawal of lean amine from the bottom of the Stripper is on flow
control to the Amine Absorber. As a result, the level in the bottom of the
Stripper, which serves as the "surge" for the system, will usually indicate if
adjustments of water makeup to the amine system (or water "bleed" from
the system) are required to maintain the proper water balance, as
discussed later in Section 7.6.3 Even if water must be bled from the
system by diverting some of the column reflux to Sour Water Stripping, the
amine content of that waste stream should be low and only infrequent
makeup of fresh amine should be required.
It may also be necessary to "purge" ammonia from the reflux water
periodically by routing some of the reflux water to the Sour Water
Stripping Unit. Although ammonia is usually removed by the circulating
water in the Wash Water Column, over a period of time, however, some of
the ammonia may carry over into the Amine Absorber and dissolve in the
amine.
When this ammonia-containing amine reaches the Stripper, the ammonia
becomes "trapped" because it is too light (volatile) to leave in the column
bottoms and too heavy to leave in the overhead (the acid gas). As a
result, the ammonia will become concentrated in the reflux water, to the
point where it exceeds its solubility limits and begins to cause plugging
problems. If this problem is suspected, simply "bleed" a small amount of
the reflux water to the disposal header to purge the ammonia from the
system, using the bleed water flow controller in the DCS to control the
bleed water rate while monitoring the reflux flow rate to ensure that
adequate reflux is maintained to the Stripper. Operating experience will
show how often (and how much) the reflux must be purged in this manner
to prevent excessive ammonia concentrations for a particular plant.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-24
There is full-flow of rich amine through the Rich Amine Filter, and full-flow
of lean amine flow through the Lean Amine Filter, the Lean Amine Carbon
Filter, and the Lean Amine After-Filter. These four filters will remove
solids and organic contaminants from the circulating amine, such as
degradation or corrosion products. The filter elements should be changed
as soon as the "change" pressure drop is reached, to remove as many
solids from the amine as possible. Finely divided solids can cause
foaming and thereby limit column capacity. While it is possible to reduce
foaming to some extent with anti-foam agents, the presence of such
agents may also reduce H
2
S/CO
2
selectivity in the Amine Absorber, so it
is preferable that they not be used as an alternative to regular
conscientious filter maintenance
7.6.3 Amine Water Balance
The water content of the circulating amine is determined by the following
factors:
1. The water content of the feed gas to the Amine Absorber (the
overhead from the Wash Water Column).
2. The water content of the treated gas leaving the Amine
Absorber.
3. The water content of the acid gas leaving the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator.
4. The amount of water makeup to (or water "bleed" from) the
amine system.
For given operating pressures, the water content of each gas stream will
be determined by the temperature at the top of the respective vessel
(Water Wash Column, Amine Absorber, and Stripper Reflux Accumulator,
respectively), and will increase as the temperature increases. Since the
Amine Absorber inlet gas is at a slightly higher pressure than the outlet
treated gas, the inlet gas will normally contain less water than is contained
in the outlet gas (if both gas streams are at the same temperature), thus
requiring water makeup to maintain the proper water content of the amine.
This situation will be reversed if the Amine Absorber overhead
temperature is lower than the Wash Water Column overhead temperature,
requiring a "bleed" of water to maintain water balance.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-25
Since the lean amine to the Amine Absorber is on flow control and
withdrawal of the rich amine from the bottom of the Amine Absorber is on
level control, a net gain or loss in the amine water balance will be reflected
by an increase or decrease, respectively, of the liquid level in the bottom
of the Stripper. Observation of this liquid level can thus guide adjustment
of water makeup/bleed rate or operating conditions to maintain the desired
water concentration of the circulating amine. Since the degree of H
2
S
removal can depend on the amine concentration of the amine, the
concentration should be maintained close to the design value (45 wt %)
by appropriate maintenance of water concentration. It is usually possible
to control the water balance without adding fresh water or "bleeding" water
to the Sour Water Stripping Unit by adjusting the operating temperatures
in the unit, as discussed in the following paragraphs. Following the steps
outlined below will allow controlling the water balance with minimum
usage of treated makeup water and minimum impact on the sour water
system.
A persistently increasing liquid level in the bottom of the Stripper at
constant flow rates and conditions for Amine Absorber feed gas and
amine indicates a gain in the amine water content. To reduce the water
content of the amine, the preferred sequence of gradual adjustments is:
A. Reduce or terminate water makeup to the amine. Makeup water is
cold condensate.
(1) Begin "bleeding" water (or increase the "bleed" water rate) from
the amine system with the flow controller on the discharge line
of the Stripper Reflux Pump.
Be careful, however, not to starve the Stripper for reflux by
withdrawing too much water. Use the DCS flow indicator for the
reflux water to monitor the operation so that adequate reflux is
maintained to the Stripper when bleeding water from the amine
system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-26
UNDER NORMAL CONDITIONS, THE REFLUX WATER
CONTAINS LITTLE OR NO AMINE BECAUSE OF THE "WASH
WATER" TRAYS ABOVE THE SOLVENT FEED TRAY IN THE
STRIPPER. HOWEVER, IF THE STRIPPER IS FLOODING OR
FOAMING (AS INDICATED BY HIGH OR ERRATIC COLUMN
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE), THE REFLUX CAN CONTAIN
LARGE AMOUNTS OF AMINE.
IF THE "BLEED" WATER LINE IS IN USE AT SUCH TIMES, A
SIGNIFICANT QUANTITY OF SOLVENT CAN BE LOST TO
THE SOUR WATER SYSTEM, AND WILL HAVE TO BE
REPLACED WITH FRESH AMINE FROM THE STORAGE
TANK. FOR THIS REASON, THE "BLEED" WATER SYSTEM
SHOULD BE BLOCKED-IN DURING UPSETS IN THE
STRIPPER.
(2) Increase the Amine Absorber overhead temperature by raising
the setpoint of the lean solvent temperature controller to
increase the lean solvent temperature.
This will increase the amount of water leaving in the fuel gas,
and it will also reduce the H
2
S-removal capability of the solvent.
An increase in solvent flow rate will probably be needed to
maintain the same H
2
S content in the vent gas, increasing the
load on the Stripper and the other process equipment
associated with the circulating solvent.
(3) Increase the acid gas temperature by increasing the
temperature setpoint of the reflux temperature controller to raise
the outlet temperature from the Stripper Reflux Condenser.
Although this will increase the water content of this stream and
reduce the water in the solvent, the effect will be small because
the quantity of acid gas is small relative to the fuel gas. This
adjustment is the least effective and would not normally be
considered during routine operations.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-27
(4) Should the solvent inventory be difficult to control due to
continuing problems with an excessive amount of water in the
solvent, the steam-heated Stripper Reboiler should be checked
for tube leaks.
B. Conversely, a persistently decreasing liquid level in the bottom of the
Stripper indicates a loss in the solvent water content. To increase
the water content of the solvent, the preferred sequence of gradual
adjustments is:
1. Reduce or terminate the "bleed" water from the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator.
2. Decrease the Amine Absorber overhead temperature by
lowering the lean solvent temperature with the lean solvent
temperature controller to reduce the amount of water leaving in
the fuel gas.
3. Decrease the acid gas temperature with the aerial cooling from
the Stripper Reflux Condenser to reduce the water loss in the
stream as much as possible.
4. Begin water makeup (or increase the makeup water rate) to the
solvent system using the make-up flow controller to add
condensate to the system..
7.6.4 Amine Loss
The loss of MDEA by chemical degradation in the ATU/ARU is expected
to be negligible because the upstream Wash Water Column should wash
out any acids or other contaminates that enter with the sour fuel gas.
Amine degradation can occur, however, under abnormal operating
conditions.
Amine degradation occurs via reactions with acids which can enter the
Amine Absorber when the Wash Water Column is experiencing an upset.
Any traces of acid entering the Amine Absorber will react with the MDEA
to form a thermally non-regenerable complex (i.e., heat-stable salt). If
present in sufficient quantity, this salt can alter the H
2
S-amine equilibrium
and prevent removal of H
2
S to the desired level in the Amine Absorber
overhead. Heat-stable salts also increase the corrosivity of the amine.
Amine quality can be restored by treatment with an amount of caustic
equivalent to the non-regenerable salt present but, if repeated caustic
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-28
treatments are necessary due to repeated mal-operation, the potential for
salt deposition in the system may rise.
The equipment in the ATU/ARU, including the seals of pumps and
blowers, should be operated at positive pressure to minimize the potential
for oxygen (air) ingress into the amine. Oxygen will react with the amine
to produce carboxylic acids that cause the solution to be corrosive. For
this same reason, it is important to maintain an inert gas "blanket" on the
MDEA storage tank to prevent oxygen contamination of the fresh amine.
Amine losses due to entrainment in the treated fuel gas or the acid gas
can be minimized by proper process operation (avoidance of column
overloading, foaming, etc.) and routine inspection of the vessel internals.
Amine losses in the water "bleed" from the Stripper reflux should be
negligible if the rectifying trays (the "wash water" trays above the amine
feed point) in the Stripper are operating properly (no flooding or foaming,
no mechanical damage).
The primary source of amine loss will likely be the mechanical losses from
pump drips, cleaning of filters, etc. Good housekeeping practices,
including prompt replacement or repair of leaking pumps, together with
proper collection of amine drips for reuse (via the ATU Drips Tank,
A2-FA1580), will minimize the mechanical loss of amine.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-29
7.6.5 Operation at Low Flow Rates
The ATU/ARU contains four columns: the Wash Water Column and the
Flash Gas Contactor, which contain structured packing; and the Amine
Absorber and Stripper, which contain valve trays. In general, the liquid
feed rate to packed towers can decrease in proportion with the gas flow
rate down to about 50% of design gas flow rate. Below this point, the
liquid rate cannot be allowed to drop any further without risking poor
column performance due to uneven liquid distribution and wetting of the
packing. Trayed towers typically offer somewhat better turndown,
allowing the liquid rate to drop to 30-40% of design before "weeping" of
the trays begins to significantly affect performance.
In the case of the Wash Water Column, decrease the wash water rate in
proportion with the gas flow rate down to about 50% of design should
maintain adequate performance. (It should be noted, however, that there
is really no detrimental effect if the wash water circulation is simply left at
the design value at all times. The only drawback is slightly higher power
consumption by the pump and aerial cooler.)
In the packed Amine Absorber, circulating more amine relative to the gas
flow rate should maintain performance. The liquid flow rate should be
maintained at a minimum of about 50%.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-30
7.7 Precommissioning Procedures
Prior to the initial startup, there are a number of precommissioning activities that
are necessary to ensure that the newly constructed plant is ready to be placed
in service. The activities outlined below should serve as a guide, but there may
be others required as a part of your normal plant procedures.
7.7.1 Preliminary Check-out
Check all equipment to ensure that it is properly installed. This will
probably require consulting Manufacturer's literature as well as
construction drawings.
A. Check and lubricate all equipment, in accordance with the
Manufacturer's recommendations.
B. Check the rotation of the following pumps by "bumping" them:
(1) Wash Water Pump.
(2) Rich Amine Pump.
(3) Stripper Reflux Pump.
(4) Lean Amine Pump.
(5) Lean Amine Booster Pump
(6) ATU Skim Oil Pump
(7) MDEA Transfer Pump
C. Check the rotation of the fans on the Lean Amine Cooler and the
Stripper Reflux Condenser, by operating each fan for a short period.
D. Check all piping and equipment to be sure that all blinds have been
removed and that no valves are vented to atmosphere.
E. Place the Instrument Air System in service to all instruments and
check the action of controllers and control valves.
F. Check all relief valves to ensure that they are installed in the proper
locations, the inlet and outlet block valves (if provided) are open, the
bypass valves (if provided) are closed, and the relief valves are set
for the correct relieving pressure.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-31
7.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out
A. Physically check all shutdown activating devices to ensure that they
activate the ESD system.
B. Physically check all devices activated by the ESD system to ensure
that they operate properly.
C. Check all relief valves to ensure that they are installed in the proper
locations and set for the correct relieving pressures.
D. The low-low level shutdowns for the pumps in the wash water and
amine systems will be tested while washing these systems as
described in the following sections.
7.7.3 Leak Testing the Process Piping and Equipment
The process piping and equipment in the ATU can be checked for leaks
by using a temporary nitrogen jumper to pressurize the process side of
the equipment and piping to about 0.6-0.7 kg/cm
2
(g), then checking
flanges, etc. for leaks (usually by applying masking tape or "Snoop" to the
flanges, and by listening for other leaks).
This same procedure can be used to leak test the ATU following
maintenance, before restarting the unit. Whenever plant maintenance
requires opening one or more of the flanged connections in the ATU it is
good practice to leak test the unit before returning it to service. This
allows detecting any leaking connections that may have resulted from the
maintenance operations before sour fuel gas is reintroduced into the unit.
To perform leak testing in the ATU, proceed as follows:
A. Reduce the output from the sour fuel gas hand control in the DCS to
0% to close the Sour Fuel Gas inlet valve.
B. Confirm that the Wash Water Column is isolated from the wash water
circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are all closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the wash
water flow control valve.
(2) The suction valves at the Wash Water Pumps.
(3) The drain valve on the suction line to the pumps.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-32
(4) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the make-up
water flow control valve.
C. Confirm that the Amine Absorber is isolated from the solvent
circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are all closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the lean
solvent flow control valve.
(2) The bypass valve and upstream block valve at the Absorber
level control valve.
(3) The drain valve upstream of the level control valve.
(4) The block valves in the water makeup line.
(5) The bypass valve and upstream block valve at the Absorber
overhead pressure control valve to the SRUs.
(6) The bypass valve and upstream block valve at the Absorber
overhead pressure control valve to the flare.
D. Use a temporary "jumper" to connect a nitrogen supply to one of the
level bridles on the Wash Water Feed Knock-out Drum and establish
a flow of nitrogen into the unit.
E. Continue adding nitrogen until the pressure reaches
0.6-0.7 kg/cm
2
(g).
Due to the volume inside the ATU, it will take several minutes for the
pressure to build up in the unit.
F. Once the desired pressure has been achieved close the valve where
the nitrogen "jumper" is connected to stop the flow of nitrogen. Check
all of the equipment and piping connections for visible or audible
signs of leakage.
G. Disconnect the nitrogen jumper.
H. Re-open valves as necessary to restore the wash water and solvent
circulation loops that were isolated from the columns in the previous
steps.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-33
7.7.4 Washing the Wash Water System
The following procedure is intended to remove grease, rust, scale, dirt,
and trash from the equipment and piping in the Wash Water system
before it is placed in operation. Washing of the system consists of three
steps: an initial water flush to remove dirt and trash from the system; an
acid wash to remove grease, rust, and scale; and a caustic wash to
acclimate the equipment and piping to alkaline pH.
Failure to clean the system properly prior to startup can lead to operating
problems (heat exchanger fouling, rapid filter plugging, etc.).
THIS PROCEDURE REQUIRES WORKING WITH ACIDIC AND
ALKALINE CHEMICALS AND SOLUTIONS. EMPLOYEES MUST
OBSERVE ALL APPLICABLE SAFETY PROCEDURES AND
ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS CONCERNING USAGE OF
PERSONAL PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, HANDLING OF
HAZARDOUS MATERIALS, DISPOSAL OF WASTE STREAMS, ETC.
7.7.4.1 Water Flush
A. Place the Wash Water flow controller in the DCS in "manual"
and set its output to 100% to fully open the Wash Water flow
control valve.
B. Place the Wash Water Column level controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the level control
valve.
C. Confirm that the Sour Fuel Gas inlet hand control in the DCS is
set to 0% output so that the Sour Fuel Gas inlet valve is fully
closed.
D. Verify that the Wash Water flow control valve is fully open.
Open both of its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
E. Verify that the Wash Water Column level control valve is fully
closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-34
F. Verify that the Sour Fuel Gas inlet valve is fully closed. (This
will prevent water from entering the upstream equipment if the
Wash Water Column is accidentally over-filled.)
G. The Wash Water Filters will not be used to filter solids during
this time, but the filter vessels and their piping are to be flushed
and cleaned. Remove the filter elements, then bolt-up the
filters. Open the inlet and outlet block valves on the filters, and
open the bypass valve around the filters.
H. Add water to the top of the Wash Water Column by placing the
Make-up Water flow control valve in manual and setting its
output to 100% to fully open the make-up water flow control
valve.
If make-up water is not available from the Sour Water Stripping
unit, use a temporary jumper to supply water (cold condensate)
to the Wash Water Column.
I. Once there is an adequate level in the column, all the way to
the top of its level gauge open the suction valve on a Wash
Water Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is
flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge
valve.
J. Watch the level in the Wash Water Column while placing the
pump in service to be sure the pump does not lose suction
while filling the downstream piping and equipment. If the level
disappears in the column, shut the pump down until enough
water (or condensate) is added to reestablish the level, then
restart the pump.
K. Once circulation is achieved and the level in the Wash Water
Column is adequate (about halfway up in the level gauge),
discontinue the addition of water (or condensate).
L. Use the low point drain valves to flush out each section of the
system. Leave the drain valves open until the water is clear.
M. Briefly open the bypass valve on the Wash Water Column level
control valve to flush this section of piping to The Sour Water
Stripping Unit. Open the upstream block valve, open the Wash
Water Column level control valve with the level controller in the
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-35
DCS, and use the downstream drain valve to flush the control
station. Once the flush water clears up, close the Wash Water
Column level control valve and the upstream block valve.
N. Circulate the water and blow down the low point drains until all
of the drain water is clear. Add more water ( or condensate) as
necessary to maintain the level in the Wash Water Column.
At some point during the washing procedure, the standby pump
should be placed in service while the other pump is shut down.
This will ensure cleaning out both pumps and their associated
piping.
O. Once the drain water is clear, completely drain the system.
Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the water
velocity helps to flush the solids from all parts of the system.
P. Allow the pump to continue running while the system drains, but
watch the pump closely to verify that the low-low level shutdown
shuts the pump down below the shutdown setpoint. If the level
drops completely out of the gauge glass before the pump shuts
down, stop the pump manually and correct the problem with the
low-low level shutdown before proceeding further.
7.7.4.2 Acid Wash
A weak (0.1 wt %) citric acid solution is used next to remove grease,
rust, and scale from the equipment and piping. The citric acid will
chelate with the iron in the rust and scale so that it dissolves in the
solution.
A. Reestablish a level in the Wash Water Column.
B. Once a level is established, start a Wash Water Pump to begin
circulating the water.
C. Add concentrated citric acid to the circulating water to make a
0.1 wt % citric acid solution.
D. After circulating for about 3 hours, start the other Wash Water
Pump and shut down the first one.
E. Circulate the solution for a total of about 6 hours, blowing down
the low point drains occasionally. Add more water (or
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-36
condensate) if necessary to maintain the level in the Wash
Water Column.
F. Briefly open the bypass valve on the Wash Water Column level
control valve to flush this section of piping to The Sour Water
Stripping Unit. Then open both block valves and use the level
controller in the DCS to open the Wash Water Column level
control valve briefly and flush the control station. Close the
Wash Water Column level control valve and the block valves.
G. After 6 hours, shut down the pump and completely drain the
system. Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the
liquid velocity will help flush any remaining solids from the
system.
7.7.4.3 Alkaline Wash
The washing operation is completed by circulating a weak alkaline
solution through the system. This will neutralize any citric acid left in
the system, and acclimate the system to high pH operation so that no
further scale is removed from the equipment and piping when the
normal Wash Water (8.0-9.5 pH) is circulated.
A. Reestablish a level in the Wash Water Column.
B. Once a level is established, start a Wash Water Pump to begin
circulating the water.
C. Add caustic to the circulating water to make a 0.02 wt%
solution. This should give a pH in the range of 11-22.
D. Check the pH of the circulating water. If the pH is less than 11,
add more caustic until the pH is 11 or higher.
E. After circulating for about 1 hour, start the other Wash Water
Pump and shut down the first one.
F. Circulate the solution for a total of about 2 hours, blowing down
the low point drains occasionally. Add more water (or
condensate) if necessary to maintain the level in the Wash
Water Column.
G. Briefly open the bypass valve on the Wash Water Column level
control valve to flush this section of piping to the sour water
header. Then open both block valves and use the level
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-37
controller in the DCS to open the Wash Water Column level
control valve briefly and flush the control station. Close the
Wash Water Column level control valve and the block valves.
H. After 2 hours, shut down the pump and completely drain the
system. Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the
liquid velocity will help flush any remaining solids from the
system.
7.7.4.4 Initial Water Fill
The Wash Water system should now be clean and ready to place in
service. All that remains is to refill the system with water and
establish the proper operating conditions.
A. Close the inlet and outlet block valves on the Wash Water
Filters (but leave the bypass valve open), then install the proper
element(s) in the filters. Leave the block valves closed for now.
B. Reestablish a level in the Wash Water Column.
C. Once a level is established, start a Wash Water Pump to begin
circulating the water.
D. Place the Wash Water Filters in service as follows:
(1) Open the vent valves on the top of the filters.
(2) "Crack" the filter inlet block valves open slightly and allow
the filters to fill with water. When the filter is full, close the
vent valve.
(3) Open the filter inlet block valves fully and open the outlet
block valves, then close the filter bypass valve.
E. Place the Wash Water flow controller in the DCS in service and
set its setpoint to its normal value. Close the bypass valve on
the Wash Water flow control valve.
F. Confirm that the Wash Water Column level control valve is
closed, then open both of its block valves. Place the level
controller in the DCS in service and set its setpoint to its normal
value.
G. Establish cooling water flow to the Amine Absorber Overhead
Cooler.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-38
The Wash Water system is now ready for service. It can remain in
this operating mode indefinitely while the rest of the ATU is prepared
for startup. Check the system periodically for indications of plugging,
etc. (low flow, erratic pump discharge pressure, high filter pressure
drop), as solid materials may accumulate at various points in the
system over time.
7.7.5 Washing the Amine System
The following procedure is intended to remove grease, rust, scale, dirt,
and trash from the equipment and piping in the solvent system before it is
placed in operation. Washing of the system consists of three steps: an
initial water flush to remove dirt and trash from the system; an acid wash
and rinse to remove grease, rust, and scale; and a weak amine wash and
rinse to acclimate the equipment and piping to alkaline pH.
Failure to clean the system properly prior to startup can lead to operating
problems (column foaming, poor treating, heat exchanger fouling, rapid
filter plugging, etc.).
THIS PROCEDURE REQUIRES WORKING WITH ACIDIC AND
ALKALINE CHEMICALS AND SOLUTIONS. EMPLOYEES MUST
OBSERVE ALL APPLICABLE SAFETY PROCEDURES AND
ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS CONCERNING USAGE OF
PERSONAL PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, HANDLING OF
HAZARDOUS MATERIALS, DISPOSAL OF WASTE STREAMS, ETC.
7.7.5.1 Water Flush
A. Place the following controllers in the DCS in "manual" with their
outputs set as indicated:
(1) Set the output from the lean solvent flow controller to
100% to fully open the lean solvent flow control valve.
(2) Open the manual block valve upstream of the lean solvent
filters.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-39
(3) Set the output from the lean solvent filter bypass flow
controller to 100% to fully open the filter bypass flow
control valve.
(4) Set the output from the Amine Absorber level controller to
100% to fully open the Amine Absorber level control valve.
(5) Set the output from the Rich Amine flow controller to 100%
to fully open the rich amine flow control valve.
(6) Set the output from the amine flow controller to the Flash
Gas Contactor to 100% to fully open the flow control valve.
(7) Set the output from the Stripper Reboiler steam flow
controller to 0% to fully close the steam flow control valve.
(8) Set the output from the Stripper Reflux Accumulator level
controller to 0% to fully close the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator level control valve.
(9) Set the output from the bleed water flow controller to 0% to
fully close the bleed water flow control valve.
(10) Set the output from the flow controller on the spill-back line
to the lean amine cooler to 0% to fully close the spill-back
flow control valve.
(11) Set the output from the makeup water flow controller to 0%
to fully close the makeup water flow control valve.
(12) Set the output from the Stripper pressure controller to 0%
to fully close the overhead pressure control valve to the
SRU.
(13) Set the outputs from the two temperature controllers to 0%
to fully close both temperature control valves to the DHT
Unit.
(14) Set the output from the lean solvent flow controller to the
LPG Treating Unit to 0% to fully close the lean solvent flow
control valve to the LPG Treating Unit.
B. Place the other Stripper pressure controller in "automatic" with a
setpoint of 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g). This will open the pressure control
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-40
valve to the flare if pressure builds in the Stripper during this
procedure.
C. Verify that the following control valves are fully open. Open
both of the isolation block valves and the bypass valve (where
applicable) at each control station.
(1) The lean amine flow control.
(2) The lean amine filter bypass.
(3) The Amine Absorber level control, (the rich solvent from
the Amine Absorber).
(4) The rich solvent flow control (the rich solvent from the Rich
Amine Flash tank)
(5) The lean solvent to the Flash Gas Contactor
D. Verify that the following control valves are fully closed. Close
both of the isolation block valves and the bypass valve at each
control station.
(1) The steam flow control valve to the Stripper Reboiler.
(2) The Stripper Reflux Accumulator level control valve.
(3) The bleed water flow control valve from the Stripper reflux.
(4) The spill-back flow controller to the Lean Amine Cooler.
(5) The makeup water flow control valve.
(6) The acid gas pressure control to the SRU.
E. Verify that the bypass valve on the pressure control valve to the
flare is closed. Open both of the isolation block valves at this
control station.
F. The solvent filters will not be used to filter solids during this
time, but the filter vessels and their piping are to be flushed and
cleaned. Remove the filter elements, then bolt-up the individual
filters. Open the inlet and outlet block valves on each filter, and
open the bypass valves for the filters.
G. Verify that the valves in the amine makeup line are closed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-41
H. Add water (cold condensate) to the Amine Absorber by opening
the flow control valve in the make-up water line.
I. Once there is an adequate level in the Rich Amine Flash Tank,
all the way to the top of its level gauge open the suction valve
on a Rich Amine Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the
pump is flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its
discharge valve.
Watch the level in the Amine Absorber and the Rich Amine
Flash Tank as the pump fills the downstream piping and begins
to fill the Stripper. When the level drops to the low-low level
shutdown it should shut down the pump. If it does not, stop the
pump manually before it loses suction and correct the problem
with the low level shutdown before proceeding.
J. Continue filling the Amine Absorber with condensate and
pumping the water to the Stripper periodically, until the level in
the Stripper is all the way to the top of its level gauge.
K. Once there is an adequate level in the Stripper, open the
suction valve on a Lean Amine Booster Pump and use its drain
valve to be sure the pump is flooded with water. Start the
pump, then open its discharge valve.
L. Once the downstream piping and equipment has been filled
with water, open the suction valve on a Lean Amine Pump and
use its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded with water.
Start the pump, then open its discharge valve
M. As the pump fills the downstream piping and begins to return
water to the Amine Absorber, watch the level in the Stripper to
be sure the Lean Amine Booster Pump does not lose suction. If
the level disappears in the column, shut both pumps down, add
more condensate to the Amine Absorber and pump it to the
Stripper to reestablish the level, then restart the Lean Amine
Booster Pump and the Lean Amine Pump.
N. As the level begins to rise in the Amine Absorber, restart the
Rich Amine Pump. Watch the levels in both columns, and shut
a pump down if necessary to keep from emptying either
column.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-42
O. Once the levels in both columns are adequate, discontinue the
addition of condensate.
P. At this point, neither the flow into or the level of the Amine
Absorber is being controlled. Both control stations are in
"manual" with the valves fully open to flush the piping as much
as possible. Depending on the hydraulics of the system, it may
be necessary to place either or both of these controls in
"automatic" to prevent losing the level in one of the columns. If
so, leave the bypass valve on the control station "cracked" so
that the bypass piping gets flushed.
Q. Use the low point drain valves to flush out each section of the
system. Leave the drain valves open until the water is clear.
R. Circulate the water and blow down the low point drains until all
of the drain water is clear. Add more condensate as necessary
to maintain the levels in the columns.
At some point during the washing procedure, the standby Rich
Amine Pump, standby Lean Amine Pump, and standby Lean
Amine Booster Pump should be placed in service while the
other pumps are shut down. This will ensure cleaning out both
pumps and their associated piping in each service.
At some point in the washing procedure, open the flow control
valve in the spill-back line to the Lean Amine Cooler to clean
out this section of piping. Then close the control valve again.
S. Once the drain water is clear, shut down the Rich Amine Pump
and completely drain the system. Drain the system as quickly
as possible, so that the water velocity will help flush the solids
from all parts of the system.
T. Allow the Lean Amine Pump and the Lean Amine Booster
Pump to continue running while the system drains, but watch
the pumps closely to verify that the Stripper low-low level
shutdown shuts the pumps down when the level falls to the
shutdown setpoint. If the level drops completely out of the
gauge glass before the pumps shut down, stop the pumps
manually and correct the problem with the low level shutdown
before proceeding further.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-43
U. Confirm that the solvent transfer line (for MDEA makeup) has
been flushed and is ready for service.
7.7.5.2 Acid Wash
A weak (0.1 wt %) citric acid solution is used next to remove grease,
rust, and scale from the equipment and piping. The citric acid will
chelate with the iron in the rust and scale so that it dissolves in the
solution.
A. Use the make-up water line to re-establish the levels in the
Amine Absorber, Rich Amine Flash Tank, and the Stripper as
before, and establish circulation of water in the system.
B. Add concentrated citric acid to the circulating water to make a
0.1 wt % citric acid solution.
C. Begin steam flow to the Stripper Reboiler and gradually raise
the temperature of the circulating solution. For maximum
effectiveness, the solution should be 65-95C throughout the
system, so adjust the steam flow accordingly. The fans on the
Lean Amine Cooler should not be operating at this time.
D. It is unlikely that any steam will leave the top of the Stripper
during this operation, so the Stripper Reflux Accumulator should
remain dry. If a level should develop in this vessel, drain the
water from the vessel using a drain valve on one of the Stripper
Reflux Pumps.
E. After circulating for about 3 hours, start the other Rich Amine
Pump and shut down the first one. Do the same with the Lean
Amine Pumps and the Lean Amine Booster Pumps.
F. Open the flow control valve in the spill-back line to the Lean
Amine Cooler and circulate through this section of piping. Then
close the control valve.
G. Circulate the hot solution for a total of about 6 hours, blowing
down the low point drains occasionally. Add more condensate
if necessary to maintain the levels in the columns.
H. After 6 hours, shut off the steam to the Stripper Reboiler, shut
down the pumps, and completely drain the system. Drain the
system as quickly as possible, so that the liquid velocity will
help flush any remaining solids from the system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-44
I. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
Amine Absorber and the Stripper as before, and establish
circulation of water to flush the system.
J. Switch to the other pumps for a few minutes, then shut down
the pumps and completely drain the system.
K. Once again, use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the
levels in the Amine Absorber and the Stripper as before, and
establish circulation of water in the system.
L. Reestablish steam flow to the Stripper Reboiler and gradually
raise the temperature in the column.
M. When the temperature begins to rise in the Stripper overhead
line, start a fan on the Stripper Reflux Condenser and place the
reflux temperature controller in service with a setpoint of 49C.
N. When a level builds in the Stripper Reflux Accumulator, drain it
to the closed drain from the drain on one of the pump cases.
O. Open the downstream block valve at the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator level control valve, then use the drain valve to
blow steam from the column backwards down the reflux line to
remove any debris. Continue until the steam blows clear, then
close the drain valve and the block valve.
P. Continue to circulate water and apply heat in the Stripper
Reboiler, until the water drained from the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator is clear. During this time, blow down the low point
drains occasionally and add more condensate if necessary to
maintain the levels in the columns, and switch to the other Rich
Amine Pump, Lean Amine Booster Pump, and Lean Amine
Pump.
Q. Once the reflux loop has cleared up (the drain water is clear),
shut off the steam to the Stripper Reboiler, shut down the
pumps, and completely drain the system. Drain the system as
quickly as possible, so that the liquid velocity will help flush any
remaining solids from the system.
R. Check the pH of the water draining from the system. If
necessary, repeat Steps K through Q until the pH of the drain
water is about the same as the pH of the condensate makeup.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-45
7.7.5.3 Weak Amine Wash
The washing operation is completed by circulating a weak amine
solution through the system. This will neutralize any citric acid left in
the system, and acclimate the system to alkaline pH operation so
that no further scale is removed from the equipment and piping when
the normal solvent is circulated.
A. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
Amine Absorber and the Stripper as before, and establish
circulation of water in the system.
B. Add enough MDEA to the circulating water to reach a
concentration of about 1 wt%.
C. Begin steam flow to the Stripper Reboiler and gradually raise
the temperature in the column.
D. When the temperature begins to rise in the Stripper overhead
line, check that at least one of the fans is running on the
Stripper Reflux Condenser.
E. When a level builds in the Stripper Reflux Accumulator, open
the suction valve on one of the Stripper Reflux Pumps and use
its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded with water. Start
the pump, open its discharge valve, then open the bypass valve
on the Stripper Reflux Accumulator level control valve to pump
the water back into the Stripper.
Watch the level in the Stripper Reflux Accumulator while
pumping it out. Shut the pump down when the vessel is empty,
then close the suction and discharge valves on the pump and
close the bypass valve on the Stripper Reflux Accumulator level
control valve.
F. Continue to circulate the solution and apply heat to the Stripper
Reboiler, pumping out the Stripper Reflux Accumulator as
required by alternating which pump is used. During this time,
blow down the low point drains occasionally and add more
condensate if necessary to maintain the levels in the columns,
and switch to the other Rich Amine Pump, Lean Amine Booster
Pump and Lean Amine Pump.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-46
G. During one of the pumping cycles for the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator, flush out the minimum flow spill-back line by
opening the manual block valve to allow circulation through this
line. Then close the manual block valve.
H. During another pumping cycle, flush out the bleed water piping
by setting the output of the bleed water flow controller to 100%
to fully open the bleed water flow control valve, opening its
upstream and downstream block valves, and opening its
bypass valve. Then close the valves and set the output of the
bleed water flow control valve back to 0%.
I. Take a sample of the circulating solution and run a foam test on
it using the procedure in Section 7.10.
J. Once the solution drained from all the low point drain valves is
clear, shut off the steam to the Stripper Reboiler, shut down the
pumps, and completely drain the system. Drain the system as
quickly as possible, so that the liquid velocity will help flush any
remaining solids from the system.
K. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
Amine Absorber and the Stripper as before, and establish
circulation of water to flush the system.
L. Open the control valve in the spill-back line to the Lean Amine
Cooler for a few minutes, then close the control valve.
M. Switch to the other pumps for a few minutes, then shut down
the pumps and completely drain the system.
N. If the solvent sample taken in Step I was foamy, repeat Steps A
through M until the solvent is not foamy.
7.7.5.4 Initial Solvent Fill
The solvent system should now be clean, ready to place in service.
All that remains is to fill the system with the proper solvent charge
and establish the proper operating conditions.
NOTE: This procedure prepares the solvent system for operation
in the shortest possible time. However, it does allow the
MDEA to come in contact with oxygen that is in the Amine
Absorber. If a slightly longer startup schedule can be
tolerated, this deficiency can be minimized or eliminated
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-47
by deferring the procedure in this section until nitrogen has
been used to purge the Wash Water Column and Amine
Absorber as described in the following section.
A. Close the inlet and outlet block valves (but leave the bypass
valves open) on the solvent filters, then install the proper
elements and/or carbon in the filters. Leave the block valves
closed on each filter for now.
B. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
Amine Absorber and the Stripper as before, and establish
circulation of water in the system.
C. Add enough MDEA to the circulating water to reach a
concentration of about 45 wt%.
D. Place in service and adjust the level controller on the Amine
Absorber to maintain its normal setpoint. Stop the condensate
and/or amine makeup when the Stripper level is about 50-60%.
E. Begin steam flow to the Stripper Reboiler and gradually raise
the temperature in the column. Place the steam flow controller
in the DCS on "automatic" with its setpoint set to its normal
value.
F. Open the high point vent valve on the Stripper overhead line
and allow the steam to purge any air from the vessel. As the
pressure builds, the vent valve can be closed.
G. Monitor the stripper pressure, and adjust the overhead pressure
controller if necessary to maintain the stripper pressure at about
0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) as the system is heated to operating
temperatures.
H. Ensure that the fans are running on the Lean Amine Cooler and
the Stripper Condenser.
I. Place the lean solvent temperature controllers in "automatic"
and set their setpoints to their normal values.
J. When a level builds in the Stripper Reflux Accumulator, open
the suction valve on one of the Stripper Reflux Pumps and use
its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded with water. Open
the block valves upstream and downstream of the reflux flow
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-48
control valve, place the reflux flow controller in "automatic" with
its setpoint set to its normal value, then start the pump and
open its discharge valve.
K. Open the block valves on the Stripper Reflux Accumulator level
control valve and place the level controller in the DCS in
"automatic" with its setpoint set to its normal value. The
Stripper Reflux Accumulator level control valve will now open as
needed to pump water back into the Stripper and maintain the
desired level in the Stripper Reflux Accumulator.
L. If the control loops on the solvent have not already been placed
in service, do so at this time. Switch the Amine Absorber level
controller, and the lean solvent flow controller in the DCS to
"automatic" with their setpoints set to their normal values.
M. Place the Amine flow controller to the Flash Gas Contactor in
automatic and set its setpoint to its normal value.
N. Place the level controller for the Rich Amine Flash Tank in
service as follows:
(1) Confirm that the level controller in the DCS is in
"automatic".
(2) Confirm that the remote setpoint the level controller is
supplying to the rich amine flow controller matches the
current local setpoint on the flow controller.
(3) Switch the rich amine flow controller to "cascade" mode so
that the setpoint for the rich amine flow will now be adjusted
automatically by the level controller.
(4) The setpoint of the level controller will be set at the last
reading. Adjust the setpoint to its normal value.
O. Place each of the solvent filters in service as follows:
(1) Open the vent valve on the top of the filter.
(2) "Crack" the filter inlet block valve open slightly and allow
the filter to fill with solvent. When the filter is full, close its
vent valve.
(3) Open the inlet and outlet block valves on the filter.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-49
(4) Slowly close the valve in the bypass line around the filter.
P. Analyze a sample of the circulating solvent using the procedure
in these guidelines to determine the amine concentration. Add
more fresh MDEA using the solvent transfer line if needed to
bring the concentration up to the design value, 45 wt %.
Q. Confirm that the bleed water flow controller is in "manual' with
its output set at 0% and that the bleed water flow control valve
is closed, then open its upstream and downstream block valves.
The solvent system is now ready for service. It can remain in this
operating mode indefinitely while the rest of the Sulfur Block is
prepared for startup. Check the system periodically for indications of
plugging, etc. (low flow, erratic pump discharge pressure, high filter
pressure drop), as solid materials may accumulate at various points
in the system over time.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-50
7.7.6 Purging the Low Pressure Columns
Prior to starting up the using the procedures in Section 7.8 of these
guidelines, nitrogen should be used to purge the Wash Water Column and
the Amine Absorber. This will displace the air introduced into the columns
while washing and filling them earlier.
At this point, the following conditions should exist in the ATU:
The Wash Water system and perhaps the amine system have been
cleaned and loaded with their respective initial fills of water and amine.
(The amine system may be waiting on purging of the Amine Absorber
before the system is loaded with amine.)
7.7.6.1 Purging the Columns
To establish nitrogen flow into the ATU, proceed as follows:
A. Reduce the output from the Sour Fuel Gas hand control in the
DCS to 0% to close the Sour Fuel Gas inlet valve.
B. Confirm that the Wash Water Column is isolated from the wash
water circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are
all closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the
wash water flow control valve.
(2) The suction valves at the Wash Water Pumps.
(3) The drain valve on the suction line to the pumps.
(4) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the
make-up water flow control valve.
C. Confirm that the Amine Absorber is isolated from the solvent
circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are all
closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the lean
solvent flow control valve.
(2) The bypass valve and upstream block valve at the
Absorber level control valve.
(3) The drain valve upstream of the level control valve.
(4) The block valves in the water makeup line.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-51
(5) The bypass valve and upstream block valve at the
Absorber overhead pressure control valve.
D. Open all of the vent valves on the PI and PDT taps on the
Wash Water Column and the Amine Absorber, and the vent
valves at the tops of the columns.
E. Use a temporary "jumper" to connect a nitrogen supply to one
of the level bridles on the Wash Water Feed Knock-out Drum
and establish a flow of nitrogen into the unit.
F. Allow the nitrogen to continue flowing long enough to reduce
the oxygen concentration in the equipment and piping to less
than 1%. Use a portable oxygen analyzer to determine the
oxygen concentration.
G. Disconnect the nitrogen jumper.
H. Re-open valves as necessary to restore the wash water and
solvent circulation loops that were isolated from the columns in
the previous steps.
NOTE: If the initial solvent fill was not loaded into the solvent
system earlier to avoid exposing the MDEA to oxygen, this
can be accomplished now. Follow the procedure given in
the previous section to fill the solvent system with its initial
solvent charge.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-52
7.8 Startup Procedures
The ATU is now ready to accept sour fuel gas from the complex.
7.8.1 Wash Water and Amine Systems
Before routing sour fuel gas into the Wash Water Column and the Amine
Absorber, the wash water and amine systems should be operating and
ready to accept sour gas. The operating conditions described below
should have been established previously at the conclusion of the washing
operations but are repeated below to serve as a "checklist" before
introducing sour fuel gas to the columns as described in the sections that
follow.
A. The H
2
S analyzer has been calibrated.
B. The Wash Water system should be charged with its initial fill of
water, so that the level in the Wash Water Column is at the normal
setpoint for the Wash Water Column level controller.
C. Wash Water should be circulating to the Wash Water Column at the
normal setpoint for the Wash Water flow controller.
D. The Wash Water Filter should be in service.
E. The amine system should be charged with its initial fill of amine, with
the level control in the DCS controlling the level in the Amine
Absorber at its normal setpoint and the level control in the DCS
controlling the level in the Rich Amine Flash Tank at its normal
setpoint.
F. The MDEA concentration in the amine should be close to its design
value (45 wt %). Add more fresh MDEA if necessary to bring the
amine to this strength.
G. Amine should be circulating through the Stripper, the Lean/Rich
Exchanger, and the Lean Amine Cooler to the distributor tray at the
top of the Amine Absorber at the normal setpoint for the flow
controller.
H. The fans should be operating on the Lean Amine Cooler, with the
temperature controllers on the lean amine controlling at their normal
setpoints.
I. The Rich Amine Filters should be in service.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-53
J. The lean amine filters should be in service, with the bypass flow
controller controlling at its normal setpoint.
K. Steam should be flowing to the Stripper Reboiler at the normal
setpoint for the flow control.
L. The overhead temperature from the Stripper should be above the low
temperature alarm point for the temperature indicator.
M. The fans should be operating on the Stripper Reflux Condenser with
the temperature controller on the outlet from the Stripper Reflux
Condenser controlling at its normal setpoint or lower.
N. The Stripper pressure controller to the SRU, should be in "manual"
with its output set to 0% so that the pressure control valve is fully
closed.
O. The Stripper pressure controller to the flare should be in "automatic"
with a setpoint of 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g).
P. The level in the Stripper Reflux Accumulator should be at the normal
setpoint for the level control.
Q. A Stripper Reflux Pump should be operating with the minimum flow
lined up to allow reflux to spill back into the Stripper Reflux
Accumulator whenever the level valve back to the Stripper is closed.
With these operating conditions established, the ATU is ready to accept
the sour fuel gas and begin treating it.
7.8.2 Sour Fuel Gas Flow to the Columns
The last step in the startup of the ATU is to bring the sour gas from the
rest of the complex into the Wash Water Column and the Amine Absorber.
They will then remove the H
2
S from the gas before sending it to the
treated fuel gas system. The H
2
S removed will be stripped from the
amine and sent to the flare initially. Once operation of the amine system
stabilizes, this acid gas will be routed to the SRUs.
Before introducing sour fuel gas into the columns, confirm that the proper
operating conditions have been established for the Wash Water and
amine systems.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-54
If any of the proper conditions have not been established, do not proceed
until correcting the problem(s). Once all of the conditions are satisfied,
complete the startup of the as follows:
A. Confirm that the sour fuel gas inlet hand control in the DCS is set to
0% output with the Sour Fuel Gas Inlet Valve closed.
B. Slowly increase the output from the sour fuel gas inlet hand control
to 100%, which will open the Sour Fuel Gas Inlet Valve and admit
sour fuel gas to the Wash Water Column.
C. When the output of the sour fuel gas inlet hand control reaches
100%, the Sour Fuel Gas Inlet Valve should be fully open and the
pressure control valve to the flare should be closed to send all of the
sour fuel gas into the Wash Water Column. Visually confirm that
these valves are properly positioned.
D. Once the operation of the Stripper has stabilized, route its acid gas,
which is presently going to the flare through a pressure valve, to the
SRUs as follows:
(1) Confirm that the Stripper pressure controller to the SRUs
in the DCS is in "manual" with its output set to 0%.
(2) Confirm that the setpoint of the Stripper pressure controller
to the SRU is tracking its current reading, then place it in
"automatic".
(3) Slowly raise the setpoint of the Stripper pressure controller
to the flare to 1.0 kg/cm
2
(g).
(4) If, necessary, adjust the setpoint of the Stripper pressure
controller to the SRU to its normal setpoint.
The Stripper pressure controller will now take over control of the
Stripper pressure by opening the pressure valve to send the acid gas
to the Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum in the SRUs. The Stripper
pressure controller to the flare will close the acid gas pressure valve
and stop the flow of acid gas to the flare. If the SRUs shut down (or
some other upset causes the Stripper pressure to rise), the Stripper
pressure controller to the flare will act as an over-ride and divert the
acid gas to the flare.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-55
E. The ATU is now fully on-stream. Before directing your attention
away from the ATU, be sure that:
(1) All controllers are functioning properly.
(2) The steam heating systems are in service and the level
control on the Reboiler condensate pot is functioning
properly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-56
7.9 Shutdown Procedures
The procedures to be used in performing a planned shutdown of the ATU, or the
ATU and ARU, will vary depending on the extent and type of work to be
performed in and around the units during the downtime period. If maintenance
is to be performed on the ATU, there is no need to also shut down the ARU.
This greatly simplifies and shortens the shutdown procedure. Section 7.9.1 that
follows is an example of such a procedure.
If the ARU must also be shut down, then more extensive procedures must be
followed to accomplish a satisfactory shutdown and minimize the time required
for performance of the desired maintenance work. Section 7.9.2 that follows is
an example of a procedure for this circumstance.
Section 7.9.3 is a discussion of emergency shutdown situations. A guide to
troubleshooting the causes of unplanned shutdowns is presented to assist in
quickly identifying and correcting the problem so that the ATU/ARU can be put
back on-line in a minimum amount of time.
The ATU/ARU is affected directly and indirectly by shutdowns and outages that
occur in other systems within the complex. The more important aspects of the
effects these other systems can have on the ATU/ARU are discussed in
Section 7.9.4.
Typical shutdown procedures are outlined and discussed in the sections that
follow for the more common cases. Your existing company procedures and
common sense operational judgment should be used to modify these
procedures as needed to serve the purpose of any given planned shutdown
situation.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-57
7.9.1 Planned Shutdown - ATU
Any equipment to be opened should be properly blinded and purged with
inert gas before admission of air, to avoid exposure to potentially toxic
gases or the formation of flammable vapor mixtures. Any equipment
containing amine solution that is to be opened or entered should be
drained completely, then flushed with condensate or steamed out to avoid
the possibility of skin or eye irritation.
It is generally preferable to shut down the ATU in a controlled fashion to
minimize the impact on the other process units. If time does not allow
performing a controlled shutdown, however, the unit can be shut down by
simply activating the ESD system (using the manual shutdown switch).
This will automatically block the feed into the ATU (sour fuel gas) and
divert the feed gas to the flare system.
To shut the ATU down in a controlled fashion proceed as follows:
A. Slowly reduce the output from the Sour Fuel Gas hand control in the
DCS. As the pressure in the sour fuel gas inlet line begins to
increase, the override pressure controller will open the pressure
control valve and begin diverting the sour fuel gas to the flare
system.
B. When the output of the Sour Fuel Gas hand control reaches 0%, the
pressure control valve should be open and the Sour Fuel Gas inlet
valve should be fully closed to send all of the sour fuel gas to the
flare system.
Visually confirm that these valves are properly positioned. Confirm
that the DCS indicates that the Sour Fuel Gas Inlet Valve is closed.
C. Allow the amine to continue to circulate until the all of the H
2
S and
CO
2
have been stripped from the amine. Once the H
2
S/CO
2
content
of the "rich" amine leaving the Absorber is essentially the same as
the "lean" amine, the ATU can be shut down and isolated from the
ARU.
D. Depending upon the type and extent of the maintenance work to be
done, the wash water can continue to circulate while maintenance is
being performed on the Amine Absorber. However, if desired, the
wash water system can be shut down as follows:
(1) Shut down the Wash Water Pump
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-58
(2) Place the Wash Water flow controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the wash
water flow control valve.
(3) Place the Wash Water Column level controller in the DCS
in "manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the level
control valve.
(4) Place the make-up water flow controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the
make-up water flow control valve.
(5) Verify that the wash water flow control valve is fully closed.
Close both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
(6) Verify that the Wash Water Column level control valve is
fully closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its
bypass valve.
(7) Verify that the make-up water flow control valve is fully
closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its
bypass valve.
E. Once the H
2
S/CO
2
content of the "rich" amine leaving the Absorber is
essentially the same as the "lean" amine, the ATU can be shut down
as follows:
(1) Shut down the Lean Amine Pump
(2) Place the lean amine flow controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the lean
amine control valve.
(3) Place the amine make-up water flow controller in the DCS
in "manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the
amine make-up water flow control valve.
(4) Place the Amine Absorber level controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 100% to fully open the level
control valve.
(5) Allow the amine to drain from the Amine Absorber until the
low-low level shutdown is activated. This should close the
level control valve. Monitor the level in the Amine Absorber
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-59
and be prepared to close the level control valve if the
low-low level shutdown fails to activate.
(6) Monitor the level in the Rich Amine Flash Tank to ensure
that rich amine does not spill over into the hydrocarbon
section of the vessel. Be prepared to take action and close
the Amine Absorber level control valve if the amine level
gets too high in the Rich Amine Flash Tank.
(7) Drain the remaining amine from the Amine Absorber by
opening the manual block valve in the drain line upstream
of the level control valve to send the remaining amine to
the Solvent Drain System.
(8) Verify that the Amine Absorber level control valve is fully
closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its
bypass valve.
(9) Verify that the lean amine flow control valve is fully closed.
Close both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
(10) Verify that the make-up water flow control valve is fully
closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its
bypass valve.
(11) Verify that the spill-back flow control valve is fully closed.
Close both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
F. The ATU is now ready to be isolated and made safe for entry.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-60
7.9.2 Planned Shutdown - ATU and ARU
Any equipment to be opened should be properly blinded and purged with
inert gas before admission of air, to avoid exposure to potentially toxic
gases or the formation of flammable vapor mixtures. Any equipment
containing amine solution that is to be opened or entered should be
drained completely, then flushed with condensate or steamed out to avoid
the possibility of skin or eye irritation.
To shut the ATU and ARU down in a controlled fashion proceed as
follows:
A. Shutdown and isolate the DHT Unit and the LPG Treating Unit using
the operating procedures for those units.
B. Slowly reduce the output from the Sour Fuel Gas hand control in the
DCS. As the pressure in the sour fuel gas inlet line begins to
increase, the pressure controller will open the pressure control valve
and begin diverting the sour fuel gas to the flare system.
C. When the output of the Sour Fuel Gas hand control reaches 0%, the
pressure control valve should be open and the Sour Fuel Gas inlet
valve should be fully closed to send all of the sour fuel gas to the
flare system.
Visually confirm that these valves are properly positioned. Confirm
that the DCS indicates that the Sour Fuel Gas Inlet Valve is closed.
D. Allow the amine to continue to circulate with steam flowing to the
Stripper Reboiler, until the all of the H
2
S and CO
2
have been stripped
from the amine. Once the H
2
S/CO
2
content of the "rich" amine is
essentially the same as the "lean" amine, the steam can be shut off
to the Stripper Reboiler.
E. Continue to circulate the amine and operate the Lean Amine Cooler
and the Stripper Reflux Condenser until the amine is cool.
F. Depending upon the type and extent of the maintenance work to be
done, the wash water can continue to circulate while maintenance is
being performed on the Amine Absorber or on the equipment in the
ARU. However, if desired, the wash water system can be shut down
as follows:
(1) Shut down the Wash Water Pump
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-61
(2) Place the Wash Water flow controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the wash
water flow control valve.
(3) Place the Wash Water Column level controller in the DCS
in "manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the level
control valve.
(4) Place the make-up water flow controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the
make-up water flow control valve.
(5) Verify that the wash water flow control valve is fully closed.
Close both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
(6) Verify that the Wash Water Column level control valve is
fully closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its
bypass valve.
(7) Verify that the make-up water flow control valve is fully
closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its
bypass valve.
G. Once the amine is cool (60C or less throughout the system), shut
down the equipment in the following order:
(1) The Rich Amine Pump.
(2) The Lean Amine Booster Pump
(3) The Lean Amine Pump.
(4) The Stripper Reflux Pump.
(5) The fans on the Lean Amine Cooler and Stripper Reflux
Condenser.
H. The ATU and ARU are now ready to be isolated and made safe for
entry.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-62
7.9.3 Emergency Shutdown
The ATU ESD system can be initiated by any of the actuating devices
outlined in Section 7.5.2.1 of these guidelines. The operator must
determine and correct the condition causing the shutdown before the can
be restarted. The problems outlined below should be investigated first by
the operator in his troubleshooting procedure.
S/D Actuation Device Possible Causes
Wash Water Feed Knock-Out
Drum
High-High Level
1. Excessive liquids being received by
the Knock-Out Drum.
2. Malfunction of level control system.
3. Level warning transmitters on the
Knock-Out Drum are plugged or
inoperable.
Amine Absorber Feed
Knock-Out Drum
High-High Level
1. Excessive liquids being received by
the Knock-Out Drum.
2. Malfunction of level control system.
3. Level warning transmitters on the
Knock-Out Drum are plugged or
inoperable.
Amine Absorber
Low-Low Level
1. Malfunction of the Lean Amine
Pump
2. Malfunction of the Lean Amine
Booster Pump
3. Malfunction of the lean amine flow
control system
4. Malfunction of the level control
system.
5. Manual drain valve left open.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-63
7.9.4 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems
The ATU/ARU system is directly affected by a shutdown and/or outage in
the LP steam system for the complex. These effects are described below.
7.9.4.1 Steam System Outage
The most immediate impact on the ATU/ARU will be the loss of
LP steam to the Stripper Reboiler if the steam outage lasts long
enough. As the heat input to the reboiler declines, stripping of the
acid gas from the amine will decline and the H
2
S in the treated fuel
gas leaving the Amine Absorber will begin to increase. This will
cause the Treated Fuel Gas analyzer to close the pressure control
valve to the treated fuel gas system to avoid sending off-spec fuel
gas into the complexs fuel gas system. The override pressure
control valve will then open and begin routing the sour fuel gas to the
flare system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-64
7.10 Analytical Procedures
This Section contains analytical procedures for determining:
1. The concentrations of total amine in the ATU/ARU solvent (Section
7.10.2).
2. The concentrations of H
2
S and CO
2
in the ATU/ARU solvent
(Sections 7.10.3 and 7.10.4).
3. The foaming tendency of ATU/ARU solvent (Section 7.10.5).
4. The H
2
S content of the ATU/ARU Amine Absorber overhead gas
(Sections 7.10.6 and 7.10.7).
7.10.1 General Procedures for Analyzing ATU/ARU Solvent
1,2
An amine solution which is to be analyzed should first be inspected
visually. If conducted by an experienced person, such an inspection will
often yield important clues to the identity of a number of contaminants.
For example, a green color in an amine solution usually indicates finely
divided iron sulfide in sub-colloidal particle size (<1 micron), whereas a
finely divided black suspension indicates the presence of larger
(>3 micron) iron sulfide particles. A green or blue solution can indicate the
possibility of either copper or nickel, while an amber colored solution may
contain suspended or dissolved iron oxide. Iron may complex with the
amine an give the solution an amber or dark red color. Thermal
degradation of the amine may give the solution a dark red to brown color.
Amines sometimes display a red or dark brown color resulting from
oxidation, particularly when combined with thermal degradation. An oil
slick on the solution or an oil-like odor is indicative of hydrocarbon
contamination. The presence of these contaminants, however, must be
proven by analysis.
The next step in analyzing an amine solution is the determination of the
percent amine and the acid gas content (H
2
S and CO
2
). Both rich and
lean solutions may be analyzed for these constituents, and from the
analyses the extent of acid gas loading and efficiency of stripping can be
ascertained. Procedures for these analyses are given in Sections 7.10.2
through 7.10.4 that follow.
1
The Dow Chemical Company, Gas Conditioning Fact Book, 1962, pp. 310-311.
2
Dow Chemical U.S.A., Gas Treating from Dow, 1987, pp. 8-1-1 8-1-2.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-65
In addition to the procedure in Section 7.10.2, the amine concentration of
the solvent can be determined by performing Kjeldahl and Van Slyke
nitrogen analyses. The Kjeldahl determination indicates the total nitrogen
content of the solution, including nitrogen from the amine and from amine
degradation products. The Van Slyke method, on the other hand, shows
amine content, but does not reveal the extent to which the original amine
has been degraded or tied up as heat stable salts. The difference
between the results obtained through Kjeldahl and Van Slyke analyses
usually indicates the degree of amine degradation. As would be
expected, little difference is obtained with initial or unused solution. These
analyses are not commonly performed in plant laboratories, but are
generally left to the chemical solvent supplier.
Heat stable salts can also be determined by a total anion assay. The
amine solution is passed through an ion exchange column containing ion
exchange resin in the hydrogen form. Acid salts are thus broken down
and the acids recovered in the column effluent, while the amine is
absorbed in the column. The acid in the effluent is determined by
potentiometric titration, and from these results plus the original amine
concentration the amount of amine in the form of heat stable salts is
calculated. Again, this type of analysis is commonly left for the chemical
solvent supplier to perform.
The foaming characteristics of an amine solution are determined
empirically in a simple apparatus consisting of an air (or gas) supply,
pressure regulator or gas manometer, graduated glass cylinder, and a gas
dispersion tube. The amine solution is poured into the graduated cylinder
and air passed through at a constant rate. After five minutes, the height of
the foam is recorded, the air flow is interrupted, and the time for the foam
to break is determined. The results thus obtained will indicate whether or
not evaluation of anti-foam agents is desirable. Section 7.10.5 describes
this procedure more completely.
A water analysis can be conducted on the amine solution to obtain a
material balance and serve as an approximate check on the amine
concentration. This is typically determined using the Karl Fischer method
of analysis, but most plant laboratories leave this procedure to the
chemical solvent supplier.
Ordinarily, the above analyses will provide an accurate picture of the
condition of the amine plant solution. At times, however, unusual
operational difficulties may be encountered in amine sweetening units
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-66
because of contaminants which are not revealed by the usual analytical
methods. When this occurs, infrared spectroscopic analysis may often be
utilized to good advantage.
Infrared spectroscopy is based on the principle that each molecule or
functional group exhibits its own particular absorption characteristics when
exposed to infrared light of a definite wavelength. A wide variety of
functional groups can be readily detected and identified by infrared
techniques. For example, it has been found that degraded or oxidized
amine solutions may contain ammonia, formic acid, a di-functional acid, a
carbonyl compound yielding a glyoxal dinitrophenylhydrazone derivative,
and a high molecular weight material that exhibits the characteristics of a
Jones polymer. Also, both mono- and di-substituted amines have been
identified. Each component exhibits its own particular effects on
corrosion, foaming, and acid gas absorption, effects which can be
determined only by the separate evaluation of each contaminant. Once
these effects are determined, a knowledge of functional groups present
and their relative concentration makes it possible to anticipate which types
of contaminants may be causing difficulties. The chemical solvent
supplier can usually perform this type of analysis more easily than the
plant laboratory.
Steps should be taken to ensure that the amine solution samples taken
are representative of the circulating solvent. Samples should be taken in
glass or plastic containers. Metal containers will cause low results for H
2
S
because sulfides will react with the metal walls of the container. Do not
use copper tubing to withdraw the samples; the copper will contaminate
the amine solution, and H
2
S will react with the copper and give low
results.
Special care should be exercised when taking samples of the rich amine
solution to avoid personnel exposure to H
2
S. Hot, fully loaded amine
solution can flash acid gas when released to atmospheric pressure,
causing low acid gas loading results in addition to the dispersion of H
2
S to
the surroundings. Take samples of the rich solution from the coolest point
in the process (the Amine Absorber outlet, usually), and cool the samples
in a stainless steel coil immersed in an ice bath or cold water to prevent
flashing. The solution should be allowed to flow to a drain in this fashion
for several minutes before taking the sample to be sure that circulating
amine is being taken.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-67
In the laboratory procedures that follow, several different reagents are
used that can be harmful if proper care is not exercised. Acids, bases,
and flammable substances are utilized in these procedures, so adherence
to proper laboratory safety practices is necessary to ensure the safety of
all personnel.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-68
7.10.2 Determination of Amine Concentration in ATU/ARU Solvent
The amine concentration in the ATU/ARU solvent can be determined by
acid titration of the lean solution. This technique is not specific for free
amine, however, as amine present in the solution as an amine-acid salt
will also react during the titration. This technique will also give erroneous
results if there are other basic materials in the solution, such as caustic or
soda ash (sometimes used to "neutralize" heat stable salts).
1. Reagents: Distilled or Deionized Water
0.5 N Hydrochloric Acid (HCl)
Bromophenol Blue Indicator
(3',3'',5',5''-tetrabromophenolsulfonephthalein)
2. Procedure:
a. Place about 95 ml of distilled or deionized water in a 250 ml
beaker or Erlenmeyer flask.
b. Add about 5 ml of lean amine solution to the water in the beaker
via pipette, recording the actual quantity.
c. Add 5 drops of Bromophenol Blue indicator to the solution in the
beaker and stir well.
d. Titrate the solution in the beaker with 0.5 N HCl to a faint yellow
color. Alternatively, if a pH meter is available, titrate to a pH of
4.5. Record the amount of HCl used in the titration.
3. Chemical reaction involved:
R
2
HN + HCl R
2
HNH
+
+ Cl
where R
2
HN = CH
3
-N-(CH
2
-CH
2
-OH)
2
= MDEA
(methyldiethanolamine)
As the hydrochloric acid is added to the solution, it reacts with the
amine to form a chloride salt. Once all the amine has reacted, the
continued addition of acid causes the pH of the solution to drop, until
the Bromophenol Blue indicator changes from blue to yellow. Note
that HCl reacts with the amine on a 1:1 molar basis.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-69
4. Calculation of Weight Percent Amine:
(
(
(
=
Sample Amine
of Gravity Sp.
Sample
of ml
Solution HCl
of Normality
Used
HCl ml
l / ml 1000
100%
Weight
Mole
Amine
Amine
% Weight
The molecular weight of MDEA is 119.17, and the specific gravity of
the solution at room temperature (20C) is about 1.059, assuming
the solution is about 45 wt% MDEA. The equation can then be
simplified to:
Sample
of ml
Solution HCl
of Normality
Used
HCl ml
11.253 Amine % Weight
(
=
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-70
7.10.3 Determination of Total Acid Gas Loading in ATU/ARU Solvent
The total acid gas (H
2
S + CO
2
) loading, relative to the amine
concentration, in either the lean or rich ATU/ARU solvent can be
determined by base titration of the solution. This procedure does not
distinguish between H
2
S and CO
2
. However, together with the procedure
in Section 7.10.4, the individual concentrations of H
2
S and CO
2
can be
determined.
1. Reagents: Methanol (CH
3
OH), Anhydrous
0.5 N Potassium Hydroxide (KOH) Solution in Methanol
Thymolphthalein Indicator in Methanol
2. Procedure:
a. Place about 125 ml of methanol in a 250 ml beaker or
Erlenmeyer flask.
b. If a pH meter is available, insert the pH meter probe into the
methanol in the beaker and adjust the pH of the methanol to
11.2 by titrating the methanol in the beaker with the 0.5 N KOH.
c. If a pH meter is not available, add 5 drops of Thymolphthalein
indicator to the methanol in the beaker. Titrate the solution in
the beaker with 0.5 N KOH until the solution turns a faint blue
color, indicating a pH of 11.2. The change to faint blue will be
sudden, so add the KOH slowly (one drop at a time).
d. Add about 20 ml of lean amine solution to the methanol in the
beaker via pipette, recording the actual quantity. If rich amine
solution is being tested, use about 10 ml of solution instead.
e. Titrate the solution in the beaker with 0.5 N KOH back to a pH
of 11.2 (or until the solution again turns a faint blue color when
using Thymolphthalein indicator). Record the amount of KOH
used in this titration.
3. Chemical reactions involved:
H
2
S + KOH K
+
+ HS
+ H
2
O
CO
2
+ KOH K
+
+ HCO
3
As the potassium hydroxide is added to the solution, it reacts with the
H
2
S and CO
2
to form potassium hydrosulfide and potassium
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-71
hydrogen carbonate salts. Once all of the acid gas has reacted, the
continued addition of base causes the pH of the solution to rise, until
the Thymolphthalein indicator changes from colorless to blue. Note
that KOH reacts with H
2
S and CO
2
on a 1:1 molar basis.
4. Calculation of Acid Gas Loading (molar basis):
(
(
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of S.G.
Sample
of ml
Solution KOH
of Normality
Used
KOH ml
l / ml 1000
100%
Weight
Mole
Amine
Amine Mole
Gas Acid Moles
Note that "ml KOH used" refers to the amount used in the second
titration, step 2.e. The "wt % amine in solvent" can be determined
using the procedure in Section 7.10.2.
The molecular weight of MDEA is 119.17, and the specific gravity of
the solution at room temperature (20C) is about 1.059, assuming
the solution is about 45 wt% MDEA. The equation can then be
simplified to:
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of ml
Solution KOH
of Normality
Used
KOH ml
11.253
Amine Mole
Gas Acid Moles
5. Special Considerations:
a. Excess moisture in the equipment will give false readings.
Water may be used to clean the equipment if the equipment is
thoroughly dried prior to use with the anhydrous methanol.
b. The faint blue titration endpoint using Thymolphthalein indicator
is not definite. It may best be determined by comparing the
color of the solution against a reference prepared by titrating a
second sample of methanol-Thymolphthalein to the same color.
c. The KOH solution and Thymolphthalein indicator solution
should be kept tightly closed to prevent loss of methanol by
vaporization. Any vaporization of methanol from the KOH
solution will change the normality of the solution.
d. The Thymolphthalein indicator solution can be prepared by
dissolving 5 grams of thymolphthalein in 100 ml of anhydrous
methanol.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-72
7.10.4 Determination of H
2
S and CO
2
Loading in ATU/ARU Solvent
The H
2
S loading, relative to the amine concentration, in either the lean or
rich ATU/ARU solvent can be determined by titration of the solution with
iodine. Since CO
2
does not react with iodine, this procedure is specific for
H
2
S. Together with the total acid gas loading determined using the
procedure in Section 7.10.3, the individual concentrations of H
2
S and CO
2
can be determined.
1. Reagents: Distilled or Deionized Water
Concentrated Hydrochloric Acid (HCl) or Sulfuric Acid
(H
2
SO
4
)
Standard Starch Solution - 1%
0.1 N Iodine Solution (I
2
)
0.1 N Sodium Thiosulfate Solution (Na
2
S
2
O
3
)
2. Procedure:
a. Measure about 25 ml of chilled iodine solution and place it in a
250 ml beaker or Erlenmeyer flask. Record the amount of
iodine solution used.
b. Carefully add about 25 ml of concentrated acid to the beaker.
c. Add about 5 ml of standard starch solution to the beaker, then
re-chill the beaker in an ice batch for 2-3 minutes.
d. Slowly add 10-20 ml of lean amine solution to the solution in the
beaker via pipette, recording the actual quantity. If rich amine
solution is being tested, use 1-2 ml of solution instead.
e. Use about 25 ml of distilled or deionized water to rinse the
inside of the beaker, then swirl the contents gently to mix the
solution without splashing it.
f. Titrate the excess iodine in the sample with the sodium
thiosulfate solution until the blue color disappears. The end
point is a pale yellow or clear color. The approach of the
endpoint is usually indicated by a milky brown tint at the top of
the liquid surface. As the endpoint nears, slow the rate of
titration and use a small amount of distilled or deionized water
to wash the flask. Record the amount of sodium thiosulfate
solution used in this titration.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-73
g. Check the pH of the titrated solution with pH paper to be sure
the solution is acidic. If the solution is not acidic, repeat the
procedure but use more acid in step 2.b.
3. Chemical reactions involved:
H
2
S + I
2
S + 2 HI
I
2
+ Na
2
S
2
O
3
2 S + NaI + NaIO
3
When the solvent is added to the iodine solution, the H
2
S in the
solvent reacts with the iodine to form hydrogen iodide and elemental
sulfur. The solution contains an excess of iodine to ensure that all of
the H
2
S reacts. The iodine solution is chilled prior to adding the
solvent to eliminate or minimize the evolution of H
2
S gas. Note that
H
2
S reacts with iodine on a 1:1 molar basis.
When the sodium thiosulfate solution is added to the solution, it
reacts with the remaining iodine to form sodium iodide and sodium
iodate, along with more elemental sulfur. (It is this elemental sulfur
that may cause the titrated solution to appear pale yellow.) Once the
last bit of iodine is consumed, the starch solution loses its
characteristic blue color. The amount of H
2
S in the solvent sample is
then calculated from the difference between the total iodine and the
iodine that reacts with the sodium thiosulfate. Note that sodium
thiosulfate reacts with iodine on a 1:1 molar basis.
The purpose of the concentrated acid is to neutralize the amine so
that it will release the H
2
S (a weaker acid) so it can react with the
iodine. If the titrated solution is not acidic in step 2.g, then the amine
was not fully neutralized and the H
2
S determination will not be
correct.
4. Calculation of H
2
S Loading (Molar Basis):
(
=
equivalent - g 2
mole - g 1
ml 1000
liter 1
Solution
of Normality
used
ml
Used
moles - g
2
2
2
I
I
I
(
(
(
(
(
=
equivalent - g 2
mole - g 1
ml 1000
liter 1
Solution
O S Na
of Normality
used
O S Na
ml
Used
O S Na
moles - g
3 2 2 3 2 2 3 2 2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-74
( )
(
(
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of S.G.
Sample
of ml
Used O S Na
moles - g
Used
moles - g
% 100
Weight
Mole
Amine
Amine Mole
S H Moles
3 2 2 2
2
I
The "wt % amine in solvent" can be determined using the procedure
in Section 7.10.2.
The molecular weight of MDEA is 119.17, and the specific gravity of
the solution at room temperature (20C) is about 1.059, assuming
the solution is about 45 wt% MDEA. Using these values and
substituting the first and second equations into the third, these
equations can be simplified to:
(
(
(
(
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of ml
Solution
O S Na
of Normality
Used
O S Na ml
Solution
of
Normality
Used
ml
5.626
Amine Mole
S H Moles
3 2 2
3 2 2
2
2
2
I
I
5. Calculation of CO
2
Loading (Molar Basis):
Using the total acid gas loading determined with the procedure in
Section 7.10.3, the CO
2
loading of the solvent is determined by
difference:
(
=
Amine Mole
S H Moles
Amine Mole
Gas Acid Moles
Amine Mole
CO Moles
2 2
6. Other Common Units:
The loadings calculated above can be easily converted to other units
commonly used within the industry:
(
=
Sample
of S.G.
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
S H Moles
166.7
Solvent Gallon
S H Grains
2 2
(
=
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
S H Moles
0.2858 S H % Wt
2
2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-75
(
=
Sample
of S.G.
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
CO Moles
0.2653
Solvent Gallon
CO SCF
2 2
(
=
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
CO Moles
0.3693 CO % Wt
2
2
Note that these conversions are specifically for MDEA. Other
amines require different conversion factors.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-76
7.10.5 Determination of Foaming Tendency of ATU/ARU Solvent
The procedure described in this section is an empirical method for
measuring the foaming tendency of aqueous amine solvents, universally
accepted within the industry.
1. Principle:
Air is bubbled through a solvent sample at a fixed rate for five
minutes, at which time the foam height is measured. The air flow is
stopped and the time for the foam to disappear is measured. The
foam height and "break" time are indicative of how high the foaming
tendency of the solvent is.
2. Equipment: 1000 ml Graduated Cylinder
Aquarium Air Pump (or laboratory air supply) with
Bubble Stone
Stop Watch (or regular watch with a second hand)
3. Procedure:
a. Pour about 200 ml of the sample solution into the graduated
cylinder and insert the bubble stone into the bottom of the
cylinder.
b. Record the level of sample in the cylinder (in ml).
c. Start the air pump or air supply to agitate the sample with
oil-free air at 4 liters per minute (0.2 Nm
3
/H).
d. After five minutes, record the height of the foam in the cylinder
(in ml). Then turn off the air supply and measure the time in
seconds for the foam to "break". For consistency, foam "break"
is defined as the first clear "fish eye" in the surface of the liquid
in the cylinder.
4. Calculation:
Foam Height = Height of Foam - Initial Height of Sample (in ml)
5. Interpretation:
Considerable experience with this test has shown that if the foam
height exceeds 200 ml or the "break" time exceeds 5 seconds, the
plant may be experiencing a foaming problem. The higher the foam
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-77
height and/or the longer it takes to "break", the more severe the
problem.
6. Other Considerations:
a. A nitrogen cylinder with the pressure regulated to about
0.35 kg/cm
2
(g), equipped with a flow rotameter, may be used
instead of air. Be sure to keep the tubing and fittings oil-free.
b. This procedure can be used to evaluate the effects of anti-foam
agents on the solvent. However, care must be exercised in
cleaning the equipment between tests since a very small
quantity of residual anti-foam agent will affect the test.
c. Foaming is sometimes caused by contaminants in the solvent
that can be removed by activated carbon treatment. The effect
of activated carbon filtration can be evaluated by running foam
tests on treated and untreated samples. The sample is treated
by mixing it with a quantity of carbon (12-20 mesh) to remove
the contaminant, then filtering the mixture through Whatman
No. 41 filter paper.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-78
7.10.6 H
2
S Conc. in Amine Absorber Ovhd by the Tutweiler Method
The overhead gas from the Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-out Drum
can be sampled from the sample connection near the sample line for the
H
2
S analyzer.
1. Using a 500 ml Tutweiler apparatus, sample and titrate the treated
gas leaving the Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-out Drum as
outlined in Section 7.10.1 of these guidelines.
2. Chemical reaction involved:
H
2
S + I
2
2 HI + S
The hydrogen sulfide (H
2
S) is converted to small particles of
elemental sulfur by the iodine during the shaking. Good shaking is
required to get good contact between the hydrogen sulfide in the gas
and the iodine in the liquid. When all of the hydrogen sulfide is
converted, the excess iodine causes the characteristic blue color in
the presence of starch. This is a universal test for starch. (Iodine
causes a blue color when it contacts starchy foods, such as potato
for example.)
5. Calculation of Mole (or Volume) percent H
2
S (dry basis):
(
+
(
=
V.P. - P
760
289
T 73 2
(11.85)
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used Solution
Iodine ml
S H % Mole
2
Where T = sample temperature, C
P = atmospheric pressure at particular location, mm Hg
V.P = vapor pressure of water at sample temperature, mm Hg
The Normality of the standard iodine solution will be 0.1 N. The last
three factors (which correct the actual H
2
S content to compensate for
expansion due to temperature, pressure, and water content) can be
combined and calculated as a function of temperature only. This has
been done for the 500-ml gas sample and is included as the
Tutweiler Factor Chart in Section 7.10.3 of these guidelines
(Chart 2). Therefore, the equation above can be simplified to:
(
(
(
(
(
(
=
Chart Factor
Tutweiler
from Factor
Solution
Iodine of
Normality
Used
Solution
Iodine ml
10,000 S H PPM
2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-79
7.10.7 H
2
S Conc. in Amine Absorber Ovhd Using Gas Detector Tubes
As an alternative to the traditional wet-chemistry method described in the
preceding Section 7.10.6 for determining the concentration of H
2
S in the
Amine Absorber overhead gas, gas detector tubes can be used to quickly
and easily make this determination. Although the discussion that follows
specifically addresses using gas detector tubes manufactured by
Drgerwerk AG of West Germany, there may be suitable detector tubes
available from other manufacturers. Drger tubes can be purchased from
most safety equipment supply companies.
The following Drger tubes can be used with this procedure:
H
2
S 5/b Drger Cat. No. CH 298 01
H
2
S 100/a Drger Cat. No. CH 291 01
7.10.7.1 Operating Principles
Drger tubes and other gas detector tubes measure gas
concentrations by using a sample pump to draw a specific volume of
the gas to be sampled into a glass tube containing a suitable
reagent. The gaseous compound of interest chemically reacts with
the reagent to produce a color change. The length of the "stain" line
is a direct function of the concentration of the compound in the
sample gas. Some detector tubes are calibrated with measured lines
to allow reading the concentration directly on the tube. Others, such
as the two listed above, have reference marks on the tube that can
be multiplied by a factor to compute the concentration.
Drger tubes are designed to be used with a Drger Model 31 gas
detector pump. This is a hand-operated bellows pump that will draw
a 100 cc sample volume for each pump stroke. Some tubes are
designed for a single sample stroke, while others may use 5, 10, or
even 20 strokes. In some cases, a tube may be used for measuring
different concentration ranges by using a different number of strokes.
a. Drger Cat. No. CH 298 01, H
2
S 5/b
This tube will measure H
2
S concentrations in the range of
50 PPM to 600 PPM when one sample stroke is used. If
desired, the range can be reduced to 5 PPM to 60 PPM by
using 10 sample strokes. Each tube contains a substrate of a
white lead compound. When exposed to H
2
S, the lead
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-80
compound is converted to brown lead sulfide. The H
2
S
concentration in PPM can be read directly from the marks on
the tube according to the length of the brown stain when using
10 sample strokes. If only one sample stroke is used, the tube
reading is multiplied by 10 to give the PPM of H
2
S. This lead
sulfide reaction is not affected by any of the other compounds
normally found in the overhead gas from the ATU/ARU Amine
Absorber.
b. Drger Cat. No. CH 291 01, H
2
S 100/a
This tube will measure H
2
S concentrations in the range of
100 PPM to 2,000 PPM when one sample stroke is used. Each
tube contains a substrate of a white lead compound. When
exposed to H
2
S, the lead compound is converted to brown lead
sulfide. The H
2
S concentration in PPM can be read directly
from the marks on the tube according to the length of the brown
stain. This lead sulfide reaction is not affected by any of the
other compounds normally found in the overhead gas from the
ATU/ARU Amine Absorber.
7.10.7.2 Sampling the Amine Absorber Overhead Gas
The overhead gas from the Amine Absorber Overhead Knock-out
Drum can be sampled from the sample connection near the sample
line for the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer.
a. Before beginning, check the Drger pump for leaks by inserting
an unopened tube into the pump and stroking the pump.
Confirm that the bellows does not re-expand. If it does, either
the pump or its seal around the tube is leaking, and the test
results will not be accurate.
b. Attach a short piece of rubber tubing to the process sample
valve.
c. Break off the tips at each end of a Drger tube and insert it into
the sample pump (with the arrow on the side of the tube
pointing toward the pump).
d. Purge the rubber tubing by venting gas to the atmosphere for a
few seconds. Pinch the rubber tubing closed at the end, close
the gas sample valve, slip the end of the rubber tubing onto the
end of the Drger tube, and reopen the sample valve.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Amine Treating & Regeneration Page 7-81
e. Stroke the sample pump one time (be sure to compress the
bellows until reaching the stops) and allow the pump to draw
the gas sample into the detector tube. The sample stroke is
complete when the metal chain on the bellows is taut.
f. Close the sample valve and remove the rubber tubing from the
end of the Drger tube and from the sample valve.
g. Read the length of the brown stain using the marks on the tube
and record the reading.
7.10.7.3 Calculations
Mole (or Volume) PPM H
2
S (wet basis):
(
=
mbar Pres., Baro.
1013
Factor
Tube
Length
Stain
S H PPM
2
The last factor corrects the measurement for pressure effects when
samples are taken at elevations above sea level. Note that the
average barometric pressure at the compex is
14.7 PSIA = 1013 mbar.
The "Tube Factor" depends on the type of Drger tube used and the
number of sample strokes:
Drger Tube Catalog No. Sample Strokes Tube Factor
H
2
S 5/b CH 298 01 1 10
H
2
S 5/b CH 298 01 10 1
H
2
S 100/a CH 291 01 1 1
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sour Water Stripping Page 8-i
Table of Contents
8. SOUR WATER STRIPPING ......................................................................................... 8-1
8.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 8-1
8.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 8-1
8.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 8-2
8.3.1 General ........................................................................................................... 8-2
8.3.2 Sour Water Collection ..................................................................................... 8-2
8.3.3 Sour Water Stripping ...................................................................................... 8-3
8.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION ................................................................................ 8-5
8.4.1 Sour Water Stripper, A2-DA1520 ................................................................... 8-5
8.4.2 Sour Water Stripper Packing and Internals, A2-DB1520 ................................ 8-5
8.4.3 Stripper Trays, A2-DB1521 ............................................................................ 8-5
8.4.4 SWS Cross Exchanger, A2-EA1520 .............................................................. 8-5
8.4.5 Sour Water Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1521 ..................................................... 8-6
8.4.6 SWS Quench Water Cooler, A2-EC1520 ....................................................... 8-6
8.4.7 SWS Bottoms Cooler, A2-EC1521 ................................................................. 8-6
8.4.8 Sour Water Flash Drum, A2-FA1520 .............................................................. 8-6
8.4.9 SWS Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1522 .................................................................. 8-7
8.4.10 SWS Skim Oil Pump Sump, A2-FA1523A/B .................................................. 8-7
8.4.11 Sour Water Tank, A2-FB1520 ........................................................................ 8-7
8.4.12 Sour Water Filter, A2-FD1520A/B .................................................................. 8-7
8.4.13 Sour Water Transfer Pump, A2-GA1520A/B .................................................. 8-7
8.4.14 SWS Feed Pump, A2-GA1521A/B ................................................................. 8-8
8.4.15 SWS Quench Water Pump, A2-GA1522A/B .................................................. 8-8
8.4.16 SWS Bottoms Pump, A2-GA1523A/B ............................................................ 8-8
8.4.17 SWS Skim Oil Pump, A2-GA1524A/B ............................................................ 8-8
8.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................... 8-9
8.5.1 SWS Shutdowns and Alarms ......................................................................... 8-9
8.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ............................. 8-11
8.6.1 SWS Stripper Operation ............................................................................... 8-11
8.6.2 Quench Water Circulation ............................................................................ 8-12
8.6.3 pH Control .................................................................................................... 8-13
8.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................................. 8-14
8.7.1 Preliminary Check-out .................................................................................. 8-14
8.7.2 Washing the Sour Water System ................................................................. 8-15
8.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES .................................................................................. 8-19
8.8.1 Initial Startup of the SWS ............................................................................. 8-19
8.8.1.1 Initial Water Fill ...................................................................................... 8-19
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sour Water Stripping Page 8-ii
8.8.1.2 Exporting Treated Water ....................................................................... 8-21
8.8.2 Normal Startup of the SWS .......................................................................... 8-23
8.8.2.1 Initial Water Fill ...................................................................................... 8-23
8.8.2.2 Exporting Treated Water ....................................................................... 8-26
8.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ............................................................................. 8-29
8.9.1 Planned Shutdown ....................................................................................... 8-29
8.9.2 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems .................................. 8-31
8.9.2.1 Steam System Outage .......................................................................... 8-31
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-1
8. SOUR WATER STRIPPING
8.1 Purpose of System
The purpose of the Sour Water Stripping (SWS) system is to remove H
2
S and
ammonia (NH
3
) from various sour water streams produced in the Sulfur Block
and elsewhere in the aromatics complex. The resulting treated water
(containing less than 20 PPMW of H
2
S and less than 20 PPMW of NH
3
) is
returned to the aromatics complex for reuse elsewhere, while the SWS off-gas
(NH
3
, H
2
S, and water vapor) is routed to the Sulfur Recovery Units (SRUs).
8.2 Safety
ALL PIPING AND VESSELS INCLUDED IN THIS UNIT EITHER CONTAIN
OR HAVE THE POTENTIAL FOR CONTAINING HAZARDOUS GASES
THAT MAY CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH. THE TWO GASES
THAT ARE MOST COMMON AND HAZARDOUS IN A TOXIC WAY ARE
HYDROGEN SULFIDE AND AMMONIA. CLOSE ATTENTION SHOULD
BE PAID TO THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION OF THESE
GUIDELINES AS TO THE NATURE AND ABILITY OF THESE GASES TO
CONTAMINATE OTHER ELEMENTS IN THIS UNIT.
AN EMPLOYEE'S KNOWLEDGE OF THE HAZARDOUS CHEMICALS AND
COMPOUNDS WITH WHICH HE WILL BE WORKING IS ONE OF THE
MOST BASIC PREREQUISITES FOR HIS OWN SAFETY, THE SAFETY
OF OTHERS, AND THE PROTECTION OF EQUIPMENT. ALL
EMPLOYEES SHOULD REVIEW THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION
OCCASIONALLY TO REFRESH THEIR MEMORIES. NEW EMPLOYEES
SHOULD STUDY IT UNTIL THE INFORMATION IS THOROUGHLY
UNDERSTOOD. PEOPLE WHO HAVE NOT BEEN PROPERLY TRAINED
SHOULD NOT BE ALLOWED TO OPERATE OR WORK IN AND AROUND
THIS PLANT.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-2
8.3 Process Description
8.3.1 General
The Systems Diagram, Material Balance and Process Flow Diagram,
Dwg. Nos. 507000-7000-01, and 507000-7000-05 through -06, are
contained in the "Process Flow Diagrams" Section of the Basic
Engineering Package. Please refer to these drawings to follow this
description of the process.
The Sour Water Stripping Unit (SWS) receives sour water streams
containing ammonia (NH
3
) and hydrogen sulfide (H
2
S) from other units in
the No. 2 Aromatics Complex. These sour water streams are combined
with sour water produced in the Sulfur Block (predominately Sour Water
from the ATU and excess quench water from the SWS) and steam
stripped to remove essentially all of the NH
3
and H
2
S from the water. The
resulting treated water (containing less than 20 PPMW of H
2
S and less
than 20 PPMW of NH
3
) is returned to the complex for reuse elsewhere,
while the SWS off-gas (NH
3
, H
2
S, and water vapor) is routed to the SRUs.
8.3.2 Sour Water Collection
Sour water from other units within the complex is combined with the sour
water streams generated within the Sulfur Block and flows to the Sour
Water Flash Drum, A2-FA1520, at 54C [129F]. This vessel is operated
at low pressure (1.05 kg/cm
2
(g) [15 PSIG]) to maximize the vaporization
and removal of any light hydrocarbons that may be entrained or dissolved
in the sour water. Any flash gases are directed to the flare header for
disposal.
The flash drum is large enough to provide 30 minutes or more of
residence time for the sour water. This allows time for any heavy
hydrocarbons entrained in the water to separate as a second liquid phase
that spills over the internal weir at the inlet end of the drum, collecting in
the SWS Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1522. The SWS Skim Oil,
A2-GA1524A/B, sends the collected hydrocarbon to the Condensate Feed
Tank on start/stop level control.
After removal of any liquid hydrocarbon, the heavier water phase passes
under the internal weir at the outlet end of the drum to be pumped to the
Sour Water Tank, A2-FB1520, by the Sour Water Transfer Pump,
A2-GA1520A/B, on level control. This tank is large enough to provide
3-4 days of residence time to allow "working off " an accumulation of sour
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-3
water after an outage. The tank also provides time for mixing which
minimizes Sour Water Stripper feed composition fluctuations due to the
many sources of sour water in the complex.
8.3.3 Sour Water Stripping
After residing in the Sour Water Tank for several days, the sour water is
pumped by the SWS Feed Pump, A2-GA1521A/B, on flow control through
the tube side of the SWS Cross Exchanger, A2-EA1520. The sour water
is preheated to 100C [211F] by cooling the treated water before flowing
to the Sour Water Stripper, A2-DA1520, to enter the column above the
first valve tray, tray #2.
Traditional reflux systems do not work well for strippers in this service
because of the highly corrosion nature of concentrated NH
3
-H
2
S aqueous
systems. For this reason, these systems often employ a direct-contact
condenser instead, using a circulating stream of quench water to provide
cooling for the upper section of the column. The Sour Water Stripper
contains an upper section of packing to provide contact between the
quench water and the stripped gases, and a lower section of valve trays to
provide contact between the sour water and the stripping steam.
The stripping section of the column contains 30 valve trays and one
chimney draw tray. As the sour water flows down the column, the NH
3
and H
2
S are stripped from the water by countercurrent contact with
stripping steam rising upward. This stripping steam is generated in the
Sour Water Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1521, using LP (3.5 kg/cm
2
(g)
[50 PSIG]) steam on flow control as the heat input. The stripping steam
strips the NH
3
and H
2
S from the water and carries it upward to the quench
section of the column. The SWS Bottoms Pump, A2-GA1523A/B, pumps
the treated water from the bottom of the column through the shell side of
the SWS Cross Exchanger, cooling the treated water from 123C [254F]
to 54C [130F] by countercurrent heat exchange with the cool sour
water. The SWS Bottoms Cooler, A2-EC1521, provides final cooling to
49C [120F] before the treated water is returned to the complex for reuse
elsewhere.
The quench section of the column contains a packed bed and a chimney
draw tray. As the stripping steam rises upward in this section, it is
countercurrently contacted by the circulating quench water, cooling the
off-gas to 85C [185F] as it condenses most of the steam. The chimney
tray below the packed bed that collects the quench water leaving the
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-4
bottom of the bed has overflow pipes to direct the condensed water onto
the valve tray (tray #2) below. The quench water collecting on the
chimney tray is pumped by the SWS Quench Water Pump,
A2-GA1522A/B, to the SWS Quench Water Cooler, A2-EC1520, to cool
the water from 99C [210F] to 66C [150F] to reject the heat removed
from the stripping steam in the quench section of the column. The cooling
rate is adjusted as necessary to control the column overhead temperature
at 85C [185F]. This allows the NH
3
and H
2
S stripped from the water to
leave the column at 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) [12 PSIG]and flow to the SRUs.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-5
8.4 Equipment Description
8.4.1 Sour Water Stripper, A2-DA1520
The upper section of the Sour Water Stripper contains a chimney draw
tray and a single bed of random packing to provide good contact between
the circulating quench water and the stripped gases. The stripping section
of the column contains 30 valve trays and one chimney draw tray. The
valve trays provide good contact between the sour water and the reboiler
vapors to strip H
2
S and NH
3
from the water.
A chimney tray is located below the bottom valve tray to gather all of the
column liquids to feed the Sour Water Stripper Reboiler. The column
section located below this chimney tray serves to separate the outlet
steam and treated water from the reboiler.
8.4.2 Sour Water Stripper Packing and Internals, A2-DB1520
This bed of random packing provides good contact between the stripped
gases entering below it and the quench fed above it inside the Sour Water
Stripper. The packing has a bed limiter above it and rests on a bed
support. The quench water is distributed over the packing by a distributor
tray. The packing is aluminum; the other internals are 316L S.S.
8.4.3 Stripper Trays, A2-DB1521
These 1-pass valve trays provide good contact between the sour water
fed above them and the reboiler vapors fed below them inside the Sour
Water Stripper. The tray decks for Trays #1 and #2 are 316L S.S. with
316 S.S. valves and bolting. For the remaining trays, the tray decks are
carbon steel and the valves are fabricated from 316 S.S. to resist
corrosion and to prevent "sticking" to the tray decks. The bottom valve
tray has a seal pan for its downcomer to maintain a liquid seal and prevent
gas from blowing up the downcomer.
The chimney tray gathers the tower liquids to feed the reboiler. The outlet
from the reboiler reenters the column below the chimney tray, with the
vapor produced by the reboiler flowing upward through the chimneys in
order to reach the valve trays above.
8.4.4 SWS Cross Exchanger, A2-EA1520
This shell and tube exchanger conserves energy by providing heat
exchange between the stripped sour water and the sour water feed
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-6
stream, so that the hot water leaving the Sour Water Stripper can preheat
the sour water before it feeds the Sour Water Stripper. This cross
exchange saves reboiler duty by preheating the sour water, and reduces
the load on the SWS Bottoms Cooler by partially cooling the hot stripped
water.
8.4.5 Sour Water Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1521
The Sour Water Stripper Reboiler is a fixed tubesheet shell and tube heat
exchanger. The exchanger is arranged as once-through vertical
thermosiphon reboiler, mounted on the side of the Sour Water Stripper.
The static head of the water above the inlet nozzle on the lower channel
provides the driving force to circulate the water through the tubes.
LP steam on the shell of the exchanger heats the water inside the tubes,
partially vaporizing it to create stripping steam to remove the H
2
S and the
NH
3
from the sour water flowing down the Sour Water Stripper.
8.4.6 SWS Quench Water Cooler, A2-EC1520
This forced-draft aerial exchanger is used to cool a circulating stream of
quench water which enters above the packed section of the Sour Water
Stripper and provides cooling for the upper section of the column. Fans
are used to circulate air across the finned tubes to remove heat from the
circulating quench water.
8.4.7 SWS Bottoms Cooler, A2-EC1521
This forced-draft aerial exchanger provides the final cooling of the stripped
sour water stream leaving the bottom of the Sour Water Stripper. Fans
are used to circulate air across the finned tubes to remove heat from the
water.
8.4.8 Sour Water Flash Drum, A2-FA1520
This horizontal vessel allows for the removal of hydrocarbons that may be
carried out of the various upstream processes with the sour water. The
sour water enters the vessel through a slotted, vertical distributor. Any
hydrocarbon that may be carried with the sour water from the upstream
processes will accumulate in the center section of this vessel. When a
sufficient amount of hydrocarbon has accumulated, the hydrocarbon will
overflow the partition and flow into the hydrocarbon section. Lighter
hydrocarbons are disengaged from the sour water and routed to the
battery limits on pressure control. Hydrocarbon-free sour water then
passes under another partition, at the opposite end of the vessel, and into
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-7
the sour water outlet section, where the sour water is pumped to the Sour
Water Tank.
8.4.9 SWS Skim Oil Sump, A2-FA1522
This horizontal vessel is located in a below-ground concrete vault. It
collects the heavy hydrocarbons from the Sour Water Flash Tank. The
collected hydrocarbon liquid is pumped back to the Condensate Feed
Tank on stop/start level control.
8.4.10 SWS Skim Oil Pump Sump, A2-FA1523A/B
These vertical vessels house the SWS Skim Oil pumps. Hydrocarbon
liquids from the SWS Skim Oil Sump flow into this vessel and are pumped
out by the SWS Skim Oil Pump.
8.4.11 Sour Water Tank, A2-FB1520
The Sour Water Tank is an above-ground vertical cylindrical tank with a
floating roof. This tank is large enough to provide 2-3 days of residence
time to allow "working off " an accumulation of sour water after an outage.
It has two level transmitters to indicate the sour water level, with a low
level alarm to alert the operators of a low level, and a low level shutdown
which will shut down the SWS Feed Pump if the level in the tank drops too
low. The tank also has multiple connections to the closed drain system
which can be used to route hydrocarbons to the closed drain if a layer of
hydrocarbon should form in the tank.
8.4.12 Sour Water Filter, A2-FD1520A/B
These full-flow filters are designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and
larger from the sour water, which will help prevent fouling of the
downstream heat exchangers.
8.4.13 Sour Water Transfer Pump, A2-GA1520A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to transfer the sour water from the Sour
Water Flash Drum to the Sour Water Tank. Each pump is designed for
the total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are
equipped with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to
the surroundings.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-8
8.4.14 SWS Feed Pump, A2-GA1521A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the sour water from the Sour
Water Tank to the Sour Water Stripper. Each pump is designed for the
total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are equipped
with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to the
surroundings.
8.4.15 SWS Quench Water Pump, A2-GA1522A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to circulate quench water to cool the
stripped gases in the upper section of the Sour Water Stripper. Each
pump is designed for the total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare.
These pumps are equipped with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of
releasing H
2
S to the surroundings.
8.4.16 SWS Bottoms Pump, A2-GA1523A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the stripped water from the
Sour Water Stripping Unit to the battery limits for use elsewhere in the
complex. Each pump is designed for the total duty; the other pump is a
100% spare.
8.4.17 SWS Skim Oil Pump, A2-GA1524A/B
These vertical sump-type pump is mounted in the SWS Skim Oil Pump
Sump to transfer the recovered hydrocarbons back to the Condensate
Feed Tank.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-9
8.5 Instrumentation and Control Systems
8.5.1 SWS Shutdowns and Alarms
There are several interlocks of significance in the SWS Unit that either
generate an alarm or shut down an individual piece of equipment. These
devices/interlocks and their effects are described in this section.
a. Sour Water Flash Drum Low-Low Level, A2-LT15209A/B/C
The Sour Water Transfer Pump (A2-GA1520A/B) could be damaged
if the pump loses suction because the level in the Sour Water Flash
Drum drops too low. This device will protect the pump by stopping it
before this can occur. The setpoint is 530 mm above the bottom of
the vessel. Note that there are three independent transmitters and
2oo3 voting logic is used for the shutdown.
b. Sour Water Tank Low-Low Level, A2-LT15218A/B/C
The SWS Feed Pump (A2-GA1521A/B) could be damaged if the
pump loses suction because the level in the Sour Water Tank drops
too low. This device will protect the pump by stopping it before this
can occur. The setpoint is 300 mm above the bottom of the vessel.
Note that there are three independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting
logic is used for the shutdown.
c. SWS Bottoms Cooler Fan High Vibration, A2-WSH15234
Each fan on the SWS Bottoms Cooler (A2-EC1521) is provided with
its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed by the switch
exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to stop the associated
fan and activate an alarm in the DCS.
d. Sour Water Stripper Low-Low Level, A2-LT15247A/B/C
The SWS Bottoms Pump (A2-GA1523A/B) could be damaged if the
pump loses suction because the level in the Sour Water Stripper
drops too low. This device will protect the pump by stopping it before
this can occur. The setpoint is 300 mm above the bottom seam of
the column. Note that there are three independent transmitters and
2oo3 voting logic is used for the shutdown.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-10
e. SWS Quench Water Cooler Fan High Vibration, A2-WSH15263
Each fan on the SWS Quench Water Cooler (A2-EC1520) is
provided with its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed by the
switch exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to stop the
associated fan and activate an alarm in the DCS.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-11
8.6 Process Principles and Operating Techniques
8.6.1 SWS Stripper Operation
The stripped water must be comparatively free of H
2
S and NH
3
to assure
attainment of the treated water specification. These contaminates are
removed from the sour water in the Sour Water Stripper by stripping them
out with steam.
The stripping steam is produced by vaporizing some of the water in the in
the Sour Water Stripper Reboiler, using LP (3.5-4.2 kg/cm
2
(g)) steam for
the heat input. The steam rate to the reboiler (and, hence, the stripping
rate) is controlled by the steam flow controller. Adjust this steam rate as
needed to keep the H
2
S and NH
3
in the treated water low, i.e., less than
20 PPMW of H
2
S and less than 20 PPMW of NH
3
.
THE DESIGN STRIPPING STEAM RATE SHOWN ON THE
PROCESS FLOW DIAGRAM SHOULD BE CLOSE TO OPTIMUM.
ALTHOUGH IT MAY BE POSSIBLE TO REDUCE THIS SOMEWHAT
WITHOUT GOING OUT OF COMPLIANCE, REDUCING THE
STRIPPING STEAM RATE SIGNIFICANTLY CAN CAUSE THE
CONCENTRATION OF H
2
S AND AMMONIA IN THE TREATED
WATER TO EXCEED THE ALLOWABLE CONCENTRATION IN THE
TREATED WATER SPECIFICATION.
IF IT IS NECESSARY TO OPTIMIZE THE STEAM TO THE SOUR
WATER STRIPPER REBOILER, REDUCE THE STEAM BY SMALL
INCREMENTS AND CHECK THE CONCENTRATION OF AMMONIA
AND H
2
S AFTER EACH CHANGE. DO NOT REDUCE THE STEAM
FURTHER IF EITHER CONCENTRATION BEGINS TO RISE
SIGNIFICANTLY.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-12
8.6.2 Quench Water Circulation
The operating conditions shown on the Process Flow Diagram for this
system (in terms of the quench water circulation rate and water
temperature) should generally be maintained. The quench water
circulation rate is controlled by the quench water flow controller in the
DCS, while the temperature is controlled by a temperature controller on
the Sour Water Stripper overhead gas line adjusting the speed of one of
the fans on the SWS Quench Water Cooler, A2-EC1520.
In general, decreasing the quench water circulation rate will increase the
quench water temperature upstream of the cooler (which increases the
corrosion rate) and may increase the Sour Water Stripper Overhead
temperature if the cooler cannot cool the quench water sufficiently. Care
should be taken when reducing the quench water circulation rate to
ensure that the corrosion rate in the quench water circulation loop does
not become excessive.
As the feed rate to the SWS Stripper decreases, the quench water
circulation rate can decrease in proportion with the feed flow rate down to
about 50% of design flow rate. Below this point, the quench water rate
cannot be allowed to drop any further without risking poor performance in
the packed section of the SWS Stripper due to uneven liquid distribution
and wetting of the packing. At lower feed rates (below 50%) simply setting
the quench water flow rate to the column at about 50% of design should
maintain adequate performance. (It should be noted, however, that there
is really no detrimental effect if the quench water circulation is simply left
at the design value at all times. The only drawback is slightly higher
power consumption by the pump and aerial cooler.)
Increasing the quench water temperature will increase the overhead gas
temperature and water content which increases the load on the
downstream SRUs (since water is a product of the Claus reaction, higher
water content in the SWS feed gas can negatively impact the recovery of
in the SRUs). However, decreasing the quench water temperature (and
correspondingly the overhead gas temperature) may lead operating
issues including salt deposition and plugging in the downstream piping
and equipment. Ammonium salts can form in the gas stream leaving the
top of the Sour Water Stripper if the gas temperature falls below about
70C. These salts can plug the mist eliminator in the top of the Sour Water
Stripper as well as the downstream piping and equipment. In addition,
decreasing the overhead gas temperature below about 82C may prevent
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-13
the ammonia from leaving the top of the column. Instead it may become
trapped in the column where it will concentrate, or it may leave in the
stripped water causing the treated water to exceed the specification for
ammonia.
The flow rate and temperatures shown on the Process Flow Diagram are
usually a good compromise between minimizing corrosion, minimizing the
load on the downstream SRUs, and minimizing operating issues within the
SWS unit.
8.6.3 pH Control
High pH water tends to hold H
2
S in solution and aids in releasing
ammonia from sour water. Conversely, low pH water tends to hold
ammonia in solution and improves the stripping of H
2
S. By injecting a
small amount of caustic near the tower bottom, ammonia stripping in the
bottom of the Sour Water Stripper can be improved while the H
2
S is still
stripped in the upper part of the tower.
Injection points for caustic addition have been supplied in the lower
section of the Sour Water Stripper. In the event that the stripped water
cannot meet the low ammonia specification, caustic can be added to the
tower to increase the pH and improve the ammonia stripping in the tower.
If caustic is added, injection control is critical to limit the pH of the stripped
water to about 8.0.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-14
8.7 Precommissioning Procedures
Prior to the initial startup, there are a number of precommissioning activities that
are necessary to ensure that the newly constructed plant is ready to be placed
in service. The activities outlined below should serve as a guide, but there may
be others required as a part of your normal plant procedures.
8.7.1 Preliminary Check-out
Check all equipment to ensure that it is properly installed. This will
probably require consulting Manufacturer's literature as well as
construction drawings.
A. Check and lubricate all equipment, in accordance with the
Manufacturer's recommendations.
B. Check the rotation of the following pumps by "bumping" them:
(1) Sour Water Transfer Pump.
(2) SWS Feed Pump
(3) SWS Quench Water Pump
(4) SWS Bottoms Pump
(5) SWS Skim Oil Pump
C. Check the rotation of the fans on the SWS Quench Water Cooler and
the SWS Bottoms Cooler, by operating each fan for a short period.
D. Check all piping and equipment to be sure that all blinds have been
removed and that no valves are vented to atmosphere.
E. Place the Instrument Air System in service to all instruments and
check the action of controllers and control valves.
F. Check all relief valves to ensure that they are installed in the proper
locations, the inlet and outlet block valves (if provided) are open, the
bypass valves (if provided) are closed, and the relief valves are set
for the correct relieving pressure.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-15
8.7.2 Washing the Sour Water System
The following procedure is intended to remove grease, rust, scale, dirt,
and trash from the equipment and piping in the Sour Water Stripping
system before it is placed in operation.
Failure to clean the system properly prior to startup can lead to operating
problems (heat exchanger fouling, rapid filter plugging, etc.).
A. Place the following controllers in the DCS in "manual" with their
outputs set as indicated:
(1) Set the output from the Sour Water Flash Drum level controller
to 0% to fully close the Sour Water Flash Drum level control
valve.
(2) Set the output from the SWS Inlet flow controller to 100% to
fully open the SWS Inlet flow control valve.
(3) Set the output from the SWS level controller to 100% to fully
open the level control valve.
(4) Set the output from the Quench Water flow controller to 100%
to fully open the Quench Water flow control valve.
(5) Set the output from the SWS Stripper Reboiler steam flow
controller to 0% to fully close the steam flow control valve.
(6) Set the output from the SWS pressure controller to 0% to fully
close the overhead pressure control valve to the SRUs.
B. Place the other SWS pressure controller in "automatic" with a
setpoint of 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g). This will open the pressure control valve
to the flare if pressure builds in the Sour Water Stripper during this
procedure.
C. Verify that the bypass valve on the pressure control valve to the flare
is closed. Open both of the isolation block valves at this control
station.
D. Place the H.P. Nitrogen supply to the Stripper overhead line in
service and open the manual block valve. This will prevent a vacuum
from forming in the Sour Water Stripper during this procedure.
E. Set the Treated Water hand control in the DCS is to 0% output to
fully open the automated valve in the Startup/Re-run line to the Sour
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-16
Water Tank, and fully close the automated valve in the Treated
Water line downstream of the SWS Bottoms Cooler. Visually confirm
that these valves are properly positioned.
F. Verify that the manual block valve at the inlet to the Sour Water Tank
is open.
G. Verify that the manual block valve in the fill line for the Quench Water
Loop is closed.
H. Verify that the SWS Inlet flow control valve is fully open. Open both
of its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
I. Verify that the SWS level control valve is fully open. Open both of its
isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
J. Verify that the Quench Water flow control valve is fully open. Open
both of its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
K. Verify that the Sour Water Flash Drum level control valve is fully
closed. (This will prevent water from entering the upstream
equipment if the Sour Water Tank is accidentally over-filled.)
L. The Sour Water Filters will not be used to filter solids during this
time, but the filter vessels and their piping are to be flushed and
cleaned. Remove the filter elements, then bolt-up the filters. Open
the inlet and outlet block valves on the filters, and open the bypass
valve around the filters.
M. Use a temporary jumper to add cold condensate to the Sour Water
Tank.
N. Once there is an adequate level in the tank, open the suction valve
on a SWS Feed Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is
flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Water Tank as the pump fills the
downstream piping and begins to fill the Sour Water Stripper. When
the level drops to the low-low level shutdown it should shut down the
pump. If it does not, stop the pump manually before it loses suction
and correct the problem with the low level shutdown before
proceeding.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-17
O. Continue filling the Sour Water Tank with condensate and pumping
the water to the Sour Water Stripper periodically, until the level in the
Stripper is all the way to the top of its level gauge.
P. Once there is an adequate level in the Stripper, open the suction
valve on a SWS Bottoms Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the
pump is flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge
valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Water Stripper as the pump fills the
downstream piping and begins to circulate back to the Sour Water
Tank. When the level drops to the low-low level shutdown it should
shut down the pump. If it does not, stop the pump manually before it
loses suction and correct the problem with the low level shutdown
before proceeding.
Q. Once circulation is achieved and the level in the Sour Water Stripper
is adequate (about halfway up in the level gauge), discontinue the
addition of condensate.
R. Circulate the water and blow down the low point drains until all of the
drain water is clear. Add more condensate as necessary to maintain
the level in the Sour Water Stripper.
At some point during the washing procedure, the standby SWS Feed
Pump and the standby SWS Bottoms pump should be placed in
service while the other pumps are shut down. This will ensure
cleaning out all pumps and their associated piping.
S. When the drain water begins to clear, open the manual block valve in
the Quench Water fill line, open the suction valve on a SWS Quench
Water Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded
with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Water Stripper as the pump fills the
quench water circulation loop. Add additional condensate to the Sour
Water Tank if necessary and pump the water to the Sour Water
Stripper.
T. Once circulation is achieved in the Quench Water loop and the level
in the Sour Water Stripper is adequate (about halfway up in the level
gauge), discontinue the addition of condensate and close the manual
block valve in the Quench Water fill line.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-18
U. Circulate the water in the Quench Water loop and blow down the low
point drains until all of the drain water is clear.
At some point during the washing procedure, the standby SWS
Quench Water Pump should be placed in service while the other
pump is shut down. This will ensure cleaning out both pumps and
their associated piping.
V. Once the drain water is clear in the main circulation loop and Quench
Water loop, shutdown the pumps and completely drain the system.
Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the water velocity
helps to flush the solids from all parts of the system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-19
8.8 Startup Procedures
8.8.1 Initial Startup of the SWS
The SWS system should now be clean, ready to place in service. All that
remains is to fill the system with water and establish the proper operating
conditions.
8.8.1.1 Initial Water Fill
A. Close the bypass valves around the following control stations:
(1) SWS Inlet flow control
(2) SWS level control
(3) Quench water flow control
B. Close the inlet and outlet block valves (but leave the bypass
valves open) on the Sour Water Filters, then install the proper
elements in the filters. Leave the block valves closed on each
filter for now.
C. Use a temporary jumper to add cold condensate to the Sour
Water Tank and reestablish the level in the Sour Water Stripper
as before.
D. Establish circulation of water in the system (including the
Quench Water loop) using the procedures in Section 8.7.2.
E. Start a fan on the SWS Bottoms Cooler and place the bottoms
temperature controller in service with a setpoint of 60C.
F. Begin steam flow to the Sour Water Stripper Reboiler and
gradually raise the temperature in the column. Place the steam
flow controller in the DCS on "automatic" with its setpoint set to
its normal value.
G. Open the high point vent valve on the Stripper overhead line
and allow the steam to purge any air from the vessel. As the
pressure builds, the vent valve can be closed.
H. When the temperature begins to rise in the SWS overhead line,
start a fan on the SWS Quench Water Cooler and place the
overhead temperature controller in service with a setpoint of
85C.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-20
I. Monitor the stripper pressure, and adjust the overhead pressure
controller if necessary to maintain the stripper pressure at about
0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) as the system is heated to operating
temperatures.
J. Ensure that the fans are running on the SWS Bottoms Cooler
and the SWS Quench Water Cooler.
K. If the control loops for the Sour Water Stripper have not already
been placed in service, do so at this time. Switch the SWS
level controller, and the SWS Inlet flow controller in the DCS to
"automatic" with their setpoints set to their normal values.
L. Place the Quench Water flow controller in automatic and set
its setpoint to its normal value.
M. Place each of the sour water filters in service as follows:
(1) Open the vent valve on the top of the filter.
(2) "Crack" the filter inlet block valve open slightly and allow
the filter to fill with sour water. When the filter is full, close
its vent valve.
(3) Open the inlet and outlet block valves on the filter.
(4) Slowly close the valve in the bypass line around the filter.
Note: At this point the sour water system is ready for service. It
can remain in this operating mode indefinitely while the
rest of the Complex is prepared for startup. Check the
system periodically for indications of plugging, etc. (low
flow, erratic pump discharge pressure, high filter pressure
drop), as solid materials may accumulate at various points
in the system over time.
N. Once there is an adequate level of Sour Water in the Sour
Water Flash Drum, open the suction valve on a Sour Water
Transfer Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is
flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge
valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Flash Drum as the pump fills the
downstream piping and begins to flow to the Sour Water Tank.
When the level drops to the low-low level shutdown it should
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-21
shut down the pump. If it does not, stop the pump manually
before it loses suction and correct the problem with the low
level shutdown before proceeding.
O. Place the Sour Water Flash Tank level controller in the DCS in
automatic and set its setpoint to its normal value.
P. Once a level of hydrocarbons has built up in the hydrocarbon
side of the Sour Water Flash Tank, the oil level controller can
also be placed automatic and its setpoint set to its normal
value.
The sour water will continue to circulate from the Sour Water Tank to
the Sour Water Stripper and back to the tank. The Sour Water Tank
is large enough to provide 3-4 days of residence time for the
produced sour water in the event the Sour Water System is not ready
to export treated water at this time.
8.8.1.2 Exporting Treated Water
Stripped sour water may not be routed to the complexs treated water
system until the temperature in the bottom of the Sour Water Stripper
is high enough to satisfy the Stripped Water Low Temperature
Interlock. This interlock disables the hand control in the DCS to
prevent the operator from routing the stripped water to the complexs
treated water system until the temperature in the bottom of the Sour
Water Stripper is sufficiently high.
Once the temperature in the bottom of the Sour Water Stripper is
high enough to satisfy the low-temperature interlock, and the
complex is producing a sufficient quantity of sour water for
processing:
A. Slowly increase the output from the Treated Water hand
control to 100%, which will open the automated valve in the
Treated Water line downstream of the SWS Bottoms Cooler
and close the automated valve in the Startup/Re-run line to the
Sour Water Tank.
B. When the output of the Treated Water hand control reaches
100%, the automated valve in the Treated Water line
downstream of the SWS Bottoms Cooler should be fully open
and the automated valve in the Startup/Re-run line fully closed
to send all of the treated water to the complexs treated water
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-22
system. Visually confirm that these valves are properly
positioned.
C. Once the operation of the Sour Water Stripper has stabilized,
route its acid gas, which is presently going to the flare through a
pressure valve to the SRUs as follows:
(1) Confirm that the Sour Water Stripper pressure controller to
the SRUs in the DCS is in "manual" with its output set to
0%.
(2) Confirm that the setpoint of the Sour Water Stripper
pressure controller to the SRUs is tracking its current
reading, then place it in "automatic".
(3) Slowly raise the setpoint of the Sour Water Stripper
pressure controller to the flare to 1.0 kg/cm
2
(g).
(4) If, necessary, adjust the setpoint of the Sour Water
Stripper pressure controller to the SRU to its normal
setpoint.
The Sour Water Stripper pressure controller will now take over
control of the Sour Water Stripper pressure by opening the
pressure valve to send the acid gas to the SWS Gas Knock-Out
Drums in the SRUs. The Sour Water Stripper pressure
controller to the flare will close the acid gas pressure valve and
stop the flow of acid gas to the flare. If the SRUs shut down (or
some other upset causes the Sour Water Stripper pressure to
rise), the Sour Water Stripper pressure controller to the flare will
act as an over-ride and divert the acid gas to the flare.
D. The SWS is now fully on-stream. Before directing your
attention away from the SWS, be sure that:
(1) All controllers are functioning properly.
(2) The steam heating systems are in service and the level
control on the Reboiler condensate pot is functioning
properly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-23
8.8.2 Normal Startup of the SWS
The procedure for startup of the SWS after it has been shut down will be
very similar to the procedure for the initial startup, except that condensate
will not be used to fill the system. For ease of reference, the steps to be
performed are written in this Section to serve as a "check list" that can be
easily followed on subsequent startups. Refer to the previous Sections for
the reasons and details pertaining to the different steps performed.
Prior to commencing SWS startup, check for the completion of all
maintenance work (connecting lines, removing blinds, etc.) if such work
was performed.
8.8.2.1 Initial Water Fill
A. Confirm that the Treated Water hand control in the DCS is to
0% output to fully open the automated valve in the Startup/Re-
run line to the Sour Water Tank, and fully close the automated
valve in the Treated Water line downstream of the SWS
Bottoms Cooler. Visually confirm that these valves are properly
positioned.
B. Place the following controllers in the DCS in "manual" with their
outputs set as indicated:
(1) Set the output from the SWS Inlet flow controller to 100%
to fully open the SWS Inlet flow control valve.
(2) Set the output from the SWS level controller to 100% to
fully open the level control valve.
(3) Set the output from the Quench Water flow controller to
100% to fully open the Quench Water flow control valve.
C. Confirm that the output from the SWS Stripper Reboiler steam
flow controller is set to 0% and the steam flow control valve is
fully closed.
D. Confirm that the output from the SWS pressure controller is set
to 0% and the overhead pressure control valve to the SRUs is
fully closed.
E. Place the other SWS pressure controller in "automatic" with a
setpoint of 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g). This will open the pressure control
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-24
valve to the flare if pressure builds in the Sour Water Stripper
during this procedure.
F. Verify that the bypass valve on the pressure control valve to the
flare is closed and that both of the isolation block valves are
open.
G. If not already in service, place the H.P. Nitrogen supply to the
Stripper overhead line in service and open the manual block
valve.
H. Verify that the manual block valve at the inlet to the Sour Water
Tank is open.
I. Verify that the manual block valve in the fill line for the Quench
Water loop is closed.
J. If the Sour Water Flash Drum is already in service and sending
sour water to the Sour Water Tank, proceed to Step L.
Otherwise, if the Sour Water Flash Drum is not in service, open
the isolation valves upstream of the flash drum to allow sour
water to enter the flash drum from the upstream Units.
K. Once there is an adequate level of sour water in the Sour Water
Flash Drum, open the suction valve on a Sour Water Transfer
Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded
with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Flash Drum as the pump fills the
downstream piping and begins to send sour water to the Sour
Water Tank. When the level drops to the low-low level
shutdown it should shut down the pump. If it does not, stop the
pump manually before it loses suction and correct the problem
with the low level shutdown before proceeding.
L. Confirm that there is an adequate level of sour water in the
Sour Water Tank, then open the suction valve on a SWS Feed
Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded
with water. Start the pump, then open its discharge valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Water Tank as the pump fills the
downstream piping and begins to fill the Sour Water Stripper.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-25
M. Continue pumping sour water to the Sour Water Stripper until
the level in the Stripper is all the way to the top of its level
gauge.
N. When there is an adequate level in the Stripper, open the
suction valve on a SWS Bottoms Pump and use its drain valve
to be sure the pump is flooded with water. Start the pump, then
open its discharge valve to begin circulating sour water back to
the Sour Water Tank.
O. Once circulation is achieved and the level in the Sour Water
Stripper is adequate, open the manual block valve in the
Quench Water fill line, open the suction valve on a SWS
Quench Water Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the
pump is flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its
discharge valve.
Watch the level in the Sour Water Stripper as the pump fills the
quench water circulation loop. If the level in the stripper falls
below the low level alarm point, stop the SWS Quench Water
Pump and pump additional sour water to the Stripper from the
Sour Water Tank to bring the level in the level back up before
restarting the SWS Quench Water Pump.
P. Once circulation is achieved in the Quench Water loop and the
level in the Sour Water Stripper is adequate (about halfway up
in the level gauge), close the manual block valve in the Quench
Water fill line.
Q. Start a fan on the SWS Bottoms Cooler and place the bottoms
temperature controller in service with a setpoint of 60C.
R. Begin steam flow to the Sour Water Stripper Reboiler and
gradually raise the temperature in the column. Place the steam
flow controller in the DCS on "automatic" with its setpoint set to
its normal value.
S. When the temperature begins to rise in the SWS overhead line,
start a fan on the SWS Quench Water Cooler and place the
overhead temperature controller in service with a setpoint of
85C.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-26
T. Monitor the stripper pressure, and adjust the overhead pressure
controller if necessary to maintain the stripper pressure at about
0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) as the system is heated to operating
temperatures.
U. Ensure that the fans are running on the SWS Bottoms Cooler
and the SWS Quench Water Cooler.
V. If the control loops for the Sour Water Stripper have not already
been placed in service, do so at this time. Switch the Sour
Water Flash Tank level controllers, the SWS level controller,
and the SWS Inlet flow controller in the DCS to "automatic" with
their setpoints set to their normal values.
W. Place the Quench Water flow controller in automatic and set
its setpoint to its normal value.
The sour water will continue to circulate from the Sour Water Tank to
the Sour Water Stripper and back to the tank. The Sour Water Tank
is large enough to provide 3-4 days of residence time for the
produced sour water in the event the Sour Water System is not ready
to export treated water at this time.
8.8.2.2 Exporting Treated Water
Stripped sour water may not be routed to the complexs treated water
system until the temperature in the bottom of the Sour Water Stripper
is high enough to satisfy the Stripped Water Low Temperature
Interlock. This interlock disables the hand control in the DCS to
prevent the operator from routing the stripped water to the complexs
treated water system until the temperature in the bottom of the Sour
Water Stripper is sufficiently high.
Once the temperature in the bottom of the Sour Water Stripper is
high enough to satisfy the low-temperature interlock, and the
complex is producing a sufficient quantity of sour water for
processing:
A. Slowly increase the output from the Treated Water hand
control to 100%, which will open the automated valve in the
Treated Water line downstream of the SWS Bottoms Cooler
and close the automated valve in the Startup/Re-run line to the
Sour Water Tank.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-27
B. When the output of the Treated Water hand control reaches
100%, the automated valve in the Treated Water line
downstream of the SWS Bottoms Cooler should be fully open
and the automated valve in the Startup/Re-run line fully closed
to send all of the treated water to the complexs treated water
system. Visually confirm that these valves are properly
positioned.
C. Once the operation of the Sour Water Stripper has stabilized,
route its acid gas, which is presently going to the flare through a
pressure valve to the SRUs as follows:
(1) Confirm that the Sour Water Stripper pressure controller to
the SRUs in the DCS is in "manual" with its output set to
0%.
(2) Confirm that the setpoint of the Sour Water Stripper
pressure controller to the SRUs is tracking its current
reading, then place it in "automatic".
(3) Slowly raise the setpoint of the Sour Water Stripper
pressure controller to the flare to 1.0 kg/cm
2
(g).
(4) If, necessary, adjust the setpoint of the Sour Water
Stripper pressure controller to the SRU to its normal
setpoint.
The Sour Water Stripper pressure controller will now take over
control of the Sour Water Stripper pressure by opening the
pressure valve to send the acid gas to the SWS Gas Knock-Out
Drums in the SRUs. The Sour Water Stripper pressure
controller to the flare will close the acid gas pressure valve and
stop the flow of acid gas to the flare. If the SRUs shut down (or
some other upset causes the Sour Water Stripper pressure to
rise), the Sour Water Stripper pressure controller to the flare will
act as an over-ride and divert the acid gas to the flare.
D. The SWS is now fully on-stream. Before directing your
attention away from the SWS, be sure that:
(1) All controllers are functioning properly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-28
(2) The steam heating systems are in service and the level
control on the Reboiler condensate pot is functioning
properly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-29
8.9 Shutdown Procedures
Typical shutdown procedures for the Sour Water Stripping Unit are outlined and
discussed in the sections that follow for the more common cases. Your existing
company procedures and common sense operational judgment should be used
to modify these procedures as needed to serve the purpose of any given
planned shutdown situation.
8.9.1 Planned Shutdown
Any equipment to be opened should be properly blinded and purged with
inert gas before admission of air, to avoid exposure to potentially toxic
gases or the formation of flammable vapor mixtures.
To shut the SWS down in a controlled fashion proceed as follows:
A. Slowly reduce the output from the Treated Water hand control in the
DCS is to 0% output to fully open the automated valve in the
Startup/Re-run line to the Sour Water Tank, and fully close the
automated valve in the Treated Water line downstream of the SWS
Bottoms Cooler. Visually confirm that these valves are properly
positioned.
B. Place the stream flow controller in manual and set its output to 0% to
close the stream flow control valve and stop the steam flow to the
Sour Water Stripper Reboiler.
C. Continue to circulate the sour water and operate the SWS Bottoms
Cooler and the SWS Quench Water Cooler until the sour water is
cool.
D. Once the sour water is cool, shut down the SWS Feed Pump to stop
the flow of sour water to the Sour Water Stripper and close the block
valves in the pump suction lines.
E. Place the SWS flow controller in the DCS in "manual" and set its
output to 0% to fully close the sour water inlet flow control valve.
F. Shutdown the SWS Quench Water Pumps and shut down the fans
on the SWS Quench Water Cooler.
G. Place the quench water flow controller in the DCS in "manual" and
set its output to 0% to fully close the quench water flow control valve.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-30
H. Use the SWS Bottoms pump to pump the sour water from the Sour
Water Stripper to the Sour Water Tank until the low-low level
shutdown is activated. This should shut down the SWS Bottoms
Pump. Monitor the level in the Sour Water Stripper and be prepared
to shut down the pump if the low-low level shutdown fails to activate.
I. Place the SWS level controller in the DCS in "manual" and set its
output to 0% to fully close the SWS level control valve.
J. Shut down the fans on the SWS Bottoms Cooler
K. Drain the remaining sour water in the SWS equipment to the Closed
Drain System.
L. Verify that the SWS level control valve is fully closed. Close both of
its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
M. Verify that the SWS flow control valve is fully closed. Close both of
its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
N. Verify that the quench water flow control valve is fully closed. Close
both of its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
O. The SWS is now ready to be isolated and made safe for entry.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 8-31
8.9.2 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems
The SWS system is directly affected by a shutdown and/or outage in the
LP steam system for the complex. These effects are described below.
8.9.2.1 Steam System Outage
The most immediate impact on the SWS will be the loss of LP steam
to the Stripper Reboiler if the steam outage lasts long enough. As
the heat input to the reboiler declines, stripping of the acid gas from
the sour water will decline and the H
2
S and NH
3
in the treated water
leaving the Sour Water Stripper will begin to increase. If this
happens, use the Treated Water hand control in the DCS to route the
treated water back to the Sour Water Tank until the LP steam system
can be brought back on-line.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-1
Table of Contents
9. SULFUR RECOVERY .................................................................................................. 9-4
9.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ....................................................................................... 9-4
9.2 SAFETY ................................................................................................................. 9-4
9.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 9-5
9.3.1 Overview ......................................................................................................... 9-5
9.3.2 General ........................................................................................................... 9-6
9.3.3 Feed Gas Processing ..................................................................................... 9-6
9.3.4 Thermal Processing ........................................................................................ 9-7
9.3.5 Catalytic Processing ....................................................................................... 9-8
9.3.6 Air Control System .......................................................................................... 9-9
9.3.7 Molten Sulfur Handling ................................................................................. 9-10
9.3.8 Steam Production ......................................................................................... 9-10
9.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION .............................................................................. 9-11
9.4.1 Reactor Furnace, A2-BA1530 (A2-BA1540) ................................................. 9-11
9.4.2 Acid Gas Burner Assembly, A2-BA1531 (A2-BA1541) ................................ 9-12
9.4.3 Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1530 (A2-FA1540) ................................. 9-12
9.4.4 SWS Gas Knock-Out Drum, A2-FA1531 (A2-FA1541) ................................ 9-12
9.4.5 Reactor, A2-DC1530 (A2-DC1540) .............................................................. 9-13
9.4.6 Catalyst for Sulfur Plant Reactors, A2-MC1530 (A2-MC1540) ..................... 9-13
9.4.7 Acid Gas Preheater, A2-EA1530 (A2-EA1540) ............................................ 9-13
9.4.8 Sulfur Condenser, A2-EA1531 (A2-EA1541) ............................................... 9-13
9.4.9 Reactor No. 1 Feed Heater, A2-EA1532 (A2-EA1542) ................................ 9-14
9.4.10 Reactor No. 2 Feed Heater, A2-EA1533 (A2-EA1543) ................................ 9-14
9.4.11 Reactor No. 3 Feed Heater, A2-EA1534 (A2-EA1544) ................................ 9-15
9.4.12 Sulfur Surge Tank, A2-FB1530 (A2-FB1540) ............................................... 9-15
9.4.13 Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum Pump, A2-GA1530A/B (A2-GA1540A/B) .......... 9-16
9.4.14 SWS Gas Knock-Out Drum Pump, A2-GA1531A/B (A2-GA1541A/B) ......... 9-17
9.4.15 Sulfur Storage Tank Vent Ejector, A2-EE1530 (A2-EE1540) ....................... 9-17
9.4.16 Process Air Blower, A2-GB1530A/B (A2-GB1540A/B) ................................. 9-18
9.4.17 Air Blower Suction Screen/Silencer, A2-FD1530A/B (A2-FD1540A/B) ........ 9-19
9.4.18 Process Air Vent Silencer, A2-FG1530A/B (A2-FG1540A/B) ....................... 9-19
9.4.19 Sulfur Drain Seal Assembly, A2-ME1530A-D (A2-ME1540A-D) .................. 9-19
9.4.20 Refractory for Reactor Furnace and Waste Heat Boiler, A2-MR1530
(A2-MR1540) .............................................................................................................. 9-20
9.4.21 Ceramic Ferrules for Waste Heat Boiler, A2-MR1532 (A2-MR1542) ........... 9-20
9.4.22 Refractory for Waste Heat Boiler, A2-MR1533 (A2-MR1543) ...................... 9-20
9.4.23 Refractory for Sulfur Condenser, A2-MR1534 (A2-MR1544) ....................... 9-20
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-2
9.4.24 Refractory for Reactor, A2-MR1535 (A2-MR1545) ...................................... 9-21
9.4.25 Rainshield for Reactor Furnace, A2-ME1531 (A2-ME1541) ........................ 9-21
9.4.26 Ceramic Ferrule for Reactor Furnace, A2-MR1531 (A2-MR1541) ............... 9-21
9.4.27 Waste Heat Boiler, A2-BF1530 (A2-BF1540) ............................................... 9-22
9.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................. 9-24
9.5.1 SRU Air:Acid Gas Ratio Control Loop .......................................................... 9-24
9.5.2 Acid Gas Burner Management System ........................................................ 9-30
9.5.3 Process Air Blower Controls ......................................................................... 9-34
9.5.4 Reactor Furnace Temperature Control ......................................................... 9-39
9.5.5 Knock-Out Drum Pump Control .................................................................... 9-41
9.5.6 "Ride-Through" System Considerations ....................................................... 9-41
9.5.7 Boiler Low-Low Level S/D Transmitter Testing ............................................ 9-44
9.5.8 SRU Emergency Shutdown Systems ........................................................... 9-46
9.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ............................. 9-56
9.6.1 Equipment Damage ...................................................................................... 9-56
9.6.2 Cold Catalyst Bed Startup ............................................................................ 9-58
9.6.3 Sulfur Solidification ....................................................................................... 9-60
9.6.4 Ammonia Salt Formation .............................................................................. 9-61
9.6.5 Catalyst Fouling ............................................................................................ 9-62
9.6.6 Operation of SRUs in Parallel ....................................................................... 9-62
9.6.7 Process air Blower Operation ....................................................................... 9-65
9.6.8 Reactor Furnace Temperature ..................................................................... 9-70
9.6.9 Ammonia Destruction Considerations .......................................................... 9-73
9.6.10 Sulfur Recovery Efficiency ............................................................................ 9-76
9.6.11 Operation at Low Flow Rates ....................................................................... 9-78
9.6.12 Pressure Drop Surveys ................................................................................ 9-82
9.6.13 Boiler Water Treatment ................................................................................ 9-84
9.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ............................................................. 9-86
9.7.1 Preliminary Check-out .................................................................................. 9-86
9.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out ....................................................................... 9-87
9.7.3 Leak Testing the Process Piping and Equipment ......................................... 9-88
9.7.4 Purging the Inlet Knock-Out Drums .............................................................. 9-93
9.7.5 Commissioning Fuel Gas and Instrument Air to the Process ....................... 9-95
9.7.6 Commissioning Nitrogen to the Process ...................................................... 9-99
9.7.7 Commissioning the Sulfur Surge Tank Heating and Ventilation ................. 9-102
9.7.8 Pre-filling the Sulfur Drain Seal Assemblies ............................................... 9-104
9.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES ................................................................................ 9-105
9.8.1 Initial Firing / Refractory Cure-out ............................................................... 9-105
9.8.2 Amine Acid Gas Flow ................................................................................. 9-117
9.8.3 SWS Gas Flow ........................................................................................... 9-124
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-3
9.8.4 Routing SRU Tailgas to the TGCU ............................................................. 9-127
9.8.5 Normal Startup - Cold System .................................................................... 9-129
9.8.6 Normal Startup - Hot System ...................................................................... 9-146
9.8.7 Firing Supplemental Fuel Gas .................................................................... 9-158
9.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ........................................................................... 9-164
9.9.1 Planned Shutdown - No Reactor Entry ....................................................... 9-165
9.9.2 Planned Shutdown for Reactor Entry ......................................................... 9-170
9.9.3 Shutting Down When Boiler Tubes Are Leaking ........................................ 9-180
9.9.4 Emergency Shutdown ................................................................................ 9-181
9.9.5 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems ................................ 9-183
9.10 ANALYTICAL PROCEDURES .......................................................................... 9-187
9.10.1 Procedure for Sampling and Titrating with a Tutweiler Apparatus ............. 9-187
9.10.2 H
2
S Concentration in Acid Gas by the Tutweiler Method ........................... 9-189
9.10.3 H
2
S and SO
2
Concentration in Tailgas by the Tutweiler Method ................ 9-192
9.10.4 Tailgas Analysis Table ................................................................................ 9-196
9.10.5 Tailgas Analysis Operating Chart ............................................................... 9-197
9.10.6 Essential Apparatus for Tutweiler Analysis ................................................ 9-199
9.10.7 Materials for Tutweiler Analysis .................................................................. 9-200
9.10.8 H
2
S and SO
2
Conc. in Tailgas Using Gas Detector Tubes ......................... 9-200
9.11 ADJUSTING STACKMATCH
+
(
=
V.P. - P
760
289
T 73 2
(11.85)
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used Solution
Iodine ml
S H % Mole
2
Where T = sample temperature, C
P = atmospheric pressure at particular location, mm Hg
V.P = vapor pressure of water at sample temperature, mm Hg
The Normality of the standard iodine solution will be 0.1 N. The last
three factors (which correct the actual acid gas content to
compensate for expansion due to temperature, pressure, and water
content) can be combined and calculated as a function of
temperature only. This has been done for the 100-ml gas sample
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-190
and is included as the Tutweiler Factor Chart in this section
(Chart 1). Therefore, the equation above is simplified to:
(
=
Chart Factor Tutweiler
from Factor
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used Solution
Iodine ml
S H % Mole
2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-191
9
.
0
9
.
5
1
0
.
0
1
0
.
5
1
1
.
0
1
1
.
5
1
2
.
0
1
2
.
5
1
3
.
0
1
3
.
5
1
4
.
0
1
4
.
5
1
5
.
0
1
5
.
5
1
6
.
0
-30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50
Air Temperature, C
T
u
t
w
e
i
l
e
r
F
a
c
t
o
r
Chart 1
Tutweiler Factor
vs.
Air Temperature
Sample Volume: 100 ml
Baro. Pressure: 1.033 kg/cm
2
(a)
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-192
9.10.3 H
2
S and SO
2
Concentration in Tailgas by the Tutweiler Method
The sulfur plant tailgas can be sampled from the sample valve on the
outlet line from the fourth pass of the Sulfur Condenser.
1. Using a 500 ml Tutweiler apparatus, sample and titrate the SRU
tailgas as outlined in Section 9.10.1.
2. Chemical reactions involved:
H
2
S + I
2
S + 2 HI
SO
2
+ I
2
+ 2 H
2
O H
2
SO
4
+ 2 HI
The hydrogen sulfide (H
2
S) and sulfur dioxide (SO
2
) are converted by
the iodine during the shaking. When both gases are completely
converted, the slightest excess of free iodine causes the
characteristic blue color with the starch solution. Although the
relative amount of each gas cannot be determined from the Tutweiler
titration alone, only sulfur dioxide is converted to sulfuric acid
(H
2
SO
4
). Therefore, a further step can be used to determine the
amount of sulfuric acid formed in order to calculate the amount of
sulfur dioxide originally present in the gas sample.
NOTE: Sulfur dioxide and hydrogen sulfide react in the presence
of water to form sulfur:
2 H
2
S + SO
2
3 S + 2 H
2
O
This side reaction (the Claus reaction) causes the iodine
titration to give a low answer. This can be minimized by
rapid titration.
3. Carefully drain the blue starch solution into a clean
250 ml Erlenmeyer flask. Rinse the inside of the Tutweiler burette
with distilled water and add this washing water to the flask with the
blue starch solution.
4. Using an eyedropper, add one drop of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate
(Na
2
S
2
O
3
) and swirl the flask. This drop should use up the excess
iodine and the starch solution should lose its blue color. If more than
one drop is required, too much iodine was added.
5. Add five drops of methyl purple indicator to the flask and swirl gently.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-193
6. Titrate carefully to a definite green end point with 0.1 N sodium
hydroxide (NaOH).
7. Chemical reactions in this titration:
H
2
SO
4
+ 2 NaOH 2 H
2
O + Na
2
SO
4
HI + NaOH H
2
O + NaI
8. Calculations:
a. For a 500-ml gas sample, Mole (or Vol) percent H
2
S + SO
2
(dry
basis):
(
+
(
=
+ V.P. - P
760
289
T 273
(2.369)
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used Solution
Iodine ml
) SO S (H
% Mole
2 2
Where T = sample temperature, C
P = atmospheric pressure at particular location, mm Hg
V.P = vapor pressure of water at sample temperature, mm Hg
The Normality of the standard iodine solution will be 0.1 N. The
last three factors (which correct the actual gas content to
compensate for expansion due to temperature, pressure, and
water content) can be combined and calculated as a function of
temperature only. This has been done for the 500-ml gas
sample and is included as the Tutweiler Factor Chart in this
section (Chart 2). Therefore, the equation above is simplified
to:
(
=
+ Chart Factor Tutweiler
from Factor
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used Solution
Iodine ml
) SO S (H
% Mole
2 2
b. Mole (or Volume) percent SO
2
(dry basis):
(
(
(
(
(
+
= 1
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used
Iodine ml
Solution NaOH
of Normality
Used
NaOH ml
SO S H
% Mole
SO % Mole
2 2
2
c. Mole (or Volume) percent H
2
S (dry basis):
Mole % H
2
S = Mole % ( H
2
S + SO
2
) Mole % SO
2
d. Molar (or Volume) Ratio of H
2
S to SO
2
in tailgas:
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-194
2
2
2 2
SO % Mole
S H % Mole
Ratio SO : S H =
Calculate each quantity as shown above and divide to obtain the
H
2
S:SO
2
ratio, or consult the Process Gas Analysis Table or the
Process Gas Analysis Operating Chart that follows the Tutweiler
Factor Chart.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-195
1
.
8
1
.
9
2
.
0
2
.
1
2
.
2
2
.
3
2
.
4
2
.
5
2
.
6
2
.
7
2
.
8
2
.
9
3
.
0
3
.
1
3
.
2
-30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50
Air Temperature, C
T
u
t
w
e
i
l
e
r
F
a
c
t
o
r
Chart 2
Tutweiler Factor
vs.
Air Temperature
Sample Volume: 500 ml
Baro. Pressure: 1.033 kg/cm
2
(a)
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-196
9.10.4 Tailgas Analysis Table
After completion of the Tutweiler iodine and sodium hydroxide titrations
(see Section 1 on the preceding pages) the Molar (or Volume) ratio of
hydrogen sulfide to sulfur dioxide in the SRU tailgas can be read directly
from this table. If the readings fall off the table, divide (or multiply) both
titration volumes by the same number in order to get within the range of
the table. Note, however, that the iodine and sodium hydroxide solutions
must be of the same Normality for the tabulated values to be correct.
Examples:
If 1.3 ml of 0.1 N iodine is used and 1.8 ml of 0.1 N sodium hydroxide
is used, the molar ratio of H
2
S:SO
2
= 1.60.
If 3.0 ml I
2
and 4.6 ml NaOH are used (these are off the table), divide
by 2 to get 1.5 ml I
2
and 2.3 ml NaOH, for a molar ratio of
H
2
S:SO
2
= 0.88.
If 0.8 ml I
2
and 1.1 ml NaOH are used, multiply by 2 to get 1.6 ml I
2
and 2.2 ml NaOH, for a molar ratio of H
2
S:SO
2
= 1.67.
The values in the table below are the ratio of H
2
S:SO
2
for the quantities of
iodine and sodium hydroxide used in the titrations.
NOTE: This table is valid only when the Normalities of the iodine and
sodium hydroxide solutions are the same.
ml
I
2
ml of NaOH
1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 2.0
0.9 8.00 3.50 2.00 1.25 0.80 0.50 0.28 0.12 0.00 * *
1.0 * 9.00 4.00 2.33 1.50 1.00 0.67 0.43 0.25 0.11 0.00
1.1 * * 10.00 4.50 2.67 1.75 1.20 0.84 0.58 0.38
1.2 * * * 11.00 5.00 3.00 2.00 1.40 1.01 0.73 0.51
1.3 * * * * 12.00 5.50 3.33 2.25 1.60 1.18 0.88
1.4 * * * * * 13.00 6.00 3.67 2.50 1.80 1.35
1.5 * * * * * * 14.00 6.50 4.00 2.75 2.00
1.6 * * * * * * * 15.00 7.00 4.33 3.00
1.7 * * * * * * * * 16.00 7.50 4.67
1.8 * * * * * * * * * 17.00 8.00
1.9 * * * * * * * * * * 18.00
2.0 * * * * * * * * * * *
* Erroneous Test
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-197
ml
I
2
ml of NaOH
2.0 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 3.0 3.1
1.2 0.51 0.33 0.20 0.09 0.00 * * * * * * *
1.3 0.88 0.63 0.44 0.30 0.18 0.08 0.00 * * * * *
1.4 1.35 1.00 0.75 0.56 0.40 0.27 0.17 0.08 0.00 * * *
1.5 2.00 1.50 1.14 0.88 0.67 0.50 0.36 0.25 0.15 0.07 0.00 *
1.6 3.00 2.20 1.67 1.29 1.00 0.78 0.60 0.45 0.33 0.23 0.14 0.07
1.7 4.67 3.25 2.40 1.83 1.43 1.13 0.89 0.70 0.55 0.42 0.31 0.21
1.8 8.00 5.00 3.50 2.60 2.00 1.57 1.25 1.00 0.80 0.64 0.50 0.38
1.9 18.00 8.50 5.33 3.75 2.80 2.17 1.71 1.38 1.11 0.90 0.73 0.58
2.0 * 19.00 9.00 5.67 4.00 3.00 2.33 1.86 1.50 1.22 1.00 0.82
2.1 * * 20.00 9.50 6.00 4.25 3.20 2.50 2.00 1.63 1.33 1.10
2.2 * * * 21.00 10.00 6.33 4.50 3.40 2.67 2.14 1.75 1.44
2.3 * * * * 22.00 10.50 6.67 4.75 3.60 2.83 2.29 1.88
2.4 * * * * * 23.00 11.00 7.00 5.00 3.80 3.00 2.43
2.5 * * * * * * 24.00 11.50 7.33 5.33 5.25 4.00
2.6 * * * * * * * 25.00 12.00 7.67 5.50 4.20
* Erroneous Test
9.10.5 Tailgas Analysis Operating Chart
The titration volumes can also be used with the following Tailgas Analysis
Operating Chart for a quick check to see how close to optimum ratio the
sulfur plant is currently running.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-198
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 8.0 8.5
m
l
o
f
I
o
d
i
n
e
S
o
l
u
t
i
o
n
Chart 3
Tailgas Analysis
Operating Chart
(Both solutions must be
the same normality)
H
2
S:SO
2
= 2.3
H
2
S:SO
2
= 1.7
DEFICIENT AIR
EXCESS AIR
ml of Sodium Hydroxide Solution
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-199
9.10.6 Essential Apparatus for Tutweiler Analysis
1. Tutweiler apparatus, complete, two 100 milliliter size and one
500 milliliter size.
2. Burette clamps, single, two.
3. Graduated cylinders, 100 milliliter and 50 milliliter, one each.
4. Automatic burettes with Teflon stopcocks, 50 milliliter, two.
5. Erlenmeyer flasks, 250 milliliter, four.
6. Ring stands, two.
7. Avery labels, approximately
7
/
8
" x 1", one package.
8. Thermometers, 0C - 400C and -30C - 120C ranges, three each.
9. Volumetric flasks with glass stoppers, 1000 milliliter, two.
10. Volumetric flask with glass stopper, 2000 milliliter, one.
11. Dropper bottles, PE (polyethylene), 4 ounce (approx. 125 ml), two.
12. Rubber tubing, " I.D.
13. Tubing clamps, six.
14. Tube fittings, " pipe to " rubber tubing, six.
15. Wash bottle, PE, 1 liter, one.
16. Reagent bottles, plain narrow mouth, with flat head stopper, Pyrex,
1 liter capacity, three.
17. Amber bottles with Bakline screw caps, 5 pint capacity (approx.
2.5 liters), two.
18. Aspirator bottle, 125 milliliter capacity, two.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-200
9.10.7 Materials for Tutweiler Analysis
1. Acculutes, sodium thiosulfate, 0.1 normal, two.
2. Acculutes, sodium hydroxide, 0.1 normal, four.
3. Acculutes, iodine, 0.1 normal, six.
4. Methyl purple indicator in dropper bottle, 4 ounce (approx. 125 ml),
one.
5. Starch solution, stabilized, 1 quart (approx. 1 liter), one.
6. Distilled water, 5 gallon, (approx. 20 liters), one.
7. Stopcock grease, silicone, one tube.
9.10.8 H
2
S and SO
2
Conc. in Tailgas Using Gas Detector Tubes
As an alternative to the traditional wet-chemistry methods described in the
preceding Section 1 for determining the concentrations of H
2
S and SO
2
in
the sulfur plant tailgas, gas detector tubes can be used to quickly and
easily make this determination. Although the discussion that follows
specifically addresses using gas detector tubes manufactured by
Drgerwerk AG of West Germany, there may be suitable detector tubes
available from other manufacturers. Drger tubes can be purchased from
most safety equipment supply companies.
The following Drger tubes are needed for this procedure:
H
2
S 0.2% Drger Cat. No. CH 281 01
(H
2
S + SO
2
) 0.2% Drger Cat. No. CH 282 01
9.10.8.1 Operating Principles
Drger tubes and other gas detector tubes measure gas
concentrations by using a sample pump to draw a specific volume of
the gas to be sampled into a glass tube containing a suitable
reagent. The gaseous compound of interest chemically reacts with
the reagent to produce a color change. The length of the "stain" line
is a direct function of the concentration of the compound in the
sample gas. Some detector tubes are calibrated with measured lines
to allow reading the concentration directly on the tube. Others, such
as the two listed above, have reference marks on the tube that can
be multiplied by a factor to compute the concentration.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-201
Drger tubes are designed to be used with a Drger Model 31 gas
detector pump. This is a hand-operated bellows pump that will draw
a 100 cc sample volume for each pump stroke. Some tubes are
designed for a single sample stroke, while others may use 5, 10, or
even 20 strokes. In some cases, a tube may be used for measuring
different concentration ranges by using a different number of strokes.
a. Drger Cat. No. CH 281 01, H
2
S 0.2%
This tube will measure H
2
S concentrations in the range of 0.2%
to 7% when one sample stroke is used. If desired, the range
can be reduced to 0.02% to 0.7% by using 10 sample strokes.
Each tube contains a substrate of a pale blue copper
compound. When exposed to H
2
S, the copper compound is
converted to black copper sulfide. The length of the black stain,
marked in cm on the tube, is multiplied by a factor stamped on
the box to give the H
2
S concentration in percent.
This copper sulfide reaction is not affected by any of the other
compounds normally found in sulfur plant tailgas. SO
2
in the
tailgas may turn the indicating layer somewhat yellow (due to
precipitation of elemental sulfur), but does not affect the H
2
S
measurement.
b. Drger Cat. No. CH 282 01, (H
2
S + SO
2
) 0.2%
This tube will measure the combined concentration of H
2
S and
SO
2
in the range of 0.2% to 7% if one sample stroke is used. If
desired, the range can be reduced to 0.02% to 0.7% by using
10 sample strokes. Each tube contains a substrate of brown
iodine. When exposed to H
2
S and/or SO
2
, the iodine reacts to
form hydroiodic acid (a gas) and the brown color disappears.
Since H
2
S reacts with iodine to form elemental sulfur, the brown
will become pale yellow. The length of the yellow stain, marked
in cm on the tube, is multiplied by a factor stamped on the box
to give the H
2
S+SO
2
concentration in percent.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-202
9.10.8.2 Sampling the Tailgas
The sulfur plant tailgas can be sampled from the sample valve on the
outlet line from the fourth pass of the Sulfur Condenser.
a. Before beginning, check the Drger pump for leaks by inserting
an unopened tube into the pump and stroking the pump.
Confirm that the bellows does not re-expand. If it does, either
the pump or its seal around the tube is leaking, and the test
results will not be accurate.
b. Attach a short piece of rubber tubing to the process sample
valve.
c. Break off the tips at each end of an H
2
S Drger tube and insert
it into the sample pump (with the arrow on the side of the tube
pointing toward the pump).
d. Purge the rubber tubing by venting tailgas to the atmosphere for
a few seconds. Pinch the rubber tubing closed at the end,
close the gas sample valve, slip the end of the rubber tubing
onto the end of the Drger tube, and reopen the sample valve.
e. Stroke the sample pump one time (be sure to compress the
bellows until reaching the stops) and allow the pump to draw
the gas sample into the detector tube. The sample stroke is
complete when the metal chain on the bellows is taut.
f. Close the sample valve, remove the rubber tubing from the end
of the Drger tube, and use the pump to draw two strokes of
fresh air through the detector tube to complete the reactions.
g. Read the length of the black stain using the cm marks on the
tube and record the reading.
h. Break off the tips at each end of an H
2
S+SO
2
Drger tube and
insert it into the sample pump (with the arrow on the side of the
tube pointing toward the pump).
i. Repeat steps d through f.
j. Read the length of the yellow stain using the cm marks on the
tube and record the reading.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-203
k. Check that the sample valve is closed, then remove the rubber
tubing.
9.10.8.3 Calculations
a. Mole (or Volume) percent H
2
S (wet basis):
(
=
mbar Pres., Baro.
1013
Box on
Factor
cm Length,
Stain
S H % Mole
2
The last factor corrects the measurement for pressure effects
when samples are taken at elevations above sea level. Note
that the average barometric pressure at the complex is
14.7 PSIA = 1013 mbar.
b. Mole (or Volume) percent H
2
S+SO
2
(wet basis):
(
= +
mbar Pres., Baro.
1013
Box on
Factor
cm Length,
Stain
) SO S H ( % Mole
2 2
c. Mole (or Volume) percent SO
2
(wet basis):
Mole % SO
2
= Mole % ( H
2
S + SO
2
) Mole % H
2
S
d. Molar (or Volume) Ratio of H
2
S to SO
2
in the tailgas:
2
2
2 2
SO % Mole
S H % Mole
Ratio SO : S H =
9.10.8.4 Example
Suppose, for example, that the following measurements are taken:
Stain Length Factor on Box
H
2
S Tube 1.5 cm 0.44
H
2
S+SO
2
Tube 2.1 cm 0.51
a. Mole % H
2
S =
(
1013
1013
(0.44) cm) (1.5
= 0.66%
b. Mole % (H
2
S +SO
2
) =
(
1013
1013
(0.51) cm) (2.1
= 1.07%
c. Mole % SO
2
= 0.66% - % 07 . 1 = 0.41%
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-204
d. H
2
S : SO
2
Ratio =
% 41 . 0
% 66 . 0
= 1.61
This indicates that the H
2
S:SO
2
ratio is a little low (less than 2.0), so
the air:acid gas ratio is on the high side. The output from the air
demand hand control should be lowered slightly, and the
measurements repeated after the SRU reaches a steady state again.
If the H
2
S:SO
2
ratio had been high (greater than 2.0), that would
have meant that the air:acid gas ratio was on the low side. In that
case, the output from thr air demand hand control would need to be
raised slightly to increase the air flow and bring the H
2
S:SO
2
ratio
down.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Sulfur Recovery Page 9-205
9.11 Adjusting StackMatch
Ignitor/Pilots
The pilots for the burners are StackMatch
(7) CO
2
+ CH
3
(CH
2
OHCH
2
)
2
N + H
2
O CH
3
(CH
2
OHCH
2
)
2
NH
+
+ HCO
3
The selectivity of the solvent for H
2
S over CO
2
is important since the
absorbed gases are recycled to the SRUs. Minimizing CO
2
pickup
reduces the amount of gas recycling to the sulfur plants, and allows the
equipment in the Sulfur Recovery and Tailgas Cleanup Units to be
smaller.
The selectivity of tertiary amines like MDEA for H
2
S is a result of the
indirect reaction that must occur between the amine and CO
2
. Unlike
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-6
primary amines (such as MEA) and secondary amines (such as DEA),
tertiary amines do not react directly with CO
2
. Instead, the CO
2
must first
be ionized into a bicarbonate ion (a slow reaction) before it will react with
the amine. Since MDEA reacts directly (and quickly) with H
2
S, proper
selection of the contact time between the amine and the process gas
allows preferential removal of the H
2
S. The selectivity of MDEA for H
2
S
over CO
2
is enhanced by lower contact temperatures, hence the use of
the trim cooler to reduce the solvent temperature before it enters the
TGCU Contactor.
The rich amine leaves the bottom of the tower at 42C [108F] and is
pumped by the TGCU Rich Amine Pump, A2-GA1561A/B, through the
TGCU Rich Amine Filter, A2-FD1562A/B, to remove accumulated solids.
The rich amine then flows on level control through the tube side of the
TGCU Lean/Rich Exchanger, A2-EA1564A/B/C, and is preheated to
105C [221F] by cooling the lean amine before flowing to the TGCU
Stripper, A2-DA1562, entering between trays #4 and #5.
11.3.5 Solvent Regeneration Section
The TGCU Stripper contains 28 valve trays (4 wash water trays, 24
stripping trays) and one chimney draw tray. As the solvent flows down the
column, the absorbed H
2
S and CO
2
are stripped from the MDEA by
countercurrent contact with stripping steam rising upward. This stripping
steam is generated in the TGCU Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1565, using
LP steam as the heat input. The heat input to the reboiler is adjusted by
flow control of the steam. The steam flow controller can optionally be
reset by the TGCU Stripper overhead temperature, which will maintain the
desired overhead temperature of 118C [244F] by varying the heat input
in proportion to the amount of acid gas contained in the rich amine.
The stripping steam supplies the heat of reaction required to reverse
reactions (6) and (7), and carries the H
2
S and CO
2
stripped from the
solvent overhead to the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser, A2-EC1562,
where the steam is condensed as the stream is cooled to 49C [120F].
The condensed water is removed by the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator, A2-FA1560, and returned as reflux to the wash water trays
in the tower by the TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump, A2-GA1563A/B. The
acid gas (H
2
S and CO
2
, along with the uncondensed water) stripped from
the solvent exits the reflux drum at 0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) [12.1 PSIG] and flows
to the two Sulfur Recovery Units.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-7
The TGCU Lean amine Pump, A2-GA1562A/B, pumps the regenerated
lean MDEA solvent from the bottom of the TGCU Stripper through the
shell side of the TGCU Lean/Rich Exchanger, cooling the lean amine from
127C [261F] to 66C [152F] by countercurrent heat exchange with the
cool rich amine. A slipstream of the lean amine then flows through the
TGCU Lean Amine Filter, A2-FD1563, to remove accumulated solids from
the solvent and through the TGCU Amine Carbon Filter, A2-FD1564,
where the activated carbon adsorbs contaminants such as degradation
products from solvent. The TGCU Amine After-Filter, A2-FD1565,
catches any carbon "fines" before the filtered slipstream rejoins the main
solvent stream and flows to the TGCU Lean Amine Cooler, A2-EC1561,
and the TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler, A2-EA1563A/B, which cool the
solvent to 38C [100F] before it returns to the top of the TGCU Contactor
on flow control.
11.3.6 Steam Production/Consumption
The TGCU consumes steam at two pressure levels, and produces steam
at one pressure level. Saturated HP steam from the SRUs is used to heat
the TGCU Reactor feed stream, and LP steam is used to reboil solvent in
the TGCU Stripper Reboiler. LP steam is produced in the TGCU Waste
Heat Reclaimer, supplying a portion of the steam consumed in reboiling
the TGCU solvent.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-8
11.4 Equipment Description
11.4.1 TGCU Quench Column, A2-DA1560
The TGCU Quench Column contains a single bed of random packing to
provide good contact between the hot process gas and the quench water
that is to cool it. The tower has a 304 S.S. woven wire mist eliminator
above the packed bed to remove entrained water droplets from the gas
before it leaves the tower.
11.4.2 TGCU Quench Column Packing, A2-DB1560
This bed of random packing provides good contact between hot process
gas entering below it and quench water fed above it inside the TGCU
Quench Column. The packing has a bed limiter above it and rests on a
bed support. The quench water is distributed over the packing by a
distributor tray. The packing is 304 S.S.; the other internals are 304 S.S.
Gaskets are installed where the bed support and distributor tray bolt to the
support ring and clips inside the TGCU Quench Column to prevent direct
contact between the stainless steel internals and the carbon steel vessel.
This electrically isolates the dissimilar metals from each other to prevent
direct contact that could lead to galvanic corrosion.
11.4.3 TGCU Contactor, A2-DA1561
The TGCU Contactor contains a single bed of random packing to provide
good contact between the process gas and the TGCU solvent to remove
H
2
S from the process gas. The tower has a 304 S.S. woven wire mist
eliminator above the top bed to remove entrained solvent droplets from
the gas before it leaves the tower.
11.4.4 TGCU Contactor Packing & Internals, A2-DB1561
This random packing bed provides good contact between process gas
entering below it and TGCU lean amine fed above it inside the TGCU
Contactor. The packing has a bed limiter above it and rests on a bed
support. The lean amine is distributed over the packing by a distributor
tray. The packing elements are 304 S.S.; the other internals are 304 S.S.
Gaskets are installed where the bed support and distributor tray bolt to the
support ring and clips inside the TGCU Quench Column to prevent direct
contact between the stainless steel internals and the carbon steel vessel.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-9
This electrically isolates the dissimilar metals from each other to prevent
direct contact that could lead to galvanic corrosion.
11.4.5 TGCU Stripper, A2-DA1562
The TGCU Stripper contains 28 valve trays to provide good contact
between the rich TGCU solvent and the reboiler vapors to strip H
2
S and
CO
2
from the solvent. The rich amine enters on the fifth tray from the top;
the four trays above that are "water wash" trays that allow the reflux water
(entering on the top tray) to remove traces of MDEA from the overhead
vapor and minimize solvent losses.
A chimney tray is located below the bottom valve tray to gather all of the
column liquids to feed the TGCU Stripper Reboiler. The column section
located below this chimney tray serves to separate the outlet steam and
lean amine from the reboiler and to provide surge for the solvent
circulating system.
11.4.6 TGCU Stripper Trays, A2-DB1562
These 1-pass valve trays provide good contact between the rich TGCU
solvent fed above them and the reboiler vapors fed below them inside the
TGCU Stripper. The trays are designed per Shell's requirements. The
tray decks are 304 S.S., and the valves are fabricated from 304 S.S. to
resist corrosion and to prevent "sticking" to the tray decks. The chimney
tray deck is 304 S.S. The bottom valve tray has a seal pan for its
downcomer to maintain a liquid seal and prevent gas from blowing up the
downcomer.
The chimney tray gathers the tower liquids to feed the reboiler. The outlet
from the reboiler reenters the column below the chimney tray, with the
vapor produced by the reboiler flowing upward through the chimneys in
order to reach the valve trays above.
The top four trays in the column are located above the rich amine feed
point and serve as water-wash trays to minimize the amount of amine
carried-over in the tower overhead. Since these trays have only the reflux
water flowing over them, the liquid rates for these trays are much lower
than for the trays lower in the column. For this reason, these four trays
are designed for minimum leakage (i.e., picket fence weirs, minimum
downcomer clearance, etc.).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-10
11.4.7 TGCU Reactor, A2-DC1560
The TGCU Reactor is of the down-flow type, with the feed gas entering
the top of the vessel and proceeding vertically downward through the
catalyst bed. A perforated baffle is installed below the inlet nozzle to
distribute the gas over the length of the vessel and prevent the inlet gas
stream from impinging directly on the catalyst bed.
A catalyst support grating is installed in the vessel to support the catalyst
bed in the center of the vessel. The support grating is covered with a
stainless steel screen to prevent the catalyst from sifting through the
grating. A small bead of castable refractory is used to seal the edges of
the support grating to prevent catalyst leaks between the grating and the
vessel shell.
11.4.8 TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator, A2-FA1560
This vertical pressure vessel removes condensed water from the stream
leaving the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser so that the water can be
used as reflux for the TGCU Stripper. The vessel has a 304 S.S. woven
wire mist eliminator in the top to remove entrained liquid droplets from the
gas before it leaves the vessel.
11.4.9 Catalyst for TGCU Reactor, A2-MC1560
Refer to the Basic Engineering Package for the type of catalyst used in
the TGCU Reactor.
11.4.10 TGCU Stripper Reboiler Condensate Pot, A2-FA1562
This vertical pressure vessel collects the condensate from the TGCU
Stripper Reboiler and returns it to the condensate system on level control.
This method of removing condensate from the exchanger provides much
smoother control of the heat input to the reboiler than a conventional
steam trap could.
As stated above, this vessel is simply a very good steam trap. During
normal operation, the steam pressure required to provide the necessary
reboil heat to the TGCU Stripper may be much less than the
3.5-4.2 kg/cm
2
(g) steam pressure available in the LP steam system. The
normal steam pressure in the shell of the reboiler may be such that the
water level in the condensate pot will rise upwards from the pot, perhaps
even within the shell of the reboiler. During these periods, the level valve
will remain fully open and the sight glass will indicate a full water level.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-11
This is a normal operating condition for this vessel. The vessel will usually
operate with a visible level only when the TGCU Stripper Reboiler is
operating near its maximum capacity with full steam pressure on the shell
of the exchanger. Under these conditions, the level control and level
valve will function normally and maintain a water level in the vessel.
11.4.11 TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, A2-EA1560
This shell and tube exchanger uses HP steam to heat the tailgas stream
from the fourth pass of the two Sulfur Condensers up to reaction initiation
temperature before it is mixed with hydrogen-rich reducing gas and flows
to the TGCU Reactor.
11.4.12 TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, A2-EA1561
The TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer is a fixed tubesheet shell and tube heat
exchanger. The tubes are immersed in the water-filled section of the
shell, allowing the boiling water in the shell of the exchanger to cool the
hot gas leaving the TGCU Reactor catalyst bed by producing LP steam.
There is no pressure control on the shell side of the boiler; it simply
"floats" on the LP steam header pressure.
The boiler is equipped with level transmittersthat will shut down the TGCU
should the water level fall to within 75 mm of the top row of tubes.
Operation of the boiler without a sufficient water level could possibly
damage the tubes.
11.4.13 TGCU Quench Water Trim Cooler, A2-EA1562A/B
This shell and tube exchanger is used to provide the final cooling of the
quench water, with cooling water from the complex as the cooling
medium.
11.4.14 TGCU Lean/Rich Exchanger, A2-EA1564
This shell and tube exchanger conserves energy by providing heat
exchange between the rich amine and the lean amine, so that the hot lean
amine leaving the TGCU Stripper can preheat the rich amine before it
feeds the TGCU Stripper. This cross exchange saves reboiler duty by
preheating the rich amine, and reduces the load on the TGCU Lean amine
Cooler by partially cooling the hot lean amine.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-12
11.4.15 TGCU Stripper Reboiler, A2-EA1565
The TGCU Stripper Reboiler is a fixed tubesheet shell and tube heat
exchanger. The exchanger is arranged as a once-through vertical
thermosiphon reboiler, mounted on the side of the TGCU Stripper. The
static head of the solvent above the inlet nozzle on the lower channel
provides the driving force to circulate the solvent through the tubes.
LP steam on the shell of the exchanger heats the solvent inside the tubes,
partially vaporizing it to create stripping steam to remove the H
2
S and the
CO
2
from the solvent flowing down the TGCU Stripper.
11.4.16 TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler, A2-EA1563
This shell and tube exchanger is used to provide the final cooling to the
TGCU solvent returning from the regeneration section of the process, with
cooling water from the complex as the cooling medium. Since the
selectivity of MDEA for absorbing H
2
S in the presence of CO
2
is better at
lower temperatures, the use of cooling water is very beneficial to the
process and results in reducing the emission of SO
2
from the TTO.
11.4.17 TGCU Quench Water Cooler, A2-EC1560
This forced-draft aerial exchanger is used to reject some of the heat from
cooling the process gas stream in the TGCU Quench Column by cooling
the circulating quench water stream. Fans are used to circulate air across
the finned tubes to remove heat from the quench water.
11.4.18 TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser, A2-EC1562
This forced-draft aerial exchanger provides cooling to condense the
majority of the water from the acid gas stream leaving the overhead of the
TGCU Stripper. Fans are used to circulate air across the finned tubes to
remove heat from the overhead stream and condense the water to be
used as reflux for the tower.
11.4.19 TGCU Lean Amine Cooler, A2-EC1561
This forced-draft aerial exchanger provides some of the final cooling of the
lean amine stream returning from the regeneration section of the TGCU
process. Fans are used to circulate air across the finned tubes to remove
heat from the solvent.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-13
SINCE THE PUMPS DESCRIBED IN THE FOLLOWING SECTIONS ARE
CONSTRUCTED OF STAINLESS STEEL, DO NOT HYDROTEST THE
ASSOCIATED VESSELS OR PIPING WITH WATER CONTAINING HIGH
LEVELS OF CHLORIDES. AVOID ALLOWING WATER CONTAINING MORE
THAN 50 PPM CHLORIDES TO COME IN CONTACT WITH THESE PUMPS TO
PREVENT STRESS CORROSION CRACKING OF THE STAINLESS STEEL.
THE LIQUID IN THESE PUMPS CONTAINS DISSOLVED H
2
S. THIS H
2
S CAN
BE RELEASED TO THE SURROUNDINGS WHEN LIQUID IS DRAINED FROM
THESE PUMPS OR FROM THE PIPING CONNECTED TO THE PUMPS.
ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS WHEN
DRAINING LIQUID FROM THESE PUMPS OR PERFORMING MAINTENANCE
ON THEM. THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES
SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF THERE IS ANY DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK
SAFELY WHEN H
2
S MAY BE PRESENT.
11.4.20 TGCU Quench Water Pump, A2-GA1560A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to circulate quench water to cool the
process gas in the TGCU Quench Column. Each pump is designed for
the total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are
equipped with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to
the surroundings.
CAUTION
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-14
11.4.21 TGCU Rich Amine Pump, A2-GA1561A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the rich amine from the TGCU
Contactor to the TGCU Stripper. Each pump is designed for the total
duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are equipped with
tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to the
surroundings.
11.4.22 TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump, A2-GA1563A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the reflux from the TGCU
Stripper Reflux Accumulator to the TGCU Stripper. Each pump is
designed for the total duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These
pumps are equipped with tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of
releasing H
2
S to the surroundings.
11.4.23 TGCU Lean Amine Pump, A2-GA1562A/B
These centrifugal pumps are used to send the lean amine from the TGCU
Stripper to the TGCU Contactor. Each pump is designed for the total
duty; the other pump is a 100% spare. These pumps are equipped with
tandem seals to reduce the likelihood of releasing H
2
S to the
surroundings.
11.4.24 TGCU Start-Up Blower, A2-GB1560
The TGCU Start-Up Blower is a single-stage fan, used to re-circulate
process gas within the TGCU Unit. Flexible connectors are used to isolate
the fan from the suction and discharge piping to allow the necessary
freedom for the expansion and movement that occurs during normal
operation.
The shaft seal is made gas-tight by using a gas-lubricated non-contacting
dual cartridge seal, so that process gas cannot escape to the
surroundings. The nitrogen seal purge should be kept in service at all
times, whether the blower is operating or not, to prevent leakage of
process gas.
The blower casing and impeller are constructed of carbon steel and
coated with "Heresite", a baked phenolic coating, for corrosion resistance.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-15
THIS BLOWER HANDLES GASES CONTAINING H
2
S, SO
2
, AND
OTHER HARMFUL GASES. ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER
PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS WHEN PERFORMING
MAINTENANCE ON THIS BLOWER. THE "GENERAL SAFETY"
SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF
THERE IS ANY DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK SAFELY WHEN
H
2
S AND/OR SO
2
MAY BE PRESENT.
WHEN THIS BLOWER IS NOT OPERATING, WATER CAN
CONDENSE FROM THE PROCESS GAS AND CAUSE CORROSION
DAMAGE TO THE BLOWER. TO PREVENT THIS, THE BLOWER IS
AUTOMATICALLY ISOLATED FROM THE PROCESS BY CLOSING
ITS SUCTION AND DISCHARGE BLOCK VALVES WHEN IT STOPS,
THEN PURGING THE BLOWER CASING WITH NITROGEN. THE
NITROGEN PURGE SHOULD BE CHECKED PERIODICALLY TO
CONFIRM THAT IT IS OPERATING PROPERLY.
11.4.25 Refractory for TGCU Reactor, A2-MR1560
A 50 mm bead of castable refractory is installed around the edges of the
catalyst bed support inside the TGCU Reactor. This seals the edges of
the bed support so that the small catalyst pellets cannot escape from the
bed.
WARNING
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-16
11.4.26 TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer, A2-ME1560
This static mixer is designed to thoroughly mix the tailgas leaving the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater and the hydrogen-rich reducing gas before
the combined stream enters the TGCU Reactor.
11.4.27 TGCU Quench Water Filter, A2-FD1560A/B
This filter is designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and larger from
a slipstream of the circulating quench water. If SO
2
enters the TGCU
Quench Column and reacts with H
2
S to form small particles of colloidal
sulfur, the filter will also help remove them.
A COMMON CONTAMINANT REMOVED BY THIS FILTER IS IRON
SULFIDE, WHICH IS PYROPHORIC AT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE.
IF THE FILTER ELEMENTS CONTAIN SUFFICIENT IRON SULFIDE,
THE ELEMENTS MAY SPONTANEOUSLY IGNITE ONCE THE
ELEMENTS DRY. ACCORDINGLY, EXERCISE PROPER CARE
WHEN HANDLING AND DISPOSING OF USED FILTER ELEMENTS.
11.4.28 TGCU Rich Amine Filter, A2-FD1562A/B
This full-flow filter is designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and
larger from the circulating rich TGCU solvent, which will help prevent
fouling of the downstream heat exchangers.
THIS FILTER HANDLES LIQUID CONTAINING H
2
S AND OTHER
HARMFUL SUBSTANCES. ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER
PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS WHEN PERFORMING
MAINTENANCE ON THIS FILTER. THE "GENERAL SAFETY"
SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF
THERE IS ANY DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK SAFELY WHEN
H
2
S MAY BE PRESENT.
WARNING
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-17
11.4.29 TGCU Lean Amine Filter, A2-FD1563
This filter is designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and larger from
a slipstream of the circulating lean TGCU solvent.
11.4.30 TGCU Amine Carbon Filter, A2-FD1564
This filter is designed to remove organic contaminants (trace
hydrocarbons, degradation products, etc.) from a slipstream of the
circulating lean TGCU solvent using a bed of activated carbon.
11.4.31 TGCU Amine After-Filter, A2-FD1565
This filter is designed to remove solid particles, particularly carbon fines,
5 microns and larger from the lean TGCU solvent leaving the TGCU
Amine Carbon Filter.
11.4.32 pH Meter Sample Filter, A2-FD1561A/B
These filters are designed to remove solid particles 5 microns and larger
from the small stream of quench water flowing to the pH analyzer probe.
There are two 100% filters so that one filter can remain in service while
the other filter is being cleaned.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-18
11.5 Instrumentation and Control Systems
11.5.1 TGCU Reactor Feed Control Loops
The TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, A2-EA1560, and TGCU Reactor Feed
Mixer, A2-ME1560, condition the combined tailgas from the SRUs before
it enters the TGCU Reactor, A2-DC1560, by heating the tailgas and
mixing it with reducing gas (hydrogen). Saturated HP steam produced in
the SRUs is used to heat the tailgas to the desired reaction temperature
(~240C [~464F]). External reducing gas is then mixed with the tailgas to
supply some of the hydrogen needed to convert all of the sulfur
compounds to H
2
S in the reactor.
Thus, here are two important control parameters: the reactor feed
temperature and the hydrogen concentration in the reactor feed. The loop
diagram on page 11-22 illustrates the components of these control loops
when implemented in a distributed control system (DCS).
There are also controls for handling specific requirements during startup
and shutdown of the front-end of the TGCU. These control loops are
shown on the loop diagram as well. All of the control loops are discussed
in the sections that follow.
11.5.1.1 Reactor Feed Temperature Control
The feed to the TGCU Reactor is the gas leaving the TGCU Reactor
Feed Mixer. The temperature of this stream depends on the amount
of heating that takes places as the combined tailgas stream flows
through the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater. A2-TIC15820 on the mixer
outlet raises or lowers the setpoint of the steam pressure controller,
A2-PIC15820, to control this temperature by adjusting the steam
pressure inside the shell of the exchanger.
To raise the reactor feed temperature, A2-TIC15820 increases the
steam pressure by increasing the setpoint of A2-PIC15820. This will
cause A2-PIC15820 to open steam control valve A2-PV15820 more,
which results in two effects. First, as the valve opens more, the
pressure drop is reduced across the valve, increasing the steam
pressure inside the shell of the exchanger. This in turn increases the
saturation temperature of the steam inside the shell, increasing the
temperature driving force and thus raising the heat input to the
process gas in the tubes. Second, as the valve opens more, the
steam flow rate increases, supplying more heat to the exchanger to
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-19
match the increase in the heat input. The net result is to increase the
heat transfer, raising the feed temperature accordingly.
Conversely, A2-TIC15820 lowers the reactor feed temperature by
reducing the setpoint of A2-PIC15820 so that it closes A2-PV15820
more. This drops the steam pressure inside the shell to reduce the
heat input, and reduces the steam flow to match. This reduces the
heat transfer, thus lowering the feed temperature.
11.5.1.2 Hydrogen Concentration Control
To ensure complete conversion of the sulfur compounds in the
TGCU Reactor, it is necessary to maintain an excess of hydrogen in
the gas leaving the reactor. The hydrogen concentration is
measured by the hydrogen analyzer, A2-AE15858, and supplied to
A2-AIC15816 in the DCS. The output from A2-AIC15816 is limited
from high and low extremes by A2-AY15816 (to protect the process
from analyzer malfunctions), and adjusts the flow rate of external
reducing gas being supplied to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer via
adjustment of the remote setpoint on the reducing gas flow controller,
A2-FIC15816. A2-AY15816 restricts the remote setpoint supplied to
A2-FIC15816 between 10% and 100% of the maximum range of the
reducing gas flow meter, 51.3 Nm
3
/H and 513.0 Nm
3
/H, respectively.
The normal sample point for hydrogen analyzer A2-AE15858 is the
treated gas leaving the overhead of the TGCU Contactor,
A2-DA1561, because this stream is the "cleanest" due to the H
2
S
removal accomplished in the tower. During startup of the TGCU,
however, there is no process gas flowing through the TGCU
Contactor until after operation of the TGCU Reactor has been "lined
out" and the process gas flow is directed into the TGCU Quench
Column and the TGCU Contactor. Until then, there is no gas flowing
in the TGCU Contactor overhead line, so an alternate sample point is
provided on the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer,
A2-EA1561, to allow the analyzer to sample the gas leaving the
TGCU Reactor.
The 4-way selector valve, A2-HV15858, provided with the analyzer
allows the operators to switch between the two sample points. LP
purge gas is also connected to this valve, so that when one sample
point is supplying process gas to the analyzer, the other sample point
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-20
is being back-purged with inert gas. This minimizes the possibility of
having one of the sample points plug when it is not in use.
The process gas that is being sampled is saturated with water, so the
data sheet for the analyzer system specifies that the sample
conditioning system includes a dryer. For the sample point on the
outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, there is also the
possibility of elemental sulfur vapor being present in the gas during
process upsets. To prevent sulfur from reaching the analyzer and
damaging it, a "sacrificial sample loop" consisting of a coil of bare
tubing is provided in this sample line. The tubing coils provide heat
transfer surface, so that if sulfur does find its way to this point in the
process, the gas will cool off enough for the sulfur to solidify,
plugging the sample loop and stopping the flow of process gas to the
analyzer before the sulfur can damage the analyzer. Should this
occur, only the coiled tubing will need to be replaced, rather than the
expensive analyzer. Note that the sample lines are to free-drain from
the analyzer back to the sample points, so the tubing coils should be
oriented in the horizontal so that the coils due not cause a "pocket" in
the sample line for this sample point.
11.5.1.3 Controls for Startup and Shutdown
The front-end of the TGCU is also equipped with three sets of
controls for use during startup and shutdown:
a. Prior to introducing SRU tailgas into the TGCU, the equipment
in the front-end of the unit must be brought up to operating
temperature. This is accomplished by using the TGCU Startup
Blower, A2-GB1560, to re-circulate gas from the outlet of the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer to the inlet of the TGCU Reactor
Feed Heater (via the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve,
A2-NV15800). This allows using the TGCU Reactor Feed
Heater to heat the gas and thereby bring all the equipment up
to operating temperature.
Flow controller A2-FIC15808 is provided to allow filling the
front-end with nitrogen prior to establishing the re-circulation
flow during startup. This same control can also be used to add
nitrogen during shutdown of the unit for cool-down purposes.
b. Prior to the initial startup of the unit, the catalyst in the TGCU
Reactor must be pre-sulfided so that it retains its activity when it
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-21
is exposed to hydrogen at elevated temperatures. The catalyst
will also have to be pre-sulfided when fresh catalyst is added to
the reactor following a catalyst change-out. A source of H
2
S is
needed for pre-sulfiding the catalyst, for which a slipstream of
amine acid gas from the ARU serves nicely. Flow controller
A2-FIC15824 is provided to allow adding a small amount of acid
gas to give an H
2
S concentration of 1-2% in the nitrogen
circulating through the front-end of the unit during catalyst
pre-sulfiding activities.
c. After the TGCU has been operating for a period of time, the
catalyst becomes pyrophoric due to the presence of iron sulfide,
FeS. Exposing catalyst containing pyrophoric FeS to air may
result in uncontrolled burning of the FeS to form H
2
S and/or
SO
2
, which obviously will prevent the entrance of personnel into
the vessel. When the TGCU is to be shut down to replace the
catalyst, or for other maintenance activities that will allow
oxygen to enter the reactor, it is necessary to perform a
controlled oxidation ("passivation") of the FeS in the catalyst by
operating at low temperature (~150C [~300F]) and controlling
a small concentration (1-2%) of oxygen in the circulating gas.
This converts the FeS into non-pyrophoric iron oxide, Fe
2
O
3
,
while leaving the catalyst in its sulfided state. Flow controller
A2-FIC15805 is provided to allow adding a small amount of
utility air to the nitrogen circulating through the front-end of the
unit to provide the oxygen for catalyst passivation.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-22
TGCU Reactor Feed Control Loops
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-23
11.5.2 Hydrogen and Hydrogen Sulfide Analyzer,
A2-AE15858/A2-AE15859
Analyzer A2-AE15858/A2-AE15859 has two separate sensors, one for
measuring hydrogen concentration and one for measuring hydrogen
sulfide concentration. The H
2
S sensor is a photometric sensor that is very
similar to the one used in the SRU air demand analyzers. It uses the
absorption of a specific wavelength of UV light to determine the H
2
S
concentration in the process gas.
The H
2
sensor in this analyzer is actually a thermal conductivity sensor.
Hydrogen has a much higher thermal conductivity than the other gases
found in the process stream, so the thermal conductivity of the process
gas is a good indication of the hydrogen concentration. To make the
sensor reading as accurate as possible, it is necessary to "zero" and
"span" the sensor with special calibration gas mixtures that have the same
"background" thermal conductivity as the expected process gas. Although
this technique works well, always remember that this sensor does not
measure hydrogen concentration directly, so its reading (particularly at low
hydrogen concentrations) may not always be accurate.
The H
2
/H
2
S analyzer can sample the process gas from two different
locations, depending on the position of the selector valve inside the
analyzer enclosure. The first sample connection is on the outlet of the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer. It should be used only during startup,
pre-sulfiding, and other special operations when the process gas is
bypassing the quench and contacting sections. This connection has a
"sacrificial" sample line, which is essentially a disposable sample cooling
coil. It is intended to protect the analyzer by cooling, condensing, and
freezing any sulfur vapor that may be present in the sample due to
process upsets. If this occurs, the cooling coil will plug before the sulfur
can reach the analyzer, sacrificing the inexpensive tubing to protect the
expensive analyzer.
The second sample point is on the overhead line from the TGCU
Contactor, and is the normal sampling point. During startup of the TGCU,
the hydrogen analyzer should be switched to this sample point as soon as
the Quench Column hand control in the DCS is used to open the Quench
Column Inlet Valve and close Quench Column Bypass Valve to send gas
through the TGCU Quench Column and the TGCU Contactor. There is
much less chance of damaging the analyzer with contaminants when
sampling gas at this point, so it is the preferred sample connection.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-24
Liquid water will destroy the H
2
sensing element in this analyzer.
Although the sample conditioning system includes a dryer to remove
water vapor from the sample gas, liquid water can get through the dryer
and damage the analyzer. Since water tends to condense from the
process gas and accumulate in stagnant areas, make sure there is no
liquid in the sample line before switching from one sample point to
another.
11.5.3 Boiler Low-Low Level S/D Transmitter Testing
The TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer has three independent level
transmitters connected to the PLC that activate the TGCU ESD system
before the water level can get low enough to cause tube damage. The
shutdown is activated when two out of three transmitters show a low-low
level. These transmitters should be tested periodically to determine that
they are functioning properly. Since 2oo3 voting is used for the low-low
level shutdowns in the TGCU ESD, the level transmitters can be tested
one at a time without having to bypass the ESD system.
Consider A2-LT15845A on the Waste Heat Reclaimer, for example. The
procedure for testing A2-LT15845B and A2-LT15845C will be similar. The
procedure for testing A2-LT15845A is as follows:
(1) The outside operator notifies the DCS operator that he is
preparing to test shutdown level transmitter "A" on the Waste
Heat Reclaimer.
(2) The DCS operator confirms that A2-LI15845B and
A2-LI15845C are both indicating adequate level in the boiler,
then notifies the outside operator to proceed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-25
DO NOT PROCEED UNLESS THE OTHER TWO LEVEL
INDICATORS SHOW ADEQUATE LEVEL IN THE BOILER.
OTHERWISE THE LOW-LOW LEVEL SHUTDOWN IN THE TGCU
ESD WILL BE ACTIVATED AS SOON AS THE OUTSIDE
OPERATOR BEGINS DRAINING THE LEVEL TRANSMITTER IN
THE NEXT STEP.
(3) After being notified to proceed by the DCS operator, the outside
operator blocks-in A2-LT15845A by closing its block valves,
then opens the drain valve on the bottom of the transmitter to
drain the water from the instrument.
(4) If the transmitter is operating properly, the DCS will alarm that
there is a low level in the Waste Heat Reclaimer on
A2-LI15845A. The DCS operator acknowledges the alarm on
the DCS and reports it to the outside operator.
(5) After being notified of the alarm, the outside operator closes the
drain valve on A2-LT15845A, slowly opens its bottom block
valve to allow the transmitter to fill with water then opens its top
block valve. This should clear the low level alarm on
A2-LI15845A in the DCS.
(6) After confirming that the low level alarm has cleared, the other
level transmitters can be tested in a similar fashion.
NOTE: The DCS operator must not begin another task until confirming
that the low level alarm has cleared. This is to guard against
having a level transmitter malfunction that causes a TGCU ESD
when the other transmitters are tested.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-26
11.5.4 Tailgas Switching Valve Controls
The tailgas switching valves and their controls for the Train 1 and Train 2
SRUs are depicted on the P&ID, dwg. no. 507000-7100-34, while the logic
flowcharts, show the logic for these controls for the Train 1 SRU.
However, it may be helpful to explain why the controls are implemented in
this manner. The discussion that follows will describe how these controls
allow routing the Train 1 SRU and Train 2 SRU tailgas streams to the
Thermal Oxidizer and the TGCU under different operating scenarios, and
will explain how the controls depicted on the P&ID correspond to the
different sections of the logic diagrams.
11.5.4.1 Repositioning the Tailgas Valves Following a TGCU ESD
As shown on the P&ID, prior to restarting the TGCU following a
TGCU ESD, the SRU tailgas valves to the TGCU (A2-HV15462 and
A2-HV15662) must be closed to satisfy the permissives for the
TGCU ESD system reset. However, before these valves can be
closed, the tailgas valves to the TTO (A2-HV15457 and
A2-HV15657) must be opened first to avoid blocking the tailgas flow
and causing the SRUs to shut down on high-high pressure. If the
valves are not opened and closed in the proper order, the SRUs
could inadvertently be shut down while preparing to restart the
TGCU.
For this reason, the TGCU ESD is an input to the PLC interlock
blocks that manipulate the controllers (A2-HIC15457, A2-HIC15462,
A2-HIC15657, and A2-HIC15662) for these valves. The PLCs and
DCS automatically reposition the valves following a TGCU ESD to
divert the SRU tailgas to the TTO, meaning that the valves are
already positioned properly for the subsequent restart of the TGCU.
The logic that accomplishes this for the Train 1 SRU is depicted on
the logic flow diagram. When the TGCU ESD is activated, the
Train 1 SRU PLC directs the DCS to set the output from
A2-HIC15457 to 100% to open A2-HV15457, proves the valve open,
then directs the DCS to set the output from A2-HIC15462 to 0% to
close A2-HV15462 and proves the valve closed. This diverts the
Train 1 SRU tailgas directly to the TTO. (The PLC logic will not take
these actions if the Train 1 SRU has its startup/run selector switch,
A2-HS15314, set to "STARTUP", since both tailgas valves will already
be closed by the startup logic for the Train 1 SRU)
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-27
Note that this same logic is also used to open the tailgas valve to the
TTO and close the tailgas valve to the TGCU if the TGCU startup/run
selector switch (A2-HS15830) is set to "STARTUP". This safeguard is
to prevent sending SRU tailgas into the TGCU before the TGCU
Reactor is ready, as this could cause a severe upset in the TGCU
Quench Column and/or TGCU Contactor (and possibly damage the
piping, equipment, quench water, and/or solvent).
11.5.4.2 Introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Scenario 1
The first scenario to consider for introducing tailgas into the TGCU is
a normal startup of the SRUs and the TGCU. Before being routed to
the TGCU, the tailgas from both SRUs is sent to the TTO via valves
A2-HV15457 and A2-HV15657, while the TGCU uses the TGCU
Startup Blower to re-circulate gas to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
via the TGCU warmup/bypass valve, A2-NV15800. Once the TGCU
is warmed up and ready to accept tailgas, the Train 1 and Train 2
SRUs can be routed to the TGCU as follows (using the Train 1 SRU
for this example).
1. The operator toggles the "fast" transfer switch, A2-HS15463 in
the DCS, to "TRANSFER TO TGCU".
2. The PLC directs the DCS to set the output from A2-HIC15462 to
100% to open the Tailgas Valve to the TGCU, A2-HV15462, then
proves that the valve is open.
3. Since the Tailgas Valve to the TTO, A2-HV15457, is still open,
the SRU tailgas will continue flowing to the TTO at this time (the
path of least resistance).
4. Once the limit switches prove A2-HV15462 is open, the PLC
directs the DCS to set the output from A2-HIC15457 to 0% to
close A2-HV15457, then proves that the valve is closed.
5. Since A2-NV15800 is open at this time, some of the SRU tailgas
may still flow through this valve directly to the TTO. The TGCU
Startup Blower will pull the rest of the tailgas into the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater.
6. If the second SRU (Train 2 in this example) is also ready to send
its tailgas to the TGCU, the operator can also toggle its "fast"
transfer switch in the DCS (A2-HS15663) to repeat these actions
for the second SRU.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-28
7. Once one or both of the tailgas valves to the TGCU is open and
the corresponding tailgas valve(s) to the TTO are closed, the
operator can use A2-HIC15800 in the DCS to close
A2-NV15800.
8. This will force all of the SRU tailgas to flow to the TGCU Reactor
Feed Heater.
9. Once A2-NV15800 is fully closed, all of the SRU tailgas must
flow to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater because there are no
longer any other open paths to the TTO. The TGCU Startup
Blower can now be shut down by toggling A2-HPB15855 in the
DCS to "STOP" to open the blower bypass valve, turn off the
blower, and close the blower suction and discharge valves.
10. All of the SRU tailgas will now be flowing through the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater, TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer, TGCU
Reactor, and TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, then flowing to the
TTO via the TGCU Quench Column bypass valve, A2-HV15851,
at the TGCU Startup Blower. Once the plant stabilizes and there
is excess hydrogen in the reactor outlet, the TGCU Quench
Column inlet valve, A2-HV15850, can be opened and
A2-HV15851 closed using A2-HIC15850 in the DCS to send the
process gas into the TGCU Quench Column and TGCU
Contactor.
For this scenario, the opening and closing of A2-HV15462 and
A2-HV15457, respectively, (or A2-HV15662 and A2-HV15657 for
Train 2) in Steps 2 and 3 can occur rapidly with no impact on either
the SRU or the TGCU. This is because A2-NV15800 will still be
open at this time, so there will be very little differential pressure
across A2-HV15462 (A2-HV15662) and there will not be an abrupt
change in pressure when A2-HV15462 (A2-HV15662) is opened or
when A2-HV15457 (A2-HV15657) is closed.
Note that A2-HS15463 and A2-HS15663 can also be used to take
the Train 1 SRU and/or Train 2 SRU tailgas out of the TGCU. Every
other toggle of these selector switches will take the opposite action to
open the tailgas valve to the TTO and then close the tailgas valve to
the TGCU. For instance, if a problem develops while introducing the
tailgas into the TGCU, toggling A2-HS15463 and A2-HS15663 to
"TRANSFER TO TTO" will immediately divert the SRU tailgas to the TTO
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-29
and block it from flowing into the TGCU. Once the problem has been
corrected, A2-HS15463 and A2-HS15663 can be toggled once again
to "TRANSFER TO TGCU" to send the SRU tailgas into the TGCU.
11.5.4.3 Introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Scenario 2
The second startup scenario to consider is when the TGCU is
already processing tailgas from one SRU, and the tailgas from the
second SRU needs to be introduced into the TGCU. Assume that
the Train 2 SRU is currently feeding the TGCU. Due to the
back-pressure from the TGCU, the pressure downstream of
A2-HV15462 will be about 0.07 kg/cm
2
(g), while the pressure
upstream of this valve will be close to 0 kg/cm
2
(g) (since
A2-HV15457 will be open to the TTO at this time). If the Train 1
tailgas was quickly switched into the TGCU in the same manner as
described above for the first scenario, a major upset would result in
both SRUs and in the TGCU:
(1) As soon as A2-HV15462 started to open, tailgas from the
Train 2 SRU would begin to back-flow through A2-HV15462
and flow to the TTO, since the pressure downstream of
A2-HV15462 at that moment would be higher than the pressure
upstream of A2-HV15462. Since A2-HV15462 is a more direct
path to the TTO for the tailgas from the Train 2 SRU, most of
the Train 2 tailgas would flow through A2-HV15462 as it opens
rather than flow through the TGCU.
The outlet temperature from the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
would begin to rise (due to the drop in tailgas flow), causing the
controls to begin reducing the steam flow rate to the heater.
Once A2-HV15462 was fully open, all of the Train 1 tailgas and
most of the Train 2 tailgas would be flowing directly to the TTO
through A2-HV15457. The TGCU controls would continue
reducing the steam flow rate to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
to try to keep its outlet temperature under control.
(2) With A2-HV15462 fully open, A2-HV15457 would begin to
close. This would begin forcing all of the Train 1 tailgas and
Train 2 tailgas into the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater.
The outlet temperature from the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
would begin to drop, causing the controls to begin increasing
the steam flow rate to the heater. Once A2-HV15457 was fully
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-30
closed, all of the Train 1 and Train 2 tailgas would be flowing to
the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, causing an abrupt increase in
its operating pressure from about 0.07 kg/cm
2
(g) to about
0.25 kg/cm
2
(g). This would cause the air and acid gas flow
rates to the SRUs to suddenly drop, possibly causing the SRUs
to flame-out. If so, the SRUs and the TGCU would shut down
and the operators would have to start over again.
(3) If the SRUs and TGCU did manage to stay on-line, the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater would be supplying less than half as
much heating as needed until the controls recover and bring the
steam flow rate up to the new requirements.
Until then, the inlet temperature to the TGCU Reactor would be
low, possibly causing incomplete conversion of SO
2
in the
reactor and allowing SO
2
to reach the quench water and solvent
systems and foul them. The reducing gas flow rate might also
require time to adjust to the higher tailgas flow rate, further
compounding the problems with conversion in the reactor.
So, the best that could be expected if the second SRU is routed to
the TGCU in the same manner as under the first scenario is an upset
in both SRUs, the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, the TGCU Reactor,
the quench water system, and the solvent system. Depending on
how quickly the SRUs respond to sudden changes in operating
pressure, the SRU burners might flame-out. In this worst case, a
complete restart of the SRUs and the TGCU would then be required.
Instead of introducing the tailgas from the second SRU into the
TGCU in an abrupt manner, what is needed is a slow, controlled
redirection of the tailgas from the TTO to the TGCU. This can be
accomplished by the DCS operator using A2-HIC15457 and
A2-HIC15462:
1. Under this scenario, the TGCU is already processing tailgas
from the Train 2 SRU. This means that the TGCU
warmup/bypass valve, A2-NV15800, is already closed. This
signals the PLC to disable the "fast" transfer switches in the
DCS, A2-HS15463 and A2-HS15663 so that the rapid switching
sequence (scenario 1) cannot be activated inadvertently.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-31
2. The DCS operator initiates the over-ride for the Train 1 tailgas
valves by toggling the "slow" transfer switch, A2-HS15464 in the
DCS, to "OVER-RIDE".
The PLC temporarily removes the limit switches on
A2-HV15457 and A2-HV15462 from the "complete flowpath
interlock" for the Train 1 SRU alarms and deactivates the "valve
malfunction" alarms on these two valves, then directs the DCS
to release control of A2-HIC15457 and A2-HIC15462 to the
operator.
3. The operator uses A2-HIC15457 to slowly begin throttling the
tailgas flow with A2-HV15457, so that the pressure at the
front-end of Train 1 is slightly higher than at the front-end of the
Train 2 SRU. The DCS operator can monitor the flows and
pressure in the Train 1 SRU and adjust A2-HIC15457
accordingly.
4. Once A2-HV15457 is throttling, the operator uses A2-HIC15462
to slowly open A2-HV15462. Some of the Train 1 tailgas may
begin to flow into the TGCU at this time, but most of it will still
flow through A2-HV15457 directly to the TTO. The DCS
operator can monitor the flows and pressures in the Train 1
SRU and the TGCU, and adjust the rate at which A2-HV15462
is opened accordingly.
5. Once A2-HV15462 is fully open, the operator uses
A2-HIC15457 to slowly close A2-HV15457 the rest of the way
and send all of the Train 1 tailgas to the TGCU. The DCS
operator can monitor the flow rates and temperatures in the
TGCU, and adjust the rate at which A2-HV15457 is closed as
needed to allow time for the controls in the TGCU to respond.
6. Once A2-HV15457 is fully closed, the Train 1 SRU is flowing to
the TGCU along with the Train 2 SRU, and the TGCU is fully
on-line.
When A2-HV15462 is fully open and A2-HV15457 is fully
closed, the PLC will automatically restore the limit switches on
A2-HV15457 and A2-HV15462 to the "complete flowpath
interlock" in the SRU alarms, restore the malfunction alarms for
these valves to their normal configurations, and reset the "slow"
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-32
transfer switch, A2-HS15464 in the DCS, back to "NORMAL" to
remove the over-ride.
One further point to note is that the "slow" transfer over-ride
switches can also be used to "back" tailgas out of the TGCU. If
the operator wants to shut down the TGCU in a controlled
fashion, this can be accomplished by using the TGCU Startup
Blower to circulate gas through the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
while slowly "backing" the SRU tailgas out of the TGCU. The
steps to perform this are essentially the same as those listed
above (but in reverse order).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-33
11.5.5 TGCU Shutdown System
The purpose of the Tailgas Cleanup Unit Emergency Shutdown system
(TGCU ESD) is to shut off the flow of tailgas, reducing gas, pre-sulfiding
gas, nitrogen, and passivation air to the TGCU when serious problems
occur. The Cause and Effect Diagram, contained in the Instrumentation
and Controls Diagrams section of the Basic Engineering Package,
describes the TGCU ESD system in block format. For reference, the
causes and effects of the ESD system shown on this diagram are
explained below.
As noted on the Cause and Effect Diagram, it is recommended that a
5 second delay be used for most of the process parameters included in
the causes of the ESD system. This is to prevent the "nuisance"
shutdowns that are sometimes caused by momentary fluctuations in the
process or the sensing elements.
11.5.5.1 Causes
Any one of the causes listed below will activate the TGCU ESD
system:
a. Manual Shutdown Switch, A2-HS15827
An operator can activate the TGCU ESD system using the
NORMAL / ESD selector switch in the DCS.
b. Both SRU ESD Systems
For normal modes of operation, the TGCU ESD system is
activated when both SRU ESD systems are activated. Without
any SRU tailgas flowing through the front-end of the TGCU,
there is nothing to process in the unit, so the TGCU is shut
down whenever both sulfur plants shut down. (Note, however,
that the TGCU ESD is not activated if one of the SRUs is still
on-line when the other SRU shuts down.)
However, if the TGCU is not yet fully processing tailgas from
either SRU, there is no reason to shut it down if no SRUs are
running. This simplifies startup of the TGCU by allowing its
ESD system to be independent of the SRU ESD systems until
tailgas is introduced into the TGCU. The example logic below
shows this concept:
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-34
c. Complete Flowpath Interlock (see Logic Flow Diagrams for the
limit switch tag numbers)
In order for the TGCU to operate without over-pressuring itself
or the Sulfur Drain Seal Assemblies in the upstream SRUs,
there must be a complete flowpath for SRU tailgas through the
TGCU to the TTO. The ESD logic can determine whether such
a complete flowpath exists by examining the status of the limit
switches on the process gas valves. There are basically three
different paths that the SRU tailgas can take to reach the TTO:
(1) The TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve, A2-NV15800, and the
TGCU Outlet Valve, A2-HV15801, are both fully open.
(2) The process gas is diverted to the TTO upstream of the
TGCU Quench Column:
(a) The TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve,
A2-HV15851, is fully open;
(b) Either the TGCU Startup Blower Bypass Valve,
A2-HV15853, is fully open, or both the TGCU Startup
Blower Suction Valve, A2-HV15852, and the TGCU
Startup Blower Discharge Valve, A2-HV15854, are
fully open; and
(c) The TGCU Outlet Valve is fully open.
(3) The process gas is flowing through the TGCU Quench
Column and the TGCU Contactor to the TTO:
(a) The TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve,
A2-HV15850, is fully open; and
(b) The TGCU Outlet Valve is fully open.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-35
If the "open" limit switches do not indicate that at least one of
these flowpaths is valid, the "complete flowpath interlock" is
tripped and the TGCU ESD system is activated. Note that the
TGCU Complete Flowpath Interlock signal to the Complete
Flowpath Interlock logic for the Train 1 SRU and the Train 2
SRU is over-ridden for 60 seconds when this occurs, allowing
time for the SRU tailgas valves to be repositioned (see
Section 11.5.4.1) and preventing nuisance alarms in the SRUs.
d. TGCU Reactor Outlet High-High Temperature,
A2-TT15842A/B/C
These devices shut down the TGCU if the reactor outlet
temperature reaches 400C. The most common cause of high
reactor outlet temperature is large concentrations of SO
2
in the
SRU tailgas streams due to poor sulfur plant performance,
leading to excessive heat of reaction in the catalyst bed. These
devices will prevent excessive temperatures in the reactor from
causing damage to the reactor vessel, its catalyst, or its catalyst
bed support. Note that there are three independent transmitters
and 2oo3 voting logic is used for the ESD (i.e., at least two
transmitters must show high-high temperature) to avoid
spurious "trips" due to the malfunction of a single transmitter.
e. TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer Low-Low Water Level,
A2-LT15845A/B/C
These devices activate the TGCU ESD system to prevent
having the water level drop below the top of the tubes in this
boiler while hot gas is flowing through the tubes, thereby
averting high effluent temperatures and higher than normal tube
wall temperatures. High effluent temperatures could cause high
overhead temperature from the TGCU Quench Column and
result in poor H
2
S removal in the TGCU Contactor, and high
tube wall temperatures could possibly damage the tubes due to
differential expansion. These devices are set to actuate if the
level falls to within 75 mm of the top of the tubes. Note that
there are three independent transmitters and 2oo3 voting logic
is used for the ESD.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-36
11.5.5.2 Effects
A TGCU shutdown, activated either manually or automatically, has
the following effects on the TGCU:
a. Opens the Train 1 SRU Tailgas Valve to the TTO, A2-HV15457,
proves it open, then closes the Train 1 SRU Tailgas Valve to
the TGCU, A2-HV15462, and proves it closed.
b. Opens the Train 2 SRU Tailgas Valve to the TTO, A2-HV15657,
proves it open, then closes the Train 2 SRU Tailgas Valve to
the TGCU, A2-HV15662, and proves it closed.
c. Disables the "fast" and "slow" tailgas transfer switches for the
Train 1 SRU (A2-HS15463 and A2-HS15464, respectively) and
for the Train 2 SRU (A2-HS15663 and A2-HS15664,
respectively).
d. Shuts off and depressurizes the nitrogen and plant air supplies
by closing block valves A2-NV15809 and A2-NV15811 and
opening vent valve A2-NV15810.
e. Shuts off and depressurizes the reducing gas supply by closing
block valves A2-NV15817 and A2-NV15819 and opening vent
valve A2-NV15818.
f. Closes the reducing gas flow control valve, A2-FV15816, by
placing A2-FIC15816 in "manual" and setting its output to 0%.
g. Shuts off the pre-sulfiding gas flow by closing block valve
A2-NV15825.
h. Closes the TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve, A2-HV15850,
and the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve, A2-HV15851, to
stop the flow of SRU tailgas into the TGCU.
i. Forces the output of A2-HIC15850 in the DCS (which controls
the TGCU Quench Column inlet and bypass valves) to 0% in
preparation for the subsequent restart.
j. Shuts down the TGCU Startup Blower, A2-GB1560; closes its
suction valve (A2-HV15852), its discharge valve (A2-HV15854),
and the nitrogen purge valve for the blower seal (A2-HV15856);
and opens its bypass valve (A2-HV15853) and the nitrogen
purge valve for the blower casing, (A2-HV15857).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-37
k. Resets DCS toggle switches A2-HS15817, A2-HS15825, and
A2-HS15809 to "OFF" and A2-HPB15855 to "STOP".
11.5.5.3 Non-ESD Shutdowns
In addition to the devices listed in Section 11.5.5.1 that activate the
TGCU ESD system, there are several interlocks of significance that
either generate an alarm or shut down an individual piece of
equipment. These devices/interlocks and their effects are described
in this section.
a. TGCU Quench Column Low-Low Level, A2-LT15867A/B/C
The TGCU Quench Water Pump (A2-GA1560A/B) could be
damaged if the pump loses suction because the level in the
TGCU Quench Column drops too low. These devices will
protect the pump by stopping it before this can occur. The
shutdown setpoint is 450 mm above the bottom seam of the
column. Note that there are three independent transmitters and
2oo3 voting logic is used for the S/D (i.e., at least two
transmitters must show low-low level) to avoid spurious "trips"
due to the malfunction of a single transmitter.
b. TGCU Quench Water Cooler Fan High Vibration,
A2-WSH15879
Each fan on the TGCU Quench Water Cooler (A2-EC1560) is
provided with its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed
by the switch exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to
stop the associated fan and activate an alarm in the DCS. The
fan will not restart until the vibration switch is reset by an
operator.
c. TGCU Contactor Low-Low Level, A2-LT15895A/B/C
The TGCU Rich Solvent Pump (A2-GA1561A/B) could be
damaged if the pump loses suction because the level in the
TGCU Contactor drops too low. These devices will protect the
pump by stopping it before this can occur. The shutdown
setpoint is 450 mm above the bottom seam of the column.
Note that there are three independent transmitters and 2oo3
voting logic is used for the S/D.
d. TGCU Lean Solvent Cooler Fan High Vibration, A2-WSH15902
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-38
Each fan on the TGCU Lean Solvent Cooler (A2-EC1561) is
provided with its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed
by the switch exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to
stop the associated fan and activate an alarm in the DCS. The
fan will not restart until the vibration switch is reset by an
operator.
e. TGCU Stripper Low-Low Level, A2-LT15932A/B/C
The TGCU Lean Solvent Pump (A2-GA1562A/B) could be
damaged if the pump loses suction because the level in the
TGCU Stripper drops too low. These devices will protect the
pump by stopping it before this can occur. The shutdown
setpoint is 450 mm above the bottom seam of the column.
Note that there are three independent transmitters and 2oo3
voting logic is used for the S/D.
f. TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser Fan High Vibration,
A2-WSH15942
Each fan on the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser (A2-EC1562)
is provided with its own vibration switch. If the vibration sensed
by the switch exceeds the preset level, the switch will trip to
stop the associated fan and activate an alarm in the DCS. The
fan will not restart until the vibration switch is reset by an
operator.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-39
11.6 Process Principles and Operating Techniques
The more important considerations involved in startup, operation, shutdown,
maintenance, and emergency procedures for the TGCU are discussed in the
remaining sections of this portion of the operating guidelines. The operator
should also be thoroughly acquainted with the equipment and the "Process
Description" section in these guidelines before attempting to operate the plant
in accordance with the operating techniques that follow. If the function of
each portion of the plant equipment is understood, the sequence of steps
outlined in the "procedures" sections will be more easily understood. In
addition, the following general discussion of principles and techniques will
clarify the reasons for some of the procedures.
11.6.1 Equipment Damage
After the initial startup, the front-end of the TGCU may contain some
sulfur, including the catalyst bed in the TGCU Reactor. Sulfur fires will
ignite at temperatures as low as 150C if sufficient oxygen is available. In
addition, TGCU catalyst is pyrophoric at ambient temperatures when in its
sulfided state (which is its normal operating condition). For these reasons,
it is very important to minimize the time periods when air (or other gases
containing oxygen) is routed through the catalyst bed. Localized high
temperatures can exist in the catalyst bed even though the temperatures
measured around the reactor are low. Because of this, sulfur and/or
catalyst ignition sometimes occurs in a catalyst bed when it is not
anticipated by temperatures that are readily available for observation.
Under ordinary circumstances, oxygen-bearing gases will only be flowing
through the reactor when passivating its catalyst. When passivating the
catalyst in the reactor, observe the reactor temperatures frequently. If the
temperatures begin to increase above 150C, reduce the amount of air
entering the reactor to limit the passivation so that the reactor
temperatures remain below 150C. This will prevent the catalyst from
reacting with oxygen so that pre-sulfiding is not required during the
subsequent startup.
Do not use water to quickly cool the TGCU Reactor after a fire. Not only
will this damage the catalyst, the rapid cooling may cause structural
damage to the TGCU Reactor. The acidic water that forms may cause
corrosion damage to the TGCU Reactor or other equipment. Nitrogen is
available to the TGCU for use in cooling a hot catalyst bed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-40
NEVER "HYDROBLAST" THE TUBES (OR ANY OTHER STEEL
SURFACES) IN THE TGCU EQUIPMENT. NOT ONLY DOES THIS
REMOVE THE PROTECTIVE SULFIDE FILM THAT FORMS ON
CARBON STEEL AND PREVENTS CORROSION, THE WATER WILL
REACT WITH THE SULFUR COMPOUNDS PRESENT IN THE
EQUIPMENT TO FORM A VARIETY OF ACIDS (SULFUROUS,
POLYTHIONIC, ETC.) THAT RAPIDLY CORRODE THE STEEL.
THERE HAVE BEEN NUMEROUS INSTANCES OF SULFUR PLANT
BOILERS BEING BLASTED DURING A TURNAROUND TO CLEAN
THEM UP, THEN HAVING THE TUBES BEGIN LEAKING AS SOON
AS THE BOILER IS RETURNED TO SERVICE.
IF THE TGCU WASTE HEAT RECLAIMER TUBES HAVE BECOME
PLUGGED, THE BEST WAY TO CLEAR THE TUBES IS TO
MECHANICALLY "ROD" THEM. IF SULFUR OR SULFUR
COMPOUNDS HAVE PLUGGED THE TUBES, IT IS OFTEN
HELPFUL TO APPLY HEAT TO THE TUBES BEFORE "RODDING",
AS THIS WILL MELT ANY SULFUR THAT MAY BE PART OF WHAT
HAS PLUGGED THE TUBES. ONE WAY TO DO THIS IS TO DRAIN
THE WATER FROM THE BOILER AND PUT STEAM ON THE
SHELL. DRAIN THE CONDENSATE PERIODICALLY TO KEEP LIVE
STEAM ON THE TUBES.
11.6.2 Catalyst Fouling
The catalyst bed in the TGCU Reactor may be severely fouled by
carry-over of heavy hydrocarbon liquids or vapors. This will cause
permanent damage to the catalyst and is to be avoided if possible, even if
shutting down the TGCU for periods is required. The most common
source of heavy hydrocarbons in TGCUs is contaminants in the reducing
gas stream. The pressure drop across the TGCU Reactor should be
monitored regularly to help detect this problem before the pressure drop
becomes so high that a plant shutdown is required to remove the fouled
catalyst.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-41
11.6.3 TGCU Reactor Operation
The purpose of the TGCU Reactor is to convert all of the sulfur
compounds in the tailgas from both SRUs into hydrogen sulfide. This is
accomplished by catalytic hydrogenation of the sulfur dioxide and sulfur
vapor, and hydrolysis of the organic sulfur compounds:
(1) SO
2
+ 3 H
2
H
2
S + 2 H
2
O
(2) S + H
2
H
2
S
(3) COS + H
2
O H
2
S + CO
2
(4) CS
2
+ 2 H
2
O 2 H
2
S + CO
2
The catalyst also promotes the classic "water gas shift" reaction:
(5) CO + H
2
O H
2
+ CO
2
This effectively converts carbon monoxide in the tailgas gas into hydrogen
for use in reactions (1) and (2) above. This is an equilibrium reaction, so it
is typical for a small amount of CO to leave a reactor, depending on the
amount of hydrogen and carbon dioxide in the reactor outlet. The CO
concentration in the reactor outlet is usually less than 100 PPM, but may
be higher if the CO
2
content of the feed gas is high or if the catalyst has
lost activity.
NOTE: A small portion of the COS and CS
2
may either not react at all,
or be reduced by the hydrogen to form methane and/or methyl
mercaptan:
(6) COS + 4 H
2
CH
4
+ H
2
S + H
2
O
(7) CS
2
+ 4 H
2
CH
4
+ 2 H
2
S
(8) COS + 3 H
2
CH
3
SH + H
2
O
(9) CS
2
+ 3 H
2
CH
3
SH + H
2
S
These reactions should produce only a few PPM of methane
and/or mercaptan unless there is a large amount of COS/CS
2
in
the SRU tailgas, or the TGCU catalyst has lost activity. Since
the TGCU amine will not remove mercaptans from the gas, any
mercaptans formed will escape to the Thermal Oxidizer and
cause increased SO
2
emissions. Methane in the reactor
effluent may result in increased CO emissions from the Thermal
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-42
Oxidizer (due to partial oxidation), depending on the operating
conditions in the Thermal Oxidizer. To avoid these problems,
the amount of COS/CS
2
entering the TGCU should be
maintained as low as possible by proper operation of the
upstream SRUs (and amine and sour water stripping units).
All of these reactions are exothermic, causing the temperature of the gas
to rise as it flows through the reactor. The hydrogenation of the SO
2
into
H
2
S is the predominant factor in the temperature rise, so the temperature
rise across the TGCU Reactor is usually a direct indication of the amount
of SO
2
entering the TGCU from the SRUs. If the temperature rise is
higher than normal (about 50-60C at design conditions), this is usually a
sign that the upstream sulfur plant(s) is off-ratio. The resulting high outlet
temperature from the TGCU Reactor cannot be corrected in the TGCU.
Rather, the problem must be corrected in the SRUs, or the upstream units
feeding the SRUs.
Regardless of the amount of SO
2
, sulfur vapor, and organic sulfur entering
the TGCU Reactor, all of it must be converted to H
2
S for proper operation
of the downstream equipment. This can be achieved (assuming normal
catalyst activity) by maintaining an adequate excess of hydrogen in the
TGCU Reactor outlet, so that all of the reactions go to completion. The
hydrogen concentration is normally measured in the treated gas leaving
the TGCU Contactor. Although the design material balance calls for a
hydrogen concentration of about 3% at this point, a concentration in the
range of 1-2% is normally adequate. However, controlling the
concentration at 3% or higher allows a much larger margin for tolerating
upsets in the upstream SRUs, and is generally preferred.
Unlike other TGCUs which use in-line burners to generate reducing gas
(because external hydrogen is not available), this TGCU receives
reducing gas from a hydrogen purification unit. However, poor ratio control
in either SRU can still lead to an excessively high outlet temperature from
the TGCU Reactor. If, for instance, an SRU is operating with excess air,
the H
2
S:SO
2
ratio will be low in the SRU tailgas (registered as high air
demand) and the SO
2
concentration will be high in the TGCU Reactor
feed. This will cause a large temperature rise in the reactor. Left
unchecked, the temperatures in the TGCU Reactor could rise to the point
of damaging the catalyst, the catalyst bed support, and/or the reactor
vessel itself. The thermocouples in the catalyst bed and in the outlet line
have alarms to provide an early warning of this condition. If the
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-43
temperature reaches 400C in the outlet line, the TGCU ESD system will
be activated to shut down the TGCU and divert the SRU tailgas to the
Thermal Oxidizer, before damaging the TGCU Reactor or its catalyst.
Be aware, however, that the "thermal mass" of the TGCU Reactor and its
catalyst bed is quite large relative to the gas flowing through them, so
temperature changes occur very slowly (particularly at low flow rates). For
this reason, it is important to watch the temperature trends around the
reactor and be prepared to take corrective action early so that the
corrections have time to take effect before a high-high temperature
shutdown is activated. It is particularly important to watch these
temperatures closely during periods of startup, shutdown, or
process upsets when the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature,
composition, and/or flow rate are changing significantly.
11.6.4 TGCU Catalyst
The active components for the hydrogenation reactions are cobalt and
molybdenum sulfides in the cobalt/molybdenum catalyst. The catalyst is
normally supplied by the catalyst vendor in its oxidized state, although
some vendors can supply pre-sulfided catalyst. Contacting the catalyst
with hydrogen at temperatures exceeding 200C prior to sulfiding should
be avoided to prevent impairing the catalyst activity, as hydrogen will
irreversibly sinter the metal oxides to form metal hydrides that do not
catalyze the TGCU reactions. Pre-sulfiding the catalyst before exposing it
to hydrogen at high temperature yields a catalyst with stable, high activity.
The catalyst is pre-sulfided by contacting it with an H
2
S-containing gas
(such as the inlet amine acid gas to the SRUs) in the presence of
hydrogen. During this operation, the following reactions occur:
(1) CoO + H
2
S CoS + H
2
O
(2) MoO
3
+ x H
2
S + (3-x) H
2
1/n Mo
n
S
n*x
+ 3 H
2
O
The molybdenum sulfide will probably be present in the form of Mo
2
S
3
,
MoS
2
, and MoS
3
. These reactions are exothermic (heat liberating), so it is
necessary to carefully control pre-sulfiding operations to prevent
overheating the catalyst and/or equipment. The TGCU Startup
Procedures Section of these guidelines contains a complete description of
the suggested pre-sulfiding procedure.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-44
The catalyst should be exposed to air only under controlled conditions
when it is in the reduced (sulfided) state as it is pyrophoric (capable of
spontaneous ignition) and rapid oxidation could occur, causing damage to
the catalyst, the TGCU Reactor, and/or the downstream equipment and
piping. The pyrophoric nature of the catalyst is caused by the presence of
iron sulfide (FeS), which gradually builds up in the catalyst due to
accumulation of corrosion products from upstream equipment and piping.
Controlled burn-off of the catalyst (passivation) to eliminate FeS can be
accomplished by low-temperature oxidation which destroys the FeS but
leaves the active Co/Mo sulfides intact. The TGCU Reactor can then be
opened for maintenance, etc. The procedure to accomplish this catalyst
"passivation" is fully described in TGCU Shutdown Procedures Section
these guidelines.
The catalyst activity should be monitored regularly so that there is
forewarning of catalyst deactivation. Shell Global Solutions recommends
using a gas chromatograph to analyze the gas downstream of the TGCU
Reactor (TGCU Contactor overhead gas, for instance) for CO, H
2
, and
COS. The CO/H
2
ratio (PPM CO divided by vol % H
2
) and the COS PPM
can then be plotted versus time. When the CO/H
2
ratio and/or the COS
PPM rise rapidly, preparations should be made to replace the TGCU
catalyst within a few months.
11.6.5 TGCU Start-Up Blower Operation
Prior to introducing SRU tailgas into the TGCU during startup, the
equipment in the front-end of the unit must be brought up to operating
temperature. This is accomplished by using the TGCU Start-Up Blower,
A2-GB1560, to re-circulate gas from the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer to the inlet of the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater (via the TGCU
Warmup/Bypass Valve). This allows using the TGCU Reactor Feed
Heater to heat the gas and thereby bring all the equipment up to operating
temperature. A flow controller is provided to allow filling the front-end
equipment and piping with nitrogen prior to establishing the re-circulation
flow during startup. Once the tailgas from the SRU(s) is brought into the
TGCU, the re-circulation from the TGCU Start-Up Blower is no longer
needed, so the blower can then be shut down.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-45
11.6.6 TGCU Quench Column Operation
The operating conditions shown on the Process Flow Diagram for this
system (in terms of circulation rate and water temperature) should
generally be maintained. Decreasing the water circulation rate will
increase the bottoms temperature (which increases the corrosion rate),
while increasing the circulation rate increases the load on the pump and
the coolers. The flow rate and temperatures shown are usually a good
compromise between minimizing corrosion and minimizing utility costs.
The quench water circulation rate is controlled by the quench water flow
controller in the DCS, while the temperature is controlled by a temperature
controller adjusting the speed of one of the fans on the TGCU Quench
Water Cooler, A2-EC1560. Although the design values will give adequate
operation, there are advantages in maintaining the quench water
temperature (which controls the overhead temperature) as low as
possible. These conditions will minimize the temperature and water
content of the overhead gas leaving the TGCU Quench Column and thus
minimize the load on the TGCU Contactor. The bottoms temperature of
the TGCU Quench Column is not critical except for controlling corrosion;
this temperature depends on the gas feed rate and the temperature and
flow rate of the circulating quench water. However, operating the quench
water at a lower or higher temperature than the TGCU lean amine can
cause the TGCU amine system to be out of water balance. Normally,
both the quench water and the TGCU amine should operate at roughly the
same temperature to minimize the impact on the amine system water
balance.
A portion of the quench water is sent to SWS Flash Drum on level control
to balance the water condensed from the process gas by the circulating
quench water and maintain the bottoms level in the TGCU Quench
Column. This "bleed" water rate depends on the amount of water in the
SRU tailgas, and the amount of water contained in the gas leaving the
column.
The TGCU Quench Water Filter removes sulfur and particulates from the
circulating quench water to maintain water clarity. The flow rate to the
filter should be maintained at its design value to provide maximum
filtration.
The appearance of the circulating quench water is a good indicator of
whether the TGCU Reactor is operating properly. A sight glass is
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-46
provided to allow the operator to observe the condition of the water. If
SO
2
should escape from the TGCU Reactor, it will react with the H
2
S
dissolved in the water to form sulfur:
(1) 2 H
2
S + SO
2
3 S + 2 H
2
O
This sulfur will be produced as tiny particles of solid sulfur, forming a
colloidal suspension in the water and giving the water a milky appearance.
The SO
2
may also remain dissolved in the water and form a weak solution
of sulfurous acid:
(2) H
2
O + SO
2
H
2
SO
3
If sufficient acid is formed to drop the pH of the quench water below 7, the
acid will often scour the iron sulfide film (which normally protects the steel
from corrosion) from the carbon steel equipment and piping. The iron
sulfide particles will turn the quench water black (or green). Either color
change (milky or black/green) is a symptom of SO
2
"break-through" from
the TGCU Reactor, meaning that inadequate reducing gas is being
supplied to the reactor. An abnormal increase in the pressure drop across
the TGCU Quench Water Filter is also a good indication of SO
2
break-through, as the sulfur and/or iron sulfide particles collect on the filter
elements.
Should any of these events occur, immediately observe the readings on
the air demand analyzers in the SRUs, the hydrogen analyzer in the
TGCU, and the quench water pH analyzer. Make appropriate corrections
to the air:acid gas ratio in the SRU(s), the hydrogen rate to the TGCU
Reactor Feed Mixer, or both to eliminate the SO
2
breakthrough. Also,
begin (or increase) caustic injection into the quench water to raise the pH
and minimize the corrosion to the system. Failure to maintain the proper
pH (generally 8.0-9.5) will quickly damage the quench water equipment
and piping due to acid corrosion, and may allow SO
2
to reach the TGCU
Contactor and form heat-stable salts with the amine. Heat-stable salts
can cause accelerated corrosion in the TGCU amine system.
If a large SO
2
deviation occurs (very low pH, very dirty quench water,
rapid plugging of the TGCU Quench Water Filter, etc.), it may be desirable
to dilute the quench water with fresh condensate makeup. This
accomplishes two things to facilitate cleanup of the quench water system:
the fresh makeup will dilute the SO
2
and help raise the pH, and the
makeup will raise the level in the TGCU Quench Column and cause the
quench water column level controller to increase the "bleed" rate of
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-47
quench water to the Sour Water Stripping Unit. The rate at which
condensate is added to the system must be regulated to keep the
temperature to the circulating pump low enough that the pump does not
cavitate. Experience will show how quickly condensate can be added
without causing pumping problems.
In this fashion, the TGCU Quench Column serves as a good scrubber
preceding the TGCU Contactor to prevent minor upsets in the SRUs or
the TGCU Reactor from degrading the TGCU amine with SO
2
.
Nevertheless, the hydrogen and pH analyzers in the TGCU should be
carefully observed and properly maintained to minimize the number and
duration of pH excursions in the quench water system. This will maximize
the service life of the quench water system and minimize the degradation
of the amine.
In addition, consider diverting the process gas from the TGCU Reactor to
the Thermal Oxidizer before it enters the TGCU Quench Column during
periods of large upsets when SO
2
may break through the reactor, before
SO
2
gets into the quench water and causes problems. Taking this
preventative measure will cause higher SO
2
emissions from the Thermal
Oxidizer and put it out of compliance, but it will allow the TGCU to be
brought back to normal operation much more quickly by avoiding a pH
excursion in the quench system and the water cleanup operation that
often results (i.e., numerous filter changes in the TGCU Quench Water
Filter).
When the TGCU is operating in "normal" mode, the TGCU Reactor
effluent can be diverted directly to the Thermal Oxidizer simply by
reducing the output on the Quench Column bypass hand controller in the
DCS to 0%. This will open the TGCU Quench Column bypass valve, and
close the TGCU Quench Column inlet valve. Since the TGCU Start-Up
Blower bypass valve is open when the blower is not operating, this gives
the process gas a path to flow to the Thermal Oxidizer.
The TGCU Reactor effluent will then be diverted to the Thermal Oxidizer
and cannot cause problems in the TGCU columns if SO
2
escapes from
the reactor. Once the upset has been corrected and gas flow into the
columns can be re-initiated by increasing the output on the Quench
Column bypass hand controller in the DCS to 100% output to restore flow
to the columns. These changes should be performed slowly enough to
minimize the "bobbles" on the air:acid gas ratio control in the SRUs, as
the operating pressures in the units will change as the valves are
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-48
repositioned. Operator judgment should be used to determine whether
the process upset or the diversion of the process gas will have the worse
impact on TGCU operation and the duration of non-compliance due to
SO
2
emissions from the Thermal Oxidizer.
11.6.7 TGCU Contactor Operation
The main requirement for the TGCU Contactor is to consistently produce
a vent gas for incineration which contains a low level of residual H
2
S.
Secondarily, a good degree of CO
2
"slip" (rejection) to the vent gas is
desirable to minimize CO
2
buildup due to the recycle of acid gas to the
upstream Claus sulfur plant.
The important parameters for controlling the H
2
S content of the TGCU
Contactor vent gas, assuming the amine is adequately stripped, are amine
temperature, amine flow rate, and contact time. The design values for
amine temperature and flow rate shown on the Process Flow Diagram
should give satisfactory operation, but it is possible to adjust these values
either to maximize the capacity of the system to tolerate upsets, or to
optimize the "slipping" of CO
2
to the vent gas. The following discussion
should be helpful if improving plant operations is desired.
The single most important factor determining the H
2
S-absorbing capacity
of the amine is its temperature. The lower the temperature of the amine,
the more favorable is its selectivity for absorbing H
2
S over CO
2
. In fact,
lowering the amine temperature has a two-fold effect on improving its
ability to absorb H
2
S. First, at lower temperature the partial pressure of
H
2
S in the amine is lower, allowing the amine to treat the gas to a lower
H
2
S content (since the vent gas approaches equilibrium with the amine in
the top of the TGCU Contactor). Second, the higher selectivity at the
lower temperature means the amine picks up less CO
2
, resulting in less
heat of reaction and less temperature rise in the column, increasing the
ability of the amine to pick up H
2
S. Thus, the best possible operation
results when both the gas and the amine fed to the TGCU Contactor are
as cool as possible. For this reason, many operators leave the quench
water and amine coolers at full capacity so that the coolers provide
maximum cooling year-round.
As would be expected, keeping the amine circulation rate at its maximum
value gives the amine system the highest capacity to handle H
2
S "peaks"
due to upsets in the upstream systems. It may not be immediately
apparent, however, that high circulation rates are detrimental to amine
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-49
performance when plant throughput is lower. Circulating more amine than
necessary increases the amount of CO
2
absorbed by the amine by
increasing the contact time in the TGCU Contactor. This increase in CO
2
pickup reduces the ability of the amine to pick up H
2
S.
In general, most companies favor operating TGCU amine systems to
provide maximum ability to tolerate upsets without going out of
compliance. These companies adhere to the following guidelines:
(1) Circulate amine at maximum capacity.
(2) Cool the quench water and amine as much as possible.
The amine strength should be monitored and the amine content of the
circulating amine should be maintained close to the 45% (by weight)
design value. Should the amine concentration decrease (normally due to
blowdown and other amine losses), it will be necessary to add fresh amine
to compensate. Laboratory procedures for analyzing TGCU amine are
given in Section 11.10 of these guidelines.
The amine should also be checked periodically for heat-stable salt
content. Heat-stable salts form when the amine in the amine (a base)
reacts with strong acids to form salts that do not decompose at the normal
amine regeneration temperature. The most common heat-stable salts
encountered in TGCU amine systems are SO
2
salts, although oxygen
contamination of the amine is another common culprit for heat-stable salts
in these systems. Heat-stable salts increase the corrosivity of the amine
(particularly at higher temperatures, like in the TGCU Stripper Reboiler)
and increase the foaming tendencies of the amine. (Interestingly,
heat-stable salts sometimes improve the H
2
S-removal capability of the
amine, but the higher corrosion rate caused by the salt far outweighs this
advantage.)
A heat-stable salt content of 2 wt % or lower is desirable. Salt contents in
the 5-20 wt % range can be corrosive and should be avoided if possible.
The only way to reduce the heat-stable salt content of the amine is by
dilution, blowing down some of the circulating amine and making up with
fresh amine. There is no means for regenerating heat-stable salt from the
amine while it is in the TGCU, as vacuum distillation is required. (In
recent years, however, several companies have successfully reclaimed
amine on-line using ion exchange on a slipstream of the amine.) There
are firms that specialize in reclaiming amine (usually off-site), and it may
be economical to use such a firm if a large amount of amine has been
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-50
contaminated with heat-stable salts. The best practice, however, is to
avoid forming heat-stable salt in the first place by proper operation of the
SRU and TGCU to avoid SO
2
breakthrough from the TGCU Reactor, and
gas-blanketing the fresh amine to avoid oxygen contamination.
The H
2
/H
2
S analyzer on the TGCU Contactor overhead, measures the
concentrations of both H
2
and H
2
S in the vent gas leaving the TGCU
Contactor. As such, it is an extremely useful troubleshooting and
optimizing tool for the TGCU. This analyzer should be maintained and
calibrated at appropriate intervals so that it will be on-line and available to
the operators.
The H
2
S concentration is particularly useful when trying to pinpoint the
cause of high SO
2
emissions from the Thermal Oxidizer, as the TGCU
Contactor is not the only possible source of high emissions. There are
several valves in the SRU and the TGCU that can allow process gases
with high sulfur content to reach the Thermal Oxidizer if the valves leak or
are not fully closed. If the SO
2
emissions from the Thermal Oxidizer are
high but the analyzer shows low H
2
S content in the TGCU Contactor
overhead, then a leaking valve is the most likely source of the excessive
sulfur reaching the Thermal Oxidizer. In particular, the automated bypass
valves in the TGCU may open slightly if their positioners or actuators are
not properly adjusted, or if sudden changes in ambient conditions cause
the positioners to move the valves slightly. If this situation occurs, it is
suggested (as the first step in troubleshooting the problem) that the
following valves be "stroked" slightly (in the order given below) to be sure
that they are fully closed:
(1) A2-NV15800 The TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve can leak
SRU tailgas directly to the Thermal Oxidizer.
(2) A2-HV15851 If the TGCU Start-Up Blower is not operating
and A2-HV15853 is open ("normal" mode
operation), the TGCU Quench Column Bypass
Valve can leak TGCU Reactor effluent directly
to the Thermal Oxidizer.
(3) A2-HV15457
A2-HV15657
The Tailgas Valve to the TTO can leak SRU
tailgas directly to the Thermal Oxidizer.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-51
(4) A2-HV15441/641
A2-HV15454/654
The SRU Warmup Bypass Valves to the TTO
can leak SRU process gas directly to the
Thermal Oxidizer if the nitrogen purge fails or is
inadequate.
Check the SO
2
emissions after stroking each valve. If the emissions are
still high after checking all the valves, then verify that both the H
2
S
analyzer and the SO
2
analyzer are calibrated properly. If these valves are
not leaking, there is usually no obvious reason why these two analyzers
should show a discrepancy in the sulfur content of the TGCU effluent.
In such cases, a systematic sampling program is usually required to
isolate the source of the sulfur entering the Thermal Oxidizer. This
sampling program need not be elaborate, as gas detector tubes for H
2
S
and SO
2
(such as Drger tubes) are often sufficient for this purpose. The
main point is to start at the TGCU Contactor overhead and work toward
the Thermal Oxidizer, taking gas samples at each spot where gas may
enter the line, in order to determine when the sulfur content goes up and
isolate the source of the sulfur. Some detective work may still be
necessary, however, as there may not be sample points available at every
location. If so, and if there are several episodes of high emissions
requiring this type of sampling, consideration should be given to installing
additional sample points during the next plant turnaround.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-52
11.6.8 TGCU Stripper Operation
The lean amine must remain comparatively free of H
2
S and CO
2
to assure
attainment of the vent gas specification. These acid gases are removed
from the rich amine in the TGCU Stripper by stripping them out with
steam. The stripping steam supplies heat to reverse the acid-base
reaction between the H
2
S/CO
2
and the amine, and also reduces the
H
2
S/CO
2
partial pressure in the vapor phase inside the column to promote
mass transfer from the liquid.
The stripping steam is produced by vaporizing some of the water in the
amine in the TGCU Stripper Reboiler, using LP (3.5-4.2 kg/cm
2
(g)) steam
for the heat input. The steam rate to the reboiler (and, hence, the amine
stripping rate) is controlled by the steam flow controller. Adjust this steam
rate as needed to keep the H
2
S and CO
2
loading in the lean amine low,
i.e., below about 0.005 mole/mole or lower. For a given column operating
pressure, the overhead temperature is a direct indication of the stripping
rate: the higher the temperature, the more stripping. Column bottoms
temperature should not be used as a guideline for degree of stripping, as
it is a function only of amine concentration and column pressure.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-53
THE DESIGN STRIPPING STEAM RATE SHOWN ON THE
PROCESS FLOW DIAGRAM SHOULD BE CLOSE TO OPTIMUM.
ALTHOUGH IT MAY BE POSSIBLE TO REDUCE THIS SOMEWHAT
WITHOUT GOING OUT OF COMPLIANCE (I.E., WITH LITTLE
CHANGE IN THE H
2
S LOADING OF THE LEAN AMINE), REDUCING
THE STRIPPING STEAM RATE SIGNIFICANTLY CAN CAUSE
ACCELERATED CORROSION DUE TO HIGH CO
2
LOADINGS IN
THE LEAN AMINE. SEVERAL PLANTS HAVE REPORTED
UNEXPECTEDLY HIGH CORROSION RATES IN THE HOT, HIGH
VELOCITY AREAS OF THE LEAN AMINE SYSTEM, SUCH AS THE
OUTLET ENDS OF THE REBOILER TUBES AND THE LEAN AMINE
PUMPS, AFTER REDUCING THE REBOILER STEAM.
IF IT IS NECESSARY TO OPTIMIZE THE STEAM TO THE TGCU
STRIPPER REBOILER, REDUCE THE STEAM BY SMALL
INCREMENTS AND CHECK THE LEAN AMINE LOADINGS (BOTH
H
2
S AND CO
2
) AFTER EACH CHANGE. DO NOT REDUCE THE
STEAM FURTHER IF EITHER LOADING BEGINS TO RISE
SIGNIFICANTLY, AND BE PREPARED TO PERFORM MORE
EXTENSIVE CORROSION MONITORING WHEN OPERATING THE
TGCU STRIPPER IN THIS MANNER. REFER TO SECTION 11.10
OF THESE GUIDELINES FOR THE PROCEDURES TO BE USED
TO DETERMINE THE LEAN AMINE LOADINGS.
The withdrawal of lean amine from the bottom of the TGCU Stripper is on
flow control to the TGCU Contactor. As a result, the level in the bottom of
the TGCU Stripper, which serves as the "surge" for the system, will
usually indicate if adjustments of water makeup to the amine system (or
water "bleed" from the system) are required to maintain the proper water
balance. Even if water must be bled from the system by diverting some of
the column reflux to The SWS Flash Drum, the amine content of that
waste stream should be low and only infrequent makeup of fresh amine
should be required.
It may also be necessary to "purge" ammonia from the reflux water
periodically by routing some of the reflux water to the Sour Water Stripper.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-54
Although the two-zone Reactor Furnaces in the SRUs will normally
destroy almost all of the ammonia entering with the SWS gas, PPM levels
of ammonia will typically leave the furnace and enter the TGCU with the
sulfur plant tailgas. This ammonia is usually removed by the circulating
water in the TGCU Quench Column, where it has the beneficial effect of
helping maintain a high pH in the quench water. In fact, ammonia (rather
than caustic) is used for pH control in many TGCUs. Over a period of
time, however, some of the ammonia may carry over into the TGCU
Contactor and dissolve in the TGCU amine.
When this ammonia-containing amine reaches the TGCU Stripper, the
ammonia becomes "trapped" because it is too light (volatile) to leave in
the column bottoms and too heavy to leave in the overhead (the acid gas).
As a result, the ammonia will become concentrated in the reflux water, to
the point where it exceeds its solubility limits and begins to cause plugging
problems. If this problem is suspected, simply "bleed" a small amount of
the reflux water to the disposal header to purge the ammonia from the
system, while monitoring the reflux flow rate to ensure that adequate
reflux is maintained to the TGCU Stripper. Operating experience will
show how often (and how much) the reflux must be purged in this manner
to prevent excessive ammonia concentrations for a particular plant. Due
to the moderate temperatures and fluid velocities typical for this section of
the plant, wet H
2
S-NH
3
corrosion is usually not a concern.
There is full-flow of rich amine through the TGCU Rich Amine Filter, and a
slipstream of lean amine flow through the TGCU Lean Amine Filter, the
TGCU Amine Carbon Filter, and the TGCU Amine After-Filter. These four
filters will remove solids and organic contaminants from the circulating
amine, such as degradation or corrosion products. The flow rate through
the lean amine filters should be maintained at the design value, and the
filter elements should be changed as soon as the "change" pressure drop
is reached, to remove as many solids from the amine as possible. Finely
divided solids can cause foaming and thereby limit column capacity.
While it is possible to reduce foaming to some extent with anti-foam
agents, the presence of such agents may also reduce H
2
S/CO
2
selectivity
in the TGCU Contactor, so it is preferable that they not be used as an
alternative to regular conscientious filter maintenance
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-55
11.6.9 TGCU Amine Water Balance
The water content of the circulating amine in a TGCU is determined by the
following factors:
A. The water content of the feed gas to the TGCU Contactor (the
overhead from the TGCU Quench Column).
B. The water content of the vent gas leaving the TGCU Contactor.
C. The water content of the TGCU recycle gas leaving the TGCU
Stripper Reflux Accumulator.
D. The amount of water makeup to (or water "bleed" from) the amine
system.
For given operating pressures, the water content of each gas stream will
be determined by the temperature at the top of the respective vessel
(TGCU Quench Column, TGCU Contactor, and TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator, respectively), and will increase as the temperature
increases. Since the TGCU Contactor inlet gas is at a slightly higher
pressure than the outlet (vent) gas, the inlet gas will normally contain less
water than is contained in the outlet gas (if both gas streams are at the
same temperature), thus requiring water makeup to maintain the proper
water content of the amine. This situation will be reversed if the TGCU
Contactor overhead temperature is lower than the TGCU Quench Column
overhead temperature, requiring a "bleed" of water to maintain water
balance.
Since the lean amine to the TGCU Contactor is on flow control and
withdrawal of the rich amine from the bottom of the TGCU Contactor is on
level control, a net gain or loss in the amine water balance will be reflected
by an increase or decrease, respectively, of the liquid level in the bottom
of the TGCU Stripper. Observation of this liquid level can thus guide
adjustment of water makeup/bleed rate or operating conditions to maintain
the desired water concentration of the circulating amine. Since the degree
of H
2
S removal can depend on the amine concentration of the amine, the
concentration should be maintained close to the design value (45 wt %)
by appropriate maintenance of water concentration. It is usually possible
to control the water balance without adding fresh water or "bleeding" water
to the Sour Water Stripping Unit by adjusting the operating temperatures
in the unit, as discussed in the following paragraphs. Following the steps
outlined below will allow controlling the water balance with minimum
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-56
usage of treated makeup water and minimum impact on the sour water
system.
A persistently increasing liquid level in the bottom of the TGCU Stripper at
constant flow rates and conditions for TGCU Contactor feed gas and
amine indicates a gain in the amine water content. To reduce the water
content of the amine, the preferred sequence of gradual adjustments is:
A. Reduce or terminate water makeup to the amine. Makeup water is
steam condensate, added at the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator.
(1) Decrease the TGCU Contactor feed gas temperature by
lowering the quench water temperature on the quench water
temperature controller and/or increasing the quench water flow
rate on the quench water flow controller.
This will reduce the amount of water entering the TGCU
Contactor, but the magnitude of adjustment available from this
step will generally be limited by the capacity of the aerial and
trim water coolers.
(2) Begin "bleeding" water (or increase the "bleed" water rate) from
the amine system with the flow controller on the discharge line
of the TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump.
Be careful, however, not to starve the TGCU Stripper for reflux
by withdrawing too much water. Use the DCS flow indicator for
the reflux water to monitor the operation so that adequate reflux
is maintained to the TGCU Stripper when bleeding water from
the amine system.
UNDER NORMAL CONDITIONS, THE REFLUX WATER
CONTAINS LITTLE OR NO AMINE BECAUSE OF THE "WASH
WATER" TRAYS ABOVE THE SOLVENT FEED TRAY IN THE
TGCU STRIPPER. HOWEVER, IF THE TGCU STRIPPER IS
FLOODING OR FOAMING (AS INDICATED BY HIGH OR
ERRATIC COLUMN DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE), THE
REFLUX CAN CONTAIN LARGE AMOUNTS OF AMINE.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-57
IF THE "BLEED" WATER LINE IS IN USE AT SUCH TIMES, A
SIGNIFICANT QUANTITY OF SOLVENT CAN BE LOST TO
THE SOUR WATER SYSTEM, AND WILL HAVE TO BE
REPLACED WITH FRESH AMINE FROM THE STORAGE
TANK. FOR THIS REASON, THE "BLEED" WATER SYSTEM
SHOULD BE BLOCKED-IN DURING UPSETS IN THE TGCU
STRIPPER.
(3) Increase the TGCU Contactor overhead temperature by raising
the setpoint of the lean solvent temperature controller to
increase the lean solvent temperature.
This will increase the amount of water leaving in the vent gas,
but it will also reduce the H
2
S-removal capability of the solvent.
An increase in solvent flow rate will probably be needed to
maintain the same H
2
S content in the vent gas, increasing the
load on the TGCU Stripper and the other process equipment
associated with the circulating solvent. Additionally, some
impairment of the CO
2
"slip" by the solvent would be expected
as a result of both the higher contact temperatures in the TGCU
Contactor and the higher solvent circulation. This will increase
the CO
2
recycled to the sulfur plants and increase the CO
2
content of the tailgas to the TGCU, further hampering the
H
2
S-removal capability of the solvent.
(4) Increase the TGCU recycle gas temperature by increasing the
temperature setpoint of the reflux temperature controller to raise
the outlet temperature from the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Condenser.
Although this will increase the water content of this stream and
reduce the water in the solvent, the effect will be small because
the quantity of recycle gas is small relative to the vent gas, and
the pressure of the recycle gas is considerably higher. This
adjustment is the least effective and would not normally be
considered during routine operations.
(5) Should the solvent inventory be difficult to control due to
continuing problems with an excessive amount of water in the
solvent, the steam-heated TGCU Stripper Reboiler should be
checked for tube leaks.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-58
B. Conversely, a persistently decreasing liquid level in the bottom of the
TGCU Stripper indicates a loss in the solvent water content. To
increase the water content of the solvent, the preferred sequence of
gradual adjustments is:
1. Reduce or terminate the "bleed" water from the TGCU Stripper
Reflux Accumulator.
2. Decrease the TGCU Contactor overhead temperature by
lowering the lean solvent temperature with the lean solvent
temperature controller to reduce the amount of water leaving in
the vent gas.
3. Decrease the TGCU recycle gas temperature with the aerial
cooling from the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser to reduce
the water loss in the stream as much as possible.
4. Begin water makeup (or increase the makeup water rate) to the
solvent system using the make-up flow controller to add
condensate to the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator. The
TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump will then send the makeup water to
the TGCU Stripper, increasing the water content of the TGCU
solvent.
Be careful, however, to regulate the makeup rate so that the
temperature to the pump does not become hot enough to cause
cavitation. Also, make sure that the makeup water rate is not
so high that the pump cannot keep up, which would cause high
level in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator. Experience will
show how quickly condensate can be added without causing
pumping or level problems.
5. Increase the TGCU Contactor feed temperature by increasing
the temperature of the quench water feeding the TGCU Quench
Column by raising the setpoint of the quench water temperature
controller.
This will increase the water content of the gas entering the
TGCU Contactor, but it also increases the vapor load and
hampers H
2
S removal, so this step should not be taken to
extremes.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-59
11.6.10 TGCU Amine Loss
At the low process temperatures and low amine loadings normally
prevailing in the TGCU process, the loss of MDEA by chemical
degradation is expected to be negligible. Amine degradation can occur,
however, under abnormal operating conditions.
Amine degradation can occur via reaction with SO
2
, which can enter the
TGCU Contactor during periods when insufficient reducing gas is fed to
the TGCU Reactor. During such periods, most of the SO
2
"breaking
through" the TGCU Reactor should be scrubbed out in the TGCU Quench
Column. However, any traces of SO
2
entering the TGCU Contactor will
react with the MDEA to form a thermally non-regenerable complex (i.e.,
heat-stable salt). If present in sufficient quantity, this salt can alter the
H
2
S-amine equilibrium and prevent removal of H
2
S to the desired level in
the TGCU Contactor overhead. Heat-stable salts also increase the
corrosivity of the TGCU amine. Amine quality can be restored by
treatment with an amount of caustic equivalent to the non-regenerable salt
present but, if repeated caustic treatments are necessary due to repeated
mal-operation, the potential for salt deposition in the system may rise.
The equipment in the TGCU, including the seals of pumps and blowers,
should be operated at positive pressure to minimize the potential for
oxygen (air) ingress into the amine. Oxygen will react with the amine to
produce carboxylic acids that cause the solution to be corrosive. For this
same reason, it is important to maintain an inert gas "blanket" on the
MDEA storage tank to prevent oxygen contamination of the fresh amine.
Amine losses due to entrainment in the vent gas or the recycle gas can be
minimized by proper process operation (avoidance of column overloading,
foaming, etc.) and routine inspection of the vessel internals. Amine losses
in the water "bleed" from the TGCU Stripper reflux should be negligible if
the rectifying trays (the "wash water" trays above the amine feed point) in
the TGCU Stripper are operating properly (no flooding or foaming, no
mechanical damage).
The primary source of amine loss will likely be the mechanical losses from
pump drips, cleaning of filters, etc. Good housekeeping practices,
including prompt replacement or repair of leaking pumps, together with
proper collection of amine drips for reuse will minimize the mechanical
loss of amine.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-60
11.6.11 Operation at Low Flow Rates
As discussed in the Sulfur Recovery Unit section of these guidelines,
operating the SRUs at low flow rates (below about 20-25% of design load)
can lead to several operating problems in the sulfur plant. It can also
cause poor column performance in the TGCU.
The TGCU contains three columns: the TGCU Quench Column and the
TGCU Contactor, which contain structured packing; and the TGCU
Stripper, which contains valve trays. In general, the liquid feed rate to
packed towers can decrease in proportion with the gas flow rate down to
about 50% of design gas flow rate. Below this point, the liquid rate cannot
be allowed to drop any further without risking poor column performance
due to uneven liquid distribution and wetting of the packing. Trayed
towers typically offer somewhat better turndown, allowing the liquid rate to
drop to 30-40% of design before "weeping" of the trays begins to
significantly affect performance.
At a total acid gas feed rate of 14 MT/D (of contained sulfur) to the SRUs,
the gas flow rates to the TGCU Quench Column and the TGCU Contactor
will be about 40% of design. In the case of the TGCU Quench Column,
simply setting the quench water flow rate to the column at about 50% of
design should maintain adequate performance. (It should be noted,
however, that there is really no detrimental effect if the quench water
circulation is simply left at the design value at all times. The only
drawback is slightly higher power consumption by the pump and aerial
cooler.)
In the packed TGCU Contactor, circulating more amine relative to the gas
flow rate should maintain performance. The liquid flow rate should be
maintained at a minimum of about 50%.
This higher amine circulation also has the advantage of absorbing more
CO
2
from the TGCU Contactor feed, which is subsequently stripped from
the amine and recycled back to the SRUs. While TGCUs are normally
operated to minimize CO
2
pickup, increasing the CO
2
pickup in this
situation is advantageous. It raises the mass flow rate in the SRUs and
the TGCU, minimizing the operating problems throughout the SRU/TGCU
systems by preventing sulfur fog formation in the Sulfur Condensers. A
higher circulation rate also means the TGCU has more capacity to remove
H
2
S from the amine, making it less likely that SRU upsets will cause SO
2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-61
emissions to exceed permit limits. It will also keep the TGCU Stripper
trays well above their minimum operating rate.
11.6.12 Pressure Drop Surveys
A commonly encountered problem in TGCUs (and sulfur plants and
Thermal Oxidizers) is a flow restriction due to high pressure drop. High
pressure drop is typically caused by a restriction at one point in the
equipment or piping, due to:
1. Accumulation of liquid (sulfur, etc.) in equipment or piping
2. Partial plugging of a catalyst bed (soot, carbon, polymers, etc.)
3. Partial plugging of a mist eliminator (sulfur, soot, catalyst, etc.)
4. Partial plugging of the packing and/or trays in a column
5. Flooding or foaming in a column
The first step in identifying the cause of the high pressure drop is to
determine which equipment pass or section of piping contains the
restriction. (It is unusual to have more than one area of high pressure
drop.) This is best accomplished by making a pressure survey of the
process side of the TGCU (and the SRUs and Thermal Oxidizer, if
necessary).
Due to the low operating pressure in the TGCU (generally 0.3 kg/cm
2
(g) or
less) and the low pressure drop in each equipment pass (generally
0.00-0.04 kg/cm
2
per pass), a single pressure gauge must be used to
make the pressure survey in order to get meaningful results. The gauge
should be a low pressure gauge for best results (a -1 - 0 - +1.5 kg/cm
2
gauge is recommended).
Beginning at the front end of the TGCU, use the pressure tap valves on
the inlet and outlet lines from each equipment pass to measure the
pressure at each point in the process. Proceed toward the back end of
the process until the pass with the high pressure drop is found. Note that
some of the pressure tap valves may be plugged with solid sulfur.
Rod-out the sample valves as necessary to obtain an accurate pressure
reading.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-62
ALWAYS OBSERVE PROPER PROCEDURES AND PRECAUTIONS
WHEN USING THE PRESSURE TAP VALVES, PARTICULARLY IF
THE VALVES ARE PLUGGED AND MUST BE CLEARED.
ALTHOUGH THE VALVES ARE ORIENTED TO MINIMIZE THE
POSSIBILITY OF FILLING WITH MOLTEN SULFUR, HOT SULFUR
MAY SUDDENLY BE EXPELLED FROM A VALVE WHEN THE PLUG
IS CLEARED. RELEASE OF TOXIC GASES (H
2
S AND SO
2
, IN
PARTICULAR) IS ALSO A POSSIBILITY. THE "GENERAL SAFETY"
SECTION OF THESE GUIDELINES SHOULD BE CONSULTED IF
THERE IS ANY DOUBT ABOUT HOW TO WORK SAFELY WHEN
H
2
S, SO
2
, OR MOLTEN SULFUR MAY BE PRESENT.
When troubleshooting problems of this nature, it is very helpful to have
pressure survey information taken previously when the unit was operating
properly. It is recommended that one or more pressure surveys be
performed early in the operating life of the plant, for comparison purposes
later if problems are encountered. Since the pressure drop of the TGCU
is a function of plant throughput (pressure drop is roughly proportional to
flow rate squared), it is even more helpful for troubleshooting purposes if
the early pressure surveys are performed at different plant throughput
rates. It is also important to record the gas flow rates to the SRUs (amine
acid gas, SWS gas, process air) and the TGCU (reducing gas) during the
pressure survey, since pressure drop depends so strongly on plant
throughput.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-63
11.6.13 Boiler Water Treatment
SAMSUNG TOTAL PETROCHEMICALS CO., LTD. IS
RESPONSIBLE FOR ESTABLISHING AND MONITORING THE
BOILER AND WATER CHEMICAL TREATMENT PROGRAM.
Proper boiler water chemical treatment is essential to achieving long
service life for the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer. Without good
day-to-day control of the water quality, solids buildup, corrosion, and
attack by the treating chemicals themselves can occur. It is Samsung
Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.'s responsibility to see that a proper
chemical treating program is initiated prior to startup and that the program
is properly monitored and refined throughout the service life of the plant.
There are many qualified boiler and water treatment companies that can
advise the owner/operator on chemical treatment testing and controls. It
is recommend that only those companies that have local technicians with
extensive experience specifically in boiler water treatment be selected to
assist with Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.'s program.
The design details incorporated in the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer have
proven to be very reliable when combined with good operator practice
regarding water treatment. However, even properly designed equipment
can be severely damaged during a short period of operation if the water
treatment program is inadequate or improper.
The TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer is equipped with a continuous
blowdown valve to remove suspended and dissolved solids from the water
inside the boiler. In addition, this boiler is equipped with an intermittent
blowdown valve. The intermittent blowdown valve should be used on a
regular basis to give the boiler a good "blow" to prevent sludge from
accumulating in the bottom of its shell.
Prior to using the intermittent blowdown valve, use the level controller in
the DCS to raise the water level in the boiler up to the high level alarm
point. Then open the intermittent blowdown valve until the level drops
back to the normal liquid level. Watch the boiler level in the sight glass
throughout this operation to ensure that the level is not lost (which would
activate the TGCU ESD and shut the TGCU down). Remember to reset
the level controller at the conclusion of this procedure.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-64
11.7 Precommissioning Procedures
Prior to the initial startup, there are a number of precommissioning activities that
are necessary to ensure that the newly constructed plant is ready to be placed
in service. The activities outlined below should serve as a guide, but there may
be others required as a part of your normal plant procedures.
11.7.1 Preliminary Check-out
Check all equipment to ensure that it is properly installed. This will
probably require consulting Manufacturer's literature as well as
construction drawings.
A. Check and lubricate all equipment, in accordance with the
Manufacturer's recommendations.
B. Check the rotation of the TGCU Start-Up Blower by operating it for a
short period (20 seconds or less) with its suction and discharge
valves closed:
C. Check the rotation of the following pumps by "bumping" them:
(1) TGCU Quench Water Pump.
(2) TGCU Rich Amine Pump.
(3) TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump.
(4) TGCU Lean Amine Pump.
D. Check the rotation of the fans on the TGCU Quench Water Cooler,
the TGCU Lean Amine Cooler, and the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Condenser, by operating each fan for a short period.
E. Check all piping and equipment to be sure that all blinds have been
removed and that no valves are vented to atmosphere.
F. Place the Instrument Air System in service to all instruments and
check the action of controllers and control valves.
G. Turn on the steam supplies to all of the steam-jacketed sulfur vapor
valves and use the vent valves on each jacket section to vent the air
from the jackets. Manually "stroke" each valve and check to be sure
each move freely.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-65
11.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out
A. Fill the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer with treated boiler feed water
up to the high level alarm point. As the level rises, check the level
transmitters and the high level alarms for proper operation.
B. Use the quick-opening blowdown valve to lower the water level in the
boiler and check for proper operation of the level transmitters, the
low level alarms, and the low-low level shutdowns.
C. Fill the boiler with treated boiler feed water back up to the normal
liquid level.
D. Physically check all shutdown activating devices to ensure that they
activate the TGCU ESD system.
E. Physically check all devices activated by the TGCU ESD system to
ensure that they operate properly.
F. Check all relief valves to ensure that they are installed in the proper
locations and set for the correct relieving pressures.
G. The low-low level shutdowns for the pumps in the quench water and
amine systems will be tested while washing these systems as
described in the following sections.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-66
11.7.3 Commissioning Nitrogen and Utility Air to the Process
The nitrogen and utility air supplies to the process side of the TGCU must
be made ready for use prior to starting up the TGCU using the procedures
in Section 11.8 of these guidelines. This requires blowing down each
section of piping to ensure that there are no liquids and/or construction
debris in the headers and supply lines. The procedure below can be used
to make sure that these gas utility systems are ready for service.
A. Place the utility air controller in the DCS in "manual" and set its
output to 0%.
B. Place the nitrogen controller in the DCS in "manual" and set its
output to 0%.
C. Confirm that the following nitrogen and utility air valves are closed:
(1) The upstream block valve, flow control valve, and the
downstream block valve in the nitrogen supply line.
(2) The upstream block valve, flow control valve, and the
downstream block valve in the utility air supply line.
(3) The automated block valves, and the steam-jacketed block
valve in the common nitrogen / air line.
(4) The block valve in the HP nitrogen supply line located near the
TGCU Reactor.
(5) The gate valves upstream and the ball valves downstream of
the flow indicators in the purges to the sensing lines for the
TGCU Reactor d/P transmitter.
(6) The ball valves in the sensing lines for the TGCU Reactor d/P
transmitter.
(7) The gate and ball valves in the purge line to the shaft seal on
the TGCU Start-Up Blower.
(8) The gate valve in the LP nitrogen supply line, and the ball valve
downstream of the flow indicator in the purge line to the TGCU
Start-Up Blower discharge line.
(9) The gate valve upstream of the flow indicator in the supply line
to the sample switching valve for the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-67
(10) The block valves in the nitrogen supply line to the TGCU
Stripper Reflux Accumulator.
D. Confirm that all of the manual vent/drain valves in the nitrogen and
utility air piping are closed.
E. If the orifice plate has already been installed in the utility air flow
meter, remove it for now
F. If the orifice plate has already been installed in the nitrogen flow
meter, remove it for now
G. Disconnect the nitrogen and utility air from the tailgas line by
performing the following steps:
(1) Unbolt the flanged connections at the steam jacketed block
valve and "drop out" this valve.
(2) Isolate and, if necessary, disconnect the steam supply and
condensate return connections for this valve.
(3) Cover the open end of the piping to prevent debris from
entering when the upstream piping is blown down.
H. Confirm that the H.P. nitrogen, L.P. nitrogen, and Utility Air supply
headers have been placed in service, with the pressure regulators
set properly and the safety relief valves in service, and with the main
supply header piping blown down and drained.
I. Rotate the spectacle blind in the utility air line to the "open" position.
J. Remove the following pressure regulators, then cover the
downstream piping to prevent debris from entering when the
upstream piping is blown down:
(1) The utility air supply regulator.
(2) The nitrogen supply regulator.
K. "Force" the PLC to open the two nitrogen blocks, and close the
nitrogen vent valve.
L. Confirm that these automated valves have moved to the proper
positions.
M. "Crack" the upstream block valve in the main utility air supply line
and allow air to blow through the piping until it is clear. Then close
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-68
the block valve, reinstall the utility air supply pressure regulator, and
reopen the block valve.
N. Using the utility air supply pressure regulator and the vent valve
downstream of the pressure control valve, adjust the utility air
regulator to the setpoint specified on the P&IDs.
O. "Crack" the block valve in the main nitrogen supply line and allow
nitrogen to blow through the piping until it is clear. Then close the
gate valve, reinstall the nitrogen supply pressure regulator, and
reopen the gate valve.
P. Using the pressure gauge and the vent valve downstream of the
nitrogen supply pressure regulator, adjust the nitrogen regulator to its
specified setpoint.
Q. Open the flow valve in the utility air line by setting the output of the
flow controller to 100% in the DCS, then use the downstream drain
valve to blow out this section of piping. Close the drain valve when
the piping is clear.
R. Open the flow valve in the nitrogen line by setting the output of the
flow controller to 100% in the DCS, then use the downstream drain
valve to blow out this section of piping. Close the drain valve when
the piping is clear.
S. "Crack" the block valve downstream of the flow valve and allow air to
blow through the piping until it is clear. Then close the bock valve.
T. Close the flow valve in the utility air line by setting the output of the
flow controller to 0% in the DCS
U. "Crack" the block valve downstream of nitrogen control valve and
allow nitrogen to blow through the piping until it is clear. Then close
the block valve.
V. Close the control valve in the nitrogen line by setting the output of the
flow controller to 0% in the DCS
W. Remove the "forces" from the PLC and confirm that both of the
automated block valves close and the automated vent valve opens.
X. Close the upstream block valve in the utility air supply line.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-69
Y. Rotate the spectacle blind in the utility air line to the "closed"
position.
Z. Close the upstream block valve in the nitrogen supply line until the
TGCU unit is ready for startup.
AA. Reconnect the nitrogen / air piping by performing the following steps:
(1) Reinstall the steam jacketed block valve and bolt the flanged
connections back together.
(2) Reinstate the steam supply and condensate return piping.
(3) If the steam system is already in service, establish steam flow
into the jacket by opening the steam supply valve. Open the
vent valve on the steam jacket long enough to vent the air from
the jacket.
(4) Reinstall the orifice plate in the utility air flow meter.
(5) Reinstall the orifice plate in the nitrogen flow meter.
BB. Open the block valve in the utility nitrogen supply line located near
the TGCU Reactor until the line is clear.
CC. The TGCU Reactor d/P transmitter has low pressure purges for both
of its sensing lines, each with a rotameter near where it connects to
the sensing line. Disconnect the upstream fitting at each rotameter
and briefly open its upstream gate valve to blow any liquids or debris
from its purge line. Reconnect each rotameter, disconnect the fitting
where each purge connects to the sensing line, open the upstream
gate valve, and open the ball valve downstream of each rotameter
briefly to blow any liquids or debris from the purge lines. Then
reconnect each purge to the sensing line and open its valve to place
it in service.
DD. Disconnect the fitting where each sensing line connects to its
process line, and open the ball valve in each sensing line briefly to
blow any liquids or debris from the lines. Then reconnect each
sensing line to its process line and open its ball valve to place it in
service.
NOTE: The two rotameters must be adjusted to the same flow rate
so that the pressure drop of the purge gas in the sensing
lines does not affect the reading of the d/P transmitter. One
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-70
way to do this is to confirm that the equalizing valve on the
d/P transmitter manifold is closed, set the rotameter on the
upstream sensing line to a small flow rate (~0.8-1.6 Nm
3
/H),
and then adjust the flow rate of the other rotameter until the
meter reads zero d/P.
EE. Disconnect the upstream fitting (in the purge line to the shaft seal on
the TGCU Start-Up Blower) and open the upstream gate and ball
valves briefly to blow any liquids or debris from the purge line.
Reconnect the rotameter and disconnect the fitting where the purge
connects to the shaft seal. Open the upstream gate valve, open the
ball valve briefly to blow any liquids or debris from the purge line,
then reconnect the purge to the shaft seal and open the ball valve to
place it in service.
FF. The nitrogen purge valve for the blower casing should already be
open. Disconnect the upstream fitting (in the purge line to the TGCU
Start-Up Blower discharge line) and open the upstream gate valve
briefly to blow any liquids or debris from the purge line. Reconnect
the rotameter and disconnect the fitting where the purge connects to
the discharge line on the TGCU Start-Up Blower. Open the
upstream gate valve, open the downstream ball valve briefly to blow
any liquids or debris from the purge line, then reconnect the purge to
the discharge line.
GG. Re-open the ball valve downstream of the nitrogen purge valve and
allow the nitrogen to pressurize the TGCU Start-Up Blower and the
piping inside the suction and discharge block valves. Check all of
the blower and piping connections for visible or audible signs of
leakage (by applying masking tape or "Snoop" to the flanges,
listening for other leaks, etc.). When done, leave the ball valve open
so that the purge is in service.
HH. Disconnect the upstream fitting (in the nitrogen supply line to the
sample switching valves) and open the upstream gate valve briefly to
blow any liquids or debris from the purge line. Reconnect the
rotameter and disconnect the fitting where the purge connects to the
sample selector valve on the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer. "Crack" the gate
valve to blow nitrogen through the piping until it is clear. Then close
the gate valve, reconnect the piping, and reopen the gate valve.
II. Remove the nitrogen supply regulator to the Reflux Accumulator.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-71
JJ. "Crack" the upstream block valve in the nitrogen supply line and
allow nitrogen to blow through the piping until it is clear. Then close
the block valve, reinstall the nitrogen supply pressure regulator, and
reopen the block valve.
KK. Using the nitrogen supply pressure regulator and the vent valve
downstream of the regulator, adjust the nitrogen regulator to the
setpoint specified on the P&IDs
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-72
11.7.4 Commissioning Hydrogen to the Process
The external hydrogen supply must be made ready for use prior to starting
up the TGCU using the procedures in Section 11.8 of these guidelines.
This requires blowing down each section of piping to ensure that there are
no liquids and/or construction debris in the headers and supply lines.
Because of the fire hazard associated with venting high-purity hydrogen,
nitrogen should be used for the initial flushing of the hydrogen piping and
for setting the pressure regulator. Once this is completed, hydrogen can
then be used to check the setting of the pressure regulator by venting the
hydrogen to a safe location using the bypass valve.
A. Place the hydrogen controller in the DCS in "manual" and set its
output to 0%.
B. Confirm that the following valves are closed:
(1) The two block valves upstream of the pressure regulator.
(2) The reducing gas supply line automated block valves, the flow
control valve, the isolation valve downstream of the control
valve and the bypass valve around the control valve.
C. Confirm that all of the manual vent/drain valves in the hydrogen
piping are closed.
D. If the orifice plate has already been installed in the hydrogen flow
meter, remove it for now.
E. Rotate the spectacle blind in the hydrogen supply line to the "closed"
position.
F. Disconnect the hydrogen piping from the line going to the TGCU
Reactor Feed Mixer by performing the following steps:
(1) Unbolt the flanged connections at the steam jacketed block
valve and "drop out" this valve.
(2) Isolate and, if necessary, disconnect the steam supply and
condensate return connections for this valve.
(3) Cover the open end of the piping to prevent debris from
entering when the upstream piping is blown down.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-73
G. Remove the pressure regulator, then cover the downstream piping to
prevent debris from entering when the upstream piping is blown
down.
H. "Force" the PLC to open the block valves in the hydrogen supply line,
and close the vent valve.
I. Confirm that these automated valves have moved to the proper
positions.
J. Use a temporary "jumper" to connect a nitrogen supply to the drain
valve upstream of the pressure regulator.
K. "Crack" the gate valve upstream of the pressure regulator and allow
nitrogen to blow through the piping until it is clear. Then close the
gate valve, reinstall the pressure regulator and reopen the gate
valve.
L. Using the pressure gauge and the vent valve downstream of the
pressure regulator, adjust the hydrogen regulator to the setpoint
specified on the P&IDs.
M. Open the reducing gas supply line control valve by setting the output
of the hydrogen controller to 100% in the DCS, then use the
downstream drain valve to blow out this section of piping. Close the
drain valve when the piping is clear.
N. "Crack" the gate valve downstream of the reducing gas supply line
control valve and allow nitrogen to blow through the piping until it is
clear. Then close the gate valve.
O. Close the reducing gas supply line control valve by setting the output
of the hydrogen controller to 0% in the DCS.
P. Briefly open the bypass valve around the control valve and allow
nitrogen to blow through the piping until it is clean. Then close the
bypass valve.
Q. Remove the "forces" from the PLC and confirm that both of the
automated block valves close and the automated vent valve opens.
R. Close the gate valve where the nitrogen "jumper" is connected to
stop the flow of nitrogen, and disconnect the nitrogen jumper.
S. Reconnect the hydrogen piping by performing the following steps:
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-74
(1) Reinstall the steam jacketed block valve and bolt the flanged
connections back together.
(2) Reinstate the steam supply and condensate return piping.
(3) If the steam system is already in service, establish steam flow
into the jacket by opening the steam supply valve. Open the
vent valve on the steam jacket long enough to vent the air from
the jacket.
(4) Reinstall the orifice plate in the hydrogen flow meter.
(5) Rotate the spectacle blind in the hydrogen supply line to the
"open" position.
T. Confirm that the hydrogen pressure regulator is properly adjusted:
(1) Open the two gate valves upstream of the pressure regulator.
(2) "Crack" the bypass valve to vent hydrogen to the flare. Adjust
the pressure regulator if necessary to maintain its setpoint,
observing the pressure on the pressure gauge.
(3) Close the bypass valve, and the gate valve immediately
upstream of the pressure regulator.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-75
11.7.5 Leak Testing the Process Piping and Equipment
THE LOW PRESSURE PROCESS PIPING (PROCESS GAS AND
SULFUR VAPOR) AND LOW PRESSURE PROCESS EQUIPMENT
IN THE TGCU ARE NOT DESIGNED TO BE HYDROSTATICALLY
TESTED. ONLY THE PIPING AND EQUIPMENT DOWNSTREAM
OF THE TGCU CONTACTOR (THE SOLVENT AND STRIPPER
SYSTEMS) ARE DESIGNED TO BE HYDROTESTED. USE THE
FOLLOWING PROCEDURE TO LEAK-TEST THE REST OF THE
TGCU.
The process piping and equipment in the TGCU can be checked for leaks
by using nitrogen to pressurize the process side of the equipment and
piping to about 0.6-0.7 kg/cm
2
(g), then checking flanges, etc. for leaks
(usually by applying masking tape or "Snoop" to the flanges, and by
listening for other leaks). In order to pressurize the TGCU with nitrogen, it
is necessary to block-in the unit by closing the outlet valve. This
procedure requires some special preparations to operate in this manner,
as detailed below.
The Complete Flowpath Interlock (see Section 11.5.5.1 of these
guidelines) must be temporarily disabled in order to operate the TGCU in
this manner. The Leak Test toggle switch in the DCS is used to direct the
PLC to bypass most of the unit shutdowns and to enable the on/off
selector switch for the nitrogen. This means that "jumpers" on the limits
switches or "forces" in the PLC are not necessary to perform this test. It
also means that it is not necessary to have water in the TGCU Waste
Heat Reclaimer during the test since the low-low water level S/D is also
bypassed.
This same procedure can be used to leak test the TGCU following
maintenance, before restarting the unit. Whenever plant maintenance
requires opening one or more of the flanged connections in the TGCU, it
is good practice to leak test the unit before returning it to service. This
allows detecting any leaking connections that may have resulted from the
maintenance operations before tailgas is reintroduced into the unit.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-76
To perform leak testing in a TGCU, proceed as follows:
A. Confirm that the nitrogen flow controller in the DCS is set to 0%
output and that the control valve in the nitrogen supply line is closed.
B. Confirm that the Quench Column inlet hand control in the DCS is set
to 0% output so that the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve will
open later in Step F when the Startup/Run selector switch is
switched to "STARTUP".
C. Confirm that the TGCU Quench Column is isolated from the quench
water circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are all
closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the quench
water flow control valve.
(2) The block valve downstream of the pH analyzer.
(3) The suction valves at the TGCU Quench Water Pumps.
(4) The drain valve on the suction line to the pumps.
(5) The block valve in the caustic supply line at the tie-in to the
suction line.
(6) The block valve in the condensate fill line at the tie-in to the
suction line.
(7) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the filtered
quench water flow control valve.
D. Confirm that the TGCU Contactor is isolated from the solvent
circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are all closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the lean
solvent flow control valve.
(2) The suction valves at the TGCU Rich Amine Pumps.
(3) The drain valve on the suction line to pumps.
(4) The block valves in the solvent makeup line at the tie-in to the
suction line.
(5) The block valve and globe valve in the condensate makeup line
at the tie-in to the suction line.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-77
E. Confirm that the spectacle blind in the utility air supply line is in the
"closed" position.
F. Switch the Startup/Run selector switch, the Startup/Run selector
switch, in the DCS to "STARTUP".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Bypasses the SRU ESD inputs to the TGCU ESD.
(2) Disables the Tailgas Valves transfer switches.
(3) Opens the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve.
(4) Enables the Leak Test Switch.
G. Confirm that the SRU Tailgas Valves to the TGCU are closed.
H. Confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve is fully open.
I. Confirm that the block valve(s), and the steam-jacketed block valve
in the nitrogen supply line are open.
J. Toggle the Leak Test Switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Bypasses the TGCU ESD to allow opening the nitrogen supply
valves via the nitrogen on/off push-button.
(2) Opens TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
K. Close the TGCU Outlet Valve.
L. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch, the nitrogen on/off push-button, in
the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens the nitrogen block valves.
(2) Closes the nitrogen vent valve.
M. Use the nitrogen flow controller in the DCS to open the nitrogen flow
control valve and send nitrogen to the TGCU to begin pressurizing it.
N. Slowly increase the output from the nitrogen flow controller until the
pressure reaches 0.6-0.7 kg/cm
2
(g) as measured by the pressure
indicator in the DCS.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-78
Due to the volume inside the TGCU, it will take several minutes for
the pressure to build up in the unit.
O. Once the desired pressure has been achieved, set the output from
the nitrogen flow controller to 0% to close the nitrogen flow control
valve. Check all of the equipment and piping connections for visible
or audible signs of leakage.
P. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "OFF".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Closes the nitrogen block valves.
(2) Opens the nitrogen vent valve.
Q. Toggle the Leak Test Switch in the DCS to "OFF".
The PLC will enable all of the ESDs for the TGCU again.
R. Open the TGCU Outlet Valve.
S. Re-open valves as necessary to restore the quench water and
solvent circulation loops that were isolated from the columns in
Steps C and D earlier.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-79
11.7.6 Washing the Quench Water System
The following procedure is intended to remove grease, rust, scale, dirt,
and trash from the equipment and piping in the quench water system
before it is placed in operation. Washing of the system consists of three
steps: an initial water flush to remove dirt and trash from the system; an
acid wash to remove grease, rust, and scale; and a caustic wash to
acclimate the equipment and piping to alkaline pH.
Failure to clean the system properly prior to startup can lead to operating
problems (heat exchanger fouling, rapid filter plugging, etc.).
THIS PROCEDURE REQUIRES WORKING WITH ACIDIC AND
ALKALINE CHEMICALS AND SOLUTIONS. EMPLOYEES MUST
OBSERVE ALL APPLICABLE SAFETY PROCEDURES AND
ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS CONCERNING USAGE OF
PERSONAL PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, HANDLING OF
HAZARDOUS MATERIALS, DISPOSAL OF WASTE STREAMS, ETC.
11.7.6.1 Water Flush
A. Place the quench water flow controller in the DCS in "manual"
and set its output to 100% to fully open the quench water flow
control valve.
B. Place the TGCU Quench Column level controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 0% to fully close the level control
valve.
C. Confirm that the Quench Column inlet hand control in the DCS
is set to 0% output so that the TGCU Quench Column inlet
valve is fully closed.
D. Place the filtered quench water flow controller in the DCS in
"manual" and set its output to 100% to fully open the filtered
quench water flow control valve.
E. Verify that the quench water flow control valve is fully open.
Open both of its isolation block valves and its bypass valve.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-80
F. Verify that the TGCU Quench Column level control valve is fully
closed. Close both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
G. Verify that the TGCU Quench Column inlet valve is fully closed.
(This will prevent water from entering the TGCU Reactor if the
TGCU Quench Column is accidentally over-filled.)
H. Verify that the filtered quench water flow control valve is fully
open. Open both of its isolation block valves and its bypass
valve.
I. The TGCU Quench Water Filter will not be used to filter solids
during this time, but the filter vessel and its piping are to be
flushed and cleaned. Remove the filter elements, then bolt-up
the filter. Open the inlet and outlet block valves on the filter,
and open the bypass valve around the filter.
J. Similarly, remove the elements from both pH Meter Sample
Filters and reinstall the filter housings. Open the inlet and outlet
block valves to the sample loop for the pH analyzer, and open
the inlet and outlet block valves for both pH Meter Sample
Filters.
K. The probe on the pH analyzer, the pH analyzer, should not be
installed until the quench water system has been cleaned and
refilled, ready for service. Verify that a temporary plug has
been screwed into the probe housing installed in the sample
piping.
L. Verify that the block valve in the caustic line is closed.
M. Add water (steam condensate) to the bottom of the TGCU
Quench Column through the condensate line.
N. Once there is an adequate level in the column, all the way to
the top of its level gauge open the suction valve on a TGCU
Quench Water Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the
pump is flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its
discharge valve.
O. Watch the level in the TGCU Quench Column while placing the
pump in service to be sure the pump does not lose suction
while filling the downstream piping and equipment. If the level
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-81
disappears in the column, shut the pump down until enough
condensate is added to reestablish the level, then restart the
pump.
P. Once circulation is achieved and the level in the TGCU Quench
Column is adequate (about halfway up in the level gauge),
discontinue the addition of condensate.
Q. Use the low point drain valves to flush out each section of the
system. Leave the drain valves open until the water is clear.
R. Briefly open the bypass valve on the TGCU Quench Column
level control valve to flush this section of piping to The Sour
Water Stripping Unit. Open the upstream block valve, open the
TGCU Quench Column level control valve with the level
controller in the DCS, and use the downstream drain valve to
flush the control station. Once the flush water clears up, close
the TGCU Quench Column level control valve and the upstream
block valve.
S. Circulate the water and blow down the low point drains until all
of the drain water is clear. Add more condensate as necessary
to maintain the level in the TGCU Quench Column.
At some point during the washing procedure, the standby pump
should be placed in service while the other pump is shut down.
This will ensure cleaning out both pumps and their associated
piping.
T. Once the drain water is clear, completely drain the system.
Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the water
velocity helps to flush the solids from all parts of the system.
U. Allow the pump to continue running while the system drains, but
watch the pump closely to verify that the low-low level shutdown
shuts the pump down below the shutdown setpoint. If the level
drops completely out of the gauge glass before the pump shuts
down, stop the pump manually and correct the problem with the
low-low level shutdown before proceeding further.
V. Verify that the caustic supply line has been flushed and is ready
for service.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-82
11.7.6.2 Acid Wash
A weak (0.1 wt %) citric acid solution is used next to remove grease,
rust, and scale from the equipment and piping. The citric acid will
chelate with the iron in the rust and scale so that it dissolves in the
solution.
A. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish a level in the
TGCU Quench Column.
B. Once a level is established, start a TGCU Quench Water Pump
to begin circulating the water.
C. Add concentrated citric acid to the circulating water to make a
0.1 wt % citric acid solution.
D. After circulating for about 3 hours, start the other TGCU
Quench Water Pump and shut down the first one.
E. Circulate the solution for a total of about 6 hours, blowing down
the low point drains occasionally. Add more condensate if
necessary to maintain the level in the TGCU Quench Column.
F. Briefly open the bypass valve on the TGCU Quench Column
level control valve to flush this section of piping to The Sour
Water Stripping Unit. Then open both block valves and use the
level controller in the DCS to open the TGCU Quench Column
level control valve briefly and flush the control station. Close
the TGCU Quench Column level control valve and the block
valves.
G. After 6 hours, shut down the pump and completely drain the
system. Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the
liquid velocity will help flush any remaining solids from the
system.
11.7.6.3 Alkaline Wash
The washing operation is completed by circulating a weak alkaline
solution through the system. This will neutralize any citric acid left in
the system, and acclimate the system to high pH operation so that no
further scale is removed from the equipment and piping when the
normal quench water (8.0-9.5 pH) is circulated.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-83
A. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish a level in the
TGCU Quench Column.
B. Once a level is established, start a TGCU Quench Water Pump
to begin circulating the water.
C. Adjust a TGCU Caustic Injection Pump to full stroke. Open the
block valve at the tank, the suction block valve, and the
discharge block valve on the pump. Start the pump, then open
the block valve in the caustic line where it enters the suction
line to the TGCU Quench Water Pump.
D. Allow the pump to run for long enough to displace the water in
the caustic supply piping (left from the earlier water flush
procedure). Add caustic to the circulating water to make a
0.02 wt% solution. This should give a pH in the range of 11-22.
E. Shut off the TGCU Caustic Injection Pump, and close the block
valve in the caustic supply at the injection point in the quench
water piping.
F. Check the pH of the circulating water. If the pH is less than 11,
add more caustic from the caustic makeup line until the pH is
11 or higher.
G. After circulating for about 1 hour, start the other TGCU Quench
Water Pump and shut down the first one.
H. Circulate the solution for a total of about 2 hours, blowing down
the low point drains occasionally. Add more condensate if
necessary to maintain the level in the TGCU Quench Column.
I. Briefly open the bypass valve on the TGCU Quench Column
level control valve to flush this section of piping to the sour
water header. Then open both block valves and use the level
controller in the DCS to open the TGCU Quench Column level
control valve briefly and flush the control station. Close the
TGCU Quench Column level control valve and the block valves.
J. After 2 hours, shut down the pump and completely drain the
system. Drain the system as quickly as possible, so that the
liquid velocity will help flush any remaining solids from the
system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-84
11.7.6.4 Initial Water Fill
The quench water system should now be clean and ready to place in
service. All that remains is to refill the system with water and
establish the proper operating conditions. This includes
"pre-charging" the system with caustic to serve as a "buffer" so that
the system pH does not drop suddenly when process gas is first
introduced into the TGCU Quench Column and H
2
S from the gas
dissolves in the water.
A. Close the inlet and outlet block valves on the TGCU Quench
Water Filter, then install the proper element(s) in the filter.
Leave the block valves closed for now.
B. Close the inlet and outlet block valves on the pH analyzer
sample loop, then install the proper elements in both pH Meter
Sample Filters. Leave the block valves closed for now.
C. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish a level in the
TGCU Quench Column.
D. Once a level is established, start a TGCU Quench Water Pump
to begin circulating the water.
E. Place the Quench Water flow controller in the DCS in service
and set its setpoint to its normal value. Close the bypass valve
on the quench water flow control valve.
F. Confirm that the TGCU Quench Column level control valve is
closed, then open both of its block valves. Place the level
controller in the DCS in service and set its setpoint to its normal
value.
G. Place the TGCU Quench Water Filter in service as follows:
(1) Open the vent valve on the top of the filter.
(2) "Crack" the filter inlet block valve open slightly and allow
the filter to fill with water. When the filter is full, close the
vent valve.
(3) Open the filter inlet block valve fully and open the outlet
block valve, then close the filter bypass valve.
(4) Place the filtered quench water flow controller in the DCS
in service and set its setpoint to its normal value. Close
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-85
the bypass valve on the filtered quench water flow control
valve.
H. Adjust a TGCU Caustic Injection Pump to full stroke. Start the
pump, then open the block valve in the caustic line where it
enters the quench water piping.
I. Allow the pump to run for a few minutes until the pH of the
solution is in the range of 12-13.
J. Shut off the TGCU Caustic Injection Pump and close its suction
valve. Leave the block valve at the injection point in the quench
water piping open.
K. Install the pH analyzer probe in its housing in the sample loop,
following the manufacturer's instructions. Place the analyzer in
service by opening the block valves on one of the pH Meter
Sample Filters (the block valves should be closed on the other
filter) and opening the inlet and outlet valves on the sample
loop. Observe the flow indicator to verify flow through the
sample loop. Analyze a sample of the quench water to confirm
that the pH analyzer is measuring the correct pH.
L. Add additional caustic if necessary to adjust the pH to 11-13.
M. Commence cooling water flow to the TGCU Quench Water Trim
Cooler if it has not already been placed in service.
The quench water system is now ready for service. It can remain in
this operating mode indefinitely while the rest of the TGCU is
prepared for startup. Check the system periodically for indications of
plugging, etc. (low flow, erratic pump discharge pressure, high filter
pressure drop), as solid materials may accumulate at various points
in the system over time.
11.7.7 Washing the Amine System
The following procedure is intended to remove grease, rust, scale, dirt,
and trash from the equipment and piping in the solvent system before it is
placed in operation. Washing of the system consists of three steps: an
initial water flush to remove dirt and trash from the system; an acid wash
and rinse to remove grease, rust, and scale; and a weak amine wash and
rinse to acclimate the equipment and piping to alkaline pH.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-86
Failure to clean the system properly prior to startup can lead to operating
problems (column foaming, poor treating, heat exchanger fouling, rapid
filter plugging, etc.).
THIS PROCEDURE REQUIRES WORKING WITH ACIDIC AND
ALKALINE CHEMICALS AND SOLUTIONS. EMPLOYEES MUST
OBSERVE ALL APPLICABLE SAFETY PROCEDURES AND
ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS CONCERNING USAGE OF
PERSONAL PROTECTIVE EQUIPMENT, HANDLING OF
HAZARDOUS MATERIALS, DISPOSAL OF WASTE STREAMS, ETC.
11.7.7.1 Water Flush
A. Place the following controllers in the DCS in "manual" with their
outputs set as indicated:
(a) Set the output from the lean solvent flow controller to 100% to
fully open the lean solvent flow control valve.
(b) Open the manual block valve upstream of the lean solvent
filters.
(c) Set the output from the TGCU Contactor level controller to
100% to fully open the TGCU Contactor level control valve.
(d) Set the output from the TGCU Stripper Reboiler steam
flow controller to 0% to fully close the steam flow control valve.
(e) Set the output from the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator level controller to 0% to fully close the TGCU
Stripper Reflux Accumulator level control valve.
(f) Set the output from the bleed water flow controller to 0%
to fully close the bleed water flow control valve.
(g) Set the output from the makeup water flow controller to
0% to fully close the makeup water flow control valve.
(h) Set the output from the TGCU Stripper pressure
controller, to 0% to fully close the pressure control valve.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-87
B. Place the other TGCU Stripper pressure controller in
"automatic" with a setpoint of 0.85 kg/cm2(g). This will open the
pressure control valve to the flare if pressure builds in the
TGCU Stripper during this procedure.
C. Verify that the following control valves are fully open.
Open both of the isolation block valves and the bypass valve
(where applicable) at each control station.
(1) The lean solvent flow control.
(2) The lean solvent from the lean solvent filters.
(3) The TGCU Contactor level control, (the rich solvent from
the TGCU Contactor).
D. Verify that the following control valves are fully closed. Close
both of the isolation block valves and the bypass valve at each
control station.
(1) The steam flow control valve to the TGCU Stripper
Reboiler.
(2) The TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator level control
valve.
(3) The bleed water flow control valve from the TGCU Stripper
reflux.
(4) The makeup water flow control valve to the TGCU Stripper
Reflux Accumulator.
(5) The acid gas pressure control to the SRU.
E. Verify that the bypass valve on the pressure control valve to the
flare is closed. Open both of the isolation block valves at this
control station.
F. The TGCU solvent filters will not be used to filter solids during
this time, but the filter vessels and their piping are to be flushed
and cleaned. Remove the filter elements, then bolt-up the
individual filters. Open the inlet and outlet block valves on each
filter, and open the bypass valves for the filters.
G. Verify that the valves in the solvent makeup line are closed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-88
H. Add water (steam condensate) to the bottom of the TGCU
Contactor through the condensate makeup line.
I. Once there is an adequate level in the TGCU Contactor, all the
way to the top of its level gauge open the suction valve on a
TGCU Rich Amine Pump and use its drain valve to be sure the
pump is flooded with water. Start the pump, then open its
discharge valve.
Watch the level in the TGCU Contactor as the pump fills the
downstream piping and begins to fill the TGCU Stripper. When
the level drops to the low-low level shutdown should shut down
the pump. If it does not, stop the pump manually before it loses
suction and correct the problem with the low level shutdown
before proceeding.
J. Continue filling the TGCU Contactor with condensate and
pumping the water to the TGCU Stripper periodically, until the
level in the TGCU Stripper is all the way to the top of its level
gauge.
K. Once there is an adequate level in the TGCU Stripper, open the
suction valve on a TGCU Lean Amine Pump and use its drain
valve to be sure the pump is flooded with water. Start the
pump, then open its discharge valve.
As the pump fills the downstream piping and begins to return
water to the TGCU Contactor, watch the level in the TGCU
Stripper to be sure the pump does not lose suction. If the level
disappears in the column, shut the pump down, add more
condensate to the TGCU Contactor and pump it to the TGCU
Stripper to reestablish the level, then restart the TGCU Lean
Amine Pump.
L. As the level begins to rise in the TGCU Contactor, restart the
TGCU Rich Amine Pump. Watch the levels in both columns,
and shut a pump down if necessary to keep from emptying
either column.
M. Once the levels in both columns are adequate, discontinue the
addition of condensate.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-89
N. At this point, neither the flow into or the level of the TGCU
Contactor is being controlled. Both control stations are in
"manual" with the valves fully open to flush the piping as much
as possible. Depending on the hydraulics of the system, it may
be necessary to place either or both of these controls in
"automatic" to prevent losing the level in one of the columns. If
so, leave the bypass valve on the control station "cracked" so
that the bypass piping gets flushed.
O. Use the low point drain valves to flush out each section of the
system. Leave the drain valves open until the water is clear.
P. Circulate the water and blow down the low point drains until all
of the drain water is clear. Add more condensate as necessary
to maintain the levels in the columns.
At some point during the washing procedure, the standby
TGCU Rich Amine Pump and standby TGCU Lean Amine
Pump should be placed in service while the other pumps are
shut down. This will ensure cleaning out both pumps and their
associated piping in each service.
Q. Once the drain water is clear, shut down the TGCU Rich Amine
Pump and completely drain the system. Drain the system as
quickly as possible, so that the water velocity will help flush the
solids from all parts of the system.
R. Allow the TGCU Lean Amine Pump to continue running while
the system drains, but watch the pump closely to verify that the
low-low level shutdown shuts the pump down when the level
falls to the shutdown setpoint. If the level drops completely out
of the gauge glass before the pump shuts down, stop the pump
manually and correct the problem with the low level shutdown
before proceeding further.
S. Confirm that the solvent transfer line (for MDEA makeup) has
been flushed and is ready for service.
11.7.7.2 Acid Wash
A weak (0.1 wt %) citric acid solution is used next to remove grease,
rust, and scale from the equipment and piping. The citric acid will
chelate with the iron in the rust and scale so that it dissolves in the
solution.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-90
A. Use the condensate makeup line to re-establish the levels in
the TGCU Contactor and the TGCU Stripper as before, and
establish circulation of water in the system.
B. Add concentrated citric acid to the circulating water to make a
0.1 wt % citric acid solution.
C. Begin steam flow to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler and gradually
raise the temperature of the circulating solution. For maximum
effectiveness, the solution should be 65-95C throughout the
system, so adjust the steam flow accordingly. The fans on the
TGCU Lean Amine Cooler should not be operating at this time,
and cooling water should not be flowing to the TGCU Lean
Amine Trim Cooler.
D. It is unlikely that any steam will leave the top of the TGCU
Stripper during this operation, so the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator should remain dry. If a level should develop in this
vessel, drain the water from the vessel using a drain valve on
one of the TGCU Stripper Reflux Pumps.
E. After circulating for about 3 hours, start the other TGCU Rich
Amine Pump and shut down the first one. Do the same with the
TGCU Lean Amine Pumps.
F. Circulate the hot solution for a total of about 6 hours, blowing
down the low point drains occasionally. Add more condensate
if necessary to maintain the levels in the columns.
G. After 6 hours, shut off the steam to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler,
shut down the pumps, and completely drain the system. Drain
the system as quickly as possible, so that the liquid velocity will
help flush any remaining solids from the system.
H. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
TGCU Contactor and the TGCU Stripper as before, and
establish circulation of water to flush the system.
I. Switch to the other pumps for a few minutes, then shut down
the pumps and completely drain the system.
J. Once again, use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the
levels in the TGCU Contactor and the TGCU Stripper as before,
and establish circulation of water in the system.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-91
K. Reestablish steam flow to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler and
gradually raise the temperature in the column.
L. When the temperature begins to rise in the TGCU Stripper
overhead line, start a fan on the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Condenser and place the reflux temperature controller in
service with a setpoint of 54C.
M. When a level builds in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator,
drain it to the closed drain from the drain on one of the pump
cases.
N. Open the downstream block valve at the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator level control valve, then use the drain valve to
blow steam from the column backwards down the reflux line to
remove any debris. Continue until the steam blows clear, then
close the drain valve and the block valve.
O. Continue to circulate water and apply heat in the TGCU Stripper
Reboiler, until the water drained from the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator is clear. During this time, blow down the low point
drains occasionally and add more condensate if necessary to
maintain the levels in the columns, and switch to the other
TGCU Rich Amine Pump and TGCU Lean Amine Pump.
P. Once the reflux loop has cleared up (the drain water is clear),
shut off the steam to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler, shut down
the pumps, and completely drain the system. Drain the system
as quickly as possible, so that the liquid velocity will help flush
any remaining solids from the system.
Q. Check the pH of the water draining from the system. If
necessary, repeat Steps J through P until the pH of the drain
water is about the same as the pH of the condensate makeup.
11.7.7.3 Weak Amine Wash
The washing operation is completed by circulating a weak amine
solution through the system. This will neutralize any citric acid left in
the system, and acclimate the system to alkaline pH operation so
that no further scale is removed from the equipment and piping when
the normal solvent is circulated.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-92
A. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
TGCU Contactor and the TGCU Stripper as before, and
establish circulation of water in the system.
B. Add enough MDEA to the circulating water to reach a
concentration of about 1 wt%.
C. Begin steam flow to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler and gradually
raise the temperature in the column.
D. When the temperature begins to rise in the TGCU Stripper
overhead line, check that at least one of the fans is running on
the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser.
E. When a level builds in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator,
open the suction valve on one of the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Pumps and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded
with water. Start the pump, open its discharge valve, then open
the bypass valve on the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator
level control valve to pump the water back into the TGCU
Stripper.
Watch the level in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator while
pumping it out. Shut the pump down when the vessel is empty,
then close the suction and discharge valves on the pump and
close the bypass valve on the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator level control valve.
F. Continue to circulate the solution and apply heat to the TGCU
Stripper Reboiler, pumping out the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator as required by alternating which pump is used.
During this time, blow down the low point drains occasionally
and add more condensate if necessary to maintain the levels in
the columns, and switch to the other TGCU Rich Amine Pump
and TGCU Lean Amine Pump.
G. During one of the pumping cycles for the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator, flush out the minimum flow spill-back line by
opening the manual block valve to allow circulation through this
line. Then close the manual block valve.
H. During another pumping cycle, flush out the bleed water piping
by setting the output of the bleed water flow controller to 100%
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-93
to fully open the bleed water flow control valve, opening its
upstream and downstream block valves, and opening its
bypass valve. Then close the valves and set the output of the
bleed water flow control valve back to 0%.
I. Take a sample of the circulating solution and run a foam test on
it using the procedure in Section 11.10.
J. Once the solution drained from all the low point drain valves is
clear, shut off the steam to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler, shut
down the pumps, and completely drain the system. Drain the
system as quickly as possible, so that the liquid velocity will
help flush any remaining solids from the system.
K. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
TGCU Contactor and the TGCU Stripper as before, and
establish circulation of water to flush the system.
L. Switch to the other pumps for a few minutes, then shut down
the pumps and completely drain the system.
M. If the solvent sample taken in Step I was foamy, repeat Steps A
through L until the solvent is not foamy.
11.7.7.4 Initial Solvent Fill
The solvent system should now be clean, ready to place in service.
All that remains is to fill the system with the proper solvent charge
and establish the proper operating conditions.
NOTE: This procedure prepares the TGCU solvent system for
operation in the shortest possible time. However, it does
allow the MDEA to come in contact with oxygen that is in
the TGCU Contactor. If a slightly longer TGCU startup
schedule can be tolerated, this deficiency can be
minimized or eliminated by deferring the procedure in this
section until nitrogen has been used to purge the TGCU
Quench Column and TGCU Contactor as described in the
following section.
A. Close the inlet and outlet block valves on the four TGCU
solvent filters, then install the proper elements and/or carbon in
the filters. Leave the block valves closed on each filter for now.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-94
B. Use the condensate makeup line to reestablish the levels in the
TGCU Contactor and the TGCU Stripper as before, and
establish circulation of water in the system.
C. Add enough MDEA to the circulating water to reach a
concentration of about 45 wt%.
D. Place in service and adjust the level controller on the TGCU
Contactor to maintain its normal setpoint. Stop the condensate
and/or amine makeup when the TGCU Stripper level is about
50-60%.
E. Begin steam flow to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler and gradually
raise the temperature in the column. Place the steam flow
controller in the DCS on "automatic" with its setpoint set to its
normal value.
F. Open the high point vent valve on the TGCU Stripper overhead
line and allow the steam to purge any air from the vessel. As
the pressure builds, the vent valve can be closed.
G. Monitor the stripper pressure, and adjust the overhead pressure
controller if necessary to maintain the stripper pressure at about
0.85 kg/cm
2
(g) as the system is heated to operating
temperatures.
H. Ensure that the fans are running on the TGCU Lean Amine
Cooler and the TGCU Stripper Condenser. Commence cooling
water flow to the TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler.
I. Place the lean solvent temperature controller in "automatic" and
set its setpoint to its normal value.
J. When a level builds in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator,
open the suction valve on one of the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Pumps and use its drain valve to be sure the pump is flooded
with water. Open the block valves upstream and downstream
of the reflux flow control valve, place the reflux flow controller in
"automatic" with its setpoint set to its normal value, then start
the pump and open its discharge valve.
K. Open the block valves on the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Accumulator level control valve and place the level controller in
the DCS in "automatic" with its setpoint set to its normal value.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-95
The TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator level control valve will
now open as needed to pump water back into the TGCU
Stripper and maintain the desired level in the TGCU Stripper
Reflux Accumulator.
L. If the control loops on the TGCU solvent have not already been
placed in service, do so at this time. Switch the TGCU
contactor level controller and the lean solvent flow controller in
the DCS to "automatic" with their setpoints set to their normal
values.
M. Place each of the four TGCU solvent filters in service as
follows:
(1) Open the vent valve on the top of the filter.
(2) "Crack" the filter inlet block valve open slightly and allow
the filter to fill with solvent. When the filter is full, close its
vent valve.
(3) Open the inlet and outlet block valves on the filter.
(4) Slowly close the valve in the bypass line around the filter.
N. Analyze a sample of the circulating solvent using the procedure
in these guidelines to determine the amine concentration. Add
more fresh MDEA using the solvent transfer line if needed to
bring the concentration up to the design value, 45 wt %.
O. Flush the makeup water line by setting the output from the
makeup water flow controller to 100% to fully open the makeup
water flow control valve, opening its upstream block valve, then
opening the downstream drain valve until the water runs clear.
Then set the output of the flow controller to 0% to close the
makeup water flow control valve, and open the downstream
block valve.
P. Confirm that the bleed water flow controller is in "manual' with
its output set at 0% and that the bleed water flow control valve
is closed, then open its upstream and downstream block valves.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-96
The solvent system is now ready for service. It can remain in this
operating mode indefinitely while the rest of the TGCU is prepared
for startup. Check the system periodically for indications of plugging,
etc. (low flow, erratic pump discharge pressure, high filter pressure
drop), as solid materials may accumulate at various points in the
system over time.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-97
11.7.8 Purging the Low Pressure TGCU Columns
Prior to starting up the TGCU using the procedures in Section 11.8 of
these guidelines, nitrogen should be used to purge the TGCU Quench
Column and the TGCU Contactor. This will displace the air introduced
into the columns while washing and filling them earlier.
At this point, the following conditions should exist in the TGCU:
1. The TGCU Start-Up Blower is not in service and is bypassed.
2. The quench water system and perhaps the amine system have
been cleaned and loaded with their respective initial fills of water
and amine. (The amine system may be waiting on purging of the
TGCU Contactor before the system is loaded with amine.)
11.7.8.1 Establishing Nitrogen Flow
To establish nitrogen flow into the TGCU, proceed as follows:
A. Confirm that the nitrogen flow controller in the DCS is set to 0%
output and that the control valve in the nitrogen supply line is
closed.
B. Confirm that the Quench Column inlet hand control in the DCS
is set to 0% output so that the TGCU Quench Column Bypass
Valve will open later in Step F when the Startup/Run selector
switch is switched to "STARTUP".
C. Confirm that the TGCU Quench Column is isolated from the
quench water circulation loop by confirming that the following
valves are all closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the
quench water flow control valve.
(2) The block valve downstream of the pH analyzer.
(3) The suction valves at the TGCU Quench Water Pumps.
(4) The drain valve on the suction line to the pumps.
(5) The block valve in the caustic supply line at the tie-in to
the suction line.
(6) The block valve in the condensate fill line at the tie-in to
the suction line.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-98
(7) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the
filtered quench water flow control valve.
D. Confirm that the TGCU Contactor is isolated from the solvent
circulation loop by confirming that the following valves are all
closed:
(1) The bypass valve and downstream block valve at the lean
solvent flow control valve.
(2) The suction valves at the TGCU Rich Amine Pumps.
(3) The drain valve on the suction line to pumps.
(4) The block valves in the solvent makeup line at the tie-in to
the suction line.
(5) The block valve and globe valve in the condensate
makeup line at the tie-in to the suction line.
E. Confirm that the spectacle blind in the utility air supply line is in
the "closed" position.
F. Toggle the Startup/Run selector switch, the Startup/Run
selector switch, in the DCS to "STARTUP".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Bypasses the SRU ESD inputs to the TGCU ESD.
(2) Disables the Tailgas Valves transfer switches.
(3) Opens the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve.
(4) Enables the Leak Test Switch.
G. Confirm that the SRU Tailgas Valves to the TGCU are closed.
H. Confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve is fully
open.
I. Confirm that the block valve(s), and the steam-jacketed block
valve in the nitrogen supply line are open.
J. Confirm that the TGCU Outlet Valve is open.
K. Reset the TGCU ESD by toggling the push-button in the DCS to
"RESET".
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-99
L. Set the output of the hand control in the DCS to 0% to close the
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
M. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens the nitrogen block valves.
(2) Closes the nitrogen vent valve.
N. Use the nitrogen flow controller in the DCS to open the nitrogen
flow control valve and send nitrogen to the front end of the
TGCU.
O. Allow the nitrogen to continue flowing long enough to reduce
the oxygen concentration in the equipment and piping to less
than 1%. Use a portable oxygen analyzer to determine the
oxygen concentration.
11.7.8.2 Purging the TGCU Start-Up Blower
A. Visually confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower suction block
valve and the discharge block valve are closed, the bypass
valve is open, the nitrogen purge to the blower seal is in
service, and the local "stop" control at the bloweris set to the
"RUN" position.
B. Start the TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop toggle
switch in the DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The nitrogen purge valveis closed.
(2) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Suction Valve is opened.
(3) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Discharge Valve is opened.
(4) After the limit switches prove these valves open, the
TGCU Start-Up Blower is started.
(5) Once the Startup Blower is started, the TGCU Start-Up
Blower Bypass Valve is closed.
C. As this valve is closed, the blower will start to load. As it does
so, the blower will begin to "pull" nitrogen through the TGCU
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-100
Reactor Feed Heater and TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer and all of
the associated piping.
D. Allow the blower to continue running long enough to reduce the
oxygen concentration in the piping to less than 1%. Use a
portable oxygen analyzer to determine the oxygen
concentration.
E. When the oxygen concentration is below 1%, shut down the
TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop toggle switch in the
DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) Open the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve.
(2) Prove the bypass valve open using the limit switches.
(3) Stop the TGCU Start-Up Blower
(4) Once the blower is stopped, the nitrogen purge valve is
opened, and the suction and discharge valves are closed.
11.7.8.3 Purging the Columns
All that remains is to open the vent valves on the low pressure
columns and allow the inert gas to displace the air in the columns.
A. Open all of the vent valves on the PI and PDT taps on the
TGCU Quench Column and the TGCU Contactor, and the vent
valves at the tops of the columns.
B. Increase the output from the Quench Column inlet hand control
in the DCS to 100% to open the TGCU Quench Column Inlet
Valve and close the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve.
C. Continue to vent inert gas until no measurable oxygen escapes
from the vents, then close all of the vent valves.
D. Decrease the output from the Quench Column inlet hand
control in the DCS to 0% to open the TGCU Quench Column
Bypass Valve and close the TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve.
E. Set the output from the nitrogen flow controller to 0% to close
the nitrogen flow control valve.
F. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "OFF".
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-101
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Closes the nitrogen block valves.
(2) Opens the nitrogen vent valve.
NOTE: If the initial solvent fill was not loaded into the solvent
system earlier to avoid exposing the MDEA to oxygen, this
can be accomplished now. Follow the procedure given in
the previous section to fill the solvent system with its initial
solvent charge.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-102
11.8 Startup Procedures
The procedure used to start up the TGCU depends on whether the catalyst in
the TGCU Reactor has been pre-sulfided. This first section describes the
procedure for the initial startup of the plant with a fresh catalyst charge (oxidized
state), or for startups after the catalyst charge has been replaced. Subsequent
startups will require a different procedure and are discussed later (Section
11.8.6 of these guidelines).
11.8.1 Initial Startup of the TGCU
During the initial startup, the catalyst in the TGCU Reactor is pre-sulfided
by contacting it with H
2
S in the presence of hydrogen. Subsequent
startups will probably not require this step. Once this has been
accomplished, the system can be placed into operation.
11.8.1.1 Initial Preparations
A. Confirm that the steam pressure controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0%, and that control valve in the
HP Steam supply line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater is
closed.
B. Place the reactor feed temperature controller in "automatic".
C. Confirm that reducing gas flow controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0%, and that the control valve in
the reducing gas supply line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer
is closed.
D. Place the hydrogen controller in "automatic".
E. Verify that the automated shutdown valves, the upstream block
valves, and the downstream steam-jacketed block valve in the
reducing gas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer are all
closed.
F. Confirm that the pre-sulfiding gas flow controller in the DCS is
in "manual" with its output set to 0%, and that the control valve
in the pre-sulfiding gas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer is
closed.
G. Verify that the automated shutdown valve and the upstream
block valve in the pre-sulfiding gas line to the TGCU Reactor
Feed Mixer are both closed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-103
H. Confirm that the nitrogen flow controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0% output, and that the control
valve in the nitrogen supply line is closed.
I. Verify that the automated shutdown valves in the nitrogen
supply line are both closed, then open the upstream block
valves and the downstream steam-jacketed block valve.
J. Confirm that the Quench Column hand control in the DCS is set
to 0% output, so that the TGCU Quench Column inlet valve will
remain fully closed and the TGCU Quench Column bypass
valve will open later when the TGCU startup/run selector switch
is switched to "STARTUP".
K. Confirm that the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer is filled with
water up to its normal liquid level.
L. Visually confirm that the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is
closed.
M. Visually confirm that the SRU 2 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is
closed.
N. Visually confirm that the manual TGCU Outlet Valve is fully
open.
O. Confirm that the Leak Test switch in the DCS is toggled to
"OFF".
P. Confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve is fully
open.
Q. Verify that the local stop control for the TGCU Start-Up Blower
is set to the run position.
11.8.1.2 Establishing Nitrogen Flow
To establish nitrogen flow into the TGCU, proceed as follows:
A. Toggle the Startup/Run selector switch in the DCS to
"STARTUP".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Bypasses the SRU ESD inputs to the TGCU ESD.
(2) Disables the Tailgas Valve transfer switchs.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-104
(3) Opens the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve.
B. Reset the TGCU ESD by toggling the switch in the DCS to
"RESET".
C. Set the output of the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve hand control
in the DCS to 0% to close the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve
and visually confirm that the valve is closed.
D. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens the nitrogen block valves.
(2) Closes the nitrogen vent valve.
E. Increase the output of the flow controller to 100% in the DCS to
open the control valve and send nitrogen to the front-end of the
TGCU.
F. Allow the nitrogen to purge the front-end of the TGCU for 15
minutes before proceeding to the next step.
11.8.1.3 Establishing Re-circulation Flow
Prior to pre-sulfiding the catalyst in the TGCU Reactor, it is
necessary to heat the reactor and catalyst up to 150-175C. To do
this, nitrogen is re-circulated through the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
with the TGCU Start-Up Blower. This re-circulating gas is heated
using HP steam in the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, then flows
through the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer, the TGCU Reactor, and the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer bringing the reactor, catalyst, and
process heat exchange surfaces up to operating temperature.
A. Visually confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower suction block
valve and the discharge block valve are closed, the bypass
valve is open, the nitrogen purge to the blower seal is in
service, and the local "stop" control at the blower is set to the
run position.
B. Start the TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop toggle
switch in the DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The nitrogen purge valve is closed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-105
(2) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Suction Valve is opened.
(3) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Discharge Valve is opened.
(4) After the limit switches prove these valves open, the
TGCU Start-Up Blower is started.
(5) Once the Startup Blower is started, the TGCU Start-Up
Blower Bypass Valve is closed.
As this valve is closed, the blower will start to load. As it does
so, the blower will begin to "pull" nitrogen through the front-end
TGCU equipment and all of the associated piping.
C. Once the blower is running, open the TGCU Warmup/Bypass
Valve by increasing the output from the hand control to 100%.
As the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve opens, the TGCU
Start-Up Blower will begin re-circulating gas from the outlet of
the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer back to the TGCU Reactor
Feed Heater (via the TGCU Contactor overhead line).
D. Once re-circulation has been established, place the nitrogen
flow controller in "automatic" and reduce its setpoint to about
5-10% of maximum flow.
E. Slowly begin to increase the setpoint of the steam pressure
controller in the DCS to establish steam flow to the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater and increase the temperature of the
re-circulating gas stream to 150-175C.
F. Open the vent valve on the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer to
vent air from the steam section.
G. Confirm that the BFW level controller and control valve to the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer are in service and functioning
properly.
H. Place the reactor feed temperature cascade control in service
as follows:
(1) Confirm that the remote setpoint that the reactor feed
temperature controller is supplying to the pressure
controller matches the current setting on the pressure
controller.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-106
(2) Confirm that the reactor feed temperature controller is in
"automatic" and its setpoint is tracking its current reading.
(3) Switch the steam pressure controller to "cascade" so that
the temperature controller can now adjust the setpoint on
the pressure controller.
(4) If necessary, slowly adjust the setpoint of the reactor feed
temperature controller to 175C.
(5) Verify that the steam pressure controller is adjusting the
HP steam pressure as needed to control the desired
temperature setting on the reactor feed temperature
controller.
I. As the equipment and piping heat up, inspect all of the
equipment and piping for the effects of thermal expansion.
J. As the steam pressure builds in the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer, close the vent valve on the steam space. The steam
pressure inside the boiler will now be "floating" on the LP steam
header.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-107
11.8.2 Pre-Sulfiding the TGCU Catalyst
Before introducing sulfur plant tailgas into the TGCU, the catalyst in the
TGCU Reactor must be "pre-sulfided" to convert the metals (cobalt and
molybdenum) from their inactive oxide state to their active sulfide state.
Once the catalyst has been pre-sulfided, it will remain in its active state
and will not require pre-sulfiding on subsequent startups. Only when the
catalyst is replaced will this pre-sulfiding procedure have to be repeated.
The catalyst is pre-sulfided by contacting it with H
2
S in the presence of
hydrogen. The amount of H
2
S must be controlled at a low concentration
to limit the temperature rise as the catalyst reacts with the sulfur, so that
excessively high temperatures are not created that could damage the
catalyst or the equipment. The catalyst will end up containing about
6 wt % sulfur at the conclusion of this procedure.
Before beginning, the following conditions should exist in the TGCU:
1. The outlet temperature from the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater is
on automatic control, maintaining about 175C.
2. The nitrogen flow controller is in "automatic" with its set point set
at 5-10% of maximum flow to add a small amount of fresh
nitrogen to the system.
3. The TGCU Start-Up Blower is in service, re-circulating nitrogen
to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater.
4. The Amine Regeneration Unit is operating and producing acid
gas. The H
2
S in this acid gas will be used to pre-sulfide the
TGCU catalyst.
Also, ensure that there is an adequate supply on hand (one or two boxes)
of gas detector tubes for measuring the H
2
S concentration into and out of
the TGCU Reactor. Sections 9.10.8 and 11.10.7 of these guidelines
describe how Drger tubes can be used to measure the H
2
S
concentration of a gas stream. The H
2
S concentration will probably be in
the range of 1-2%, so Drger Catalog No. CH 281 01 gas detector tubes
are appropriate.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-108
11.8.2.1 Establishing Reducing Gas Flow
Before introducing H
2
S into the TGCU Reactor, reducing gas must
be added to the re-circulating gas stream.
A. Confirm that the reducing gas controller in the DCS is set to 0%
output and that the control valve in the reducing gas supply line
is closed.
B. Prior to placing the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer in service, be sure that its
sample line does not contain any water, etc.:
(1) Close the sample valve on the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer outlet channel.
(2) Disconnect the sample line from the sample valve and
from the 2-way analyzer sample switching valve. Drain any
water from the line and check that it is not plugged, then
reinstall the sample line.
(3) Repeat Step (2) for the other sample line (connected to
the sample valve on the TGCU Contactor overhead line).
(4) Switch the sample selector valve in the analyzer enclosure
so that the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer takes its sample from the
TGCU Contactor overhead line, and use the zero and
span gas to confirm the calibration of the analyzer. Make
any necessary adjustments to the analyzer per the
manufacturer's instructions.
(5) Switch the sample selector valve in the analyzer enclosure
so that the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer takes its sample from the
outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, then open the
sample valve. The hydrogen analyzer will now be
sampling the process gas, as indicated by the reading on
the hydrogen controller in the DCS, while the other sample
line on the TGCU Contactor overhead line is now being
back-purged with nitrogen.
C. Open the upstream manual block valves and the
steam-jacketed block valve in the reducing gas supply line to
the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-109
D. To begin introducing reducing gas into the circulating gas
stream, toggle the Reducing Gas On/Off switch in the DCS to
"ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens the reducing gas block valves.
(2) Closes the reducing gas vent valve.
E. Switch the reducing gas controller to "automatic" and slowly
begin to increase its setpoint to open the control valve and
begin introducing reducing gas into the re-circulating stream.
As the reducing gas flow rate increases, the hydrogen
concentration displayed on the hydrogen controller will
increase.
F. The reducing gas concentration should be 0.5-5% while
pre-sulfiding. If necessary, adjust the setpoint on the reducing
gas controller to control the reading in this range.
NOTE: It is important to control the hydrogen concentration
within this range while pre-sulfiding the catalyst. A
hydrogen reading lower than this could mean that a
reducing atmosphere is not being maintained inside
the TGCU Reactor to insure that the H
2
S properly
sulfides the catalyst. Conversely, too much hydrogen
can damage the catalyst by reacting with the cobalt
and molybdenum to form inactive metal hydrides.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-110
DO NOT ALLOW HYDROGEN TO CONTACT THE TGCU
CATALYST AT TEMPERATURES ABOVE 200C IN THE
ABSENCE OF H
2
S. IF THERE IS NO H
2
S PRESENT, THE
HYDROGEN WILL REACT IRREVERSIBLY WITH THE
CATALYST TO FORM INACTIVE METAL HYDRIDES. IF ANY
DELAYS ARE ENCOUNTERED IN INTRODUCING H
2
S, STOP
THE FLOW OF REDUCING GAS UNTIL READY TO RESUME.
G. As described in previous sections of these guidelines, the
hydrogen controller can adjust the flow of hydrogen to the
TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer to control the hydrogen
concentration, via the limit relay. Place the hydrogen
concentration cascade control in service as follows:
(1) Confirm that the remote setpoint that the hydrogen
controller is supplying to the reducing gas flow controller in
the DCS matches the current setting on the flow controller.
(2) Confirm that the hydrogen controller is in "automatic" and
its setpoint is tracking its current reading.
(3) Switch the reducing gas controller to "cascade" so that the
concentration controller can now adjust the setpoint of the
flow controller.
(4) If necessary, slowly adjust the setpoint of the hydrogen
controller to 2%.
H. Periodically check that the hydrogen controller and the reducing
gas controller maintain the hydrogen concentration in the
proper range (0.5-5%) throughout the pre-sulfiding operation.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-111
11.8.2.2 Pre-Sulfiding the Catalyst
The sulfur for pre-sulfiding the TGCU catalyst comes from H
2
S in the
amine acid gas produced by the Amine Regeneration Unit. The
amount of acid gas entering the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer is to be
adjusted to give an H
2
S concentration of about 1-2% going into the
TGCU Reactor. Gas detector tubes can be used to measure the H
2
S
concentration in the inlet and outlet from the TGCU Reactor. When
the outlet H
2
S concentration is essentially the same as the inlet
concentration, then the catalyst has absorbed all the sulfur that it can
and pre-sulfiding is complete at that temperature level.
A. Confirm that the pre-sulfiding gas flow controller in the DCS is
set to 0% output, and that the control valve in the pre-sulfiding
gas supply line is closed.
B. Verify that the automated shutdown valve, and the manual
block valves in the pre-sulfiding gas supply line are closed.
Rotate the spectacle blind to the open position, then briefly
open the drain valve to verify that there are no liquids in the line
between the control valve and the shutdown valve.
C. Open the manual block valves in the pre-sulfiding gas line.
D. Toggle the Pre-sulfiding Gas On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should open the automated pre-sulfiding gas block
valve.
E. Place the pre-sulfiding gas flow controller in "automatic" and
increase its setpoint to slowly open the control valve and allow
a small flow of acid gas into the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer.
Adjust the setpoint as necessary to give an H
2
S concentration
of 1-2% (measured with the gas detector tubes) in the inlet to
the TGCU Reactor.
F. Using the reactor feed temperature controller in the DCS, slowly
raise the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature stepwise to 200C
while maintaining the H
2
S concentration in the inlet at 1-2% and
the hydrogen concentration indicated on the hydrogen controller
at 0.5-5%.
Look for signs that the H
2
S has begun to react with the catalyst
(i.e. the temperatures in the reactor begin to rise). If no
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-112
temperature rise is seen in the TGCU Reactor, proceed to
Step I.
IF EXCESSIVE CATALYST BED TEMPERATURES OCCUR AT
ANY TIME ON THE REACTOR BED TEMPERATURE
INDICATORS IN THE DCS, REDUCE THE AMOUNT OF H
2
S IN
THE REACTOR INLET. THE TEMPERATURE RISE IN THE
REACTOR IS DUE TO THE HEAT OF REACTION FROM H
2
S
REACTING WITH THE CATALYST. REDUCING THE H
2
S
CONCENTRATION WILL REDUCE THE REACTION RATE AND
REDUCE THE TEMPERATURE RISE ACCORDINGLY.
DO NOT REDUCE THE H
2
S CONCENTRATION TO ZERO,
HOWEVER. THIS WOULD ALLOW HYDROGEN TO REACT
WITH THE CATALYST AND DAMAGE IT AS DISCUSSED
PREVIOUSLY.
G. Once the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature reaches 200C,
maintain this temperature while sampling the H
2
S concentration
in the inlet and outlet of the reactor.
H. When the outlet H
2
S concentration is approximately equal to the
inlet concentration, pre-sulfiding is complete at this temperature
level.
I. Increase the inlet temperature stepwise to 230C with the
reactor feed temperature controller.
J. Once the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature reaches 230C,
maintain this temperature while sampling the H
2
S concentration
in the inlet and outlet of the reactor. When the outlet H
2
S
concentration is approximately equal to the inlet concentration,
pre-sulfiding is complete at this temperature level.
K. Increase the inlet temperature stepwise to 260C with the
reactor feed temperature controller.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-113
After the entire bed reaches 260C, hold it at this temperature
for 4 hours. Monitor the catalyst bed temperatures and the
TGCU Reactor outlet temperature through the temperature
indicators in the DCS carefully as the reaction front moves
through the bed. Do not allow any of these temperatures to
exceed 340C, by reducing the inlet temperature and/or the
inlet H
2
S concentration as necessary.
L. At the conclusion of the 4 hour heat soak at 260C, the H
2
S
concentration should be the same in the outlet gas as it is in the
inlet gas. If not, continue to hold the inlet at 260C until the
concentrations are equal.
M. The catalyst is now in its active state. Discontinue the flow of
pre-sulfiding gas by reducing the setpoint of the pre-sulfiding
gas flow controller to 0%. Toggle the Pre-sulfiding Gas On/Off
switch in the DCS to "OFF" to close the block valve and visually
confirm that the valve is closed.
N. Close the manual block valves in the pre-sulfiding gas supply
line.
THE PRE-SULFIDING LINE WILL NOT BE USED AGAIN
UNTIL THE CATALYST IN THE TGCU REACTOR IS
REPLACED AND A FRESH CHARGE CATALYST MUST
BE PRE-SULFIDED. TO MINIMIZE THE CHANCE OF
INADVERTENTLY SENDING AMINE ACID GAS TO THE
TGCU REACTOR FEED HEATER, IT IS RECOMMENDED
THAT THE SPECTACLE BLIND BE ROTATED BACK TO
THE CLOSED POSITION AT THIS TIME.
O. Slowly lower the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature to its normal
value by adjusting the setpoint of the reactor feed temperature
controller.
P. Slowly adjust the setpoint of the hydrogen controller to its
normal values (3%). Verify that the reducing gas flow controller
is adjusting the rate accordingly.
The TGCU can continue operating in this manner indefinitely
until ready to bring SRU tailgas into the unit. During this time,
observe the temperatures in the TGCU Reactor and the
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-114
hydrogen concentration on the hydrogen controller to be sure
that these control loops are operating properly. Also, continue
to observe the operation of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer to
ensure that no problems develop in this boiler, and monitor the
operation of the TGCU Start-Up Blower.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-115
11.8.3 Routing SRU Tailgas to the TGCU
The TGCU is now ready to accept tailgas from the SRUs. At first, the
tailgas will be routed through just the front-end of the TGCU (TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater, TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer, TGCU Reactor, and
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer). Then, once this part of the process has
lined out, the process gas will be switched into the TGCU Quench
Column and the TGCU Contactor.
Before beginning, the following conditions should exist in the TGCU:
1. The Reactor Feed Heater is operating smoothly and the inlet
temperature to the TGCU Reactor is being controlled at
230-240C.
2. The TGCU Reactor is up to normal operating temperature and its
catalyst has been pre-sulfided.
3. The TGCU Start-Up Blower is in service, re-circulating nitrogen
to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater.
4. The H
2
/H
2
S analyzer has been calibrated and is sampling the
process gas leaving the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer.
5. The hydrogen controller is controlling the hydrogen at or above
the normal setpoint
6. One or both SRUs are operating smoothly on amine acid gas, or
amine acid gas and SWS gas, and the air demand indicated on
the air control is +2.0% or lower. (If the air demand is higher
than this, the tailgas from the SRU contains excessive amounts
of SO
2
and could cause overheating of the TGCU Reactor.)
If any of these conditions are not true, do not attempt to bring SRU tailgas
into the TGCU. In particular, do not attempt switching tailgas into the
TGCU when the SRU(s) is(are) experiencing an upset. The result will
be multiple upset units to deal with. Instead, focus your attention on
stabilizing the operation of the SRU(s) first (usually by correcting a
problem in the upstream Amine Regeneration and/or Sour Water Stripper
units), and then use the procedure that follows to establish tailgas flow
into the TGCU.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-116
11.8.3.1 Introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Scenario 1
The first scenario to consider for introducing tailgas into the TGCU is
a normal startup of the SRUs and the TGCU. Before being routed to
the TGCU, the tailgas from both SRUs is sent to the TTO while the
TGCU uses the TGCU Startup Blower to re-circulate gas to the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater via the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
Once the TGCU is warmed up and ready to accept tailgas, the
Train 1 and Train 2 SRUs can be routed to the TGCU as follows
(using the Train 1 SRU for this procedure).
A. Confirm that the hydrogen controller is in "automatic" and controlling
the hydrogen concentration at or above its normal setpoint, (3%).
B. Toggle the SRU 1 "fast" transfer switch in the DCS, to "TRANSFER TO
TGCU".
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is opened.
(2) After the limit switches prove this valve open, the SRU 1
Tailgas Valve to the TTO is closed.
Visually confirm that these valves have moved to the proper
positions.
At this point, the tailgas from SRU 1 can flow to the TTO via either of
two routes:
(1) Through the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU and then
through the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
(2) Through the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU and then
through the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, the TGCU Reactor,
the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, and the TGCU Start-Up
Blower.
C. If the second SRU (Train 2) is also ready to send its tailgas to the
TGCU, toggle the SRU 2 "fast" transfer switch in the DCS to repeat
these actions for the other SRU.
For this scenario, the opening and closing of Tailgas Valves to the
TGCU and the Tailgas Valves to the TTO in Steps B and C can
occur rapidly with no impact on either the SRU or the TGCU. This is
because the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve will still be open at this
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-117
time, so there will be very little differential pressure across the
Tailgas Valves to the TGCU and there will not be an abrupt change
in pressure when the Tailgas Valves to the TGCU are opened or
when the Tailgas Valves to the TTO are closed.
Note: The fast transfer switches can also be used to take the
Train 1 SRU and/or Train 2 SRU tailgas out of the TGCU.
Every other toggle of these selector switches will take the
opposite action to open the tailgas valve to the TTO and
then close the tailgas valve to the TGCU.
In the next step, the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve is closed to force
the process gas to take the second path, so that the TGCU Start-Up
Blower can be shut down.
D. Slowly reduce the output from the hand control to 0% to close the
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
Now all of the SRU tailgas must flow through the TGCU Reactor
Feed Heater, etc. as this is the only open flowpath to the TTO.
E. With the SRU tailgas flowing through the TGCU Reactor Feed
Heater, the re-circulation from the TGCU Start-Up Blower is no
longer needed.
Shut down the TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop selector
switch in the DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The TGCU Start-Up Blower bypass valve is opened and proved
open.
(2) The TGCU Start-Up Blower is stopped.
(3) The nitrogen purge valve is opened.
(4) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Suction Valve and the TGCU
Start-Up Blower Discharge Valve are closed.
Confirm that these valves have moved to the proper positions and
that the blower has stopped.
F. Place the nitrogen flow controller in "manual" and set its output to 0%
to close the control valve and stop the flow of nitrogen into the
TGCU.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-118
G. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "OFF".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Closes nitrogen blocks.
(2) Opens nitrogen vent valve.
H. Close the downstream steam-jacketed block valve in the nitrogen
supply line where it joins the tailgas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed
Mixer.
I. Allow the TGCU to operate in this fashion until all operating
conditions are stable. In particular, observe the operation of the
reactor feed temperature controller and the hydrogen controller to
ensure that the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature remains under
control and there is adequate hydrogen (2% or higher) in the TGCU
Reactor outlet.
At this point, all of the tailgas from both SRUs is flowing into the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, mixing with the external reducing gas in
the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer, entering the TGCU Reactor to
convert all of the sulfur compounds to H
2
S, being cooled in the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, and flowing through the TGCU
Quench Column Bypass Valve and the TGCU Start-Up Blower
Bypass Valve to the Thermal Oxidizer via the TGCU Contactor
overhead line and the TGCU Outlet Valve.
Once the operation of the TGCU front-end has stabilized, the
process gas can be introduced into the TGCU columns as described
in Section 11.8.5 of these guidelines. If the columns are not ready
the front-end of the TGCU can operate indefinitely in this manner
until ready to switch the process gas to the columns.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-119
11.8.3.2 Introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Scenario 2
The second startup scenario to consider is when the TGCU is
already processing tailgas from one SRU, and the tailgas from the
second SRU needs to be introduced into the TGCU. Assume that
the Train 2 SRU is currently feeding the TGCU. Due to the
back-pressure from the TGCU, the pressure downstream of SRU 1
Tailgas Valve to the TGCU will be about 0.07 kg/cm
2
(g), while the
pressure upstream of this valve will be close to kg/cm
2
(g) (since the
SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO will be open to the TTO at this time).
If the Train 1 tailgas was quickly switched into the TGCU in the same
manner as described above for the first scenario, a major upset
would result in both SRUs and in the TGCU:
As soon as the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU started to open,
tailgas from the Train 2 SRU would begin to back-flow through the
SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU and flow to the TTO, since the
pressure downstream of the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU at
that moment would be higher than the pressure upstream of the SRU
1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU. Since the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the
TGCU is a more direct path to the TTO for the tailgas from the
Train 2 SRU, most of the Train 2 tailgas would flow through the SRU
1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU as it opens rather than flow through the
TGCU. The outlet temperature from the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater
in the TGCU would begin to rise (due to the drop in tailgas flow)
while the controls began reducing the steam flow rate to the heater.
Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU was fully open, all of the
Train 1 tailgas and most of the Train 2 tailgas would be flowing
directly to the TTO. The TGCU controls would continue reducing the
steam flow rate to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater to try to keep its
outlet temperature under control.
Then, once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU was fully open, the
SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO would begin to close. This would
begin forcing all of the Train 1 tailgas and Train 2 tailgas into the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater. The outlet temperature from it would
begin to drop while the controls began increasing the steam flow rate
to the heater. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO was fully
closed, all of the Train 1 and Train 2 tailgas would be flowing to the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, causing an abrupt increase in its
operating pressure from about 0.07 kg/cm
2
(g) to about 0.3 kg/cm
2
(g).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-120
This would cause the air and acid gas flow rates to the SRUs to
suddenly drop, possibly causing the SRUs to flame-out. If so, the
SRUs and the TGCU would shut down and the operators would have
to start over again.
If the SRUs and TGCU did manage to stay on-line, the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater would only be supplying about half as much
heating as needed until the controls recover and bring the steam flow
rate up to the new requirements. Until the controls recover, the inlet
temperature to the TGCU Reactor would be low, possibly causing
incomplete conversion of SO
2
in the reactor and allowing SO
2
to
reach the quench water system and foul it. The reducing gas flow
rate might also require time to adjust to the higher tailgas flow rate,
further compounding the problems with conversion in the reactor.
So, the best that could be expected if the second SRU is routed to
the TGCU in the same manner as under the first scenario is an upset
in both SRUs, the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, the TGCU Reactor,
and the quench water system. Depending on how quickly the SRUs
respond to sudden changes in operating pressure, the SRU burners
might flame-out. In this worst case, a complete restart of the SRUs
and the TGCU would then be required.
Instead of introducing the tailgas from the second SRU into the
TGCU in an abrupt manner, what is needed is a slow, controlled
redirection of the tailgas from the TTO to the TGCU. This can be
accomplished by the DCS operator using the hand controls for the
SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO and the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the
TGCU.
Under this scenario, the TGCU is already processing tailgas from the
Train 2 SRU. This means that the TGCU warmup/bypass valve is
already closed. This signals the PLC to disable the "fast" transfer
switches in the DCS, so that the rapid switching sequence
(scenario 1) cannot be activated inadvertently.
A. Initiate the over-ride for the Train 1 tailgas valves by toggling the
Train 1 "slow" transfer switch in the DCS, to "OVER-RIDE". The PLC
temporarily removes the limit switches on the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to
the TTO and the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU from the
"complete flowpath interlock" for the Train 1 SRU alarms and
deactivates the "valve malfunction" alarms on these two valves, then
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-121
directs the DCS to release control of the hand controls for these
valves to the operator.
B. Use the hand control to slowly begin throttling the tailgas flow with
the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO, so that the pressure at the
front-end of Train 1 is slightly higher than at the front-end of the
Train 2 SRU. Monitor the flows and pressure in the Train 1 SRU and
adjust the hand control accordingly.
C. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO is throttling, use the other
hand control to slowly open the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU.
Some of the Train 1 tailgas may begin to flow into the TGCU at this
time, but most of it will still flow through the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve
directly to the TTO. Monitor the flows and pressures in the Train 1
SRU and the TGCU, and adjust the rate at which he opens the SRU
1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU accordingly.
D. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is fully open, use the
hand control to slowly close the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO the
rest of the way and send all of the Train 1 tailgas to the TGCU.
Monitor the flow rates and temperatures in the TGCU, and adjust the
rate at which he closes the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO as
needed to allow time for the controls in the TGCU to respond.
E. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO is fully closed, the Train 1
SRU is flowing to the TGCU along with the Train 2 SRU, and the
TGCU is fully on-line.
Once both valves have moved into position, the PLC will
automatically restore the limit switches on the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve
to the TTO and the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU to the
"complete flowpath interlock" in the SRU alarms, restore the
malfunction alarms for these valves to their normal configurations,
and reset the "slow" transfer switch in the DCS, back to "NORMAL"
and remove the over-ride.
One further point to note is that the "slow" transfer over-ride switches
can also be used to "back" tailgas out of the TGCU. If the operator
wants to shut down the TGCU in a controlled fashion, this can be
accomplished by using the TGCU Startup Blower to circulate gas
through the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater while slowly "backing" the
SRU tailgas out of the TGCU. The steps to perform this are
essentially the same as those listed above (but in reverse order).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-122
11.8.4 Quench Water and Amine Systems
Before switching process gas into the TGCU Quench Column and the
TGCU Contactor, the quench water and amine systems should be
operating and ready to accept gas. The operating conditions described
below should have been established previously at the conclusion of the
washing operations, but are repeated below to serve as a "checklist"
before introducing process gas to the columns as described in
Section 11.8.5 that follows.
A. The quench water system should be charged with its initial fill of
water, so that the level in the TGCU Quench Column is at the normal
setpoint for the Quench Column level controller.
B. Quench water should be circulating to the TGCU Quench Column at
the normal setpoint for the quench water flow controller.
C. Cooling water should be flowing to the TGCU Quench Water Trim
Cooler and the TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler.
D. The fans should be operating on the TGCU Quench Water Cooler,
with the temperature controller on the quench water controlling at its
normal setpoint or lower.
E. The TGCU Quench Water Filter should be in service with the filtered
quench water flow controller controlling at its normal setpoint.
F. The quench water pH analyzer should be in service (with one pH
Meter Sample Filter in service, and the other blocked-in for use as a
spare) with the quench water pH analyzer in the DCS showing a pH
of 11 or higher. Add caustic to the quench water if necessary to
raise the pH to this level.
G. The amine system should be charged with its initial fill of amine, with
the level control in the DCS controlling the level in the TGCU
Contactor at its normal setpoint.
H. The MDEA concentration in the amine should be close to its design
value (45 wt %). Add more fresh MDEA if necessary to bring the
amine to this strength.
I. Amine should be circulating through the TGCU Stripper, the TGCU
Lean/Rich Exchanger, the TGCU Lean Amine Cooler, and the TGCU
Lean Amine Trim Cooler to the distributor tray at the top of the TGCU
Contactor at the normal setpoint for the flow controller.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-123
J. The fans should be operating on the TGCU Lean Amine Cooler, with
the temperature controller on the lean amine controlling at its normal
setpoint or lower.
K. The TGCU Rich Amine Filter should be in service.
L. The TGCU lean amine filters should be in service.
M. Steam should be flowing to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler at the
normal setpoint for the flow control.
N. The overhead temperature from the TGCU Stripper should be above
the low temperature alarm point for the temperature indicator.
O. The fans should be operating on the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Condenser with the temperature controller on the outlet from the
TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser controlling at its normal setpoint or
lower.
P. The TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the SRU, should be in
"manual" with its output set to 0% so that the pressure control valve
is fully closed.
Q. The TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the flare should be in
"automatic" with its setpoint set at its normal value.
R. The level in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator should be at the
normal setpoint for the level control.
S. A TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump should be operating with the
minimum flow lined up to allow reflux to spill back into the TGCU
Stripper Reflux Accumulator whenever the level valve back to the
TGCU Stripper is closed.
With these operating conditions established, the back-end of the TGCU is
ready to accept the process gas from the front-end of the unit and begin
treating it.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-124
11.8.5 Process Gas Flow to the TGCU Columns
The last step in the startup of the TGCU is to bring the process gas from
the front-end of the TGCU into the TGCU Quench Column and the TGCU
Contactor. The TGCU will then remove the H
2
S from the gas before
sending it to the TTO. The H
2
S removed will be stripped from the amine
and sent to the flare initially. Once operation of the amine system
stabilizes, this acid gas will be recycled back to the SRUs.
Before introducing process gas into the TGCU columns, confirm that the
following conditions are all true:
1. The front-end of the TGCU is processing SRU tailgas and is
operating smoothly on automatic control.
2. The hydrogen controller is controlling the hydrogen concentration
in the outlet of the TGCU Reactor at or above its setpoint.
3. The proper operating conditions have been established for the
quench water and amine systems (see Section 11.8.4).
If any of these conditions are not true, do not proceed until correcting the
problem(s). Once all of these conditions are satisfied, complete the
startup of the TGCU as follows:
A. Confirm that the Quench Column hand control in the DCS is set to
0% output with the TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve closed and the
TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve open.
B. Use the drain valve downstream of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer
to drain any liquids that may have accumulated in the TGCU Quench
Column inlet line.
C. Slowly increase the output from the Quench Column hand control to
100%, which will open the Quench Column inlet valve and admit
process gas to the TGCU Quench Column, then close the TGCU
Quench Column Bypass Valve to prevent gas from bypassing to the
Thermal Oxidizer.
Note that the pressure drop through the TGCU Quench Column and
the TGCU Contactor will raise the operating pressures of the SRU
and the TGCU and can affect the process gas flow rates, so allow
time for the flow and flow-ratio control loops to respond.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-125
D. When the output of the Quench Column hand control reaches 100%,
the Quench Column inlet valve should be fully open and the TGCU
Quench Column Bypass Valve fully closed to send all of the process
gas into the TGCU Quench Column. Visually confirm that these
valves are properly positioned.
E. As process gas flows into the columns, watch the operation of the
quench water system carefully. It is typical to see a slow decrease in
the quench water pH as H
2
S in the process gas dissolves into the
water, but a rapid decline in pH could indicate SO
2
in the process
gas from incomplete reaction in the TGCU Reactor. Be ready to add
caustic if needed to keep the pH above 7.
NOTE: The quench water will probably turn black or green on this
first introduction of H
2
S into the system (due to small
particles of iron sulfide in the water). The TGCU Quench
Water Filter should clear up the water in a few hours.
F. If the quench water pH drops drastically or there is a sudden drop in
the hydrogen concentration on the hydrogen controller, the process
gas can be "backed" out of the columns by reducing the output of the
Quench Column hand control back to 0%. This will open the TGCU
Quench Column Bypass Valve to divert the gas to the TTO and close
the Quench Column inlet valve to stop gas from flowing into the
TGCU Quench Column. Once the operating problem is corrected
and the hydrogen controller is once again showing adequate
hydrogen, use the Quench Column hand control to re-initiate gas
flow to the columns.
G. Once the columns are operating stably, switch the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer
to take its sample from the TGCU Contactor overhead line by
checking that the sample line is clear of liquid, confirming that the
sample valve on the overhead line is open, and switching the sample
selector valve in the analyzer enclosure to sample from the TGCU
Contactor overhead line. (Note that the sample line on the outlet
from the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer is now being back-purged
with nitrogen.)
The gas stream from the TGCU Contactor is "cleaner" than the one
leaving the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer and is less likely to cause
problems in the hydrogen analyzer. However, if the Quench Column
hand control is used to divert gas to the TTO during an upset as
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-126
described in the previous step, the analyzer must be switched back
to the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer to get a good
reading, as gas will no longer be flowing in the TGCU Contactor
overhead line.
H. Once the operation of the TGCU Stripper has stabilized, route its
acid gas, which is presently going to the flare through a pressure
valve, back to the SRUs as follows:
(1) Confirm that the TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the SRUs
in the DCS is in "manual" with its output set to 0%.
(2) Confirm that the setpoint of the TGCU Stripper pressure
controller to the SRUs is tracking its current reading, then place
it in "automatic".
(3) Slowly raise the setpoint of the TGCU Stripper pressure
controller to the flare to 1.0 kg/cm
2
(g).
(4) If, necessary, adjust the setpoint of the TGCU Stripper pressure
controller to the SRU to its normal setpoint.
The TGCU Stripper pressure controller will now take over control of
the TGCU Stripper pressure by opening the pressure valve to send
the acid gas to the Acid Gas Knock-Out Drums in the SRUs. The
TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the flare will close the acid gas
pressure valve and stop the flow of acid gas to the flare. If the SRUs
shut down (or some other upset causes the TGCU Stripper pressure
to rise), the TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the flare will act as
an over-ride and divert the acid gas to the flare.
I. If desired, the quench water and amine systems can be optimized at
this time for more efficient operation, or for more capacity to handle
upsets. Section 11.6 offers suggestions and guidelines for these
systems. If maximizing the capacity to handle process upsets
without going out of compliance is desired, consider the following
suggestions:
(1) Lower the setpoint of the temperature controller on the quench
water to maximize the aerial cooling. This will cool the feed gas
to the TGCU Contactor as much as possible to minimize the
load on the column and improve amine selectivity and treating
ability.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-127
(2) Lower the setpoint of the temperature control on the lean amine
to maximize the aerial cooling. This will cool the amine to the
TGCU Contactor as much as possible to maximize the amine
selectivity and treating ability.
(3) Lower the setpoint of the temperature controller on the outlet
from the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser as much as
possible. This will minimize the water content of the TGCU acid
gas returning to the sulfur plant and improve the recovery there.
The aerial coolers and trim coolers will not be able to maintain these
temperatures when the ambient conditions are very warm, of course.
However, setting the controllers this way will keep the fan speed high
to maximize cooling at all times.
J. The TGCU is now fully on-stream. Before directing your attention
away from the TGCU, be sure that:
(1) Both SRU Tailgas Valves to the TTO and the TGCU
Warmup/Bypass Valve are fully closed (to prevent leakage of
SRU tailgas to the Thermal Oxidizer that would cause high SO
2
emissions and the resulting permit violation).
(2) The TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve is fully closed (to
prevent leakage of TGCU Reactor effluent to the Thermal
Oxidizer that would cause high SO
2
emissions and the resulting
permit violation).
(3) All controllers are functioning properly.
(4) The steam heating systems are in service on the jacketed sulfur
vapor valves and the steam traps are functioning properly.
(5) The Thermal Oxidizer is functioning properly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-128
11.8.6 Normal Startup of the TGCU
The procedure for startup of the TGCU after it has been shut down will be
very similar to the procedure for the initial startup, Sections 11.8.1 through
11.8.5 of these guidelines, except that the catalyst will not require
pre-sulfiding. For ease of reference, the steps to be performed are written
in this Section to serve as a "check list" that can be easily followed on
subsequent startups. Refer to the previous Sections for the reasons and
details pertaining to the different steps performed.
Prior to commencing TGCU startup:
(1) Check for the completion of all maintenance work (connecting
lines, removing blinds, etc.) if such work was performed.
(2) If any of the flanged connections in the TGCU were opened for
maintenance or other purposes while the TGCU was off-line, it
is good practice to leak test the TGCU before returning it to
service. Refer to Section 11.7.5 of these guidelines for a
suggested procedure to accomplish this.
(3) Place all the steam heating systems on the sulfur vapor valve
jackets in service. Check all steam traps for proper operation,
and use the vent valves to sweep non-condensibles out of the
steam spaces.
(4) Physically check all shutdown activating devices to ensure that
they activate the TGCU ESD system.
(5) Physically check all devices activated by the TGCU ESD
system to ensure that they operate properly.
11.8.6.1 Initial Preparations
A. Confirm that steam pressure controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0%, and that control valve in the
HP Steam supply line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater is
closed.
B. Place the reactor feed temperature controller in "automatic".
C. Confirm that reducing gas flow controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0%, and that the control valve in
the reducing gas supply line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer
is closed.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-129
D. Place the hydrogen controller in "automatic".
E. Verify that the automated shutdown valves, the block valves, and
the downstream steam-jacketed block valve in the reducing gas
line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer are all closed.
F. Confirm that pre-sulfiding gas flow controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0%, and that the control valve in
the pre-sulfiding gas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer is
closed.
G. Verify that the automated shutdown valve and the upstream
block valves in the pre-sulfiding gas line to the TGCU Reactor
Feed Mixer are both closed.
H. Confirm that the nitrogen flow controller in the DCS is in
"manual" with its output set to 0% output, and that the control
valve in the nitrogen supply line is closed.
I. Verify that the shutdown valves are closed in the nitrogen
supply line, and the upstream block valves are open. Open the
downstream steam-jacketed block valve.
J. Confirm that the Quench Column hand control in the DCS is set
to 0% output, so that the TGCU Quench Column inlet valve will
remain fully closed and the TGCU Quench Column bypass
valve will open later in when the TGCU startup/run selector
switch is switched to "STARTUP".
K. Confirm that the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer is filled with
water up to its normal liquid level.
L. Visually confirm that both SRU Tailgas Valves to the TGCU are
closed.
M. Visually confirm that the manual TGCU Outlet Valve is fully
open.
N. Confirm that the Leak Test switch in the DCS is toggled to
"OFF".
O. Confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve is fully
open.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-130
P. Verify that the local stop control for the TGCU Start-Up Blower
is set to the "RUN" position.
Q. Check that the sample line from the outlet of the TGCU Waste
Heat Reclaimer to the hydrogen analyzer is clear of liquids.
Confirm that sample valve on the outlet channel of the boiler is
open, then switch the sample selector valve in the analyzer
enclosure to sample from the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer.
Note that the other sample line on the TGCU Contactor
overhead line is now being back-purged with nitrogen.
11.8.6.2 Purging the Low Pressure TGCU Columns
Unless the water or the amine was drained from the low pressure
TGCU columns (the TGCU Quench Column and the TGCU
Contactor, respectively), or either column was opened for
maintenance during the prior shutdown, the columns will not contain
air and so will not require purging before proceeding with startup.
However, if the activities prior to this startup did allow air to enter
either or both columns, this air should be purged from the system
before proceeding so that a combustible mixture cannot form in the
columns as process gas is introduced.
If purging of the columns is required, nitrogen can be introduced
using the nitrogen flow controller to purge the air from the columns.
This procedure is given in Section 11.7.8 of these guidelines. Refer
to and follow this procedure to purge the columns before continuing
with Section 11.8.6.3 that follows.
11.8.6.3 Establishing Nitrogen Flow
To establish nitrogen flow into the TGCU, proceed as follows:
A. Toggle the Startup/Run selector switch in the DCS to
"STARTUP".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(a) Bypasses both SRU ESD inputs to the TGCU ESD.
(b) Disables the Tailgas Valve toggle switches.
(c) Opens the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-131
B. Reset the TGCU ESD by toggling the switch in the DCS to
"RESET".
C. Set the output of the hand control in the DCS to 0% to close the
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve and visually confirm that the
valve is closed.
D. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens the nitrogen block valves.
(2) Closes the nitrogen vent valve.
E. Increase the output of the nitrogen flow controller to 100% in
the DCS to open the control valve and send nitrogen to the
front-end of the TGCU.
F. Allow the nitrogen to purge that front-end of the TGCU for 15
minutes before proceeding to the next step.
11.8.6.4 Establishing Re-circulation Flow
A. Start the TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop toggle
switch in the DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The nitrogen purge valve is closed.
(2) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Suction Valve is opened.
(3) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Discharge Valve is opened.
(4) After the limit switches prove these valves open, the
TGCU Start-Up Blower is started.
(5) Once the Startup Blower is started, the TGCU Start-Up
Blower Bypass Valve is closed.
As this valve is closed, the blower will start to load. As it does
so, the blower will begin to "pull" nitrogen through the front-end
TGCU equipment and all of the associated piping.
B. Once the blower is running, open the TGCU Warmup/Bypass
Valve by increasing the output from the hand control to 100%.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-132
As the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve opens, the TGCU
Start-Up Blower will begin re-circulating gas from the outlet of
the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer back to the TGCU Reactor
Feed Heater (via the TGCU Contactor overhead line).
C. Once re-circulation has been established, place the nitrogen
flow controller in "automatic" and reduce its setpoint to about
5-10% of maximum flow.
D. Slowly begin to increase the setpoint of the steam pressure
controller in the DCS to establish steam flow to the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater and increase the temperature of the
re-circulating gas stream to 150-175C.
E. Open the vent valve on the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer to
vent air from the steam section.
F. Confirm that the BFW level controller and control valve to the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer are in service and functioning
properly.
G. Place the reactor feed temperature cascade control in service
as follows:
(1) Confirm that the remote setpoint that the reactor feed
temperature controller is supplying to the pressure
controller matches the current setting on the pressure
controller.
(2) Confirm that the reactor feed temperature controller is in
"automatic" and its setpoint is tracking its current reading.
(3) Switch the steam pressure controller to "cascade" so that
the temperature controller can now adjust the setpoint on
the pressure controller.
(4) If necessary, slowly adjust the setpoint of the reactor feed
temperature controller to 175C.
(5) Verify that the steam pressure controller is adjusting the
HP steam pressure as needed to control the desired
temperature setting on the reactor feed temperature
controller.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-133
11.8.6.5 Establishing Reducing Gas Flow
Before introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Reactor, reducing
gas must be added to the re-circulating gas stream.
A. Open the upstream manual block valves and the
steam-jacketed block valve in the reducing gas supply line to
the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer.
B. Toggle the Reducing Gas On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens reducing gas block valves.
(2) Closes reducing gas vent valve.
C. Place the reducing gas controller in "automatic" and slowly
begin to increase its setpoint to open the control valve and
begin introducing reducing gas into the re-circulating stream.
As the reducing gas flow rate increases, the hydrogen
concentration displayed on the hydrogen controller will
increase.
D. Place the hydrogen concentration cascade control in service as
follows:
(1) Confirm that the remote setpoint that the hydrogen
controller is supplying to the reducing gas flow controller
matches the current setting on the flow controller.
(2) Confirm that the hydrogen controller is in "automatic" and
its setpoint is tracking its current reading.
(3) Switch the reducing gas controller to "cascade" so that the
concentration controller can now adjust the setpoint of the
flow controller.
(4) If necessary, slowly adjust the setpoint of the hydrogen
controller to its normal value.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-134
11.8.6.6 Routing SRU Tailgas to the TGCU
The TGCU is now ready to accept tailgas from the SRUs.
Before beginning, the following conditions should exist in the TGCU:
1. The Reactor Feed Heater is operating smoothly and the inlet
temperature to the TGCU Reactor is being controlled at
230-240C.
2. The TGCU Reactor is up to normal operating temperature and its
catalyst has been pre-sulfided.
3. The TGCU Start-Up Blower is in service, re-circulating nitrogen
to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater.
4. The H
2
/H
2
S analyzer has been calibrated and is sampling the
process gas leaving the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer.
5. The hydrogen controller is controlling the hydrogen at or above
the normal setpoint
6. One or both SRUs are operating smoothly on amine acid gas, or
amine acid gas and SWS gas, and the air demand indicated on
the air control is +2.0% or lower. (If the air demand is higher
than this, the tailgas from the SRU contains excessive amounts
of SO
2
and could cause overheating of the TGCU Reactor.)
If any of these conditions are not true, do not attempt to bring SRU
tailgas into the TGCU. In particular, do not attempt switching
tailgas into the TGCU when the SRU(s) is(are) experiencing an
upset. The result will be multiple upset units to deal with. Instead,
focus your attention on stabilizing the operation of the SRU(s) first
(usually by correcting a problem in the upstream Amine
Regeneration and/or Sour Water Stripper units), and then use the
procedure that follows to establish tailgas flow into the TGCU.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-135
Introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Scenario 1
The first scenario to consider for introducing tailgas into the TGCU is
a normal startup of the SRUs and the TGCU. Before being routed to
the TGCU, the tailgas from both SRUs is sent to the TTO while the
TGCU uses the TGCU Startup Blower to re-circulate gas to the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater via the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
Once the TGCU is warmed up and ready to accept tailgas, the
Train 1 and Train 2 SRUs can be routed to the TGCU as follows
(using the Train 1 SRU for this procedure).
A. Confirm that the hydrogen controller is in "automatic" and controlling
the hydrogen concentration at or above its normal setpoint, (3%).
B. Toggle the SRU 1 "fast" transfer switch in the DCS, to "TRANSFER TO
TGCU".
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is opened.
(2) After the limit switches prove this valve open, the SRU 1
Tailgas Valve to the TTO is closed.
Visually confirm that these valves have moved to the proper
positions.
C. If the second SRU (Train 2) is also ready to send its tailgas to the
TGCU, toggle the SRU 2 "fast" transfer switch in the DCS to repeat
these actions for the other SRU.
For this scenario, the opening and closing of Tailgas Valves to the
TGCU and the Tailgas Valves to the TTO in Steps B and C can
occur rapidly with no impact on either the SRU or the TGCU. This is
because the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve will still be open at this
time, so there will be very little differential pressure across the
Tailgas Valves to the TGCU and there will not be an abrupt change
in pressure when the Tailgas Valves to the TGCU are opened or
when the Tailgas Valves to the TTO are closed.
Note: The fast transfer switches can also be used to take the
Train 1 SRU and/or Train 2 SRU tailgas out of the TGCU.
Every other toggle of these selector switches will take the
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-136
opposite action to open the tailgas valve to the TTO and
then close the tailgas valve to the TGCU.
D. Slowly reduce the output from the hand control to 0% to close the
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
Now all of the SRU tailgas must flow through the TGCU Reactor
Feed Heater, etc. as this is the only open flowpath to the TTO.
E. Shut down the TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop selector
switch in the DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The TGCU Start-Up Blower bypass valve is opened and proved
open.
(2) The TGCU Start-Up Blower is stopped.
(3) The nitrogen purge valve is opened.
(4) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Suction Valve and the TGCU
Start-Up Blower Discharge Valve are closed.
Confirm that these valves have moved to the proper positions and
that the blower has stopped.
F. Place the nitrogen flow controller in "manual" and set its output to 0%
to close the control valve and stop the flow of nitrogen into the
TGCU.
G. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "OFF".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Closes nitrogen blocks.
(2) Opens nitrogen vent valve.
H. Close the downstream steam-jacketed block valve in the nitrogen
supply line where it joins the tailgas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed
Mixer.
I. Allow the TGCU to operate in this fashion until all operating
conditions are stable. In particular, observe the operation of the
reactor feed temperature controller and the hydrogen controller to
ensure that the TGCU Reactor inlet temperature remains under
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-137
control and there is adequate hydrogen (2% or higher) in the TGCU
Reactor outlet.
At this point, all of the tailgas from both SRUs is flowing into the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater, mixing with the external reducing gas in
the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer, entering the TGCU Reactor to
convert all of the sulfur compounds to H
2
S, being cooled in the
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, and flowing through the TGCU
Quench Column Bypass Valve and the TGCU Start-Up Blower
Bypass Valve to the Thermal Oxidizer via the TGCU Contactor
overhead line and the TGCU Outlet Valve.
Once the operation of the TGCU front-end has stabilized, the
process gas can be introduced into the TGCU columns.
Introducing SRU Tailgas into the TGCU Scenario 2
The second startup scenario to consider is when the TGCU is
already processing tailgas from one SRU, and the tailgas from the
second SRU needs to be introduced into the TGCU. Under this
scenario, the TGCU is already processing tailgas from the Train 2
SRU. This means that the TGCU warmup/bypass valve is already
closed. This signals the PLC to disable the "fast" transfer switches in
the DCS, so that the rapid switching sequence (scenario 1) cannot
be activated inadvertently.
A. Initiate the over-ride for the Train 1 tailgas valves by toggling the
Train 1 "slow" transfer switch in the DCS, to "OVER-RIDE". The PLC
temporarily removes the limit switches on the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to
the TTO and the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU from the
"complete flowpath interlock" for the Train 1 SRU alarms and
deactivates the "valve malfunction" alarms on these two valves, then
directs the DCS to release control of the hand controls for these
valves to the operator.
B. Use the hand control to slowly begin throttling the tailgas flow with
the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO, so that the pressure at the
front-end of Train 1 is slightly higher than at the front-end of the
Train 2 SRU. Monitor the flows and pressure in the Train 1 SRU and
adjust the hand control accordingly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-138
C. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO is throttling, use the other
hand control to slowly open the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU.
Some of the Train 1 tailgas may begin to flow into the TGCU at this
time, but most of it will still flow through the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve
directly to the TTO. Monitor the flows and pressures in the Train 1
SRU and the TGCU, and adjust the rate at which he opens the SRU
1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU accordingly.
D. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is fully open, use the
hand control to slowly close the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO the
rest of the way and send all of the Train 1 tailgas to the TGCU.
Monitor the flow rates and temperatures in the TGCU, and adjust the
rate at which the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO is closed to allow
time for the controls in the TGCU to respond.
E. Once the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO is fully closed, the Train 1
SRU is flowing to the TGCU along with the Train 2 SRU, and the
TGCU is fully on-line.
Once both valve have moved into position, the PLC will automatically
restore the limit switches on the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO and
the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU to the "complete flowpath
interlock" in the SRU alarms, restore the malfunction alarms for
these valves to their normal configurations, and reset the "slow"
transfer switch in the DCS, back to "NORMAL" and remove the
over-ride.
11.8.6.7 Quench Water and Amine Systems
Before switching process gas into the TGCU Quench Column and
the TGCU Contactor, the quench water and amine systems should
be operating and ready to accept the process gas.
A. The quench water system should be filled with water, so that
the level in the TGCU Quench Column is at the normal setpoint
for the Quench Column level controller.
B. Quench water should be circulating to the TGCU Quench
Column at the normal setpoint for the quench water flow
controller.
C. Cooling water should be flowing to the TGCU Quench Water
Trim Cooler and the TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-139
D. The fans should be operating on the TGCU Quench Water
Cooler, with the temperature controller on the quench water
controlling at its normal setpoint or lower.
E. The TGCU Quench Water Filter should be in service with the
filtered quench water flow controller controlling at its normal
setpoint.
F. The quench water pH analyzer should be in service (with one
pH Meter Sample Filter in service, and the other blocked-in for
use as a spare) with the quench water pH analyzer in the DCS
showing a pH of 11 or higher. Add caustic to the quench water
if necessary to raise the pH to this level.
G. The amine system should be filled with amine, with the level
control in the DCS controlling the level in the TGCU Contactor
at its normal setpoint.
H. The MDEA concentration in the amine should be close to its
design value (45 wt %). Add more fresh MDEA if necessary to
bring the amine to this strength.
I. Amine should be circulating through the TGCU Stripper, the
TGCU Lean/Rich Exchanger, the TGCU Lean Amine Cooler,
and the TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler to the distributor tray at
the top of the TGCU Contactor at the normal setpoint for the
flow controller.
J. The fans should be operating on the TGCU Lean Amine Cooler,
with the temperature controller on the lean amine controlling at
its normal setpoint or lower.
K. The TGCU Rich Amine Filter should be in service.
L. The TGCU lean amine filters should be in service, with the flow
controller controlling at its normal setpoint.
M. Steam should be flowing to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler at the
normal setpoint for the flow controller.
N. The overhead temperature from the TGCU Stripper should be
above the low temperature alarm point for the temperature
indicator.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-140
O. The fans should be operating on the TGCU Stripper Reflux
Condenser with the temperature controller on the outlet from
the TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser controlling at its normal
setpoint or lower.
P. The TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the SRU should be in
"manual" with its output set to 0% so that the pressure valve is
fully closed.
Q. The TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the flare should be in
"automatic" with its setpoint set to its normal value.
R. The level in the TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator should be
at the normal setpoint for the level control.
S. A TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump should be operating with the
minimum flow lined up to allow reflux to spill back into the
TGCU Stripper Reflux Accumulator whenever the level valve
back to the TGCU Stripper is closed.
With these operating conditions established, the back-end of the
TGCU is ready to accept the process gas from the front-end of the
unit and begin treating it.
11.8.6.8 Process Gas Flow to the TGCU Columns
The startup of the TGCU can now be completed by switching the
process gas to flow into the columns. Before introducing process
gas into the TGCU columns, confirm that the following conditions are
all true:
1. The front-end of the TGCU is processing SRU tailgas and is
operating smoothly on automatic control.
2. The hydrogen controller is controlling the hydrogen
concentration in the outlet of the TGCU Reactor at or above its
setpoint.
3. The proper operating conditions have been established for the
quench water and amine systems.
If any of these conditions are not true, do not proceed until correcting
the problem(s). Once all of these conditions are satisfied, complete
the startup of the TGCU as follows:
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-141
A. Confirm that the Quench Column hand control in the DCS is set
to 0% output with the TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve closed
and the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve open.
B. Use the drain valve downstream of the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer to drain any liquids that may have accumulated in
the TGCU Quench Column inlet line.
C. Slowly increase the output from the Quench Column hand
control to 100%, which will open the Quench Column inlet valve
and admit process gas to the TGCU Quench Column, then
close the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve to prevent gas
from bypassing to the Thermal Oxidizer.
Note that the pressure drop through the TGCU Quench Column
and the TGCU Contactor will raise the operating pressures of
the SRU and the TGCU and can affect the process gas flow
rates, so allow time for the flow and flow-ratio control loops to
respond.
D. When the output of the Quench Column hand control reaches
100%, the Quench Column inlet valve should be fully open and
the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve fully closed to send
all of the process gas into the TGCU Quench Column. Visually
confirm that these valves are properly positioned.
E. As process gas flows into the columns, watch the operation of
the quench water system carefully. A sudden drop in pH
usually indicates SO
2
in the process gas from incomplete
reaction in the TGCU Reactor. Be ready to add caustic if
needed to keep the pH above 7.
F. If the quench water pH drops drastically or there is a sudden
drop in the hydrogen concentration on the hydrogen controller,
the process gas can be "backed" out of the columns by
reducing the output of the Quench Column hand control back to
0%. This will open the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve to
divert the gas to the TTO and close the Quench Column inlet
valve to stop gas from flowing into the TGCU Quench Column.
Once the operating problem is corrected and the hydrogen
controller is once again showing adequate hydrogen, use the
Quench Column hand control to re-initiate gas flow to the
columns.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-142
G. Once the columns are operating stably, switch the H
2
/H
2
S
analyzer to take its sample from the TGCU Contactor overhead
line by checking that the sample line is clear of liquid,
confirming that the sample valve on the overhead line is open,
and switching the sample selector valve in the analyzer
enclosure to sample from the TGCU Contactor overhead line.
(Note that the sample line on the outlet from the TGCU Waste
Heat Reclaimer is now being back-purged with nitrogen.)
H. Once the operation of the TGCU Stripper has stabilized, route
its acid gas, which is presently going to the flare through the
pressure valve, back to the SRU as follows:
(1) Confirm that the TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the
SRU in the DCS is in "manual" with its output set to 0%.
(2) Confirm that the setpoint of the TGCU Stripper pressure
controller is tracking its current reading, then place it in
"automatic".
(3) Slowly raise the setpoint of the TGCU Stripper pressure
controller to the flare to 1.0 kg/cm2(g).
(4) If necessary, adjust the setpoint of the TGCU Stripper
pressure controller to its normal setpoint.
The TGCU Stripper pressure controller will now take over
control of the TGCU Stripper pressure by opening the pressure
valve to send the acid gas to the Acid Gas Knock-Out Drum in
the SRU. The TGCU Stripper pressure controller to the flare
will close the next pressure valve and stop the flow of acid gas
to the flare. If the SRU shuts down (or some other upset
causes the TGCU Stripper pressure to rise), the TGCU Stripper
pressure controller to the flare will act as an over-ride and divert
the acid gas to the flare.
I. If desired, the quench water and amine systems can be
optimized at this time for more efficient operation, or for more
capacity to handle upsets.
J. The TGCU is now fully on-stream. Before directing your
attention away from the TGCU, be sure that:
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-143
(1) The SRU Tailgas Valve to the TTO and the TGCU
Warmup/Bypass Valve are fully closed (to prevent leakage of
SRU tailgas to the Thermal Oxidizer that would cause high SO
2
emissions and the resulting permit violation).
(2) The TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve is fully closed (to
prevent leakage of TGCU Reactor effluent to the Thermal
Oxidizer that would cause high SO
2
emissions and the resulting
permit violation).
(3) All controllers are functioning properly.
(4) The steam heating systems are in service on the jacketed sulfur
vapor valves and the steam traps are functioning properly.
(5) The Thermal Oxidizer is functioning properly.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-144
11.9 Shutdown Procedures
The procedures to be used in performing a planned shutdown of the TGCU will
vary depending on the extent and type of work to be performed in and around
the unit during the downtime period. If there are no plans for opening the TGCU
such that air would be allowed entry to the catalyst bed in the TGCU Reactor,
few special procedures are required in performing the shutdown. In general,
unless there is a suspected problem in the TGCU Reactor or the catalyst is to
be replaced, there is no benefit to be gained from opening up the TGCU
Reactor. If the TGCU Reactor does not need to be opened (or exposed to
significant air entry during some other maintenance procedure), there is no need
to passivate the TGCU Reactor catalyst. This greatly simplifies and shortens
the shutdown procedure. Section 11.9.1 that follows is an example of such a
procedure.
If the catalyst is to be replaced, if the TGCU Reactor must be entered, or if
maintenance on some other portion of the plant will allow a significant amount of
air to enter the TGCU Reactor, then more extensive and lengthy procedures
must be followed to accomplish a satisfactory shutdown and minimize the time
required for performance of the desired maintenance work. Section 11.9.2 that
follows is an example of a procedure for this circumstance.
There are a couple of special circumstances related to shutdown procedures
that are also discussed. Section 11.9.3 discusses considerations for the
shutdown procedure when the tubes in the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer are
leaking. Special precautions to observe while the TGCU is shut down are
discussed in Section 11.9.4.
Section 11.9.5 is a discussion of emergency shutdown situations. A guide to
troubleshooting the causes of unplanned shutdowns is presented to assist in
quickly identifying and correcting the problem so the TGCU can be put back
on-line in a minimum amount of time.
The TGCU is affected directly and indirectly by shutdowns and outages that
occur in other systems within the Sulfur Block. The more important aspects of
the effects these other systems can have on the TGCU are discussed in
Section 11.9.6.
Typical shutdown procedures are outlined and discussed in the sections that
follow for the more common cases. Your existing company procedures and
common sense operational judgment should be used to modify these
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-145
procedures as needed to serve the purpose of any given planned shutdown
situation.
11.9.1 Planned Shutdown - No Reactor Entry
When there are no plans to open up the TGCU Reactor, there is no need
to passivate the catalyst during the shutdown procedure. Even when
entry to other parts of the TGCU is planned, this can normally be
accomplished without exposing the catalyst bed to significant amounts of
air by using slip-blinds to isolate the TGCU Reactor prior to purging, etc.
Under these circumstances, the shutdown procedure given in this section
may be used as a guide.
Any equipment to be opened should be properly blinded and purged with
inert gas before admission of air, to avoid exposure to potentially toxic
gases or the formation of flammable vapor mixtures. It is particularly
important to isolate the TGCU from the reducing gas and pre-sulfiding gas
supply lines. Any equipment containing amine solution that is to be
opened or entered should be drained completely, then flushed with
condensate or steamed out to avoid the possibility of skin or eye irritation.
It is always best, but not absolutely necessary, to purge the sulfur-bearing
gases from as much of the TGCU as possible prior to shutting the TGCU
down. This minimizes the chance of sulfur plugging in the piping or
equipment during the subsequent restart, and minimizes the purging and
cleaning required prior to vessel entry. This is accomplished by diverting
the SRU tailgas to the Thermal Oxidizer, then using nitrogen to purge the
front-end of the TGCU to the Thermal Oxidizer.
It is generally preferable to shut down the TGCU in a controlled fashion,
particularly if the SRUs are to remain on-line, to minimize the impact on
the other process units. If time does not allow performing a controlled
shutdown, however, the unit can be shut down by simply activating the
TGCU ESD system (using the manual shutdown switch). This will
automatically block the feeds into the TGCU (SRU tailgas, reducing gas,
pre-sulfiding gas, and nitrogen/utility air) and divert the SRU tailgas to the
Thermal Oxidizer, although it results in a much bigger "bobble" to the
SRUs.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-146
To shut the TGCU down in a controlled fashion and purge the
sulfur-bearing gases from the front-end of the unit, proceed as follows:
A. Check that the sample line from the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer to the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer is clear of liquids. Confirm that
sample valve on the outlet channel of the boiler is open, then switch
the sample selector valve in the analyzer enclosure to the "START-UP"
position (taking sample from the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer).
B. Visually confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve is fully
open and that the DCS indicates that the valve is open.
C. Slowly reduce the output from the Quench Column hand control in
the DCS to divert the process gas from the TGCU columns and send
it to the Thermal Oxidizer. The Quench Column hand control will
open the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve, then close the
TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve.
D. When the output of the Quench Column hand control reaches 0%,
the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve should be fully open and
the Quench Column inlet valve fully closed to send all of the process
gas to the Thermal Oxidizer via the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass
Valve.
Visually confirm that these valves are properly positioned. Confirm
that the DCS indicates that the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve
is open, and that the TGCU Quench Column Inlet Valve is closed.
E. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
The PLC should perform the following actions:
(1) Opens nitrogen block.
(2) Closes nitrogen vent valve.
F. Open the downstream steam-jacketed block valve in the nitrogen
supply line where it joins the tailgas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed
Mixer.
G. Increase the output of the nitrogen flow controller to 100% in the
DCS to fully open the control valve and send nitrogen to the
front-end of the TGCU.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-147
H. Slowly increase the output from the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve
hand control in the DCS to 100% to fully open the TGCU
Warmup/Bypass Valve.
Some of the SRU tailgas will continue to flow through the TGCU
Reactor Feed Heater, etc. to the TTO through the TGCU Start-Up
Blower Bypass Valve, but most of the tailgas will flow instead through
the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve to the TTO.
I. Toggle the fast transfer switch for SRU 1 in the DCS to "CLOSE".
The PLC will open the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TTO then close
the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU. All of the SRU 1 tailgas is
now flowing directly to the TTO via the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve, and
none of the tailgas is entering the TGCU.
Visually confirm that these valves have moved to the proper
positions. Verify that the DCS indicates that the SRU 1 Tailgas
Valve to the TTO is open and that the SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the
TGCU is closed.
J. Toggle the fast transfer switch for SRU 2 in the DCS to "CLOSE".
The PLC will open the SRU 2 Tailgas Valve to the TTO then close
the SRU 2 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU. All of the SRU 2 tailgas is
now flowing directly to the TTO via the SRU 2 Tailgas Valve, and
none of the tailgas is entering the TGCU.
Visually confirm that these valves have moved to the proper
positions. Verify that the DCS indicates that the SRU 2 Tailgas
Valve to the TTO is open and that the SRU 2 Tailgas Valve to the
TGCU is closed.
NOTE: If a status does not change, or if a valve
malfunction alarm is activated, it means that the limit
switches on the associated valve never confirmed that the
valve moved to the proper position. If this problem cannot
be corrected, it will not be possible to continue with this
procedure to shut down the TGCU in a controlled fashion.
Instead, use the S/D button to activated the TGCU ESD
system and shut down the TGCU immediately.
K. Toggle the Reducing Gas On/Off switch in the DCS to "OFF".
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-148
The PLC will close the reducing gas block valves, open the vent
valve, and force the control valve to "manual" and 0% output.
Confirm that the DCS indicates that these valves have moved to the
proper position.
L. Close the steam-jacketed block valve in the reducing gas supply line.
M. Reduce the output from the hand control in the DCS to 0% to close
the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve. Visually confirm that the valve is
closed.
N. Now that the reducing gas has been isolated and the tailgas from the
SRU has been switched to the Thermal Oxidizer, allow the front-end
of the TGCU to operate in this fashion for about 15 minutes to purge
the process gas out to the Thermal Oxidizer.
O. Place the HP steam pressure controller for the TGCU Reactor Feed
Heater in "manual" and set its output to 0% to close control valve.
P. Activate the TGCU ESD system using the S/D button.
Q. Close the steam-jacketed valve in the nitrogen supply line where it
joins the tailgas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer.
R. Close the manual TGCU Outlet Valve.
THE OVER-PRESSURE PROTECTION FOR THE TGCU IS
THROUGH THE THERMAL OXIDIZER VENT STACK. HOWEVER,
IF THE TGCU OUTLET VALVE IS CLOSED WHILE THE TGCU IS
SHUT DOWN, STEPS MUST BE TAKEN TO ENSURE THAT THE
TGCU IS NOT COMPLETELY BLOCKED-IN BY CREATING
ANOTHER OPENING FROM THE TGCU TO THE ATMOSPHERE
SO THAT THE TGCU CANNOT BE OVER-PRESSURED.
S. Visually confirm that:
(1) The SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is closed.
(2) The SRU 2 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is closed.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-149
(3) The TGCU Outlet Valve is closed.
(4) The nitrogen/utility air to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater is
blocked-in and bled.
(5) The reducing gas to the TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer is blocked-in
and bled.
(6) The pre-sulfiding gas shutdown valve is closed.
(7) The suction and discharge valves for the TGCU Startup Blower
are closed and the nitrogen purge is in service.
(8) The TGCU Quench Column inlet valve and the TGCU Quench
Column Bypass valve are closed.
(9) All steam heating services on the sulfur vapor valve jackets are
still functioning and the steam traps are operating properly.
T. All temperatures in the front-end of the TGCU should be monitored to
confirm that no air leaks into the system (due to "drafting" from the
Thermal Oxidizer, for instance) and causes a fire in the catalyst bed.
If desired, a small flow of nitrogen can be introduced into the
front-end of the TGCU by using the Leak Test switch in the DCS to
allow opening the block valves on the nitrogen supply line, then
opening the control valve to establish a small flow of nitrogen.
"Crack" the TGCU Outlet Valve to allow the nitrogen to escape to the
Thermal Oxidizer and prevent over-pressuring the TGCU.
U. Allow the TGCU amine to continue to circulate with steam flowing to
the TGCU Stripper Reboiler, until the all of the H
2
S and CO
2
have
been stripped from the amine. Once the H
2
S/CO
2
content of the
"rich" amine is essentially the same as the "lean" amine, the steam
can be shut off to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler.
V. Continue to circulate the TGCU amine and operate the TGCU Lean
Amine Cooler, the TGCU Lean Amine Trim Cooler, and the TGCU
Stripper Reflux Condenser until the amine is cool.
W. Once the amine is cool (60C or less throughout the system), shut
down the equipment in the following order:
(1) The TGCU Quench Water Pump.
(2) The TGCU Rich Amine Pump.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-150
(3) The TGCU Lean Amine Pump.
(4) The TGCU Stripper Reflux Pump.
(5) The fans on the TGCU Quench Water Cooler, TGCU Lean
Amine Cooler, and TGCU Stripper Reflux Condenser.
X. If the TGCU will be down for an extended period, special precautions
should be taken to prevent the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer tubes
from cooling to the point where water can condense inside them.
Most of the corrosion that occurs in TGCUs is due to the acidic water
that can form if the plant is allowed to get cold.
Close the steam outlet valve on the boiler and open the vent valves
on the boiler to de-pressure it. Make sure that the boiler level control
continues to operate properly so that the water level does not drop
below the tubes until they have cooled and the boiler is fully
de-pressured. Once the boiler is de-pressured, block-in its BFW
supply and drain the water from it. Then use a temporary "jumper" to
supply LP steam to the boiler shell. Drain the condensate from the
boiler occasionally to keep the tubes safely above the water
condensation temperature (100-110C).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-151
11.9.2 Planned Shutdown for Reactor Entry
When the TGCU Reactor must be opened for maintenance or to replace
the catalyst, it is normally necessary to passivate the catalyst as a part of
the shutdown procedure. After the TGCU has been operating for a period
of time, the catalyst becomes pyrophoric due to the presence of iron
sulfide, FeS. Exposing catalyst containing pyrophoric FeS to air may
result in uncontrolled burning of the FeS to form H
2
S and/or SO
2
, which
obviously will prevent the entrance of personnel into the vessel.
For this reason, controlled oxidation ("passivation") of the FeS in the
catalyst is carried out at low temperature (~150C) by admitting a small air
flow into the circulating gas. This converts the FeS into non-pyrophoric
iron oxide, Fe
2
O
3
, while leaving the catalyst in its sulfided state. The only
SO
2
produced during passivation should come from the FeS present.
Pre-sulfiding of the catalyst will not be required during the next startup
(assuming the catalyst is not replaced).
This procedure requires an ample supply of a suitable inert gas (nitrogen,
etc.) to circulate through the TGCU Reactor and cool it. Make sure a
supply of inert gas is available and ready to use before beginning this
procedure. Utility air is used for passivating the catalyst.
In an emergency, or if the catalyst is to be replaced, it can be handled in a
pyrophoric state if it is kept under water or nitrogen. Soaking the catalyst
in water will, however, weaken the catalyst substrate and make the
catalyst more susceptible to crumbling and attrition. For this reason, and
due to the corrosive nature of liquid water on the TGCU Reactor vessel
and piping, this practice is not recommended.
There are service companies, however, that can unload the TGCU
catalyst bed after it has been cooled to near ambient temperature using
nitrogen. The service company then performs all necessary work relating
to removing and replacing the catalyst under a nitrogen "blanket". This
eliminates the need to passivate the catalyst, reducing the time required to
replace the TGCU catalyst. Some refineries and gas plants also purchase
pre-sulfided replacement catalyst, resulting in less time for the subsequent
startup.
The procedure in this section is used to make the TGCU catalyst safe for
atmospheric air replacement.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-152
A. Follow the procedure given previously in Section 11.9.1 to purge the
front-end of the TGCU, to shut down the quench water system, and
to strip, cool, and shut down the amine system, but do not Activate
the TGCU ESD system using the S/D button, or isolate the nitrogen
supply, or close the TGCU outlet Valve (Steps P-R) in
Section 11.9.1).
NOTE: Do not drain the water from the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer (Step X in Section 11.9.1). The boiler and its
BFW controls must remain in service until the completion
of the catalyst passivation procedure.
B. Confirm that the TGCU Outlet Valve is open and start a small
nitrogen purge into the bottom of the TGCU Quench Column. (This is
typically done by hooking up a temporary jumper to a connection on
one of the level bridles.)
This will purge through both the TGCU Quench Column and the
TGCU Contactor and ensure that the SO
2
formed during passivation
does not contaminate the quench water or the amine.
C. If the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer is not already switched to sample from the
outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, check that the sample
line from the outlet of the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer to the
analyzer is clear of liquids, confirm that the sample valve on the
outlet channel of the boiler is open, then switch the sample selector
valve in the analyzer enclosure to the "STARTUP" position.
D. Visually confirm that the TGCU Start-Up Blower suction block valve
and discharge block valve are closed, the bypass valve is open, the
nitrogen purge to the blower seal is in service, and the local "stop"
control at the blower is set to the run position.
E. Start the TGCU Start-Up Blower using the start/stop toggle switch in
the DCS.
The PLC will perform the following actions:
(1) The nitrogen purge valve is closed.
(2) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Suction Valve is opened.
(3) The TGCU Start-Up Blower Discharge Valve is opened.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-153
(4) After the limit switches prove these valves open, the TGCU
Start-Up Blower is started.
(5) Once the Startup Blower is started, the TGCU Start-Up Blower
Bypass Valve is closed.
As this valve is closed, the blower will start to load. As it does so, the
blower will begin to "pull" nitrogen through the TGCU Reactor Feed
Heater and TGCU Reactor Feed Mixer and all of the associated
piping.
F. Once the blower operation has stabilized, open the TGCU
Warmup/Bypass Valve by increasing the output from its hand control
to 100%.
As the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve opens, the TGCU Start-Up
Blower will begin re-circulating gas from the outlet of the TGCU
Waste Heat Reclaimer back to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater (via
the TGCU Contactor overhead line).
G. Once re-circulation has been established, place nitrogen flow
controller in "automatic" and adjust its setpoint to 5-10% of maximum
flow.
H. Allow the front-end of the TGCU to operate in this manner until the
following conditions are both satisfied:
(1) The hydrogen controller shows 0.5% or less hydrogen
concentration in the circulating gas.
(2) The catalyst bed in the TGCU Reactor has been cooled below
150C per the temperatures indicated in the DCS for the
catalyst bed and for the reactor outlet.
I. Verify that the utility air flow controller is in "manual" and set to 0%
output.
J. Verify that flow control valve, the upstream block valve, and the
downstream block valve are all closed in the utility air supply line.
K. Rotate the spectacle blind in the utility air line to the "open" position,
then open the upstream block valve and the downstream block valve.
L. Slowly increase the output from the flow controller to open the flow
valve and admit a small amount of utility air into the circulating gas
and begin passivating the catalyst. A maximum oxygen
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-154
concentration in the range of 0.5-1.0% will probably be required
during the initial stages of passivation.
THE AMOUNT OF AIR ADDED MUST BE LIMITED INITIALLY
TO AVOID EXCESSIVE TEMPERATURE RISE ACROSS THE
TGCU REACTOR AS THE FeS IN THE CATALYST IS
OXIDIZED. TEMPERATURES IN EXCESS OF 175C MAY
CAUSE THE SULFIDED CATALYST TO REACT WITH THE
OXYGEN. IF THIS OCCURS, THE CATALYST WILL HAVE TO
BE PRE-SULFIDED DURING THE NEXT STARTUP. ALSO,
CATALYST DAMAGE MAY OCCUR IF LOCAL CATALYST
TEMPERATURES BECOME EXCESSIVE.
DO NOT ALLOW THE CATALYST BED TEMPERATURES TO
EXCEED 150C. REDUCE THE UTILITY AIR FLOW AS
NECESSARY TO KEEP THE REACTOR BED
TEMPERATURES AND THE OUTLET TEMPERATURE AT
150C OR BELOW.
M. As the temperature rise across the reactor starts to decrease, the
oxygen concentration in the circulating gas may be increased by
using the flow controller to open the flow valve further and increase
the air flow into the circulating stream.
N. When there is no longer any temperature rise across the reactor, the
passivation of the catalyst is complete. Discontinue the flow of
nitrogen to the front-end of the TGCU by placing the nitrogen flow
controller in "manual" and setting its output to 0% to close the control
valve. Observe the TGCU Reactor temperatures to ensure that no
further reaction occurs (leave the nitrogen flowing to the TGCU
Quench Column).
If the catalyst bed temperatures start to rise when the nitrogen flow is
discontinued, re-establish nitrogen flow until the bed cools again,
then stop the nitrogen flow. Repeat this step as necessary until there
is no temperature rise in the reactor with the nitrogen flow shut off.
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-155
O. Once the nitrogen flow has been discontinued, the TGCU Start-Up
Blower is no longer needed for re-circulation. Shut down the blower
as follows:
(1) Reduce the output from the hand control to 0% to close the
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve and stop the recycle flow to the
TGCU Reactor Feed Heater.
Verify that the valve has closed, and that the DCS indicates that
this valve has closed.
(2) Shut down the blower using the start/stop selector switch in the
DCS.
The PLC will open the TGCU Blower Bypass Valve, stop the
blower, turn on the nitrogen purge, and close its suction and
discharge valves. Verify that the DCS indicates each valve has
moved to the proper position.
P. Use the flow controller to raise the utility air flow to 80% or more and
allow air to cool the TGCU Reactor.
Continue the air flow until the temperature leaving the TGCU Reactor
is about the same temperature as the air entering the TGCU
Reactor.
Q. At the completion of the cooling operation, activate the TGCU ESD
using the S/D button to shut down and isolate the utility air.
R. Close the upstream block valve and the downstream block valve in
the utility air supply line, then rotate the spectacle blind to the
"closed" position. Close the steam-jacketed block valve at the
junction with the tailgas line to the TGCU Reactor Feed Heater.
S. Discontinue the flow of nitrogen to the TGCU Quench Column, then
close the TGCU Outlet Valve.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-156
THE OVER-PRESSURE PROTECTION FOR THE TGCU IS
THROUGH THE THERMAL OXIDIZER VENT STACK. HOWEVER,
IF THE TGCU OUTLET VALVE IS CLOSED WHILE THE TGCU IS
SHUT DOWN, STEPS MUST BE TAKEN TO ENSURE THAT THE
TGCU IS NOT COMPLETELY BLOCKED-IN BY CREATING
ANOTHER OPENING FROM THE TGCU TO THE ATMOSPHERE
SO THAT THE TGCU CANNOT BE OVER-PRESSURED.
T. Visually confirm that:
(1) The SRU 1 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is closed.
(2) The SRU 2 Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is closed.
(3) The TGCU Outlet Valve is closed.
(4) The nitrogen to the TGCU Reactor and the TGCU Quench
Column is positively isolated from the TGCU.
(5) The pre-sulfiding gas shutdown valve is closed.
(6) The TGCU Start-Up Blower is shut down, with its suction and
discharge valves closed and the nitrogen purge in service.
(7) The TGCU Quench Column inlet valve and the TGCU Quench
Column bypass valve are closed.
(8) All steam heating services on the sulfur vapor valve jackets are
still functioning and the steam traps are operating properly.
U. The TGCU catalyst is now passivated and cooled, and can be safely
handled. The TGCU is now ready to be isolated and made safe for
entry.
V. If the TGCU will be down for an extended period, special precautions
should be taken to prevent the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer tubes
from cooling to the point where water can condense inside them.
Most of the corrosion that occurs in TGCUs is due to the acidic water
that can form if the plant is allowed to get cold.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-157
Close the steam outlet valve on the boiler and open the vent valves
on the boiler to de-pressure it. Make sure that the boiler level control
continues to operate properly so that the water level does not drop
below the tubes until they have cooled and the boiler is fully
de-pressured. Once the boiler is de-pressured, block-in its BFW
supply and drain the water from it. Then use a temporary "jumper" to
supply LP steam to the boiler shell. Drain the condensate from the
boiler occasionally to keep the tubes safely above the water
condensation temperature (100-110C).
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-158
11.9.3 Shutting Down When Boiler Tubes Are Leaking
One special circumstance that merits discussion is shutting down the
TGCU when there are tube leaks in the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer.
While the plant is running, minor tube leaks usually cause little damage
because the hot process gas vaporizes the boiler feed water before it has
a chance to form acid and cause rapid corrosion. When the TGCU is shut
down, however, several problems can develop:
1. Liquid water may accumulate in the equipment or piping and
form a variety of acids (sulfurous, polythionic, etc.) that will
rapidly corrode the steel.
2. Water and/or steam may reach the TGCU Reactor catalyst and
weaken or damage it.
If a boiler tube leak is suspected, a shutdown procedure similar to the
following may be appropriate:
A. Switch the SRU tailgas from the TGCU to the Thermal Oxidizer.
B. Activate the TGCU ESD system using the S/D button.
C. Close the TGCU Outlet Valve.
D. De-pressure the TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer, taking care to reduce
the pressure slowly enough to avoid over-stressing the boiler.
E. Maintain a visible water level in the boiler. Water must remain in the
boiler until it is de-pressured to prevent overheating damage to the
tubes.
F. Once the boiler is fully de-pressured, drain the water from the boiler
to prevent any further leakage into the process side of the
equipment.
G. The TGCU is now ready to be isolated and made safe for entry.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-159
11.9.4 Special Precaution During Shutdowns
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS VERY IMPORTANT TO
PROTECT THE TGCU DURING SHUTDOWNS. FAILURE TO
OBSERVE THESE PRECAUTIONS CAN LEAD TO "STUCK"
VALVES IN THE PROCESS GAS LINES, RESULTING IN AN
EXTENSIVE (AND EXPENSIVE) SHUTDOWN TO REPAIR THE
VALVE(S).
When a TGCU is shut down for any appreciable length of time, water
vapor in the process gas can condense and accumulate in the low spots.
Since the process gas contains CO
2
, H
2
S, SO
2
, and other compounds, the
condensed water can be quite acidic. As this acid water trickles over the
piping, it corrodes the metal. If this water then reaches a steam-jacketed
valve or pipe, the water will boil away and deposit the corrosion products
on the heated surface. This occurrence can quickly cause a
steam-jacketed valve to become "stuck", which usually results in an
extended shutdown to repair the valve before that TGCU can be restarted.
This problem can be prevented, by keeping water from accumulating near
these valves during shutdowns. The valves to be protected are:
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve
TGCU Outlet Valve
The most positive means for preventing condensation of water in the unit
is to purge it with inert gas (nitrogen, etc.). One way to accomplish this is
as follows:
A. Confirm that the Quench Column hand control in the DCS is set to
0% output.
B. Confirm that the SRU Tailgas Valve to the TGCU is closed.
C. Confirm that the Leak Test switch in the DCS is toggled to "OFF".
D. Switch the Startup/Run selector switch in the DCS to "STARTUP".
CAUTION
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-160
The PLC will open the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve. Verify
that the DCS indicates that the Quench Column Bypass Valve is
open.
E. Toggle the Leak Test switch to "ON".
F. Close the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve by reducing the output of
the hand control to 0%. Verify that the DCS indicates that the valve
has closed.
G. Verify that the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve is open and that
the DCS indicates that the valve is fully open.
H. Open the steam-jacketed block valve in the nitrogen supply line.
I. Toggle the Nitrogen On/Off switch in the DCS to "ON".
J. Place the nitrogen flow controller in "manual" and adjust its output to
open the control valve slightly and establish a small flow of nitrogen
into the front-end of the TGCU.
K. "Crack" the TGCU Outlet Valve open slightly to allow the nitrogen to
flow to the Thermal Oxidizer. Adjust the TGCU Outlet Valve to
"pinch" so that the pressure in the TGCU is slightly positive (about
0.07-0.15 kg/cm
2
(g)) on the pressure indicator in the DCS.
L. With the valves arranged in this manner, the purge gas will proceed
as follows:
(1) Through the TGCU Rector Feed Heater, TGCU Reactor Feed
Mixer, TGCU Reactor, and TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer.
(2) Through the TGCU Quench Column Bypass Valve.
(3) Through the TGCU Start-Up Blower Bypass Valve.
(4) Through the TGCU Contactor overhead line, flowing past the
TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve.
(5) Through the TGCU Outlet Valve and out to the Thermal
Oxidizer.
This will keep purge gas sweeping through or past all of the
steam-jacketed process gas valves so that condensed water will not
accumulate and cause problems.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-161
If it is not possible to purge the TGCU with inert gas while it is shut
down, it is possible to protect these valves by using drain valves to
prevent the accumulation of water near the steam-jacketed valves.
In order to accomplish this, drain valves in the following locations are
used:
(1) In the bottom of the TGCU Contactor overhead line, between
the TGCU Warmup/Bypass Valve and the TGCU
Warmup/Bypass Valve.
(2) In the bottom of the outlet line from the TGCU Waste Heat
Reclaimer.
With these drain valves open, there should not be significant
accumulation of condensed water near any of the steam-jacketed
process gas block valves.
BE CERTAIN THAT THE SRU TAILGAS VALVES TO THE
TGCU, AND THE TGCU OUTLET VALVE ARE CLOSED IF THE
SRU IS OPERATING WHEN THE TGCU IS SHUT DOWN.
LEAVING EITHER OF THESE VALVES OPEN WHILE THE SRU
IS OPERATING WILL ALLOW SRU TAILGAS TO ENTER THE
TGCU, RESULTING IN SOLVENT CONTAMINATION,
CORROSION DAMAGE, AND POSSIBLE PERSONNEL
EXPOSURE TO H
2
S AND SO
2
.
MAKE CERTAIN ALL THESE DRAIN VALVES ARE CLOSED
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO RESTART THE TGCU.
To use these drain valves, proceed as follows:
A. Confirm that the SRU Tailgas Valves to the TGCU are closed.
B. Close the TGCU Outlet Valve. Make sure that this valve is
closed tightly.
C. Open the two special drain valves. Observe appropriate
precautions to prevent personnel exposure to H
2
S and/or SO
2
that may still be contained in the unit, or that may leak into the
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-162
unit later. It is recommended that warning signs be posted to
identify the hazard that exists near these drain valves.
D. Check the drain valves periodically to be sure that process gas
is not escaping to the surroundings.
E. Close the drain valves before attempting to restart the
TGCU.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-163
11.9.5 Emergency Shutdown
The TGCU ESD system can be initiated by any of the actuating devices
outlined in Section 11.5 of these guidelines. The operator must determine
and correct the condition causing the shutdown before the TGCU can be
restarted. The problems outlined below should be investigated first by the
operator in his troubleshooting procedure.
S/D Actuation Device Possible Causes
TGCU Reactor
High-High Outlet Temperature
1. The sulfur plant(s) is(are) off-ratio
causing the SRU tailgas stream to
contain large amounts of SO
2
,
resulting in excessive heat release
in the catalyst bed.
2. Malfunction of the reactor feed
heater temperature control system
or control valve.
3. The utility air normally used during
shutdown operations to passivate
the catalyst has been left open.
TGCU Waste Heat Reclaimer
Low-Low Level
1. Loss of make-up water supply
pressure.
2. Make-up water line plugged, or
manual block valve closed or
pinched.
3. Malfunction of the level control
system.
4. Manual blowdown valve left open.
Complete Flowpath Interlock 1. The TGCU outlet block valve is not
fully open.
2. An automated process gas valve in
the TGCU has failed to open fully
as directed by the PLC.
3. Malfunction of the limit switch is
causing a false indication that the
valve is not open.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-164
11.9.6 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems
The Tailgas Cleanup system is directly or indirectly affected by shutdowns
and/or outages in five other systems in the complex. These effects are
described below.
11.9.6.1 Amine Regeneration Unit Outages
Amine acid gas flow from the Amine Regeneration Unit(s) can be
interrupted for a variety of reasons. For instance, the gas flow to the
absorber in the complex can be blocked manually or automatically,
the amine flow from the flash tank to the stripper can be interrupted,
etc. When these events occur, the acid gas flow will not cease
immediately due to the residence time in the amine distribution
piping, the flash tank, and the stripper. If processing in the affected
Amine Regeneration Unit is restarted within the time frame of this
system residence time, the amine acid gas flow to the SRUs
upstream of the TGCU will probably dip, but should not stop
completely.
If the interruption in the Amine Regeneration Unit is long enough,
though, the amine acid gas flow can fall far enough to cause the acid
gas flame(s) in the SRU(s) to become unstable, at which point the
SRU ESD system will be activated by "flame failure".
Section 11.9.6.3 below describes the effect of this on the TGCU.
11.9.6.2 Sour Water Stripper Outages
SWS gas flow from the Sour Water Stripper can also be interrupted
for a variety of reasons. However, since the loss of SWS gas flow to
the SRUs generally has minimal impact, outages in this system are
usually of little consequence to the SRUs or the TGCU.
11.9.6.3 Sulfur Recovery Unit ESD System
The SRU ESD systems stop the flow of acid gas to the affected
SRU. As a result, the tailgas flow from that SRU ceases almost
immediately. If only a single SRU shuts down, the TGCU will stay
online processing SRU tailgas from the remaining SRU. However, if
both SRUs shutdown, then there would be no SRU tailgas flowing
through the front-end of the TGCU, and consequently nothing to
process. So, the TGCU is shut down whenever the both of the sulfur
plants shut down.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-165
However, if the TGCU is not yet processing tailgas from either SRU,
there is no reason to shut it down if the SRUs are not running. This
simplifies startup of the TGCU by allowing its ESD system to be
independent of the SRU ESD systems until tailgas is introduced into
the TGCU.
11.9.6.4 Thermal Oxidizer ESD System
A TTO ESD has no direct effect on the TGCU, as the flow of TGCU
effluent to the Thermal Oxidizer will not be interrupted. However,
when the TTO ESD shuts down the Thermal Oxidizer Burner, the
sulfur compounds in the Thermal Oxidizer feed gas will no longer be
oxidized to sulfur dioxide. This means that hydrogen sulfide will be
vented to the atmosphere from the top of the Thermal Oxidizer Vent
Stack. Under normal circumstances, this is not a cause for concern
because the TGCU is processing the SRU tailgas. Since the H
2
S
content of the TGCU effluent should be low and the stack is tall,
dangerous ground level concentrations of H
2
S should not develop.
However, note the warning that appears in Section 12.6.2 of these
guidelines regarding high temperature in the Thermal Oxidizer if the
SRU tailgas and/or TGCU effluent gas contains excessive amounts
of H
2
S. Also, note that the operating permit for this plant may not
allow venting un-incinerated gases for extended periods. Review the
permit before operating in this mode for a lengthy period.
If the H
2
S concentration in the TTO feed gas is high (above 3.0%),
do not attempt to restart the Thermal Oxidizer. Instead, direct your
attention to the amine or SWS unit upstream of the SRUs that is
probably causing the problem and bring the SRUs back on-ratio.
This will allow the TGCU to reduce the H
2
S concentration in the
Thermal Oxidizer feed gas to an acceptable level, so that restart of
the Thermal Oxidizer can proceed smoothly.
Failure to correct the upstream problem(s) first will likely lead to
the TTO shutting down again on high-high temperature,
requiring another restart of the TTO.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-166
11.9.6.5 Steam System Outage
There are three impacts on the TGCU if the complex steam system
is shut down. One of these will only create problems if the steam
supply to the TGCU is unavailable for a long period of time - the
heating for the steam-jacketed process gas valves will be lost,
possibly leading to solid sulfur freezing in these valves.
The most immediate impact on the TGCU will be the loss of
LP steam to the TGCU Stripper Reboiler if the steam outage lasts
long enough. As the heat input to the reboiler declines, stripping of
the acid gas from the amine will decline and the H
2
S in the TGCU
effluent gas leaving the TGCU Contactor will begin to increase. This
will quickly lead to high SO
2
emissions from the Thermal Oxidizer
Vent Stacks as indicated in the DCS.
A third impact on the TGCU will be the loss of LP steam to the
stripper reboilers in the Amine Regeneration Unit if the steam outage
lasts long enough. As the heat input to the reboilers declines,
stripping of the acid gas from the amine will decline and the amine
acid gas flow rate to the SRUs will gradually diminish. If the amine
acid gas flow falls far enough to cause an acid gas flame to become
unstable, the SRU ESD system will be activated by "flame failure" as
described previously in the discussion about the Amine Regeneration
Unit outages, with the resulting impact on the TGCU as previously
described in Section 11.9.6.3.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-167
11.10 Analytical Procedures
This Section contains analytical procedures for determining:
1. The concentrations of total amine in the TGCU solvent (Section 11.10.2).
2. The concentrations of H2S and CO2 in the TGCU solvent (Sections
11.10.3 and 11.10.4).
3. The foaming tendency of TGCU solvent (Section 11.10.5).
4. The H2S content of the TGCU Contactor overhead gas (Sections 11.10.6
and 11.10.7).
5. The performance level of the TGCU Reactor catalyst (Section 11.10.8).
11.10.1 General Procedures for Analyzing TGCU Solvent
1,2
An amine solution which is to be analyzed should first be inspected
visually. If conducted by an experienced person, such an inspection will
often yield important clues to the identity of a number of contaminants.
For example, a green color in an amine solution usually indicates finely
divided iron sulfide in sub-colloidal particle size (<1 micron), whereas a
finely divided black suspension indicates the presence of larger
(>3 micron) iron sulfide particles. A green or blue solution can indicate the
possibility of either copper or nickel, while an amber colored solution may
contain suspended or dissolved iron oxide. Iron may complex with the
amine an give the solution an amber or dark red color. Thermal
degradation of the amine may give the solution a dark red to brown color.
Amines sometimes display a red or dark brown color resulting from
oxidation, particularly when combined with thermal degradation. An oil
slick on the solution or an oil-like odor is indicative of hydrocarbon
contamination. The presence of these contaminants, however, must be
proven by analysis.
The next step in analyzing an amine solution is the determination of the
percent amine and the acid gas content (H
2
S and CO
2
). Both rich and
lean solutions may be analyzed for these constituents, and from the
analyses the extent of acid gas loading and efficiency of stripping can be
ascertained. Procedures for these analyses are given in Sections 11.10.2
through 11.10.4 that follow.
1
The Dow Chemical Company, Gas Conditioning Fact Book, 1962, pp. 310-311.
2
Dow Chemical U.S.A., Gas Treating from Dow, 1987, pp. 8-1-1 8-1-2.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-168
In addition to the procedure in Section 11.10.2, the amine concentration of
the solvent can be determined by performing Kjeldahl and Van Slyke
nitrogen analyses. The Kjeldahl determination indicates the total nitrogen
content of the solution, including nitrogen from the amine and from amine
degradation products. The Van Slyke method, on the other hand, shows
amine content, but does not reveal the extent to which the original amine
has been degraded or tied up as heat stable salts. The difference
between the results obtained through Kjeldahl and Van Slyke analyses
usually indicates the degree of amine degradation. As would be
expected, little difference is obtained with initial or unused solution. These
analyses are not commonly performed in plant laboratories, but are
generally left to the chemical solvent supplier.
Heat stable salts can also be determined by a total anion assay. The
amine solution is passed through an ion exchange column containing ion
exchange resin in the hydrogen form. Acid salts are thus broken down
and the acids recovered in the column effluent, while the amine is
absorbed in the column. The acid in the effluent is determined by
potentiometric titration, and from these results plus the original amine
concentration the amount of amine in the form of heat stable salts is
calculated. Again, this type of analysis is commonly left for the chemical
solvent supplier to perform.
The foaming characteristics of an amine solution are determined
empirically in a simple apparatus consisting of an air (or gas) supply,
pressure regulator or gas manometer, graduated glass cylinder, and a gas
dispersion tube. The amine solution is poured into the graduated cylinder
and air passed through at a constant rate. After five minutes, the height of
the foam is recorded, the air flow is interrupted, and the time for the foam
to break is determined. The results thus obtained will indicate whether or
not evaluation of anti-foam agents is desirable. Section 11.10.5 describes
this procedure more completely.
A water analysis can be conducted on the amine solution to obtain a
material balance and serve as an approximate check on the amine
concentration. This is typically determined using the Karl Fischer method
of analysis, but most plant laboratories leave this procedure to the
chemical solvent supplier.
Ordinarily, the above analyses will provide an accurate picture of the
condition of the amine plant solution. At times, however, unusual
operational difficulties may be encountered in amine sweetening units
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-169
because of contaminants which are not revealed by the usual analytical
methods. When this occurs, infrared spectroscopic analysis may often be
utilized to good advantage.
Infrared spectroscopy is based on the principle that each molecule or
functional group exhibits its own particular absorption characteristics when
exposed to infrared light of a definite wavelength. A wide variety of
functional groups can be readily detected and identified by infrared
techniques. For example, it has been found that degraded or oxidized
amine solutions may contain ammonia, formic acid, a di-functional acid, a
carbonyl compound yielding a glyoxal dinitrophenylhydrazone derivative,
and a high molecular weight material that exhibits the characteristics of a
Jones polymer. Also, both mono- and di-substituted amines have been
identified. Each component exhibits its own particular effects on
corrosion, foaming, and acid gas absorption, effects which can be
determined only by the separate evaluation of each contaminant. Once
these effects are determined, a knowledge of functional groups present
and their relative concentration makes it possible to anticipate which types
of contaminants may be causing difficulties. The chemical solvent
supplier can usually perform this type of analysis more easily than the
plant laboratory.
Steps should be taken to ensure that the amine solution samples taken
are representative of the circulating solvent. Samples should be taken in
glass or plastic containers. Metal containers will cause low results for H
2
S
because sulfides will react with the metal walls of the container. Do not
use copper tubing to withdraw the samples; the copper will contaminate
the amine solution, and H
2
S will react with the copper and give low
results.
Special care should be exercised when taking samples of the rich amine
solution to avoid personnel exposure to H
2
S. Hot, fully loaded amine
solution can flash acid gas when released to atmospheric pressure,
causing low acid gas loading results in addition to the dispersion of H
2
S to
the surroundings. Take samples of the rich solution from the coolest point
in the process (the TGCU Contactor outlet, usually), and cool the samples
in a stainless steel coil immersed in an ice bath or cold water to prevent
flashing. The solution should be allowed to flow to a drain in this fashion
for several minutes before taking the sample to be sure that circulating
amine is being taken.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-170
In the laboratory procedures that follow, several different reagents are
used that can be harmful if proper care is not exercised. Acids, bases,
and flammable substances are utilized in these procedures, so adherence
to proper laboratory safety practices is necessary to ensure the safety of
all personnel.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-171
11.10.2 Determination of Amine Concentration in TGCU Solvent
The amine concentration in the TGCU solvent can be determined by acid
titration of the lean solution. This technique is not specific for free amine,
however, as amine present in the solution as an amine-acid salt will also
react during the titration. This technique will also give erroneous results if
there are other basic materials in the solution, such as caustic or soda ash
(sometimes used to "neutralize" heat stable salts).
1. Reagents: Distilled or Deionized Water
0.5 N Hydrochloric Acid (HCl)
Bromophenol Blue Indicator
(3',3'',5',5''-tetrabromophenolsulfonephthalein)
2. Procedure:
a. Place about 95 ml of distilled or deionized water in a 250 ml
beaker or Erlenmeyer flask.
b. Add about 5 ml of lean amine solution to the water in the beaker
via pipette, recording the actual quantity.
c. Add 5 drops of Bromophenol Blue indicator to the solution in the
beaker and stir well.
d. Titrate the solution in the beaker with 0.5 N HCl to a faint yellow
color. Alternatively, if a pH meter is available, titrate to a pH of
4.5. Record the amount of HCl used in the titration.
3. Chemical reaction involved:
R
2
HN + HCl R
2
HNH
+
+ Cl
where R
2
HN = CH
3
-N-(CH
2
-CH
2
-OH)
2
= MDEA
(methyldiethanolamine)
As the hydrochloric acid is added to the solution, it reacts with the
amine to form a chloride salt. Once all the amine has reacted, the
continued addition of acid causes the pH of the solution to drop, until
the Bromophenol Blue indicator changes from blue to yellow. Note
that HCl reacts with the amine on a 1:1 molar basis.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-172
4. Calculation of Weight Percent Amine:
(
(
(
=
Sample Amine
of Gravity Sp.
Sample
of ml
Solution HCl
of Normality
Used
HCl ml
l / ml 1000
100%
Weight
Mole
Amine
Amine
% Weight
The molecular weight of MDEA is 119.17, and the specific gravity of
the solution at room temperature (20C) is about 1.059, assuming
the solution is about 45 wt% MDEA. The equation can then be
simplified to:
Sample
of ml
Solution HCl
of Normality
Used
HCl ml
11.253 Amine % Weight
(
=
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-173
11.10.3 Determination of Total Acid Gas Loading in TGCU Solvent
The total acid gas (H
2
S + CO
2
) loading, relative to the amine
concentration, in either the lean or rich TGCU solvent can be determined
by base titration of the solution. This procedure does not distinguish
between H
2
S and CO
2
. However, together with the procedure in
Section 11.10.4, the individual concentrations of H
2
S and CO
2
can be
determined.
1. Reagents: Methanol (CH
3
OH), Anhydrous
0.5 N Potassium Hydroxide (KOH) Solution in Methanol
Thymolphthalein Indicator in Methanol
2. Procedure:
a. Place about 125 ml of methanol in a 250 ml beaker or
Erlenmeyer flask.
b. If a pH meter is available, insert the pH meter probe into the
methanol in the beaker and adjust the pH of the methanol to
11.2 by titrating the methanol in the beaker with the 0.5 N KOH.
c. If a pH meter is not available, add 5 drops of Thymolphthalein
indicator to the methanol in the beaker. Titrate the solution in
the beaker with 0.5 N KOH until the solution turns a faint blue
color, indicating a pH of 11.2. The change to faint blue will be
sudden, so add the KOH slowly (one drop at a time).
d. Add about 20 ml of lean amine solution to the methanol in the
beaker via pipette, recording the actual quantity. If rich amine
solution is being tested, use about 10 ml of solution instead.
e. Titrate the solution in the beaker with 0.5 N KOH back to a pH
of 11.2 (or until the solution again turns a faint blue color when
using Thymolphthalein indicator). Record the amount of KOH
used in this titration.
3. Chemical reactions involved:
H
2
S + KOH K
+
+ HS
+ H
2
O
CO
2
+ KOH K
+
+ HCO
3
As the potassium hydroxide is added to the solution, it reacts with the
H
2
S and CO
2
to form potassium hydrosulfide and potassium
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-174
hydrogen carbonate salts. Once all of the acid gas has reacted, the
continued addition of base causes the pH of the solution to rise, until
the Thymolphthalein indicator changes from colorless to blue. Note
that KOH reacts with H
2
S and CO
2
on a 1:1 molar basis.
4. Calculation of Acid Gas Loading (molar basis):
(
(
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of S.G.
Sample
of ml
Solution KOH
of Normality
Used
KOH ml
l / ml 1000
100%
Weight
Mole
Amine
Amine Mole
Gas Acid Moles
Note that "ml KOH used" refers to the amount used in the second
titration, step 2.e. The "wt % amine in solvent" can be determined
using the procedure in Section 11.10.2.
The molecular weight of MDEA is 119.17, and the specific gravity of
the solution at room temperature (20C) is about 1.059, assuming
the solution is about 45 wt% MDEA. The equation can then be
simplified to:
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of ml
Solution KOH
of Normality
Used
KOH ml
11.253
Amine Mole
Gas Acid Moles
5. Special Considerations:
a. Excess moisture in the equipment will give false readings.
Water may be used to clean the equipment if the equipment is
thoroughly dried prior to use with the anhydrous methanol.
b. The faint blue titration endpoint using Thymolphthalein indicator
is not definite. It may best be determined by comparing the
color of the solution against a reference prepared by titrating a
second sample of methanol-Thymolphthalein to the same color.
c. The KOH solution and Thymolphthalein indicator solution
should be kept tightly closed to prevent loss of methanol by
vaporization. Any vaporization of methanol from the KOH
solution will change the normality of the solution.
d. The Thymolphthalein indicator solution can be prepared by
dissolving 5 grams of thymolphthalein in 100 ml of anhydrous
methanol.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-175
11.10.4 Determination of H
2
S and CO
2
Loading in TGCU Solvent
The H
2
S loading, relative to the amine concentration, in either the lean or
rich TGCU solvent can be determined by titration of the solution with
iodine. Since CO
2
does not react with iodine, this procedure is specific for
H
2
S. Together with the total acid gas loading determined using the
procedure in Section 11.10.3, the individual concentrations of H
2
S and
CO
2
can be determined.
1. Reagents: Distilled or Deionized Water
Concentrated Hydrochloric Acid (HCl) or Sulfuric Acid
(H
2
SO
4
)
Standard Starch Solution - 1%
0.1 N Iodine Solution (I
2
)
0.1 N Sodium Thiosulfate Solution (Na
2
S
2
O
3
)
2. Procedure:
a. Measure about 25 ml of chilled iodine solution and place it in a
250 ml beaker or Erlenmeyer flask. Record the amount of
iodine solution used.
b. Carefully add about 25 ml of concentrated acid to the beaker.
c. Add about 5 ml of standard starch solution to the beaker, then
re-chill the beaker in an ice batch for 2-3 minutes.
d. Slowly add 10-20 ml of lean amine solution to the solution in the
beaker via pipette, recording the actual quantity. If rich amine
solution is being tested, use 1-2 ml of solution instead.
e. Use about 25 ml of distilled or deionized water to rinse the
inside of the beaker, then swirl the contents gently to mix the
solution without splashing it.
f. Titrate the excess iodine in the sample with the sodium
thiosulfate solution until the blue color disappears. The end
point is a pale yellow or clear color. The approach of the
endpoint is usually indicated by a milky brown tint at the top of
the liquid surface. As the endpoint nears, slow the rate of
titration and use a small amount of distilled or deionized water
to wash the flask. Record the amount of sodium thiosulfate
solution used in this titration.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-176
g. Check the pH of the titrated solution with pH paper to be sure
the solution is acidic. If the solution is not acidic, repeat the
procedure but use more acid in step 2.b.
3. Chemical reactions involved:
H
2
S + I
2
S + 2 HI
I
2
+ Na
2
S
2
O
3
2 S + NaI + NaIO
3
When the solvent is added to the iodine solution, the H
2
S in the
solvent reacts with the iodine to form hydrogen iodide and elemental
sulfur. The solution contains an excess of iodine to ensure that all of
the H
2
S reacts. The iodine solution is chilled prior to adding the
solvent to eliminate or minimize the evolution of H
2
S gas. Note that
H
2
S reacts with iodine on a 1:1 molar basis.
When the sodium thiosulfate solution is added to the solution, it
reacts with the remaining iodine to form sodium iodide and sodium
iodate, along with more elemental sulfur. (It is this elemental sulfur
that may cause the titrated solution to appear pale yellow.) Once the
last bit of iodine is consumed, the starch solution loses its
characteristic blue color. The amount of H
2
S in the solvent sample is
then calculated from the difference between the total iodine and the
iodine that reacts with the sodium thiosulfate. Note that sodium
thiosulfate reacts with iodine on a 1:1 molar basis.
The purpose of the concentrated acid is to neutralize the amine so
that it will release the H
2
S (a weaker acid) so it can react with the
iodine. If the titrated solution is not acidic in step 2.g, then the amine
was not fully neutralized and the H
2
S determination will not be
correct.
4. Calculation of H
2
S Loading (Molar Basis):
(
=
equivalent - g 2
mole - g 1
ml 1000
liter 1
Solution
of Normality
used
ml
Used
moles - g
2
2
2
I
I
I
(
(
(
(
(
=
equivalent - g 2
mole - g 1
ml 1000
liter 1
Solution
O S Na
of Normality
used
O S Na
ml
Used
O S Na
moles - g
3 2 2 3 2 2 3 2 2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-177
( )
(
(
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of S.G.
Sample
of ml
Used O S Na
moles - g
Used
moles - g
% 100
Weight
Mole
Amine
Amine Mole
S H Moles
3 2 2 2
2
I
The "wt % amine in solvent" can be determined using the procedure
in Section 11.10.2.
The molecular weight of MDEA is 119.17, and the specific gravity of
the solution at room temperature (20C) is about 1.059, assuming
the solution is about 45 wt% MDEA. Using these values and
substituting the first and second equations into the third, these
equations can be simplified to:
(
(
(
(
(
=
Solvent in
Amine % Wt
Sample
of ml
Solution
O S Na
of Normality
Used
O S Na ml
Solution
of
Normality
Used
ml
5.626
Amine Mole
S H Moles
3 2 2
3 2 2
2
2
2
I
I
5. Calculation of CO
2
Loading (Molar Basis):
Using the total acid gas loading determined with the procedure in
Section 11.10.3, the CO
2
loading of the solvent is determined by
difference:
(
=
Amine Mole
S H Moles
Amine Mole
Gas Acid Moles
Amine Mole
CO Moles
2 2
6. Other Common Units:
The loadings calculated above can be easily converted to other units
commonly used within the industry:
(
=
Sample
of S.G.
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
S H Moles
166.7
Solvent Gallon
S H Grains
2 2
(
=
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
S H Moles
0.2858 S H % Wt
2
2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-178
(
=
Sample
of S.G.
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
CO Moles
0.2653
Solvent Gallon
CO SCF
2 2
(
=
Sample in
Amine % Wt
Amine Mole
CO Moles
0.3693 CO % Wt
2
2
Note that these conversions are specifically for MDEA. Other
amines require different conversion factors.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-179
11.10.5 Determination of Foaming Tendency of TGCU Solvent
The procedure described in this section is an empirical method for
measuring the foaming tendency of aqueous amine solvents, universally
accepted within the industry.
1. Principle:
Air is bubbled through a solvent sample at a fixed rate for five
minutes, at which time the foam height is measured. The air flow is
stopped and the time for the foam to disappear is measured. The
foam height and "break" time are indicative of how high the foaming
tendency of the solvent is.
2. Equipment: 1000 ml Graduated Cylinder
Aquarium Air Pump (or laboratory air supply) with
Bubble Stone
Stop Watch (or regular watch with a second hand)
3. Procedure:
a. Pour about 200 ml of the sample solution into the graduated
cylinder and insert the bubble stone into the bottom of the
cylinder.
b. Record the level of sample in the cylinder (in ml).
c. Start the air pump or air supply to agitate the sample with
oil-free air at 4 liters per minute (0.2 Nm
3
/H).
d. After five minutes, record the height of the foam in the cylinder
(in ml). Then turn off the air supply and measure the time in
seconds for the foam to "break". For consistency, foam "break"
is defined as the first clear "fish eye" in the surface of the liquid
in the cylinder.
4. Calculation:
Foam Height = Height of Foam - Initial Height of Sample (in ml)
5. Interpretation:
Considerable experience with this test has shown that if the foam
height exceeds 200 ml or the "break" time exceeds 5 seconds, the
plant may be experiencing a foaming problem. The higher the foam
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-180
height and/or the longer it takes to "break", the more severe the
problem.
6. Other Considerations:
a. A nitrogen cylinder with the pressure regulated to about
0.35 kg/cm
2
(g), equipped with a flow rotameter, may be used
instead of air. Be sure to keep the tubing and fittings oil-free.
b. This procedure can be used to evaluate the effects of anti-foam
agents on the solvent. However, care must be exercised in
cleaning the equipment between tests since a very small
quantity of residual anti-foam agent will affect the test.
c. Foaming is sometimes caused by contaminants in the solvent
that can be removed by activated carbon treatment. The effect
of activated carbon filtration can be evaluated by running foam
tests on treated and untreated samples. The sample is treated
by mixing it with a quantity of carbon (12-20 mesh) to remove
the contaminant, then filtering the mixture through Whatman
No. 41 filter paper.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-181
11.10.6 H
2
S Conc. in TGCU Contactor Ovhd by the Tutweiler Method
The overhead gas from the TGCU Contactor can be sampled from the
sample connection near the sample line for the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer.
1. Using a 500 ml Tutweiler apparatus, sample and titrate the treated
gas leaving the TGCU Contactor as outlined in Section 7.10.1 of
these guidelines.
2. Chemical reaction involved:
H
2
S + I
2
2 HI + S
The hydrogen sulfide (H
2
S) is converted to small particles of
elemental sulfur by the iodine during the shaking. Good shaking is
required to get good contact between the hydrogen sulfide in the gas
and the iodine in the liquid. When all of the hydrogen sulfide is
converted, the excess iodine causes the characteristic blue color in
the presence of starch. This is a universal test for starch. (Iodine
causes a blue color when it contacts starchy foods, such as potato
for example.)
3. Calculation of Mole (or Volume) percent H
2
S (dry basis):
(
+
(
=
V.P. - P
760
289
T 73 2
(11.85)
Solution Iodine
of Normality
Used Solution
Iodine ml
S H % Mole
2
Where T = sample temperature, C
P = atmospheric pressure at particular location, mm Hg
V.P = vapor pressure of water at sample temperature, mm Hg
The Normality of the standard iodine solution will be 0.1 N. The last
three factors (which correct the actual H
2
S content to compensate for
expansion due to temperature, pressure, and water content) can be
combined and calculated as a function of temperature only. This has
been done for the 500-ml gas sample and is included as the
Tutweiler Factor Chart in Section 9.10 of these guidelines (Chart 2).
Therefore, the equation above can be simplified to:
(
(
(
(
(
(
=
Chart Factor
Tutweiler
from Factor
Solution
Iodine of
Normality
Used
Solution
Iodine ml
10,000 S H PPM
2
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-182
11.10.7 H
2
S Conc. in TGCU Contactor Ovhd Using Gas Detector Tubes
As an alternative to the traditional wet-chemistry method described in the
preceding Section 11.10.6 for determining the concentration of H
2
S in the
TGCU Contactor overhead gas, gas detector tubes can be used to quickly
and easily make this determination. Although the discussion that follows
specifically addresses using gas detector tubes manufactured by
Drgerwerk AG of West Germany, there may be suitable detector tubes
available from other manufacturers. Drger tubes can be purchased from
most safety equipment supply companies.
The following Drger tubes can be used with this procedure:
H
2
S 5/b Drger Cat. No. CH 298 01
H
2
S 100/a Drger Cat. No. CH 291 01
11.10.7.1 Operating Principles
Drger tubes and other gas detector tubes measure gas
concentrations by using a sample pump to draw a specific volume of
the gas to be sampled into a glass tube containing a suitable
reagent. The gaseous compound of interest chemically reacts with
the reagent to produce a color change. The length of the "stain" line
is a direct function of the concentration of the compound in the
sample gas. Some detector tubes are calibrated with measured lines
to allow reading the concentration directly on the tube. Others, such
as the two listed above, have reference marks on the tube that can
be multiplied by a factor to compute the concentration.
Drger tubes are designed to be used with a Drger Model 31 gas
detector pump. This is a hand-operated bellows pump that will draw
a 100 cc sample volume for each pump stroke. Some tubes are
designed for a single sample stroke, while others may use 5, 10, or
even 20 strokes. In some cases, a tube may be used for measuring
different concentration ranges by using a different number of strokes.
a. Drger Cat. No. CH 298 01, H
2
S 5/b
This tube will measure H
2
S concentrations in the range of
50 PPM to 600 PPM when one sample stroke is used. If
desired, the range can be reduced to 5 PPM to 60 PPM by
using 10 sample strokes. Each tube contains a substrate of a
white lead compound. When exposed to H
2
S, the lead
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-183
compound is converted to brown lead sulfide. The H
2
S
concentration in PPM can be read directly from the marks on
the tube according to the length of the brown stain when using
10 sample strokes. If only one sample stroke is used, the tube
reading is multiplied by 10 to give the PPM of H
2
S. This lead
sulfide reaction is not affected by any of the other compounds
normally found in the overhead gas from the TGCU Contactor.
b. Drger Cat. No. CH 291 01, H
2
S 100/a
This tube will measure H
2
S concentrations in the range of
100 PPM to 2,000 PPM when one sample stroke is used. Each
tube contains a substrate of a white lead compound. When
exposed to H
2
S, the lead compound is converted to brown lead
sulfide. The H
2
S concentration in PPM can be read directly
from the marks on the tube according to the length of the brown
stain. This lead sulfide reaction is not affected by any of the
other compounds normally found in the overhead gas from the
TGCU Contactor.
11.10.7.2 Sampling the TGCU Contactor Overhead Gas
The overhead gas from the TGCU Contactor can be sampled from
the sample connection near the sample line for the H
2
/H
2
S analyzer.
1. Before beginning, check the Drger pump for leaks by inserting
an unopened tube into the pump and stroking the pump.
Confirm that the bellows does not re-expand. If it does, either
the pump or its seal around the tube is leaking, and the test
results will not be accurate.
2. Attach a short piece of rubber tubing to the process sample
valve.
3. Break off the tips at each end of a Drger tube and insert it into
the sample pump (with the arrow on the side of the tube pointing
toward the pump).
4. Purge the rubber tubing by venting gas to the atmosphere for a
few seconds. Pinch the rubber tubing closed at the end, close
the gas sample valve, slip the end of the rubber tubing onto the
end of the Drger tube, and reopen the sample valve.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-184
5. Stroke the sample pump one time (be sure to compress the
bellows until reaching the stops) and allow the pump to draw the
gas sample into the detector tube. The sample stroke is
complete when the metal chain on the bellows is taut.
6. Close the sample valve and remove the rubber tubing from the
end of the Drger tube and from the sample valve.
7. Read the length of the brown stain using the marks on the tube
and record the reading.
11.10.7.3 Calculations
Mole (or Volume) PPM H
2
S (wet basis):
(
=
mbar Pres., Baro.
1013
Factor
Tube
Length
Stain
S H PPM
2
The last factor corrects the measurement for pressure effects when
samples are taken at elevations above sea level. Note that the
average barometric pressure at the complex is
14.7 PSIA = 1013 mbar.
The "Tube Factor" depends on the type of Drger tube used and the
number of sample strokes:
Drger Tube Catalog No. Sample Strokes Tube Factor
H
2
S 5/b CH 298 01 1 10
H
2
S 5/b CH 298 01 10 1
H
2
S 100/a CH 291 01 1 1
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-185
11.10.8 Monitoring the Performance Level of TGCU Catalyst
The activity of the cobalt-molybdenum catalyst in the TGCU Reactor
should remain adequate for years. For trouble-shooting purposes,
however, its activity should be monitored at regular intervals, beginning at
the initial startup, to establish its baseline performance.
Two of the reactions that occur in the TGCU Reactor (refer to
Section 11.6.3 of these guidelines for a complete discussion) are:
CO + H
2
O H
2
+ CO
2
COS + H
2
O H
2
S + CO
2
The first reaction is the classic "water gas shift" reaction. Since this is an
equilibrium reaction, an equilibrium constant for the reaction can be
expressed in terms of the reactant and product concentrations:
| || |
| || | O H CO
CO H
K
2
2 2
eq
=
This equilibrium constant is mainly a function of temperature. Since the
TGCU Reactor outlet temperature for a given plant is fairly constant, as
are the concentrations of CO
2
and H
2
O in the process gas, then the ratio
of CO to H
2
in the TGCU Reactor effluent should remain fairly constant as
long as the catalyst activity does not change.
Similarly, the hydrolysis of COS to convert it to H
2
S is an equilibrium
reaction. Its equilibrium constant can be expressed as:
| || |
| || | O H COS
CO S H
K
2
2 2
eq
=
Since the temperature, H
2
S concentration, H
2
O concentration, and CO
2
concentration of the TGCU Reactor outlet should all be fairly constant,
then the COS concentration of the gas leaving the TGCU Reactor should
be fairly constant.
It is for these reasons that Shell recommends using a gas chromatograph
to analyze the TGCU Reactor effluent gas for H
2
, CO, and COS on a
regular basis (once per month, for instance). Using the results of the
chromatograph analyses, the CO/H
2
ratio and the COS concentration can
be plotted over time and allow trends to be detected in the catalyst
activity.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Cleanup Page 11-186
The CO/H
2
ratio is usually plotted as PPM CO divided by % H
2
, and the
COS is usually plotted as PPM. From the discussions above, it is clear
that a trend upward in either value, CO/H
2
ratio or COS concentration,
indicates lower catalyst activity. Shell suggests planning to replace the
catalyst within a few months once either value begins to rise rapidly. Note
that the sample for the chromatograph can be taken from the gas leaving
the TGCU Quench Column, since the H
2
, CO, and COS concentrations
(on a dry basis) will be the same there as those leaving the TGCU
Reactor. Because this gas stream is cooler and contains less water, it is
often easier to sample and analyze than the TGCU Reactor effluent.
As discussed in Section 11.6.3, it is also typical to find methane and/or
methyl mercaptan in the TGCU Reactor effluent gas resulting from side
reactions between hydrogen and the COS and CS
2
produced in the
Reactor Furnace in the sulfur plant. It can be informative to record the
concentrations of CH
4
and/or CH
3
SH from the chromatographic analyses
as well. An increase in either component may indicate a loss in TGCU
catalyst activity. However, higher CH
4
and/or CH
3
SH concentrations
leaving the TGCU Reactor may also be due to higher COS/CS
2
concentrations entering the TGCU Unit due to lower catalyst activity in the
sulfur plant. In order to allow determining whether such an increase is
due to loss of activity in the sulfur plant or the TGCU Unit, it is helpful to
analyze the TGCU Reactor inlet gas periodically with the gas
chromatograph and record the amount of COS, CS
2
, and CO in the TGCU
Reactor feed. Collecting samples of this gas is somewhat more difficult
because the gas contains sulfur vapor, but the additional information
provided by analyzing this stream can be extremely helpful for monitoring
plant operations.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Page 12-1
Table of Contents
12. TAILGAS THERMAL OXIDIZER ............................................................................ 12-2
12.1 PURPOSE OF SYSTEM ..................................................................................... 12-2
12.2 SAFETY ............................................................................................................... 12-2
12.3 PROCESS DESCRIPTION .................................................................................. 12-3
12.4 EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION .............................................................................. 12-4
12.4.1 Thermal Oxidizer, A2-BA1570 ...................................................................... 12-4
12.4.2 Thermal Oxidizer Burner, A2-BA1571 .......................................................... 12-4
12.4.3 Steam Knock-out Drum, A2-FA1570 ............................................................ 12-4
12.4.4 Thermal Oxidizer Air Blower, A2-GB1570A/B .............................................. 12-4
12.4.5 Thermal Oxidizer Vent Stack, A2-ME1570 ................................................... 12-5
12.4.6 Refractory for Thermal Oxidizer, A2-MR1570 .............................................. 12-5
12.4.7 Thermal Oxidizer Waste Heat Boiler, A2-BF1570 ........................................ 12-5
12.5 INSTRUMENTATION AND CONTROL SYSTEMS ............................................. 12-7
12.5.1 Thermal Oxidizer Burner Management System ........................................... 12-7
12.5.2 Thermal Oxidizer Temperature Control ...................................................... 12-10
12.5.3 Thermal Oxidizer Excess Oxygen Control .................................................. 12-10
12.5.4 Boiler Low-Low Level S/D Transmitter Testing .......................................... 12-11
12.5.5 Thermal Oxidizer Shutdown System .......................................................... 12-13
12.6 PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND OPERATING TECHNIQUES ........................... 12-18
12.6.1 Equipment Damage .................................................................................... 12-18
12.6.2 Effect of Upstream Operations on the Thermal Oxidizer ............................ 12-21
12.6.3 "Swapping" Air Blowers During Operation .................................................. 12-23
12.6.4 Boiler Water Treatment .............................................................................. 12-24
12.7 PRECOMMISSIONING PROCEDURES ........................................................... 12-26
12.7.1 Preliminary Check-out ................................................................................ 12-26
12.7.2 Shutdown System Check-out ..................................................................... 12-27
12.7.3 Commissioning Fuel Gas, Pilot Gas, and I/A to the Process ..................... 12-28
12.8 STARTUP PROCEDURES ................................................................................ 12-33
12.8.1 Initial Firing / Refractory Cure-out ............................................................... 12-33
12.8.2 Normal Startup ........................................................................................... 12-48
12.9 SHUTDOWN PROCEDURES ........................................................................... 12-58
12.9.1 Planned Shutdown - No Entry .................................................................... 12-59
12.9.2 Planned Shutdown for Entry ....................................................................... 12-61
12.9.3 Shutting Down When Boiler Tubes Are Leaking ........................................ 12-65
12.9.4 Emergency Shutdown ................................................................................ 12-66
12.9.5 Effects of Shutdowns and Outages in Other Systems ................................ 12-69
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Page 12-2
12. TAILGAS THERMAL OXIDIZER
12.1 Purpose of System
The purpose of the Tailgas Thermal Oxidation (TTO) system is to receive the
tailgas from Sulfur Recovery Units (SRUs) or the Tailgas Cleanup Unit (TGCU),
the vapors from the Sulfur Surge Tanks, and the spent degassing air from the
Sulfur Degassing Unit (SDU), thermally incinerate all the sulfur compounds to
sulfur dioxide (SO
2
), and disperse the effluent safely to the atmosphere. The
effluent will normally contain less than 200 PPMV of SO
2
on a dry, 0% oxygen
basis. High-pressure superheated steam is produced by waste heat recovery
from the thermal oxidation process.
12.2 Safety
ALL PIPING AND VESSELS INCLUDED IN THIS UNIT EITHER CONTAIN
OR HAVE THE POTENTIAL FOR CONTAINING HAZARDOUS GASES
THAT MAY CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH. THE TWO GASES
THAT ARE MOST COMMON AND HAZARDOUS IN A TOXIC WAY ARE
HYDROGEN SULFIDE AND SULFUR DIOXIDE. CLOSE ATTENTION
SHOULD BE PAID TO THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION OF THESE
GUIDELINES AS TO THE NATURE AND ABILITY OF THESE GASES TO
CONTAMINATE OTHER ELEMENTS IN THIS UNIT.
AN EMPLOYEE'S KNOWLEDGE OF THE HAZARDOUS CHEMICALS AND
COMPOUNDS WITH WHICH HE WILL BE WORKING IS ONE OF THE
MOST BASIC PREREQUISITES FOR HIS OWN SAFETY, THE SAFETY
OF OTHERS, AND THE PROTECTION OF EQUIPMENT. ALL
EMPLOYEES SHOULD REVIEW THE "GENERAL SAFETY" SECTION
OCCASIONALLY TO REFRESH THEIR MEMORIES. NEW EMPLOYEES
SHOULD STUDY IT UNTIL THE INFORMATION IS THOROUGHLY
UNDERSTOOD. PEOPLE WHO HAVE NOT BEEN PROPERLY TRAINED
SHOULD NOT BE ALLOWED TO OPERATE OR WORK IN AND AROUND
THIS PLANT.
WARNING
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Page 12-3
12.3 Process Description
The Systems Diagram, Material Balance and Process Flow Diagram, Dwg. Nos.
507000-7000-01, and 507000-7000-10 through -11, are contained in the
"Process Flow Diagrams" Section of the Basic Engineering Package. Please
refer to these drawings to follow this description of the process.
When the TGCU is operating, the TGCU effluent containing H
2
S and COS flows
to the Thermal Oxidizer, A2-BA1570, at about 39C [102F]. When the TGCU
Unit is not in service, tailgas from each SRU containing H
2
S, SO
2
, COS, CS
2
,
and elemental sulfur flows directly to the Thermal Oxidizer at about 156C
[313F]. The spent degassing air from the Sulfur Degassing Unit and the sweep
air streams from each Sulfur Surge Tank (both containing traces of H
2
S and
sulfur vapor) are also routed to the Thermal Oxidizer. In the Thermal Oxidizer,
essentially all of the sulfur compounds are incinerated to SO
2
by the
high-temperature oxidizing atmosphere created inside the Thermal Oxidizer. In
addition, most of the carbon monoxide (CO) in the feed stream is oxidized to
carbon dioxide, resulting in very low CO emissions from the Tailgas Thermal
Oxidation system.
Heat is provided to the Thermal Oxidizer by combustion of fuel gas in the
Thermal Oxidizer Burner, A2-BA1571. Combustion air for the burner is supplied
by the Thermal Oxidizer Air Blower, A2-GB1570A/B. The fuel gas flow rate is
adjusted to maintain the furnace temperature at 816C [1500F] to ensure
complete incineration of the sulfur compounds and carbon monoxide in the feed
to the Thermal Oxidizer.
The effluent from the Thermal Oxidizer flows to the Thermal Oxidizer Waste
Heat Boiler, A2-BF1570. The gas is cooled to about 288C [550F] as it
generates and superheats steam at 45.0 kg/cm
2
(g) [640 PSIG], which is
exported to the HP steam header at about 400C [752F] for use as motive
steam to the Sulfur Pit Ejector and for use elsewhere in the refinery. (Note that
the HP steam produced in each SRU is also superheated in this boiler by
combining it with the steam this boiler generates.) The cooled effluent is then
dispersed to the atmosphere from the top of the Thermal Oxidizer Vent Stack,
A2-ME1570.
Operating Guidelines Samsung Total Petrochemicals Co., Ltd.
Fall 2011 Daesan, Korea
SULFUR BLOCK
Issued 30 August 2011 Tailgas Thermal Oxidation Page 12-4
12.4 Equipment Description
12.4.1 Thermal Oxidizer, A2-BA1570
The Thermal Oxidizer is a non-catalytic thermal incineration chamber.
The furnace shell is internally lined with refractory insulation to protect it
against the extreme process temperatures inside. The maximum
operating temperature is about 1000C. Although the furnace can
withstand short excursions above this temperature, prolonged operation
above this temperature can damage the refractory or the downstream
boiler.
12.4.2 Thermal Oxidizer Burner, A2-BA1571
This burner is specifically designed to burn fuel gas to provide the heat
input for the Thermal Oxidizer. The burner assembly consists of the main
fuel gas burner tip, a pilot, two flame scanners, two viewports, and
specially designed air distribution baffles to effect proper combustion.
This complete unit is installed in the front of the Thermal Oxidizer.
The StackMatch